Loading...
7413 - Plans VOL 1 - 2019 Intersection ImpDOME SUN VALLEYVIEWYUCCA VALLEY HILTON I NGHA MKCUBROYAL ACRES Y OR K HARTLEE FIELD WOODLANDHILLSGOLDENO A K BEND JUPITER APOLLO PERSHING JUNO TITANREDSTONEATLASNEPTUNE SELENE HERCULES DENTONWINDSOR ORR CORONDO CORDOVABELL HENRYBOLIVER Evers Park STROUD PRAIRIE INDUSTRIALPECAN OAK HICKORY AUSTINCEDARWALNUT PEARL PARKWAYBOLIVER WITHERS TEXASBELLSAWYER AUSTINOAKLANDCOLLEGE SCHMITZ OWENS FOREST OAK LAWN PEACH HERITAGE WOODLAND Texas Womans University THIRD FIRST ELM LOCUSTEVERS SILVER KINGS ROW SALADO KINGSTON TRACE GREEN OAKS LA PALOMA QUAIL RID GEWINDSOR VICTORIA HILLCRUHC HEATHERAVONERVDO EMERSONHA NOVERARCHERT REE I NGBURN FOXCROFT MILL POND CHEBI FREEDOMOLDNORTHCooper LOCHLEYWILLIAMSBURG MISTYWOOD NOTTINGHAMLAURELWOODJAMESTOWNParkROYALWOODHAVENWOODEKAY GREENWOOD GLENWOODSHERWOODCLOVER ROBINWOODLIVE OAK MOHICAN CREEK SHAWNEETWILIGHT LANEBELLAIREBOBOLINK HUMMINGBIRD BLUEBIRDMOCKINGBIRDORIOLE MEADOWLARK WOODTHRUSH KINGFISHER CARDINALPAISLEY AUDRALAGUNA SIERRA MANHATTEN WINDSOR BLUE- BONNETSTUART SHERMANWILSONW OODBRIGHT- WOOD OAKRIDGEDRIFTWOOD CHISHOLM LINWOOD GREENWOOD CRESTWOODNORTHWOODCHERRYWOODSAULESNWO BR ROBERTS UNIVERSITY Texas Womans Golf Course RUDDELLMINGO CHOCTAW SEMINOLE REDWOODTYLER WAYNEBOYD SNYDERMOZINGOLATTIMORE AUDRA OAK TREE WHITE OAK MEADOW OAKAUTUMN OAKPINOAKLATTIMOREWILLISMAY TEXAS BRADSHAWCRAWFORDWOODDAVISRUDDELL HETTIEJANNIEDAVIS WOODFORDMULKEYROSEOakwood Cemetery RUDDELLWOODMC KINNEYFRAMEULANDYELLOWSTONEKAYEWOODBELL FOXWOODS OLYMPIAWOLF- TRAP ASPEN WELLINGTONSTRATFORD PICKWICK CAMBRIDGE OLD ORCHARDBROKE BOWWINDYHILLEMERSON CRAIGMISTY WOOD BRAIRWOODBRITTANY TERRY BEVERLY ANYSA HOWARDLATTIMORE CHISTOPHER BARNES MACK LEE MACKPAISLEY WESTONPACE AUDRA WINDBREAK SILVER DOME Park Mack1.52.2 0.1 1.72.4 2.6 1.42.31.3 0.60.1 0.10.11.00.7HARTLEE COURT FARRISFARRIS77 377 380377 OAKSHIRE Pop 66,276 DENTON Park Center Civic Park Phoenix Park Woodrow Park MilamTREEOAKMcKINNEY 2164 2164 426 428 288 288 428 LONG NOT TI NGHAMS TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJSTSCALE:10160405.tbl1:1PENTABLE:1:42:29 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR SHEET LIST VOLUME 1 VOLUME 3 VOLUME 1 SITE 1-3 CROSS SECTIONS EPIC EC(9)-16 EC(1)-16 THRU EC(3)-16 TXDOT STANDARDS (TEMPORARY EROSION) SITE 1-3 EROSION CONTROL PLANS TS-000A THRU TS-006 CITY OF DENTON- STANDARD DETAILS (SIGNAL) RVSD-18 (DAL) PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEAD DETAILS (DAL) TRAFFIC SIGNAL HEAD DETAIL (DAL) WZ(BTS-1)-13 MA-DPD-12 TS-CF-04 CFA-12 SNS-95 LUM-A-12 MA-D-12 MA-C(ILSN)-12 LMA(1)-12(DAL) THRU LMA(4)-12(DAL) ED(8)-14 THRU ED(9)-14 ED(1)-14 THRU ED(6)-14 LMA(5)-12(DAL) TS-FD-12 (DAL) TXDOT STANDARDS (SIGNAL) SITE 1-3 SIGNAL LAYOUTS & DETAILS SITE 1-3 SIGNAL GENERAL NOTES TSR (4) - 13 TSR (3) - 13 SMD(TWT)-08 SMD(SLIP-1)-08 THRU SMD(SLIP-3)-08 SMD(GEN)-08 X1-X15 181 178-180 175-177 172-174 152-171 151 150 149 147-148 146 145 144 143 142 141 140 136-139 134-135 128-133 127 126 112-125 111 110 109 108 105 - 107 104 VOLUME 2FINAL PLANS SUBMITTAL JULY, 2020 PROJECT # 188282 LOOP 288 & McKINNEY ST (SITE 5) McKINNEY ST (SITE 4) HERCULES LANE & LOCUST STREET (SITE 3) SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 (SITE 2) NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE (SITE 1) WATER DETAILS WASTEWATER DETAILS DRIVE APPROACH DETAILS COD SIDEWALK DETAILS CITY OF DENTON- STANDARD DETAILS (UTILITY) W50 W49 W48 W47 SMD(FRP)-08 PM(1)-20 THRU PM(3)-20 TXDOT STANDARDS (SIGNING AND STRIPING PLANS) SITE 1-3 SIGNING AND STRIPING PLANS SIDEWALK DETAILS DRIVEWAY APPROACH DETAIL CURB & GUTTER/JOINT INTERSECTION/HEADER DETAIL CONCRETE PAVING CROSS SECTION DETAILS CITY OF DENTON- STANDARD DETAILS (ROADWAY) SSTR TE(HMAC)-11 SSCB(1F)-10 SGT(10S)31-16 TRF REPCP-14 PED-18 JS-14 GF(31)TR TL3-19 GF(31)MS-19 CRR CRCP(1)-20 CPCD-14 CCCG-12 TXDOT STANDARDS (ROADWAY) SITE 1-3 GRADING PLANS SITE 1- 3 ROADWAY PLANS SITE 1-3 REMOVALS PLANS WZ(UL)-13 WZ(STPM)-13 WZ(RCD)-13 WZ(BTS)-13 WZ(BRK)-13 TCP(7-1)-13 TCP(6-2)-12 THRU TCP(6-5)-12 TCP(2-1)-18 THRU TCP(2-4)-18 SSCB(2)-10 SLED-19 CSB(1)-10 BC(1)-14 1 THRU BC(12)-14 ABSORB(M)-19 TXDOT STANDARDS (TRAFFIC) SITE 1-3 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLANS CONSTRUCTION NARRATIVE SITE 1-3 TCP GENERAL NOTES & SITE 1-3 TYPICAL SECTIONS SITE 1-3 SIGNAL QUANTITY SUMMARY SITE 1-3 ROADWAY QUANTITY SUMMARY COVER SHEET 103 100 - 102 93 - 99 92 91 90 89 87-88 86 85 84 83 81 - 82 77 - 80 76 74-75 73 72 70 - 71 68 - 69 67 64 - 66 57 - 63 50 - 56 49 48 47 45 -46 44 43 39 - 42 35 - 38 33 - 34 32 30 - 31 18 - 29 17 12-16 11 6-10 4-5 2-3 1 SMD (GEN)-08 SMD(SLIP-1)-08 TO SMD(SLIP-3)-08 TSR(3)-13, TSR(4)-13 PM(1)-12 TO PM(3)-12 MISC. PIPE DETAILS CGT-POC PCO PDD PJB PB PED-18 CCCG-12 REPCP-14 JS-14 CRCP (1)-20 TCP(2-1)-18,TCP(2-5)-18 BC(1)-14 1 THRU BC(12)-14 TXDOT STANDARDS (UTILITY) SITE 5 DRAINAGE PLAN SITE 5 PAVEMENT MARKING & SIGNS SITE 5 DRIVEWAY PLAN & PROFILE SITE 5 TURN LANE PAVEMNT SITE 5 REMOVALS COVER SHEET SITE 4 TXDOT STANDARDS SITE 4 CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS SITE 4 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN SITE 4 PAVEMENT MARKINGS LAYOUT SITE 4 DRAINAGE CALCULATIONS SITE 4 DRAINAGE PLAN SITE 4 PAVING LAYOUT SITE 4 REMOVAL PLAN SITE 4 CONTROL SHEET SITE 4 TYPICAL SECTIONS SITE 4 QUANTITIES COVER SHEET W46 W42-W45 W41-W42 W38-W40 W37 W36 W34-W35 W33 W32 W31 W27-W30 W26 W24-W25 W23 W21-W22 W19-W20 W7-W18 W6 W5 W4 W3 W2 W1 V19-V32 V11-V18 V10 V9 V8 V7 V6 V5 V4 V3 V2 V1 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS INTERSECTION SHERMAN DR & LOOP 288 SITE 2 INTERSECTION LOCUST ST & HERCULES LN SITE 3 INTERSECTION UNIVERSITY DR NOTTINGHAM DR & SITE 1 INTERSECTION McKINNEY ST SITE 4 INTERSECTION McKINNEY ST LOOP 288 & SITE 5 8/5/2020 2 QUANTITY SUMMARY QUANTITY SHEET N.T.S. ** QUANTITES AND PLANS PROVIDED BY THE CITY OF DENTON * MODIFIED TXDOT STANDARD ITEM ITEM CITY/TXDOT DESCRIPTION UNIT QUANTITY University Nott/Sherm/ 288 Herc Locust/ St ** McKINNEY McKinney** Loop 288/ TOTAL 1 104 - 6001 REMOVING CONC (PAV)SY 100 51 17 0 0 32 2 104 - 6009 REMOVING CONC (RIPRAP)SY 552 0 552 0 0 0 3 104 - 6015 REMOVING CONC (SIDEWALKS)SY 277 120 0 25 5 127 4 104 - 6017 REMOVING CONC (DRIVEWAYS)SY 138 56 0 0 0 82 5 104 - 6022 REMOVING CONC (CURB AND GUTTER)LF 902 423 0 0 44 435 6 104 - 6037 REMOVE CONC (RAIL)LF 516 14 288 214 0 0 7 104 - 6067 REMOVING CONC (SAWCUT)LF 4661 430 2840 1391 0 0 8 110 - 6001 EXCAVATION (ROADWAY)CY 2300 181 1492 627 0 0 9 132 - 6004 EMBANKMENT (FINAL)(DENS CONT)(TY B)CY 1622 12 1177 433 0 0 10 160 - 6003 FURNISHING AND PLACING TOPSOIL (4")SY 3111 133 1650 1328 0 0 11 247 - 6231 FL BS (CMP IN PLACE)(TY A GR 1-2)(10")SY 4390 0 4390 0 0 0 12 260 - 6006 LIME TRT (EXST MATL) (6")SY 1759 178 0 1581 0 0 13 260 - 6009 LIME TRT (EXST MATL)(10")SY 463 0 0 0 0 463 14 260 - 6016 LIME (HYD, COM, OR QK(SLURRY))TON 7 1 5 1 0 1 15 260 - 6027 LIME TRT (EXST MATL)(8")SY 4802 160 4642 0 0 0 16 *305 - 6003 SALV, HAUL & STKPL RCL APH PV (VAR DEPTH)SY 4723 671 4008 0 44 0 17 *340 - 6070 1.5" D-GR HMA(SQ) TY-C SY 7970 131 7839 0 0 0 18 *340 - 6142 1.5" D-GR HMA(SQ) TY-D SY 1351 0 0 1307 44 0 19 *341 - 6003 3" D-GR HMA TY A SY 4145 0 4145 0 0 0 20 *341 - 6004 6.5" D-GR HMA TY A SY 44 0 0 0 44 0 21 *341 - 6008 6.5" D-GR HMA TY-B SY 1615 162 0 1453 0 0 22 *341 - 6009 4" D-GR HMA TY-B SY 463 0 0 0 0 463 23 360 - 6018 CONC PVMT (JOINTED - CPCD) (8")SY 216 146 70 0 0 0 24 360 - 6021 CONC PVMT (JOINTED - CPCD) (11")SY 463 0 0 0 0 463 25 420 - 6062 CL C CONC (RETAINING WALL)CY 4 0 0 0 0 4 26 420 - 6066 CL C CONC (RAIL FOUNDATION)CY 107 0 107 0 0 0 27 432 - 6045 RIPRAP (MOW STRIP)(4 IN)CY 7 0 7 0 0 0 28 432 - 6047 RIPRAP (MOW STRIP)(6 IN)CY 17 0 17 0 0 0 29 450 - 6054 RAIL (TY SSTR) (W/DRAIN SLOTS)LF 761 0 761 0 0 0 30 464 - 6003 RC PIPE (CL III)(18 IN)LF 37 0 0 0 37 0 31 464 - 6005 RC PIPE (CL III)(24 IN)LF 48 0 0 0 48 0 32 464 - 6008 RC PIPE (CL III)(36 IN)LF 8 0 0 0 8 0 33 464 - 6018 RC PIPE (CL IV)(24 IN)LF 7 0 0 0 0 7 34 464 - 6020 RC PIPE (CL IV)(36 IN)LF 14 0 0 0 0 14 35 *465 - 6209 JUNCTION BOXES, MANHOLES, AND INLETS (10' INLET)EA 1 0 0 0 1 0 36 *465 - 6225 JUNCTION BOXES, MANHOLES, AND INLETS (8'x6' JUNCTION BOX)EA 1 0 0 0 1 0 37 *465 - 6226 JUNCTION BOXES, MANHOLES, AND INLETS (8'x8' JUNCTION BOX)EA 1 0 0 0 1 0 38 465 - 6393 INLET(COMPL)(RECESS CURB)(10')EA 1 0 0 0 0 1 39 465 - 6399 INLET(COMPL)(CURB)(20')EA 1 0 0 0 0 1 40 496 - 6002 REMOV STR (INLET)EA 2 0 0 0 0 2 41 496 - 6007 REMOV STR (PIPE)LF 4 0 0 0 0 4 42 500 - 6001 MOBILIZATION LS 1 0 0 0 0 0 43 502 - 6001 BARRICADES, SIGNS AND TRAFFIC HANDLING MO 4 0 0 0 0 0 44 506 - 6002 ROCK FILTER DAMS (INSTALL) (TY 2)LF 50 0 30 20 0 0 45 506 - 6011 ROCK FILTER DAMS (REMOVE)LF 50 0 30 20 0 0 46 506 - 6020 CONSTRUCTION EXITS (INSTALL) (TY 1)SY 390 78 156 156 0 0 47 506 - 6024 CONSTRUCTION EXITS (REMOVE)SY 390 78 156 156 0 0 48 506 - 6041 BIODEG EROSN CONT LOGS (INSTL) (12")LF 3571 268 1965 1338 0 0 49 506 - 6043 BIODEG EROSN CONT LOGS (REMOVE)LF 3571 268 1965 1338 0 0 50 512 - 6089 PTB(FRN&INSTL)(SSCB OR CSB)(TY1)OR(STL)LF 1139 0 1139 0 0 0 51 512 - 6091 PTB(REMOVE)(SSCB OR CSB)(TY1)OR(STL)LF 1139 0 1139 0 0 0 52 529 - 6008 CONC CURB & GUTTER (TY II)LF 1089 426 0 139 89 435 53 530 - 6004 DRIVEWAYS (CONC)SY 138 38 0 0 0 100 54 531 - 6001 CONC SIDEWALKS (4")SY 317 107 0 98 0 112 55 540 - 6006 MTL BEAM GD FEN TRANS (THRIE-BEAM)EA 2 0 2 0 0 0 56 544 - 6001 GUARDRAIL END TREATMENT (INSTALL)EA 2 0 2 0 0 0 57 545 - 6005 CRASH CUSH ATTEN (REMOVE)EA 2 0 2 0 0 0 58 545 - 6019 CRASH CUSH ATTEN (INSTL)(S)(N)(TL3)EA 2 0 2 0 0 0 59 636 - 6001 ALUMINUM SIGNS (TY A)SF 91 31 24 0 0 36 60 644 - 6001 IN SM RD SN SUP&AM TY10BWG(1)SA(P)EA 8 3 3 0 0 2 61 644 - 6028 IN SM RD SN SUP&AM TYS80(1)SA(P-BM)EA 2 0 0 0 0 2 62 644 - 6068 RELOCATE SM RD SN SUP&AM TY 10BWG EA 5 0 4 1 0 0 63 644 - 6070 RELOCATE SM RD SN SUP&AM TY S80 EA 5 0 5 0 0 0 64 644 - 6075 RELOCATE SM RD SN SUP&AM(SIGN ONLY)EA 3 0 0 0 0 3 65 644 - 6076 REMOVE SM RD SN SUP&AM EA 10 4 4 1 0 1 66 666 - 6011 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)4"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 7781 412 3463 2535 611 760 67 666 - 6029 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)8"(DOT)(090MIL)LF 334 294 0 0 40 0 68 666 - 6035 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)8"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 1503 387 572 216 328 0 69 666 - 6041 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)12"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 849 665 0 104 0 80SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:42:31 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 3 QUANTITY SUMMARY N.T.S. QUANTITY SHEET ITEM ITEM CITY/TXDOT DESCRIPTION UNIT QUANTITY University Nott/Sherm/ 288 Herc Locust/ St ** McKINNEY McKinney** Loop 288/ TOTAL 70 666 - 6047 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)24"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 472 192 206 38 36 0 71 666 - 6053 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(ARROW)(090MIL)EA 15 4 6 2 3 0 72 666 - 6077 REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(WORD)(090MIL)EA 15 4 6 2 3 0 73 666 - 6098 REF PAV MRK TY I(W)18"(YLD TRI)(090MIL)EA 24 0 0 0 0 24 74 666 - 6146 REFL PAV MRK TY I (Y)24"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 1144 0 515 555 74 0 75 *666 - 6131 REFL PAV MRK TY I (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090MIL)LF 6176 545 2302 2434 895 0 76 672 - 6007 REFL PAV MRKR TY I-C EA 108 39 49 14 0 6 77 672 - 6009 REFL PAV MRKR TY II-A-A EA 416 0 216 200 0 0 78 677 - 6001 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (4")LF 17731 294 5735 7503 4199 0 79 677 - 6003 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (8")LF 1306 349 188 667 102 0 80 677 - 6005 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (12")LF 665 665 0 0 0 0 81 677 - 6007 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (24")LF 689 138 219 332 0 0 82 677 - 6008 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (ARROW)EA 8 4 4 0 0 0 83 677 - 6012 ELIM EXT PAV MRK & MRKS (WORD)EA 3 1 2 0 0 0 84 678 - 6001 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (4")LF 20843 1796 8283 7603 2401 760 85 678 - 6004 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (8")LF 1543 387 572 216 368 0 86 678 - 6006 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (12")LF 849 665 0 104 0 80 87 678 - 6008 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (24")LF 1616 192 721 593 110 0 88 678 - 6009 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (ARROW)EA 15 4 6 2 3 0 89 678 - 6016 PAV SURF PREP FOR MRK (WORD)EA 15 4 6 2 3 0 90 3002 - 6001 MEMBRANE UNDERSEAL GAL 3293 75 1907 1270 41 0 91 *7049 - 6024 PLUG 24" RCP PIPE EA 1 0 0 0 0 1 ** QUANTITES AND PLANS PROVIDED BY THE CITY OF DENTON * MODIFIED TXDOT STANDARD SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:42:33 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 4 QUANTITY SUMMARY 1SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:37 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ITEMS TO BE PROVIDED BY CONTRACTOR ITEM BID CODE DESCRIPTION UNIT QUANTITY TOTAL UNIVERSITY DRIVE NOTTINGHAM DRIVE AND LOOP 288 SHERMAN DRIVE AND 1 416-6003 DRILL SHAFT (30 IN)LF 44 0 44 2 416-6004 DRILL SHAFT (36 IN)LF 39 13 26 3 416-6006 DRILL SHAFT (48 IN)LF 22 22 0 4 618-6023 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (2")LF 160 115 45 5 618-6029 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (3")LF 555 55 500 6 618-6030 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (3") (BORE)LF 580 195 385 7 618-6033 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (4")LF 525 15 510 8 618-6034 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (4") (BORE)LF 385 0 385 9 618-6037 CONDT (PVC) (SCH 40) (6")LF 5 0 5 10 620-6009 ELEC CONDR (NO.6) BARE LF 2220 405 1815 11 620-6010 ELEC CONDR (NO.6) INSULATED LF 380 0 380 12 621-6001 TRAY CABLE (3 CONDR) (14 AWG) - LUMINAIRES AND ILSN LF 6625 1095 5530 13 621-6002 TRAY CABLE (3 CONDR) (12 AWG) - APS PUSHBUTTONS LF 1800 1800 0 14 624-6009 GROUND BOX TY D (162922)EA 3 3 0 15 624-6010 GROUND BOX TY D (162922) W/ARPON EA 8 0 8 16 680-6002 INSTALL HWY TRF SIG (ISOLATED)EA 2 1 1 17 *INSTALL LUMINAIRE HEAD LED (400 W EQUIVALENT) (FULL CUTOFF)EA 2 2 0 18 *INSTALL LUMINAIRE HEAD LED (240 W EQUIVALENT)EA 6 0 6 19 *ALUMINUM SIGNS SF 120 60 60 20 *WIND DAMPNER EA 3 1 2 21 *+INSTALLATION OF MESH RADIO ASSEMBLY WITH ANTENNA(S)EA 1 1 0 22 *+INSTALL CAT5E-RADIO CABLE LF 145 145 0 23 682-6001 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (GREEN)EA 18 4 14 24 682-6002 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (GREEN ARROW)EA 6 4 2 25 682-6003 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (YELLOW)EA 18 4 14 26 682-6004 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (YELLOW ARROW)EA 12 8 4 27 682-6005 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (RED)EA 18 4 14 28 682-6006 VEHICLE SIGNAL SECTION (12 IN) LED (RED ARROW)EA 6 4 2 29 682-6018 PED SIG SEC (LED)(COUNTDOWN)EA 8 8 0 30 682-6023 BACKPLATE (12 IN) (3 SEC)EA 18 4 14 31 682-6024 BACKPLATE (12 IN) (4 SEC)EA 6 4 2 32 684-6033 TRF CBL (TY A) (14 AWG) (7 CONDR)LF 2970 2220 750 33 684-6047 TRF CBL (TY A) (14 AWG) (21 CONDR)LF 2620 505 2115 34 686-6036 INS TRF SIG PL AM(S)1 ARM(32')LUM&ILSN EA 4 0 4 35 686-6048 INS TRF SIG PL AM(S)1 ARM(44')LUM&ILSN EA 2 0 2 36 686-6052 INS TRF SIG PL AM(S)1 ARM(48')LUM&ILSN EA 1 1 0 37 686-6060 INS TRF SIG PL AM(S)1 ARM(55')LUM&ILSN EA 1 1 0 38 687-6001 PED POLE ASSEMBLY EA 6 6 0 39 **DRILL SHAFT (TRF SIG POLE) (24 IN)LF 30 30 0 40 690-6007 REPLACE OF GROUND BOXES EA 3 3 0 41 690-6024 REMOVAL OF SIGNAL HEAD ASSM EA 2 2 0 42 690-6025 REPLACE OF SIGNAL HEAD ASSM EA 4 4 0 43 690-6028 REPLACE OF SIGNAL RELATED SIGNS EA 2 2 0 44 690-6030 REMOVAL OF PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTONS EA 1 1 0 45 690-6031 REPLACE OF PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTONS EA 1 1 0 46 690-6100 REMOVE TRAFFIC SIGNAL EA 2 2 0 47 690-6136 REMOVE RADAR VEHICLE DETECTION SYSTEM EA 1 1 0 48 6058-6001 BBU SYSTEM (EXTERNAL BATT CABINET)EA 1 0 1 49 6292-6002 RVDS(ADVANCE DETECTION ONLY)EA 6 2 4 50 6292-6005 RVDS(ADVANCE DET ONLY)(INSTALL ONLY)EA 6 2 4 51 ***RADAR ADVANCE DETECTION CABLE LF 2095 485 1610 NOTE: 1. * SUBSIDIARY TO ITEM 680 2. ** SUBSIDIARY ITEM 687-6001 3. *** SUBSIDIARY TO ITEM 6292 4. + COORDINATE WITH CITY TO OBTAIN SPECIFICATIONS 08/05/2020 5 QUANTITY SUMMARY 2SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:38 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ITEMS TO BE PROVIDED BY CITY OF DENTON ITEM DESCRIPTION UNIT QUANTITY TOTAL UNIVERSITY DRIVE NOTTINGHAM DRIVE AND LOOP 288 SHERMAN DRIVE AND 1 CABINET BREAKAWAY FOUNDATION EA 1 0 1 2 CABINET ASSY HENKE TS1 P44 EA 1 0 1 3 CONTROLLER, COBALT EA 1 0 1 4 DETECTOR, OPTICOM CABLE LF 1910 440 1470 5 DETECTOR OPTICOM #764 EA 4 2 2 6 DETECTOR OPTICOM #721 EA 2 0 2 7 SIGN, ILSN CLEAN PROF DS EA 8 2 6 8 PELCO ILSN MOUNT EA 8 2 6 9 CABLE, CAT 5E 4PR 24AWG LF 920 150 770 10 GRIDSMART SINGLE CAMERA/DUAL PROCESSOR FISH-EYE CAMERA SYSTEM EA 3 1 2 11 POLARA NAVIGATOR PB STATION EA 8 8 0 12 POLARA NAVIGATOR CCU EA 1 1 0 13 ILLUMINATED STREET NAME SIGNS EA 8 2 6 NOTE: 1. SEE CITY OF DENTON TRAFFIC STANDARDS, NOTES AND SPECIFICATIONS FOR MATERIAL AND SIGNAL EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS. 08/05/2020 6 6" MONOLITHIC CURB 8" LIME TREATMENT 8" CONCRETE PAVEMENT JOINTED CPCD EXIST 8" LIME TREATMENT EXIST 8" CONCRETE PAVEMENT LEGEND A B C D E F G H I J K L TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL - SSTR 4" CONCRETE RIPRAP 6" TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 6" LIME SUBGRADE 2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) 4 1/2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) EXIST 6" LIME SUBGRADE EXIST 2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) EXIST 4 1/2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) EXIST 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) AA BB CC DD EE EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE C&G EX 2' C&G EX 2' 11'11'11'11' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) EX LANE LANE PR TURNEX LANE PR LANE PR LANENOTT & UNIVWIDENING PR 0'-11' VARSBNB NOTTINGHAM RD STA 100+92 TO STA 102+23 E B C D E F G H I C&G PR 2' 0'-11' VAR C&G EX 2' 11'11'11'11' [ XNOTT HOR 1" = 20' VER 1"=N/A 2010 TYPICAL SECTIONSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:1:42:35 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE C&G EX 2' C&G EX 2' 11'11'11'11' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANEPR LANE PR LANE EX LANE SB NB NOTTINGHAM RD CA B D [ XNOTT C&G EX 2' 11'11'11'11'C&G EX 2' STA 104+58 TO STA 106+44 EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE C&G EX 1' C&G EX 1' 12'11'11'12' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) EX LANE LANE PR TURNEX LANE PR LANE PR LANE WIDENING PR SB NB NOTTINGHAM RD STA 102+23 TO STA 104+58 AA BB CC DD EE C&G PR 1' 0'-12' VAR C&G EX 1' 11'11'11'12' [ XNOTT 0'-11' VAR 5. SEE MISC PAVING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REMOVAL LINE. 4. EXISTING HMAC & SUBGRADE SHALL BE CUT TO NEAT UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 3. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE OF CURB OR FACE OF RAIL A PROJECTION OF THE EXISTING CROSS SLOPE. 2. PROPOSED PAVEMENT WIDENING CROSS SLOPE SHALL BE LIMITS FOR CURB, RAIL, MBGF,MOW STRIP, RIRPRAP ETC.. 1. SEE ROADWAY PLANS FOR EXACT EDGE CONDITION STATION NOTES: NOTES FOR TYPICALS EX LANEEX PARK EX LANE EX PARK VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) EX LANEPR PARK PR LANE PR PARK PR LANE 22'-0' VAR 11' STA 106+44 TO STA 108+01 NOTTINGHAM RD SB NB LEGEND CA B D [ XNOTT C&G EX 2' C&G EX 2' 11'11'11'11' C&G EX 2' 0'-11' VAR 11'11' 0'-11' VAR C&G EX 2' TYPICAL SECTIONS 8/5/2020 7 LEGEND A B C D E F G H I J K L TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL - SSTR 4" CONCRETE RIPRAP 6" TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 8" LIME SUBGRADE 10" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) 3" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE A) 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) PAVEMENT UNDERSEAL EXIST 8" LIME SUBGRADE EXIST 12" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) EXIST 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE SHLD EX 2' SHLD EX 2' 11'11'11'11' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR WIDENING EX LANE LANE PR TURN 11'-22' VAR. EX LANE PR LANE PR LANESHERM & 288 SHERMAN DR STA 56+00 TO STA 57+35 SB NB CA B E F G H [ XSHERM D PR SHLD 0'-10' VAR 0'-11' VAR 11'11'11'11'SHLD EX 2' HOR 1" = 20' VER 1"=N/A 2010 TYPICAL SECTIONSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:1:42:39 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE SHLD EX 2' SHLD EX 2' 11'11'11'11' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANE PR LANE PR LANE PR WIDENINGPR WIDENING PR LANE LANE PR TURN 0'-21' VAR. SB NB SHERMAN DR STA 59+64 TO STA 60+75 MEDIAN CE B G H E F H E F G 94' SPAN LENGTH [ XSHERM 22'-32' VAR. DD PR SHLD 0'-10' VAR PR SHLD 0'-10' VAR 11'11'11'0'-14' VAR. 11'11' 5. SEE MISC PAVING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REMOVAL LINE. 4. EXISTING HMAC & SUBGRADE SHALL BE CUT TO NEAT UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 3. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE OF CURB OR FACE OF RAIL A PROJECTION OF THE EXISTING CROSS SLOPE. 2. PROPOSED PAVEMENT WIDENING CROSS SLOPE SHALL BE LIMITS FOR CURB, RAIL, MBGF,MOW STRIP, RIRPRAP ETC.. 1. SEE ROADWAY PLANS FOR EXACT EDGE CONDITION STATION NOTES: NOTES FOR TYPICALS EX LANEEX LANE EX LANE EX LANE SHLD EX 2' SHLD EX 2' 11'11'11'11' VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANE PR LANE PR LANE PR WIDENINGPR WIDENING PR LANE LANE PR TURN 0'-21' VAR. SB NB SHERMAN DR STA 57+35 TO STA 59+64 MEDIAN CA B G H E F H E F G [ XSHERM 22'-32' VAR. D 0'-10' VAR PR SHLDPR SHLD 0'-10' VAR 11'11'11'0'-14' VAR. 11'11' TYPICAL SECTIONS SHEET 1 OF 3 8/5/2020 8 LEGEND A B C D E F G H I J K L TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL - SSTR 4" CONCRETE RIPRAP 6" TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 8" LIME SUBGRADE 10" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) 3" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE A) 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) PAVEMENT UNDERSEAL EXIST 8" LIME SUBGRADE EXIST 12" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) EXIST 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANEPR LANEPR LANEPR SHLD PR SHLD PR WIDENING PR LANE LANE PR TURN EX LANEEX SHLD EX SHLD 0'-23' VAR. 0'-12' VAR. 0'-14' VAR. 10'11'11'10' SHERMAN DR STA 66+00 TO STA 70+25 SB NB CA B G H E FE F G H MEDIAN MEDIAN WIDENING PR [ XSHERM DD 10' 0'-11' VAR.0'-11' VAR. 11'3'-14' VAR. 11' 0'-11' VAR. 10' HOR 1" = 20' VER 1"=N/A 2010 TYPICAL SECTIONSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:1:42:42 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANEPR LANEPR LANE PR WIDENING PR WIDENING PR LANE LANE PR TURN EX LANEEX SHLD EX SHLD 30'-32' VAR. 18'-21' VAR. 10'11'9'-14' VAR. 11'10' STA 64+92 TO STA 66+00 SHERMAN DR SB NB C B G H E F H E F G MEDIAN MEDIAN [ XSHERM A D D 11'11'11'14'11'11' PR SHLD 7'-10' VAR PR SHLD 8'-10' VAR 5. SEE MISC PAVING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REMOVAL LINE. 4. EXISTING HMAC & SUBGRADE SHALL BE CUT TO NEAT UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 3. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE OF CURB OR FACE OF RAIL A PROJECTION OF THE EXISTING CROSS SLOPE. 2. PROPOSED PAVEMENT WIDENING CROSS SLOPE SHALL BE LIMITS FOR CURB, RAIL, MBGF,MOW STRIP, RIRPRAP ETC.. 1. SEE ROADWAY PLANS FOR EXACT EDGE CONDITION STATION NOTES: NOTES FOR TYPICALSEX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANEPR LANEPR LANE PR WIDENING PR WIDENING PR LANE EX LANE EX SHLD 20'-21' VAR. 20'-21' VAR. TURN LANE MEDIAN/ TURN LANE PR CONT. 11'12'17'-19' VAR. 11'EX SHLD 7' 12'7' SB NB SHERMAN DR STA 60+75 TO STA 63+80 CE B G H E F H E F G J K J K *VARIES 2:1 MAX3:1 USUAL 4'4' 2:12:1 M AX3:1 U SU A LEX. COLUMN*(6:1 USUAL, 3:1 MAX)TYPICAL16'TYPICAL16'EX. COLUMN94' SPAN LENGTH [ XSHERM LL D D 9'-10' VAR PR SHLDPR SHLD 9'-10' VAR 11'11'14'11'11' EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) PR LANEPR LANEPR LANE PR WIDENING PR WIDENING PR LANE LANE PR TURN EX LANEEX SHLD EX SHLD 30'-32' VAR. 18'-21' VAR. 10'11'9'-14' VAR. 11'10' STA 63+80 TO STA 64+92 SHERMAN DR SB NB CE B G H E F H E F G MEDIAN MEDIAN [ XSHERM DD 7'-10' VAR PR SHLDPR SHLD 8'-10' VAR 11'11'11'14'11'11' SHEET 2 OF 3 8/5/2020 9 LEGEND A B C D E F G H I J K L TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL - SSTR 4" CONCRETE RIPRAP 6" TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 8" LIME SUBGRADE 10" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) 3" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE A) 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) PAVEMENT UNDERSEAL EXIST 8" LIME SUBGRADE EXIST 12" FLEX BASE (TYPE A) EXIST 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE C) HOR 1" = 20' VER 1"=N/A 2010 TYPICAL SECTIONSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:1:42:46 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 5. SEE MISC PAVING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REMOVAL LINE. 4. EXISTING HMAC & SUBGRADE SHALL BE CUT TO NEAT UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 3. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE OF CURB OR FACE OF RAIL A PROJECTION OF THE EXISTING CROSS SLOPE. 2. PROPOSED PAVEMENT WIDENING CROSS SLOPE SHALL BE LIMITS FOR CURB, RAIL, MBGF,MOW STRIP, RIRPRAP ETC.. 1. SEE ROADWAY PLANS FOR EXACT EDGE CONDITION STATION NOTES: NOTES FOR TYPICALS EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) EX LANEEX SHLD EX SHLD SHERMAN DR STA 70+25 TO STA 71+40 SB NB C B [ XSHERM A 10'11' MEDIAN 0'-3' VAR. 11'10' EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) CA B SHLD EX 2' 12'12'SHLD EX 7' EX LANE EB 288 EXIT RAMP WB 288 EXIT RAMP [ XWB288EXIT[ XEB288EXIT EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) CA B EB 288 ENTRANCE RAMP WB 288 ENTRANCE RAMP SHLD EX 7' 12'12'SHLD EX 2' EX LANE [ XWB288ENTR[ XEB288ENTR SHEET 3 OF 3 8/5/2020 10 LEGEND A B C D E F G H I J K L TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL - SSTR 4" CONCRETE RIPRAP 6" TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 6" LIME SUBGRADE 2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) 4 1/2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE D) EXIST 6" LIME SUBGRADE EXIST 2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) EXIST 4 1/2" ASPHALT BASE (TYPE B) EXIST 1 1/2" ASPHALT PAVING (TYPE D)HERCULES & LOCUST EX LANE EX LANE EX LANE STA 101+85 TO STA 106+85 SB NB CA B D LOCUST ST SHLD EX 2' 11'11' SHLD EX 2' MEDIAN 4'-15' VAR. E FG H FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 PR WIDENING STA 110+33 TO STA 115+04 0'-11' SHLD VAR [ XLOCUS SHLD PR 4' 0'-11' VAR. 11' SHLD EX 2' PR LANE 0'-11' VAR HOR 1" = 20' VER 1"=N/A 2010 TYPICAL SECTIONSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:1:42:50 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS HERCULES & LOCUST EX LANE EX LANE EX LANE PR LANE STA 106+85 TO STA 108+59 SB NB CA B D LOCUST ST SHLD EX 2' 11'11' SHLD EX 2' E FG H FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 PR WIDENING SHLD PR 4' 11'11'11' SHLD EX 2' LANE PR TURN 15' [ XLOCUS EX LANE EX LANE EX LANE PR LANE STA 108+59 TO STA 110+33 SB NB CA B D LOCUST ST SHLD EX 2' 11'11' SHLD EX 2' E FG H FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) VARIES (0.02 PR WIDENING SHLD PR 4' 11'11'11' SHLD EX 2' LANE PR TURN 15' [ XLOCUS SB NB EX LANE EX LANE VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL)VARIES (0.02 FT/FT USUAL) STA 50+00 TO STA 54+61 C D A B C&G EX 2' 14'7'7'14'C&G EX 2' LANE EX TURN HERCULES LN [ XHERCU 5. SEE MISC PAVING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REMOVAL LINE. 4. EXISTING HMAC & SUBGRADE SHALL BE CUT TO NEAT UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 3. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE OF CURB OR FACE OF RAIL A PROJECTION OF THE EXISTING CROSS SLOPE. 2. PROPOSED PAVEMENT WIDENING CROSS SLOPE SHALL BE LIMITS FOR CURB, RAIL, MBGF,MOW STRIP, RIRPRAP ETC.. 1. SEE ROADWAY PLANS FOR EXACT EDGE CONDITION STATION NOTES: NOTES FOR TYPICALS TYPICAL SECTIONS 8/5/2020 11 SCALE NOT TO SCALE TCP GENERAL NOTES: NARRATIVE: CONSTRUCTION PHASE: SITE 1 NOTTINGHAM DR & UNIVERISTY DR INTERSECTION CONSTRUCTION PHASE: SITE 2 SHERMAN DR & LOOP 288 INTERSECTION CONSTRUCTION PHASE: SITE 3 HERCULES LN & LOCUST ST INTERSECTION 11. TCP PHASING ASSUMES THAT ALL UTILITY RELOCATIONS ARE COMPLETE PRIOR TO START OF ROADWAY CONSTRUCTION. AND DRIVEWAYS, UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 10. MAINTAIN PROPERTY OWNER ACCESS ACROSS WORK ZONES AT ALL TIMES. PLASTIC DRUMS WILL BE USED TO DELINEATE INTERSECTIONS 9. EXISTING SIGNAL AND ITS NETWORK SHALL BE KEPT OPERATIONAL AT ALL TIMES. EXISTING OR PROPOSED BARRIER ENDS MUST BE PROTECTED FROM ONCOMING TRAFFIC BY AN ACCEPTABLE ATTENUATOR. BARRIER TO NEEDED LOCATIONS DURING THE TRANSITION OF WORK FROM ONE SEGMENT TO THE NEXT. ANY AND ALL EXPOSED 8. PROTECT TRAFFIC AND WORK AREAS WHEN CONSTRUCTING ACCESS POINTS. WHEN SHIFTING COMPENSATION WILL BE ALLOWED. 7. COORDINATION WITH OTHER CONTRACTOR SHALL BE CONSIDERED SUBSIDIARY TO THE CONTRACT AND NO ADDITIONAL OF THE ENGINEER. CONTROL SEQUENCING IN PROPER ORDER TO BEST ACCOMMODATE TRAFFIC AND TO THE SATISFACTION INVOLVED SHALL COORDINATE WITH ONE ANOTHER IN AN ACCEPTABLE MANNER TO PERFORM CONSTRUCTION AND TRAFFIC 6. OTHER SECTIONS OUTSIDE AND ADJACENT TO THIS CONTRACT MAY BE UNDER CONTRACT. THE CITY AND EACH CONTRACTOR BEFORE FINAL EMBANKMENT OPERATIONS BEGIN. INLET WALLS TO ALLOW FOR TEMPORARY DRAINAGE. THE FOURTH WALL SHALL ONLY BE CONSTRUCTED IMMEDIATELY INLETS THAT ARE TO BE RAISED SHALL NOT CREATE DRAINAGE OBSTRUCTIONS. ONLY RAISE THREE THE ENGINEER. ALL DRAINAGE FACILITIES INCLUDING ANY TEMPORARY PIPES SHALL BE KEPT IN GOOD CONDITION. 5. MAINTAIN DRAINAGE DURING ALL PHASES OF CONSTRUCTION IN A MANNER ACCEPTABLE TO PLACED OR HAZARD IT WAS PROTECTING HAS BEEN ELIMINATED. 4. METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE REMOVAL SHALL OCCUR ONLY AFTER PORTABLE CONCRETE TRAFFIC BARRIER HAS BEEN CONTROL PLAN SHALL BE REMOVED OR COVERED TEMPORARILY AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. 3. ANY EXISTING SIGNS INCLUDING SPEED LIMIT SIGNS THAT MAY BE IN CONFLICT WITH THE PROPOSED TRAFFIC START OF CONSTRUCTION. THIS WORK WILL BE COVERED UNDER ITEM 6001 "PORTABLE CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGN". 2. GIVE AT LEAST ONE WEEK ADVANCED NOTICE TO THE TRAVELING PUBLIC OF THE INTENDED ASSOCIATED WITH A CHANGE IN THE PLANS WITHOUT ENGINEER'S APPROVAL IN WRITING. AN ALTERNATE PLAN FOR APPROVAL BY THE CITY. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL NOT BEGIN ANY WORK NOT INTENDED TO PROHIBIT MODIFICATIONS TO THESE PLANS OR SUBMITTING 1. THESE PLANS ARE PROVIDED TO INDICATE A POSSIBLE CONSTRUCTION SEQUENCE FOR THIS PROJECT AND ARE 6. REMOVE TCP AND SW3P DEVICES. 5. PLACE PERMANENT SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKINGS ACCORDING TO SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKING LAYOUT. 4. PERFORM MILL & OVERLAY OPERATIONS USING SINGLE LANE CLOSURES. ON USING NIGHTTIME OR WEEKEND CLOSURES. ALL PROPOSED SIGNALS MUST BE INSTALLED PRIOR TO REMOVING EXISTING INTERSECTION CONTROL. SIGNAL OPERATION TO BE SWITCHED 3. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING ACCORDING TO THE PLAN LAYOUT, ENTRANCE AND EXIT RAMP TO REMAIN OPEN DURING CONSTRUCTION. 2. PLACE SW3P DEVICES AND WORK ZONE MARKINGS. 1. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING USING SHOULDER CLOSURE. INSTALL CONSTRUCTION SIGNS AND IMPLEMENT TCP SETUP ACCORDING TO TXDOT BC STANDARDS. 7. REMOVE TCP AND SW3P DEVICES. 6. PLACE PERMANENT SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKINGS ACCORDING TO SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKING LAYOUT. 5. PERFORM MILL & OVERLAY OPERATIONS USING SINGLE LANE CLOSURES. EXISTING SIGNALS. SIGNAL OPERATION TO BE SWITCHED OVER USING NIGHTTIME OR WEEKEND CLOSURES. TEMP SIGNALS ARE NOT ANTICIPATED. ALL PROPOSED SIGNALS MUST BE INSTALLED PRIOR TO REMOVING 4. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING, CURB, SIDEWALK AND PED RAMPS ACCORDING TO THE PLAN LAYOUT. 3. MAINTAIN/PROVIDE INLET ADJUSTMENTS AS SHOWN IN TCP GENERAL NOTE 5. 2. PLACE SW3P DEVICES AND WORK ZONE MARKINGS. TCP SETUP ACCORDING TO TXDOT BC STANDARDS. 1. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING USING SINGLE LANE CLOSURE.INSTALL CONSTRUCTION SIGNS AND IMPLEMENT 7. REMOVE TCP AND SW3P DEVICES. 6. PLACE PERMANENT SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKINGS ACCORDING TO SIGNING AND PAVEMENT MARKING LAYOUT. 5. PERFORM MILL & OVERLAY OPERATIONS USING SINGLE LANE CLOSURES. 4. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING, CURB, SIDEWALK AND PED RAMPS ACCORDING TO THE PLAN LAYOUT. 3. MAINTAIN/PROVIDE INLET ADJUSTMENTS AS SHOWN IN TCP GENERAL NOTE 5. 2. PLACE SW3P DEVICES AND WORK ZONE MARKINGS. TCP SETUP ACCORDING TO TXDOT BC STANDARDS. 1. CONSTRUCT PROPOSED WIDENING ON LOCUST USING SHOULDER CLOSURES. INSTALL CONSTRUCTION SIGNS AND IMPLEMENT 3. SITE 1 NOTTINGHAM DR & UNIVERSITY DR INTERSECTION TO BE CONSTRUCTED LAST. 2. PROVIDE A MINIMUM 1' SHOULDER WHERE PORTABLE CONCRETE TRAFFIC BARRIER IS SHOWN ON THE PLANS UNLESS NOTED OTHERWISE. 1. MAINTAIN EXISTING LANE CONFIGURATION, UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED.SCALE:10160405.tbl1:20PENTABLE:3:02:38 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS GENERAL NOTES AND CONSTRUCTION NARRATIVE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLANS 8/5/2020 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN - PHASE 1 12 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50.0355PENTABLE:1:43:27 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 10 0 +0 0 1 0 1 +001 02+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 POT 100+00.00PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.8836"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2aEXIST ROWEXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW [ XUNIV 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D SIDEWALK CLOSED R9-9 24"x12" SIDEWALK CLOSED R9-9 24"x12" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT R3-7R THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT CW4-1aL LEGEND TRAFFIC DRUMS/BARRELS TEMP SIGN POST FLASHING ARROW BOARD TRAILER MOUNTED TYPE 3 BARRICADE WORK ZONE PHASE 1 WORK ZONE PHASE 1A E UNI VERSI TY DRE UNI VERSI TY DREXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWEXIST ROW NOTTINGHAM DR EXIST ROW [ XUNIV 170' 120' 120' 120' 320' 4 40' 3 2 0' 3 2 0' 3 2 0' 170' 120' 120' 120' 320' 4 40' 3 2 0' 3 2 0' 3 2 0' 3 2 0' 120'120'120' 36"X36" R3-8(3) 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 8/5/2020 13 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN PHASE 2 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50.0355PENTABLE:1:43:49 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 1 0 1 +001 02+00103+00PT 103+70.89 100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 POT 100+00.00PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a EXI ST ROW36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a [XNOTT [XUNIV [XUNIV [XNOTT THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT CW4-1aL RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT R3-7R 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D LEGEND TRAFFIC DRUMS/BARRELS TEMP SIGN POST FLASHING ARROW BOARD TRAILER MOUNTED TYPE 3 BARRICADE WORK ZONE E UNI VERSI TY DREXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWNOTTINGHAM DR E UNI VERSI TY DREXI ST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW 440'320'320'320'100'320' 120' 55' 100' 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 120'120'120' 8/5/2020 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 14 SHEET 1 OF 2MATCHLINE STA. 62+00.004" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:44:20 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 50+00 51+00 52+00 53+00 54+00 55+00 56+00 57+00 58+00 59+00 60+00 61+00 62+00POT 50+00.00100+00101+0050+0051+0052+0053+0054+00POT 50+00.00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D VARIES X 30" VARIES X30" 30" X 30" R3-XX 30" X 30" R3-XX VARIES X 30" LEGEND TRAFFIC DRUMS/BARRELS TEMP SIGN POST FLASHING ARROW BOARD TRAILER MOUNTED WORK ZONE PCTB ATTENTUATOR 320'320'320'120'SHERMAN DRIVE RANDALL STREETEXIST ROWPROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROW50'R 30'R50'R 100'120' BEGIN TAPER BEGIN PCTB INSTALL ATTENTUATOR END CHANNELIZING DEVICES 6.32' LT STA 50+45.09 [XWB288ENTER END PCTB 500'90'[ XSHERM [ XEB288EXIT [ XEB288ENTER 21.56' RT [ XSHERM STA 50+00.00, BEGIN TAPER 11.00' RT [ XSHERM STA 55+00.00, END TAPER 23.37' LT [ XSHERM STA 56+34.21, BEGIN TAPER 11.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 57+53.77, BEGIN TAPER ATTENTUATOR PCTB 7.19' RT STA 51+52.48, [ XEB288EXIT END TAPER SAWCUT 5.45' LT STA 100+46.60, XEB288ENTER END PCTB 30'R 3.08' LT STA 103+00.79, [ XEB288EXIT 11.70' RT [ XEB288EXIT STA 52+42.32, BEGIN TAPER BEGIN PCTB INSTALL ATTENTUATOR END CHANNELIZING DEVICES 8.92' RT STA 100+65.33, XEB288ENTER 30'R R3-6R ONL YONL Y R3-8 LS R3-6R 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 62+00.00TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 15 SHEET 2 OF 2 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:44:48 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND TRAFFIC DRUMS/BARRELS TEMP SIGN POST FLASHING ARROW BOARD TRAILER MOUNTED WORK ZONE PCTB ATTENTUATOR 62+00 63+00 64+00 65+00 66+00 67+00 68+00 69+00 70+00 71+00 72+00 73+00 74+00 75+00 76+00 PI 76+34.37POT 77+00.0050+0051+0052+0053+0054+00100+00101+00PC 50+00.00PT 54+65.98POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a VARIES X30" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D VARIES X 30" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D VARIES X 30" 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 30" X 30" R3-XX 30" X 30" R3-XX 320'320'320' 500' 130' BEGIN TAPER BEGIN PCTB INSTALL ATTENTUATOR END CHANNELIZING DEVICES ATTENTUATOR 6.32' LT STA 50+45.09 [XWB288ENTER END PCTB 5.15' RT STA 53+26.05, [XWB288ENTER BEGIN TAPER 8.20' RT STA 54+23.31, [XWB288ENTER END TAPER100'14.81' LT STA 54+34.51, [XWB288ENTER END TAPER PROP ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROW[ XHSERM [ XWB288ENTER SHERMAN DRIVE 10.40' RT STA 70+18.87 [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER 24.86' RT STA 71+45.48' [ XSHERM END TAPER 24.03' LT STA 74+89.74, [ XSHERM END TAPER 12.02' LT STA 69+89.89, [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER 120'120'SAWCUT 11.70' RT [ XEB288EXIT STA 52+42.32, BEGIN TAPER BEGIN PCTB INSTALL ATTENTUATOR END CHANNELIZING DEVICES 75'9.61' RT STA 101+56.71, [ XWB288EXIT END TAPER [ XWB288EXIT ONL YONL Y R3-8 LS R3-6R R3-6R 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.00MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.00TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 16 VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:45:18 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS PC 116+39.30PT 118+78.9250+0051+0052+0053+0054+00POT 50+00.00 109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00 SS SS SS 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X36" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R SIDEWALK CLOSED R9-9 24"x12" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a EXIST ROW 320'200' 80'80' 80'80'510'[ XLOCUS PLUM HOLLOW20'R 50'R N LOCUST ST 20'R EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 100'12' 11'PC 100+00.00PT 108+00.00POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+0051+00100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 HHHH 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a SIDEWALK CLOSED R9-9 24"x12" CLOSED RIGHT LANE CW20-5R 36"X36" 36"X36" ROAD AHEAD WORK CW20-1D 36"X18" END ROAD WORK G20-2a EXIST ROW 120'120'120'150'320' 150' LINE SAWCUT EXIST ROW N LOCUST ST [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW N LOCUST ST [ XHERCU 50'R LINE SAWCUT 11' LEGEND TRAFFIC DRUMS/BARRELS TEMP SIGN POST FLASHING ARROW BOARD TRAILER MOUNTED TYPE 3 BARRICADE WORK ZONE 8/5/2020 DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\absorbm19.dgn8/5/2020FILE:DATE:Standard Division DesignTXDOT ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE CONVERSION OF THIS STANDARD TO OTHER FORMATS OR FOR INCORRECT RESULTS OR DAMAGES RESULTING FROM ITS USE.THE USE OF THIS STANDARD IS GOVERNED BY THE "TEXAS ENGINEERING PRACTICE ACT". NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND IS MADE BY TXDOT FOR ANY PURPOSE WHATSOEVER. DISCLAIMER:LINDSAY TRANSPORTATION SOLUTIONS ABSORB(M)-19 GENERAL NOTES PART NUMBER C-SCR FH 3/8-16 X 1 GR5 PLT SYSTEM TL-3 1 PART DESCRIPTION 1 1 2 SYSTEM TL-2 1 12 1 1 3 8 C-SCR FH 3/8-16 X 1 1/2 GR5 PLT BSI-1809036-00 BSI-1809037-00 BSI-1809038-00 1 8 9 11 12 13 10 BSI-1808014-00 BSI-1808002-00 2 3 * *COMPONENTS PRE-ASSEMBLED WITH ELEMENT ASSEMBLY BSI-4004598 BSI-4004599 BSI-1809053-00 BSI-2001998 BSI-2001999 8 12 8 12 8 12 BSI-1809035-00 NOSE PLATE 1 1 1 1 BSI-1808005-00 BSI-2002001 PIN ASSEMBLY 8 10 6 6ANC MECH 5/8-11X5 (GALV) TRANSITION STRAP (RIGHT-HAND)-(GALV) TRANSITION STRAP (LEFT-HAND)-(GALV) TRANSITION-(GALV) TENSION STRAP-(GALV) MIDNOSE-(GALV) SECTION A-A 24" WIDTH 42" HEIGHT ELEVATION VIEW (MASH TL-3 & TL-2) CRASH CUSHION PRE-ASSEMBLED ABSORBING (ELEMENTS) #ITEM 2 3 5 7 6 4 (ITEM 13) ANCHORS MECHANICAL (ITEM 1) TRANSITION 23'-8" MAXIMUM LENGTH OF SYSTEM REAR ELEMENT (3)MIDDLE ELEMENT (2)FRONT ELEMENT (1) THE INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS MANUAL. THE ABSORB-M, IT IS NOT INTENDED TO REPLACE THIS STANDARD IS A BASIC REPRESENTATION OF NOTE: BARRIER BOTH-SIDE TRAFFIC FLOW BARRIER RIGHT-SIDE TRAFFIC FLOW BARRIER LEFT-SIDE TRAFFIC FLOW (ITEM 2)(ITEM 2)(ITEM 2) TRAFFIC FLOW ON THE LEFT-SIDE, BOTH -SIDES AND RIGHT-SIDE. FOR (TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES). DECALs ARE AVAILABLE FOR PLAN SET AND SHALL BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE TEXAS MUTCD DELINEATION DECAL ORIENTATION IS SHOWN ON THE CONSTRUCTION APPLY A HIGH REFLECTIVE DECAL TO THE NOSE PLATE. NOTE: APPLY DECAL NOSE PLATE ** TRAFFIC FLOW, LEFT, RIGHT OR BOTH-SIDES. THE MANUFACTURER FOR THE CORRECT DECAL PER ENGINEER OR CONTRACTOR SHALL COORDINATE WITH NOTE:** DELINEATION DECAL PLACEMENT GUIDE * 42" MAX A APLAN VIEW EFFECTIVE LENGTH OF SYSTEM 20'-11 ƒ" SYSTEM SHOWN - ABSORB-M TL-3 TRAFFIC FLOW TRAFFIC FLOW FILL CAPS DRAIN PLUGS 17 NOTE: TL-2 OR TL-3 UNITS FRONT ELEMENT DO NOT ADD WATER TO 20'- 11 ƒ" 14'- 7 ƒ" 23'- 8" 17'- 4" TL-3 TL-2 2 3 SACRIFICIAL 14 ABSORB-M INSTALLATION AND INSTRUCTIONS MANUAL 1 1 8. DO NOT ADD WATER TO FRONT ELEMENT (TL-2 OR TL-3 UNIT). 7. THE USE OF THE ABSORB-M IS RESTRICTED TO A BARRIER HEIGHT OF UP TO 42 INCHES. 6. THE ABSORB-M SHOULD BE LOCATED APPROXIMATELY PARALLEL WITH THE BARRIER. 5. THE INSTALLATION AREA SHOULD BE FREE FROM CURBS, ELEVATED OBJECTS, OR DEPRESSIONS. 4. MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE CROSS-SLOPE IS 8%. ASPHALT, OR ANY SURFACE CAPABLE OF BEARING THE WEIGHT OF THE SYSTEM. NOT NEED TO BE ATTACHED TO A FOUNDATION AND CAN BE INSTALLED ON TOP OF CONCRETE, 3. THE ABSORB-M IS A WATER FILLED NON-REDIRECTIVE, GATING CRASH CUSHION THAT DOES 2. THE ABSORB-M SYSTEM IS ONLY APPROVED FOR USE IN (TEMPORARY WORK ZONE) LOCATIONS. AT (707) 374-6800. 180 RIVER ROAD, RIO VISTA, CA 94571 CONTACT: LINDSAY TRANSPORTATION SOLUTIONS (LTS) - BARRIER SYSTEMS,INC. 1. FOR SPECIFIC INFORMATION REGARDING THE INSTALLATION AND TECHNICAL GUIDANCE, TEMPORARY - WORK ZONE (PROVIDED BY OTHERS) CREATED BY VINCENT PARKER TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER [JULY 2019] DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT VP TxDOT KM C TxDOT: JULY 2019 QTY QTYBILL OF MATERIALS (BOM) ABSORB-M TL-3 & TL-2 SYSTEMS TEST LEVEL LENGTH EFFECTIVE LENGTH MAXIMUM ELEMENTS NUMBER OF absorbm19 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\acz35016.dgn8/5/20201:45:20 PMTxDOT GENERAL NOTES L March 2010 Standard Division Design $ACZ(350)-16$ acz35016.dgn KM VP VP SACRIFICIAL REVISED 03, 2016 (VP) REVISED 06, 2013 (VP) barrier or C of merging barrier. 6. The ACZ 350 should be approximately parallel with the objects, or depressions. 5. The installation area should be free from curbs, elevated 4. Maximum permissible cross-slope is 8% . for details. and nose assembly. See manufacturer's installation manual transition assembly, rear bay assembly, front bay assembly, 3. The ACZ 350 system consist of four major components, the weight of the system. of concrete, asphalt, or any surface capable of bearing the to be attached to a foundation and can be installed on top non-redirective, gating crash cushion that does not need (Work Zone) locations. The ACZ 350 is a water filled 2. The ACZ 350 system is approved for use in temporary specific system assembly and element orientation. 2. Refer to Installation manual and configuration chart for at 1(888)323-6374. 70 W. Madison St. Suite 2350. Chicago, IL 60602 guidance of the system, contact: Trinity Highway - Energy Absorption 1. For specific information regarding installation and technical ENERGY ABSORPTION TRINITY HIGHWAY ACZ(350)-16 C TxDOT: TEMPORARY - WORK ZONE ACZ-350 22" PLAN VIEW (See Transition option table) Transition Assembly. FRONT BAY ASSEMBLYREAR BAY ASSEMBLY BI-DIRECTIONAL TRAFFIC FLOW SHOWN. TRAFFIC 33" ELEVATION VIEW (SEE SYSTEM TABLE) SYSTEM LENGTH TL-3,(31'-7") OR TL-2,(18'-7") TRAFFIC NO STRIPING TRAFFIC PASSES ON THE RIGHT 3595608-0000 3595608-1000 3595608-2000 ON THE LEFT TRAFFIC PASSES 3595608-3000 TRAFFIC PASSES ON BOTH SIDES 1 1 1 1 REAR BAY ASSY,ACZ-350,TL-3 FRONT BAY ASSY,ACZ-350,TL-33595601-0000 3595601-0000 3595608-*000 4 3 2 1 TRANSITION ASSEMBLYSEE TABLE NOSE,ACZ-350, (See Below) DESCRIPTION QTYPART NO.ITEM SEE DETAILS BELOW FOR NOSE DELINEATION PARTS LIST THE GENERAL NOTES). THE PLANS (I.E. ATTENUATOR LOCATION DETAILS OR IN BACKUP AND TRANSITION TYPES ARE SHOWN ELSEWHERE ON 3595616-0000 3595618-0000 3595620-0000 CTB SAFETY SHAPE (8" TOP) CSB F-SHAPE (9 •" TOP) SSCB SINGLE SLOPE (8" TOP) product manual) may be required. (See the Manufacurer's bi-directional sites, additional hardware The ACZ 350 system is approved for use at TRANSITION OPTIONS TRANSITION ASSEMBLY OPTIONS BARRIERPART NO. SYSTEM LENGTH ACZ-350 (NARROW) SYSTEM 18'- 7" 31'- 7" LEVEL TEST TL-2 TL-3TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONTNovember 2002 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:21 PM 95 SHEET 1 OF 12 AND REQUIREMENTS GENERAL NOTES BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION 4-03 9-07 5-10 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic 18 BC(1)-14 8-14 bc-14.dgn http://www.txdot.gov THE DOCUMENTS BELOW CAN BE FOUND ON-LINE AT COMPLIANT WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES LIST (CWZTCD) TEXAS MANUAL ON UNIFORM TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES (TMUTCD) STANDARD HIGHWAY SIGN DESIGNS FOR TEXAS (SHSD) TRAFFIC ENGINEERING STANDARD SHEETS MATERIAL PRODUCER LIST (MPL) ROADWAY DESIGN MANUAL - SEE "MANUALS (ONLINE MANUALS)" DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS (DMS) Phone (512) 416-3118 Traffic Operations Division - TE Texas Department of Transportation below or by contacting: and their sources and may be found on-line at the web address given Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD) describes pre-qualified products Only pre-qualified products shall be used. The "Compliant Work Zone BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION (BC) STANDARD SHEETS GENERAL NOTES: or as approved by the Engineer. right-of-way line as possible, or located behind a barrier or guardrail, must be parked away from travel lanes. They should be as close to the 13. Inactive equipment and work vehicles, including workers' private vehicles devices. 12. The Engineer has the final decision on the location of all traffic control exists. be in place only while work is actually in progress or a definite need 11. Except for devices required by Note 10, traffic control devices should shall be erected at or near the CSJ limits. strips. The BEGIN ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES, CONTRACTOR and END ROAD WORK signs solely of mobile operation work, such as striping or milling edgeline rumble the TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE sign will not be required on projects consisting sign with plaque shall be erected in advance of the CSJ limits. However, TEXT LATER (see Sign Detail G20-10T) and the WORK ZONE TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE 10. As shown on BC(2), the OBEY WARNING SIGNS STATE LAW sign, STAY ALERT TALK OR appropriate traffic control devices to be used. BC sheets are examples. As necessary, the Engineer will determine the most 9. The temporary traffic control devices shown in the illustrations of the provide a detail to the Contractor before the sign is manufactured. not shown in this manual shall be shown in the plans or the Engineer shall "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas," latest edition. Sign details 8. All signs shall be constructed in accordance with the details found in the justify the signing. divided highways where median width will permit and traffic volumes 7. The Engineer may require duplicate warning signs on the median side of revised to show appropriate work zone distance. directed by the Engineer. The BEGIN ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES sign shall be necessary warning signs as shown on these sheets, the TCP sheets or as adjacent project is completed first, the Contractor shall erect the redundant and the work areas appear continuous to the motorists. If the FINES DOUBLE, and other advance warning signs if the signing would be 6. When projects abut, the Engineer(s) may omit the END ROAD WORK, TRAFFIC Design Manual" or engineering judgment. "A Policy on Geometric Design of Highways and Streets," the TxDOT "Roadway Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials (AASHTO), applicable design criteria contained in manuals such as the American 5. Geometric design of lane shifts and detours should, when possible, meet the the approximate location of any device without the approval of the Engineer. control devices as shown in the plans. The Contractor may not move or change 4. The Contractor is responsible for installing and maintaining the traffic sign and seal Contractor proposed changes. by a licensed professional engineer for approval. The Engineer may develop, 3. The Contractor may propose changes to the TCP that are signed and sealed responsibility of the Engineer. 2. The development and design of the Traffic Control Plan (TCP)is the shown in the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" (TMUTCD). The information contained in these sheets meet or exceed the requirements devices, construction pavement markings, and typical work zone signs. to show typical examples for placement of temporary traffic control 1. The Barricade and Construction Standard Sheets (BC sheets) are intended WORKER SAFETY APPAREL NOTES: considered for high traffic volume work areas or night time work. performance for Class 2 or 3 risk exposure. Class 3 garments should be Apparel," or equivalent revisions, and labeled as ANSI 107-2004 standard the requirements of ISEA "American National Standard for High-Visibility within the right-of-way shall wear high-visibility safety apparel meeting 1. Workers on foot who are exposed to traffic or to construction equipment 3.0" Radius, 1.25" Border, 0.75" Indent, Black on Yellow; 3.0" Radius, 1.25" Border, 0.75" Indent, Black on Orange; .75"1.5"2"2"AND SYMBOL BORDER LEGEND, BLACK R=1.1".94.94.94.94.41.42.31"1" .67".67" 1".31" 9" R=.44" R=.79" R=.13".31".31"14".31"1.14"1.14"R=.75"2.57"2.88"1.17"5.55"17.5"6.38" 1.68"1.68"1.68" 8.38" 4.9"19.7"6"24.5"4.9"3.25"6"D12"48"4"1.25"3.5"20"36"3.5"5"C20"20"20" 3.5"12"2.8"6.3"2.8"11.7"2.8"14.6"3.5" 60" 1.25" SIGN DETAIL (G20-10T)5".41[STAY ALERT] Font: D [TALK OR TEXT LATER] Font: C specified length; WHITE BLACK WHITE BACKGROUND YELLOW FLUORESCENT COLORS: LEGEND BORDER AND BLACK BACKGROUND FLUORESCENT ORANGE DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:22 PM96 SHEET 2 OF 12 R11-2 ROAD CLOSED XX ROAD WORK AHEAD END ROAD WORK END ROAD WORK CW20-1D CW1-6 ROAD WORK AHEAD CW20-1D NAME ADDRESS CITY STATE CONTRACTOR ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES BEGIN ROAD WORK AHEAD ROAD WORK AHEAD PROJECT1 Block - City 1 Block - City ROAD WORK NEXT X MILESROAD WORK END ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES PROJECTCROSSROAD * X X X X ROAD WORK AHEAD END ROAD WORK END ROAD WORK CW20-1D NAME ADDRESS CITY STATE CONTRACTOR WORK ZONE TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE WHEN WORKERS ARE PRESENT * * ROAD WORK BEGIN T-INTERSECTION ROAD WORK AHEAD CW20-1D CW20-1D CW20-1D 3X 3X XX ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES NEXT X MILES INTERSECTED ROADWAY 1000'-1500' - Hwy 1000'-1500' - Hwy CSJ Limit CSJ Limit XXXXX XXXXX * 1,5,6 X X TYPICAL LOCATION OF CROSSROAD SIGNS X X WORK ZONE TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE WHEN WORKERS ARE PRESENT WORK ZONE TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE WHEN WORKERS ARE PRESENT R20-5T G20-5T G20-5T CW1-4R WORK AREAS IN MULTIPLE LOCATIONS WITHIN CSJ LIMITS SAMPLE LAYOUT OF SIGNING FOR WORK BEGINNING AT THE CSJ LIMITS ** ** ** ** ** ** ** ** ** SAMPLE LAYOUT OF SIGNING FOR WORK BEGINNING DOWNSTREAM OF THE CSJ LIMITS CW1-4L ** CW20-1E WORK ROAD G20-5T / MILE1 2 NEXT X MILES * * TYPICAL CONSTRUCTION WARNING SIGN SIZE AND SPACING 30 MPH 35 40 45 50 55 60 320 400 500 600 Posted Speed Sign Spacing (Apprx.) 2 65 700 70 800 3** 2 2 2 "X" Feet 120 160 240 75 900 2 80 1000 2 SPACING SIZE 4 9-07 Devices Channelizing Devices Channelizing min. 80' AREA WORK Limit CSJ 1 and 4) see Note (Optional 1 and 4) see Note (Optional G20-2 G20-1aT G20-1aT NEXT X MILES G20-2 CW13-1P SPACE WORK CW13-1PMPH MPH G20-2 SPACE WORK Channelizing Devices LEGEND Sign Type 3 Barricade spacing requirements. TMUTCD for sign Spacing chart or the Warning Sign Size and See Typical Construction G20-1bTR G20-1bTL R20-5T R20-5aTP G20-6T G20-2 R20-5aTP R20-5T G20-5aP G20-5aP G20-2 G20-6T channelizing devices Type 3 Barricade or devices channelizing Barricade or Type 3 G20-6T GENERAL NOTES or Series Number Sign Freeway Expressway/ Road Conventional CW20 CW21 CW22 48" x 48" 48" x 48" CW23 CW25 CW1, CW2, CW7, CW8, 36" x 36" 48" x 48" CW9, CW11, CW14 CW3, CW4, CW5, CW6, 48" x 48" 48" x 48" CW8-3, CW10, CW12 CSJ LIMITS AT T-INTERSECTION R20-3T ** TxDOT G20-5aP R20-5aTP 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic X channelizing devices. within the project limits. See the applicable TCP sheets for exact location and spacing of signs and "ROAD WORK AHEAD"(CW20-1D)signs are placed in advance of these work areas to remind drivers they are still When extended distances occur between minimal work spaces, the Engineer/Inspector should ensure additional (G20-1bTR)" signs shall be replaced by the detour signing called for in the plans. The "ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES" left arrow(G20-1bTL) and "ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES" right arrow NAME"(G20-6T) sign behind the Type 3 Barricades for the road closure (see BC(10) also). 2. If construction closes the road at a T-intersection the Contractor shall place the "CONTRACTOR being performed at or near an intersection. such as a flagger and accompanying signs, or other signs, that should be used when work is 1. The Engineer will determine the types and location of any additional traffic control devices, PROJECT LIMIT BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION WARNING SIGNS STATE LAW OBEY **R20-3T* WARNING SIGNS STATE LAW OBEY WORK ZONE TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE WHEN WORKERS ARE PRESENT BEGIN**G20-9TP **R20-5T **R20-5aTP the plans or as determined by the Engineer/Inspector, shall be in place. 6. When work occurs in the intersection area, appropriate traffic control devices, as shown elsewhere in 5. Additional traffic control devices may be shown elsewhere in the plans for higher volume crossroads. will determine whether a roadway is considered high volume. motorists of the length of construction in either direction from the intersection. The Engineer 4. The "ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES"(G20-1aT)sign shall be required at high volume crossroads to advise Zone Standard Sheets. location and spacing of any sign not shown on the BC sheets, Traffic Control Plan sheets or the Work be considered part of the minimum requirements. The Engineer/Inspector will determine the proper AHEAD, LOOSE GRAVEL, or other appropriate signs. When additional signs are required, these signs will 3. Based on existing field conditions, the Engineer/Inspector may require additional signs such as FLAGGER in the plans. crossroads. The Engineer will determine whether a road is low volume. This information shall be shown Texas" manual for sign details. The Engineer may omit the advance warning signs on low volume "Typical Construction Warning Sign Size and Spacing"). See the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for with the reduced size 36" x 18" "END ROAD WORK"(G20-2) sign on low volume crossroads (see Note 4 under 2. The Engineer may use the reduced size 36" x 36" ROAD WORK AHEAD (CW20-1D) sign mounted back to back (G20-2) "END ROAD WORK" sign, unless noted otherwise in plans. 1. The typical minimum signing on a crossroad approach should be a "ROAD WORK AHEAD" (CW20-1D)sign and a SPEED LIMIT XX X * location with sign coordinate line should NO-PASSING Beginning of SPEED LIMIT XX* R2-1 R2-1 19 BC(2)-14 8-14 R2-1 SPEED LIMIT XX ** X G20-10T XX CW1-4L MPHCW13-1P NAME ADDRESS CITY STATE CONTRACTOR ROAD WORK NEXT X MILES BEGIN * ** * NOTES * the end of the work zone. Contractor will install a regulatory speed limit sign at Control Plan. and other signs or devices as called for on the Traffic Area for placement of "ROAD WORK AHEAD" (CW20-1D)sign consisting solely of mobile operations work. FINES DOUBLE signs will not be required on projects Required CSJ Limit signing. See Note 10 on BC(1). TRAFFIC if workers are present. lying outside the CSJ Limits where traffic fines may double motorist of entering or leaving a part of the work zone signs are required outside the CSJ Limits. They inform the shall be used as shown on the sample layout when advance The "BEGIN WORK ZONE"(G20-9TP) and "END WORK ZONE" (G20-2bT) No decimals shall be used. to the nearest whole mile with the approval of the Engineer. This distance shall replace the "X" and shall be rounded WORK NEXT X MILES"(G20-5T)sign for each specific project. to be placed on the G20-1 series signs and "BEGIN ROAD The Contractor shall determine the appropriate distance DO NOT PASS appropriate) (as R4-1 sizes. Sign Designs for Texas" manual for complete list of available sign design 6. See sign size listing in "TMUTCD", Sign Appendix or the "Standard Highway 5. Only diamond shaped warning sign sizes are indicated. Location of Crossroad Signs". crossroads at the discretion of the Engineer. See Note 2 under "Typical 4. 36" x 36" "ROAD WORK AHEAD" (CW20-1D)signs may be used on low volume or more advance warning. 3. Distance between signs should be increased as required to have 1/2 mile advance warning. 2. Distance between signs should be increased as required to have 1500 feet 1. Special or larger size signs may be used as necessary. work area and/or distance between each additional sign. Minimum distance from work area to first Advance Warning sign nearest the (TMUTCD) typical application diagrams or TCP Standard Sheets. see Part 6 of the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" For typical sign spacings on divided highways, expressways and freeways, G20-10T SPEED LIMIT R2-1 XX ** X X X ** * G20-2bT END WORK ZONE ** (See note 2 below) May be mounted on back of "ROAD WORK AHEAD"(CW20-1D) sign with approval of Engineer. DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:22 PM97 SHEET 3 OF 12 TxDOT 9-07 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic WORK ZONE SPEED LIMIT BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION 20 SPEED LIMIT 60 SPEED LIMIT 70 TYPICAL APPLICATION OF WORK ZONE SPEED LIMIT SIGNS WORK ZONE SPEED LIMIT 60 WORK ZONE WORK ZONE SPEED LIMIT 70 (750' - 1500')(750' - 1500') R2-1 R2-1 R2-1 R2-1 Reduced speeds should only be posted in the vicinity of work activity and not throughout the entire project. LIMIT SPEED CW3-5 See General Note 4 60 and approved by the Texas Transportation Commission, or by City Ordinance when within Incorporated City Limits. Work zone speed limits shall be regulatory, established in accordance with the "Procedures for Establishing Speed Zones," or covered during periods when they are not needed. Regulatory work zone speed signs (R2-1) shall be removed signing. additional advance See BC(2) for one direction only. Signing shown for LIMITS CSJ Note 4 See General LIMIT SPEED CW3-5 60 G20-5aP G20-5aP SPEED LIMIT 60 GENERAL NOTES GUIDANCE FOR USE: mounting height. 3. Speed zone signs are illustrated for one direction of travel and are normally posted for each direction of travel. 40 mph and greater 0.2 to 2 miles 35 mph and less 0.2 to 1 mile 5. Regulatory speed limit signs shall have black legend and border on a white reflective B. Flagger stationed next to sign. A. Law enforcement. C. Portable changeable message sign (PCMS). This type of work zone speed limit should be included on the design of the traffic control plans when restricted geometrics with a lower design speed are present in the work zone and modification of the geometrics to a higher design speed is not feasible. Work activity may also be defined as a change in the roadway that requires a reduced speed for motorists to safely negotiate the work area, including: a) rough road or damaged pavement surface b) substantial alteration of roadway geometrics (diversions) c) construction detours d) grade e) width As long as any of these conditions exist, the work zone speed limit signs SHORT TERM WORK ZONE SPEED LIMITS the traffic control plans when workers or equipment are not behind concrete f) other conditions readily apparent to the driver projects where speed control is of major importance. E. Speed monitor trailers or signs. D. Low-power (drone) radar transmitter. (See Removing or Covering on BC(4)). Long/Intermediate Term Work Zone Speed Limit signs, when approved as described above, should be posted and visible to the motorist when work activity is present. motorists only when work activity is present. When work activity is not present, signs shall be removed or covered. Short Term Work Zone Speed Limit signs should be posted and visible to the background (See "Reflective Sheeting" on BC(4)). 4. Frequency of work zone speed limit signs should be: 8. Techniques that may help reduce traffic speeds include but are not limited to: 2. Regulatory work zone speed limit signs shall be placed on supports at a 7 foot minimum should remain in place. 1. Regulatory work zone speed limits should be used only for sections of construction LONG/INTERMEDIATE TERM WORK ZONE SPEED LIMITS zone reduction see TxDOT form #1204 in the TxDOT e-form system. conditions and factors impacting allowable regulatory construction speed 10.For more specific guidance concerning the type of work, work zone Work Zone Speed Limits should only be posted as approved for each project. 9. Speeds shown on details above are for illustration only. This type of work zone speed limit may be included on the design of barrier, when work activity is within 10 feet of the traveled way or actually in the travelled way. otherwise noted under "REMOVING OR COVERING" on BC(4). 7. Turning signs from view, laying signs over or down will not be allowed, unless as directly, but shall be considered subsidiary to Item 502. "WORK ZONE"(G20-5aP) plaque and the "SPEED LIMIT"(R2-1)signs shall not be paid for 6. Fabrication, erection and maintenance of the"ADVANCE SPEED LIMIT"(CW3-5)sign, Note 4 See General R2-1 WORK ZONE SPEED LIMIT 60 R2-1 signing. additional advance See BC(2) for one direction only. Signing shown for G20-5aPG20-5aP SPEED LIMIT 70 R2-1 LIMITS CSJ BC(3)-14 8-14 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:22 PM98 SHEET 4 OF 12 9-07 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic TEMPORARY SIGN NOTES BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION 21CurbXXTravel lane edge 12' min. FRONT ELEVATION SIDE ELEVATIONTravel lane edge OR TYPICAL MINIMUM CLEARANCES FOR LONG TERM AND INTERMEDIATE TERM SIGNS * * CONTRACTOR REQUIREMENTS FOR MAINTAINING PERMANENT SIGNS WITHIN THE PROJECT LIMITS 0'-6' 1. Permanent signs are used to give notice of traffic laws or regulations, call attention to conditions that are potentially hazardous to traffic operations, show route designations, destinations, directions, distances, services, points of interest, and other geographical, recreational, or cultural information. Drivers proceeding through a work zone need the same, if not better route guidance as normally installed on a roadway without construction. 2. When permanent regulatory or warning signs conflict with work zone conditions, 3. When existing permanent signs are moved and relocated due to construction purposes, they shall be visible to motorists at all times. 4. If existing signs are to be relocated on their original supports, they shall be installed on crashworthy bases as shown on the SMD Standard sheets. The signs shall meet the required mounting heights shown on the BC Sheets or the SMD Standards. This work should be paid for under the appropriate pay item for relocating existing signs. 5. If permanent signs are to be removed and relocated using temporary supports, the Contractor shall use crashworthy supports as shown on the BC sheets or the CWZTCD. The signs shall meet the required mounting heights shown on the BC Sheets or the SMD Standards during construction. This work should be paid for under the appropriate pay item for relocating existing signs. 6. Any sign or traffic control device that is struck or damaged by the Contractor or his/her construction equipment shall be replaced as soon as possible by the Contractor to ensure proper guidance for the motorists. This will be subsidiary to Item 502. remove or cover the permanent signs until the permanent sign message matches the roadway condition. ** ** ATTACHMENT FOR SIGN SUPPORTS Wood STOP/SLOW PADDLES 10"10" 24" 24" 24" 24" 8"C 8"B †" 9"8Š" R=2"3" „"+ 6.0' min. Fiber Reinforced Plastic Wood, metal or the ground. SIZE OF SIGNS SIGN SUBSTRATES SIGN LETTERS Hand Signaling Devices in the TMUTCD. shall only be as specifically described in Section 6E.03 4. Any lights incorporated into the STOP or SLOW paddle faces length of 6' to the bottom of the sign. 3. STOP/SLOW paddles may be attached to a staff with a minimum retroreflectorized. 2. When used at night, the STOP/SLOW paddle shall be as detailed below. by flaggers. The STOP/SLOW paddle size should be 24" x 24" 1. STOP/SLOW paddles are the primary method to control traffic curb from minimum 2 ' min. 6' 9.0' max. 7.0' min. 9.0' max. 7.0' min. 9.0' max. 7.0' min. shoulder Paved shoulder Paved above sign protrude shall not Support above sign protrude shall not Support substrate. back of the sign 1/2 way up the extend more than Sign supports shall Legend & Border - White Background - Red Legend & Border - Black Background - Orange Supplemental plaques (advisory or distance) should not cover the surface of the parent sign. When plaques are placed on dual-leg supports, they should be attached to the upright nearest the travel lane. Objects shall NOT be placed under skids as a means of leveling. When placing skid supports on unlevel ground, the leg post lengths must be adjusted so the sign appears straight and plumb. MPH be allowed. other means. by splicing or extended or repaired supports shall not be any means. Wood joined or spliced by signs shall not be support. Multiple directly to the sign shall be attached Each sign Nails shall NOT sign supports substrates to other types of procedures for attaching sign manufacturer's recommended or screws. Use TxDOT's or will be by bolts and nuts Attachment to wooden supports FLAGS ON SIGNS greater 6' or of at least the same gauge material. should be at least 5 times nominal post size, centered on the splice and the sign substrate, not near the base of the support. Splice insert lengths above and two below the spice point. Splice must be located entirely behind height will only be allowed when the splice is made using four bolts, two Splicing embedded perforated square metal tubing in order to extend post GENERAL NOTES FOR WORK ZONE SIGNS 1. Contractor shall install and maintain signs in a straight and plumb condition and/or as directed by the Engineer. 2. Wooden sign posts shall be painted white. 3. Barricades shall NOT be used as sign supports. 4. All signs shall be installed in accordance with the plans or as directed by the Engineer. Signs shall be used to regulate, warn, and guide the traveling public safely through the work zone. 5. The Contractor may furnish either the sign design shown in the plans or in the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas" (SHSD). The Engineer/Inspector may require the Contractor to furnish other work zone signs that are shown in the TMUTCD but may have been omitted from the plans. Any variation in the plans shall be documented by written agreement between the Engineer and the Contractor's Responsible Person. All changes must be documented in writing before being implemented. This can include documenting the changes in the Inspector's TxDOT diary and having both the Inspector and Contractor initial and date the agreed upon changes. 6. The Contractor shall furnish sign supports listed in the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Device List" (CWZTCD). The Contractor shall install the sign support in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations. If there is a question regarding installation procedures, the Contractor shall furnish the Engineer a copy of the manufacturer's installation recommendations so the Engineer can verify the correct procedures are being followed. 7. The Contractor is responsible for installing signs on approved supports and replacing signs with damaged or cracked substrates and/or damaged or marred reflective sheeting as directed by the Engineer/Inspector. 8. Identification markings may be shown only on the back of the sign substrate. The maximum height of letters and/or company logos used for identification shall be 1 inch. DURATION OF WORK (as defined by the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" Part 6) 1. The types of sign supports, sign mounting height,the size of signs, and the type of sign substrates can vary based on the type of work being performed. The Engineer is responsible for selecting the appropriate size sign for the type of work being performed. The Contractor is responsible for ensuring the sign support, sign mounting height and substrate meets manufacturer's recommendations in regard to crashworthiness and duration of work requirements. a. Long-term stationary - work that occupies a location more than 3 days. more than one hour. c. Short-term stationary - daytime work that occupies a location for more than 1 hour in a single daylight period. d. Short, duration - work that occupies a location up to 1 hour. e. Mobile - work that moves continuously or intermittently (stopping for up to approximately 15 minutes.) SIGN MOUNTING HEIGHT 1. The bottom of Long-term/Intermediate-term signs shall be at least 7 feet, but not more than 9 feet, above the paved surface, except as shown for supplemental plaques mounted below other signs. 2. The bottom of Short-term/Short Duration signs shall be a minimum of 1 foot above the pavement surface but no more than 2 feet above 3. Long-term/Intermediate-term Signs may be used in lieu of Short-term/Short Duration signing. appropriate Long-term/Intermediate sign height. 5. Regulatory signs shall be mounted at least 7 feet, but not more than 9 feet, above the paved surface regardless of work duration. REFLECTIVE SHEETING 1. All signs shall be retroreflective and constructed of sheeting meeting the color and retro-reflectivity requirements of DMS-8300 for rigid signs or DMS-8310 for roll-up signs. The web address for DMS specifications is shown on BC(1). 1. All sign letters and numbers shall be clear, and open rounded type uppercase alphabet letters as approved by the Federal Highway Administration (FHWA) and as published in the "Standard Highway Sign Design for Texas" manual. Signs, letters and numbers shall be of first class workmanship in accordance with Department Standards and Specifications. REMOVING OR COVERING 1. When sign messages may be confusing or do not apply, the signs shall be removed or completely covered. 2. Long-term stationary or intermediate stationary signs installed on square metal tubing may be turned away from traffic 90 degrees when 3. Signs installed on wooden skids shall not be turned at 90 degree angles to the roadway. These signs should be removed or completely covered when not required. 4. When signs are covered, the material used shall be opaque, such as heavy mil black plastic, or other materials which will cover the 9. The Contractor shall replace damaged wood posts. New or damaged wood sign posts shall not be spliced. 1. The Contractor shall furnish the sign sizes shown on BC (2) unless otherwise shown in the plans or as directed by the Engineer. intersections where the sign may be seen from approaching traffic. the sign message is not applicable. This technique may not be used for signs installed in the median of divided highways or near any 1. The Contractor shall ensure the sign substrate is installed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations for the type of sign support that is being used. The CWZTCD lists each substrate that can be used on the different types and models of sign supports. 2. "Mesh" type materials are NOT an approved sign substrate, regardless of the tightness of the weave. 3. All wooden individual sign panels fabricated from 2 or more pieces shall have one or more plywood cleat, 1/2" thick by 6" wide, fastened to the back of the sign and extending fully across the sign. The cleat shall be attached to the back of the sign using wood screws that do not penetrate the face of the sign panel. The screws shall be placed on both sides of the splice and spaced at 6" centers. The Engineer may approve other methods of splicing the sign face. b. Intermediate-term stationary - work that occupies a location more than one daylight period up to 3 days, or nighttime work lasting 2. White sheeting, meeting the requirements of DMS-8300 Type A, shall be used for signs with a white background. FL3. Orange sheeting, meeting the requirements of DMS-8300 Type B or Type C , shall be used for rigid signs with orange backgrounds.FL 4. Short-term/Short Duration signs shall be used only during daylight and shall be removed at the end of the workday or raised to 5. Burlap shall NOT be used to cover signs. SIGN SUPPORT WEIGHTS 6. Duct tape or other adhesive material shall NOT be affixed to a sign face. 1. Where sign supports require the use of weights to keep from turning over, the use of sandbags with dry, cohesionless sand should be used. 2. The sandbags will be tied shut to keep the sand from spilling and to maintain a constant weight. 3. Rock, concrete, iron, steel or other solid objects shall not be permitted for use as sign support weights. 4. Sandbags should weigh a minimum of 35 lbs and a maximum of 50 lbs. 5. Sandbags shall be made of a durable material that tears upon vehicular 6. Rubber ballasts designed for channelizing devices should not be used for ballast on portable sign supports. Sign supports designed and manufactured with rubber bases may be used when shown on the CWZTCD list. 7. Sandbags shall only be placed along or laid over the base supports of the traffic control device and shall not be suspended above ground level or hung with rope, wire, chains or other fasteners. Sandbags shall be placed along the length of the skids to weigh down the sign support. 8. Sandbags shall NOT be placed under the skid and shall not be used to level sign supports placed on slopes. impact. Rubber (such as tire inner tubes) shall NOT be used. the sign face. red-orange in color. Flags shall not be allowed to cover any portion of shall be 16 inches square or larger and shall be orange or fluorescent 1. Flags may be used to draw attention to warning signs. When used the flag entire sign face and maintain their opaque properties under automobile headlights at night, without damaging the sign sheeting. 7. Signs and anchor stubs shall be removed and holes backfilled upon completion of work. BC(4)-14 8-14 DN:CK:DW:CK: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:23 PM 99 7-13 22of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:30" 40" 27" 36" 24" 2x6 2x4 x 40" 72" 2x6 Front Side Top * * that can be used for each approved sign support. See the CWZTCD for the type of sign substrate NOT be allowed. Posts shall be painted white. Wood sign posts MUST be one piece. Splicing will See BC(4) for definition of "Work Duration." post wood 4x4 sign face 21 sq. ft. of Maximum block 4x4 post wood 4x4 requirement height for sign See BC(4) This will be considered subsidiary to Item 502. foundations shall be removed from the project site. 3. When project is completed, all sign supports and CWZTCD List. 7 ft. circle, except for specific materials noted on the 2. No more than 2 sign posts shall be placed within a connection. lag screws must be used on every joint for final supports, but 3/8" bolts with nuts or 3/8" x 3 1/2" 1. Nails may be used in the assembly of wooden sign GENERAL NOTES Front * post wood 4x4 requirement height for sign See BC(4) sign face 12 sq. ft. of Maximum 24" 60" 2x6 2x6 Top block 4x4 skid 2x6 additional stability. be increased for Length of skids may 24"2x4 brace 4x4 block4x4 block Side screws (min.) lag or 3/8" x 3 1/2" 3/8" bolts w/nuts LONG/INTERMEDIATE TERM STATIONARY - PORTABLE SKID MOUNTED SIGN SUPPORTS SKID MOUNTED WOOD SIGN SUPPORTS PERFORATED SQUARE METAL TUBING GROUND MOUNTED SIGN SUPPORTS Two post installations can be used for larger signs. The maximum sign square footage shall adhere to the manufacturer's recommendation. Refer to the CWZTCD and the manufacturer's installation procedure for each type sign support. 4" max. Ground surface WING CHANNEL Post Sign Post Base for embedment. See the CWZTCD 48" 5' square tubing or 1 3/4" x 1 3/4" with 5/16" holes 1 3/4" galv. round (DO NOT SPLICE) 12 ga post 1 3/4" x 1 3/4" x 11 foot CWZTCD LIST. SEE BC(1) FOR WEBSITE LOCATION. AND SHORT TERM SUPPORTS CAN BE FOUND ON THE MORE DETAILS OF APPROVED LONG/INTERMEDIATE Posts of Number MOUNTED SIGN SUPPORTS WOOD POST SYSTEM FOR GROUND WEDGE ANCHORS 18" 4" * 4" 6" of Traffic Direction Dia.(typ) 1 1/2"17 1/2"20 1/2"5 BOLT (TYP.) 3/8" X 4-1/2 gr. 3" telescopes into sleeve (hole to hole) 12 ga. support 1 3/4 " x 1 3/4 " x 129" tubing diagonal brace to hole) 12 ga. square perforated 1 3/4 " x 1 3/4 " x 52" (hole tubing cross brace to hole) 12 ga. square perforated 1 3/4 " x 1 3/4 " x 32" (hole 20 1/2"above pavement provide 7' height telescope to Upright must 5 bolt 3/8 " X 3" gr. Ground surface Post Sign (Direct Embedment) OPTION 1 max. 4" Ground surface Post Sign weak soils. 55" min. in strong soils, 34" min. in (Anchor Stub) OPTION 2 post) than sign (1/4" larger Anchor Stub desirable 9" max. 4" Ground surface Post Sign post) x 18" than sign (1/2" larger sleeve reinforcing Optional 18" weak soils. 55" min. in strong soils, 34" min. in (Anchor Stub and Reinforcing Sleeve)) OPTION 3 post) than sign (1/4" larger Anchor Stub desirable 9" bolted anchor Lap-splice/base minimum 48" sign only thinwall plastic 10mm extruded 9 sq. ft. or less- 1/2" plywood is allowed. the CWZTCD, except 5/8" plywood. substrate listed in section J.2.d of 16 sq. ft. or less of any rigid sign OTHER DESIGNS "Traffic Engineering Standard Sheets" on BC(1)). if approved by the Engineer. (See web address for face. They may be set in concrete or in sturdy soils sign supports for signs up to 10 square feet of sign on the SMD Standard Sheets may be used as temporary Both steel and plastic Wedge Anchor Systems as shown 84"41"21"131 1/2 "4" sign panel and supports (2 per support) joining 3/8" x 3" gr. 5 bolt FILE: REVISIONS C TxDOT bc-14.dgn November 2002 9-07 36" match sideslope needed to pin at angle weld starts here weldhere starts weld back fill puddle. weld, do not directions. Minimum going in opposite opposite sides Welds to start on 48" 2" Side View upright 12 ga. 2" x 2" x 2.5' 60" 3" SKID MOUNTED PERFORATED SQUARE STEEL TUBING SIGN SUPPORTS around tubing Completely welded8 1/2" 7/16" 32'SINGLE LEG BASE 5' weld welded to skid tubing sleeve perforated 12 ga. square (hole to hole) 2" x 2" x 8" tubing upright perforated 12 ga. square (hole to hole) 1 3/4 " x 1 3/4 " x 129" tubing skid 12 ga. perforated (hole to hole) 2" x 2" x 59" Standard Division Operations Traffic TYPICAL SIGN SUPPORT BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION SHEET 5 OF 12 BC(5)-14 8-14 DN:CK:DW:CK: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:23 PM100 SHEET 6 OF 12 Standard Division Operations Traffic MESSAGE SIGN (PCMS) PORTABLE CHANGEABLE BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION 23 TxDOT TxDOTTxDOT TxDOT FILE: C TxDOT 9-07 PCMS SIGNS WITHIN THE R.O.W. SHALL BE BEHIND GUARDRAIL OR CONCRETE BARRIER OR SHALL HAVE A MINIMUM OF FOUR (4) PLASTIC DRUMS PLACED PERPENDICULAR TO TRAFFIC ON THE LANES SHIFT in Phase 1 must be used with STAY IN LANE in Phase 2.** Roadway designation # IH-number, US-number, SH-number, FM-number 1. When Full Matrix PCMS signs are used, the character height and legibility/visibility requirements shall be maintained as listed in Note 15 under "PORTABLE CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGNS" above. shall maintain the legibility/visibility requirement listed above. for, or replace that sign. 4. A full matrix PCMS may be used to simulate a flashing arrow board provided it meets the visibility, flash rate and dimming requirements on BC(7), for the same size arrow. FULL MATRIX PCMS SIGNS Access Road ACCS RD Major MAJ Construction WORDING ALTERNATIVES 1. The words RIGHT, LEFT and ALL can be interchanged as appropriate. 2. Roadway designations IH, US, SH, FM and LP can be interchanged as appropriate. 3. EAST, WEST, NORTH and SOUTH (or abbreviations E, W, N and S) can be interchanged as appropriate. 4. Highway names and numbers replaced as appropriate. 5. ROAD, HIGHWAY and FREEWAY can be interchanged as needed. 6. AHEAD may be used instead of distances if necessary. 7. FT and MI, MILE and MILES interchanged as appropriate. 8. AT, BEFORE and PAST interchanged as needed. 9. Distances or AHEAD can be eliminated from the message if a location phase is used. 3. When symbol signs are represented graphically on the Full Matrix PCMS, they shall only supplement the use of the static sign represented, and shall not substitute APPLICATION GUIDELINES 1. Only 1 or 2 phases are to be used on a PCMS. 2. The 1st phase (or both) should be selected from the "Road/Lane/Ramp Closure List" and the "Other Condition List". 3. A 2nd phase can be selected from the "Action to Take/Effect on Travel, Location, General Warning, or Advance Notice Phase Lists". 4. A Location Phase is necessary only if a distance or location is not included in the first phase selected. 5. If two PCMS are used in sequence, they must be separated by and should be understandable by themselves. 6. For advance notice, when the current date is within seven days of the actual work date, calendar days should be replaced with days of the week. Advance notification should typically be for CLOSED BLVD XXXXXXXX **LANE IN STAY CONST AHD CROSSING XING RT LN Vehicles (s)VEH, VEHS UPR LEVEL LWR LEVEL HR, HRS 1. The Engineer/Inspector shall approve all messages used on portable changeable message signs (PCMS). 2. Messages on PCMS should contain no more than 8 words (about four to eight characters per word), not including simple words such as "TO," "FOR," "AT," etc. 3. Messages should consist of a single phase, or two phases that alternate. Three-phase messages are not allowed. Each phase of the message should convey a single thought, and must be understood by itself. 4. Use the word "EXIT" to refer to an exit ramp on a freeway; i.e., "EXIT CLOSED." Do not use the term "RAMP." 5. Always use the route or interstate designation (IH, US, SH, FM) along with the number when referring to a roadway. 6. When in use the bottom of a stationary PCMS message panel should be a minimum 7 feet above the roadway, where possible. 7. The message term "WEEKEND" should be used only if the work is to start on Saturday morning and end by Sunday evening at midnight. Actual days and hours of work should be displayed on the PCMS if work is to begin on Friday evening and/or continue into Monday morning. 8. The Engineer/Inspector may select one of two options which are avail- able for displaying a two-phase message on a PCMS. Each phase may be displayed for either four seconds each or for three seconds each. 9. Do not "flash" messages or words included in a message. The message should be steady burn or continuous while displayed. 10. Do not present redundant information on a two-phase message; i.e., keeping two lines of the message the same and changing the third line. 12. Do not display the message "LANES SHIFT LEFT" or "LANES SHIFT RIGHT" on a PCMS. Drivers do not understand the message. the face of the sign. 14. The following table lists abbreviated words and two-word phrases that are acceptable for use on a PCMS. Both words in a phrase must be displayed together. Words or phrases not on this list should not be PORTABLE CHANGEABLE MESSAGE SIGNS SHOULD BE PLACED WITH ONE DRUM AT EACH OF THE FOUR CORNERS OF THE UNIT. OF TRAFFIC. WHEN EXPOSED TO TWO WAY TRAFFIC, THE FOUR DRUMS UPSTREAM SIDE OF THE PCMS, WHEN EXPOSED TO ONE DIRECTION WHEN NOT IN USE, REMOVE THE PCMS FROM THE RIGHT-OF-WAY OR PLACE THE PCMS BEHIND BARRIER OR GUARDRAIL WITH SIGN PANEL TURNED PARALLEL TO TRAFFIC WORD OR PHRASEABBREVIATION ABBREVIATION WORD OR PHRASE 2. When symbol signs, such as the "Flagger Symbol"(CW20-7) are represented graphically on the Full Matrix PCMS sign and, with the approval of the Engineer, it abbreviated, unless shown in the TMUTCD. bars is appropriate. PCMS has malfunctioned. A pattern such as a series of horizontal solid not alarm motorists and will only be used to alert workers that the 17. If disabled, the PCMS should default to an illegible display that will left or right justified. 16. Each line of text should be centered on the message board rather than and must be legible from at least 400 feet. daylight. Truck mounted units must have a character height of 10 inches should be legible from at least 600 feet at night and 800 feet in units. They should be visible from at least 1/2 (.5) mile and the text 15. PCMS character height should be at least 18 inches for trailer mounted 13. Do not display messages that scroll horizontally or vertically across 11. Do not use the word "Danger" in message. 7-13of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER: no more than one week prior to the work. a minimum of 1000 ft. Each PCMS shall be limited to two phases, RECOMMENDED PHASES AND FORMATS FOR PCMS MESSAGES DURING ROADWORK ACTIVITIES Phase 2: Possible Component Lists CAUTION USE Notice List ** Advance List Warning XX MPH SPEED ADVISORY XX MPH LIMIT SPEED XX MPH SPEED MAXIMUM XX MPH SPEED MINIMUM EXIT LANE RIGHT SAFELY DRIVE CARE WITH DRIVE X PM XX AM- TUE-FRI MONDAY BEGINS MAY XX BEGINS XX AM XX PM - MAY X-X X PM-X AM XX APR XX- FRI-SUN NEXT XX PM TO XX AM AUG XX TUE NEXT XX AM XX PM- TONIGHT Road/Lane/Ramp Closure List (The Engineer may approve other messages not specifically covered here.) * DELAYS EXPECT Other Condition List Phase 1: Condition Lists See Application Guidelines Note 6. List Action to Take/Effect on Travel List Location XXX FT CLOSED SHOULDER XXX FT CLOSED RIGHT LN X MILE CLOSED EXIT XXX CLOSED TO BE RIGHT LN CLOSED ROAD FRONTAGE OPEN LANES RIGHT X CLOSURES LANE DAYTIME CLOSED EXIT I-XX SOUTH TUE - FRI CLOSED X LANES XXX FT ROADWORK XXXX FT FLAGGER XXXX FT NARROWS RIGHT LN XXXX FT TRAFFIC MERGING XXXX FT GRAVEL LOOSE X MILE DETOUR SH XXXX PAST ROADWORK XXXX FT BUMP XXXX FT SIGNAL TRAFFIC XXXX FT REPAIRS ROAD XXXX FT NARROWS LANE XX MILE TRAFFIC TWO-WAY XXXX FT LANES UNEVEN XXXX FT ROAD ROUGH FRI-SUN NEXT ROADWORK X MILES EXIT US XXX SHIFT LANES SOUTH US XXX STAY ON RIGHT MERGE X EXITS NEXT DETOUR US XXX N USE TRUCKS TRUCKS FOR WATCH XXX FT SPEED REDUCE ROUTES OTHER USE RIGHT X LINES FORM RD EXIT XXXXX USE NORTH I-XX USE EXIT TO I-XX N I-XX E USE TRUCKS FOR WATCH DELAYS EXPECT STOP TO PREPARE USE SHOULDER END WORKERS FOR WATCH FM XXXX AT CROSSING RAILROAD BEFORE MILES X NEXT EXIT US XXX PAST XXXXXXX TO XXXXXXX FM XXXX TO US XXX XXX FT TRAFFIC CONST EXIT XXX USE CLOSED EXIT X MILE CLOSED FREEWAY CLOSED LANES RIGHT X CLOSED LANES VARIOUS AT SH XXX CLOSED ROAD FM XXXX CLSD AT ROAD CLOSED LANE CENTER CLOSURES LANE NIGHT CLOSED DRIVEWAY MALL BC(6)-14 8-14 DENTON of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:23 PMSHEET 7 OF 12 CONCRETE TRAFFIC BARRIER (CTB) LOW PROFILE CONCRETE BARRIER (LPCB) 16" DELINEATION OF END TREATMENTS BARRIER REFLECTORS FOR CONCRETE TRAFFIC BARRIER AND ATTENUATORS treatments and manufacturers. the CWZTCD List for approved end Highway Research Report 350. Refer to as defined in the National Cooperative zones shall meet crashworthy standards End treatments used on CTB's in work END TREATMENTS FOR CTB'S USED IN WORK ZONES WARNING LIGHTS 1. Warning lights shall meet the requirements of the TMUTCD. 2. Warning lights shall NOT be installed on barricades. 3. Type A-Low Intensity Flashing Warning Lights are commonly used with drums. They are intended to warn of or mark a potentially hazardous 4. Type-C and Type D 360 degree Steady Burn Lights are intended to be used in a series for delineation to supplement other traffic control devices. Their use shall be as indicated on this sheet and/or other sheets of the plans by the designation "SB". 5. The Engineer/Inspector or the plans shall specify the location and type of warning lights to be installed on the traffic control devices. 6. When required by the Engineer, the Contractor shall furnish a copy of the warning lights certification. The warning light manufacturer will certify the warning lights meet the requirements of the latest ITE Purchase Specifications for Flashing and Steady-Burn Warning Lights. WARNING LIGHTS MOUNTED ON PLASTIC DRUMS 1. Type A flashing warning lights are intended to warn drivers that they are approaching or are in a potentially hazardous area. 2. Type A random flashing warning lights are not intended for delineation and shall not be used in a series. 3. A series of sequential flashing warning lights placed on channelizing devices to form a merging taper may be used for delineation. If used, the successive flashing of the sequential warning lights should occur from the beginning of the taper to the end of the merging taper in order to identify the desired vehicle path. The rate of flashing for each light shall be 65 flashes per minute, plus or minus 10 flashes. 4. Type C and D steady-burn warning lights are intended to be used in a series to delineate the edge of the travel lane on detours, on lane changes, on lane closures, and on other similar conditions. 5. Type A, Type C and Type D warning lights shall be installed at locations as detailed on other sheets in the plans. 6. Warning lights shall not be installed on a drum that has a sign, chevron or vertical panel. 7. The maximum spacing for warning lights on drums should be identical to the channelizing device spacing. 1. A warning reflector or approved substitute may be mounted on a plastic drum as a substitute for a Type C, steady burn warning light at the discretion of the Contractor unless otherwise noted in the plans. 2. The warning reflector shall be yellow in color and shall be manufactured using a sign substrate approved for use with plastic drums listed on the CWZTCD. 3. The warning reflector shall have a minimum retroreflective surface area (one-side) of 30 square inches. 4. Round reflectors shall be fully reflectorized, including the area where attached to the drum. 5. Square substrates must have a minimum of 30 square inches of reflectorized sheeting. They do not have to be reflectorized where it attaches to the drum. 6. The side of the warning reflector facing approaching traffic shall have sheeting meeting the color and retroreflectivity requirements for 7. When used near two-way traffic, both sides of the warning reflector shall be reflectorized. 8. The warning reflector should be mounted on the side of the handle nearest approaching traffic. 9. The maximum spacing for warning reflectors should be identical to the channelizing device spacing requirements. WARNING REFLECTORS MOUNTED ON PLASTIC DRUMS AS A SUBSTITUTE FOR TYPE C (STEADY BURN) WARNING LIGHTS Reflectors Barrier 3. Where traffic is on one side of the CTB, two (2) Barrier Reflectors shall be mounted in approximately the midsection of each section of CTB. An alternate mounting location is uniformly spaced at one end of each CTB. This will allow for attachment of a barrier grapple without damaging the reflector. The Barrier Reflector mounted on the side of the CTB shall be located directly below the reflector mounted on top of the barrier, as shown in the detail above. 4. Where CTB separates two-way traffic, three barrier reflectors shall be mounted on each section of CTB. The reflector unit on top shall have two yellow reflective faces (Bi-Directional)while the reflectors on each side of the barrier shall have one yellow reflective face, as shown in the detail above. 5. When CTB separates traffic traveling in the same direction, no barrier reflectors will be required on top of the CTB. 6. Barrier Reflector units shall be yellow or white in color to match the edgeline being supplemented. 7. Maximum spacing of Barrier Reflectors is forty (40) feet. 8. Pavement markers or temporary flexible-reflective roadway marker tabs shall NOT be used as CTB delineation. 9. Attachment of Barrier Reflectors to CTB shall be per manufacturer's recommendations. 10.Missing or damaged Barrier Reflectors shall be replaced as directed by the Engineer. 11.Single slope barriers shall be delineated as shown on the above detail. See D & OM (VIA) recommendations. as per manufacturer's 3 Barrier Reflectors Install a minimum of TRUCK-MOUNTED ATTENUATORS Type C Warning Light or approved substitute mounted on a drum adjacent to the travel way. 4. The Flashing Arrow Board should be able to display the following symbols: control devices that should be used in conjunction with the Flashing Arrow Board. 3. The Engineer/Inspector shall choose all appropriate signs, barricades and/or other traffic or work on shoulders unless the "CAUTION" display (see detail below) is used. 2. Flashing Arrow Boards should not be used on two-lane, two-way roadways, detours, diversions moving maintenance or construction activities on the travel lanes. 1. The Flashing Arrow Board should be used for all lane closures on multi-lane roadways, or slow to bottom of panel. 14. Minimum mounting height of trailer mounted Arrow Boards should be 7 feet from roadway flash rate and dimming requirements on this sheet for the same size arrow. 13. A full matrix PCMS may be used to simulate a Flashing Arrow Board provided it meets visibility, 12. A Flashing Arrow Board SHALL NOT BE USED to laterally shift traffic. 11. The Flashing Arrow Board shall be mounted on a vehicle, trailer or other suitable support. display may be used during daylight operations. 10. The flashing arrow display is the TxDOT standard; however, the sequential Chevron 9. The sequential arrow display is NOT ALLOWED. intervals of 25 percent for each sequential phase of the flashing chevron. 8. Minimum lamp "on time" shall be approximately 50 percent for the flashing arrow and equal The flashing rate of the lamps shall not be less than 25 nor more than 40 flashes per minute. 7. The Flashing Arrow Board shall be capable of minimum 50 percent dimming from rated lamp voltage. 6. The straight line caution display is NOT ALLOWED. Diamond Caution mode as shown. 5. The "CAUTION" display consists of four corner lamps flashing simultaneously, or the Alternating REQUIREMENTS C 48 x 96 15 1 mile B 30 x 60 13 3/4 mile MINIMUM TRAFFIC BARRIER OR GUARDRAIL. ARROW BOARD BEHIND CONCRETE RIGHT-OF-WAY OR PLACE THE THE ARROW BOARD FROM THE WHEN NOT IN USE, REMOVE shall be equipped with automatic dimming devices. Flashing Arrow Boards devices placed perpendicular to traffic on the upstream side of traffic. taper or merging taper, otherwise they shall be delineated with four (4) channelizing Arrow Boards may be located behind channelizing devices in place for a shoulder ATTENTION LEFT & RIGHT CHEVRON ARROWLEFT & RIGHT ALTERNATING DIAMOND CAUTION DOUBLE ARROW OR 4 CORNER CAUTION FLASHING ARROW BOARDS 16" tall plastic bracket Barrier Reflector on manufacturer's recommendations. Attach the delineators as per reflectors is 20 feet. Max. spacing of barrier extended distance from the TMA. area is spread down the roadway and the work crew is an 6. The only reason a TMA should not be required is when a work without adversely affecting the work performance. 30 to 100 feet in advance of the area of crew exposure 5. A TMA should be used anytime that it can be positioned in the plans. 4. TMAs are required on freeways unless otherwise noted 3. Refer to the CWZTCD for a list of approved TMAs. Level 3 TMAs. 2. Refer to the CWZTCD for the requirements of Level 2 or or the Manual for Assessing Safety Hardware (MASH). Cooperative Highway Research Report No. 350 (NCHRP 350) must meet the requirements outlined in the National 1. Truck-mounted attenuators (TMA) used on TxDOT facilities 8. The location of warning lights and warning reflectors on drums shall be as shown elsewhere in the plans. 7. When used to delineate curves, Type-C and Type D Steady Burn Lights should only be placed on the outside of the curve, not the inside. DMS 8300-Type B or Type C. 30 square inches reflective surface area of at least or square.Must have a yellow Warning reflector may be round FL FL area. Their use shall be as indicated on this sheet and/or other sheets of the plans by the designation "FL". The Type A Warning Lights shall not be used with signs manufactured with Type B or C Sheeting meeting the requirements of Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300. BC(7)-14 7-13 WARNING LIGHTS & ATTENUATOR ARROW PANEL, REFLECTORS, BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 101 Standard Division Operations Traffic 9-07 24 1. Barrier Reflectors shall be pre-qualified, and conform to the color and reflectivity requirements of DMS-8600. A list of prequalified Barrier Reflectors can be found at the Material Producer List web address shown on BC(1). 2. Color of Barrier Reflectors shall be as specified in the TMUTCD. The cost of the reflectors shall be considered subsidiary to Item 512. 8-14 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:24 PMSHEET 8 OF 12 4-03 9-07 mount with diagonals sloping down towards travel way (Maximum Sign Dimension) 18" x 24" Sign 1. For long term stationary work zones on freeways, drums shall be used as the primary channelizing device. 2. For intermediate term stationary work zones on freeways, drums should be used as the primary channelizing device but may be replaced in tangent sections by vertical panels, or 42" two-piece cones. In tangent sections if personnel are present on the project at all times to maintain the cones in proper position and location. 3. For short term stationary work zones on freeways, drums are the preferred approved by the Engineer. 4. Drums and all related items shall comply with the requirements of the current version of the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" (TMUTCD) and the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD). 5. Drums, bases, and related materials shall exhibit good workmanship and shall be free from objectionable marks or defects that would adversely 6. The Contractor shall have a maximum of 24 hours to replace any plastic drums identified for replacement by the Engineer/Inspector. The replace- ment device must be an approved device. 1. Plastic drums shall be a two-piece design; the "body" of the drum shall be the top portion and the "base" shall be the bottom. 2. The body and base shall lock together in such a manner that the body separates from the base when impacted by a vehicle traveling at a speed of 20 MPH or greater but prevents accidental separation due to normal handling and/or air turbulence created by passing vehicles. 3. Plastic drums shall be constructed of lightweight flexible, and deformable materials. The Contractor shall NOT use metal drums or single piece plastic drums as channelization devices or sign supports. 4. Drums shall present a profile that is a minimum of 18 inches in width at the 36 inch height when viewed from any direction. The height of drum unit (body installed on base) shall be a minimum of 36 inches and a maximum of 42 inches. 5. The top of the drum shall have a built-in handle for easy pickup and shall be designed to drain water and not collect debris. The handle shall have a minimum of two widely spaced 9/16 inch diameter holes to allow attachment of a warning light, warning reflector unit or approved compliant sign. 6. The exterior of the drum body shall have a minimum of four alternating orange and white retroreflective circumferential stripes not less than 4 inches nor greater than 8 inches in width. Any non-reflectorized space between any two adjacent stripes shall not exceed 2 inches in width. 7. Bases shall have a maximum width of 36 inches, a maximum height of 4 inches, and a minimum of two footholds of sufficient size to allow base to be held down while separating the drum body from the base. 8. Plastic drums shall be constructed of ultra-violet stabilized, orange, high-density polyethylene (HDPE) or other approved material. Chevron CW1-8, Opposing Traffic Lane Divider, Driveway sign D70a, Keep Right channelizing device but may be replaced in tapers, transitions and tangent one-piece cones may be used with the approval of the Engineer but only 1. Signs used on plastic drums shall be manufactured using substrates listed on the CWZTCD. 2. Chevrons and other work zone signs with an orange background 3. Vertical Panels shall be manufactured with orange and white 4. Other sign messages (text or symbolic) may be used as approved by the Engineer. Sign dimensions shall not exceed 5. Signs shall be installed using a 1/2 inch bolt (nominal) and nut, two washers, and one locking washer for each connection. 6. Mounting bolts and nuts shall be fully engaged and adequately torqued. Bolts should not extend more than 1/2 inch beyond nuts. 7. Chevrons may be placed on drums on the outside of curves, on merging tapers or on shifting tapers. When used in these locations they may be placed on every drum or spaced not more than on every third drum. A minimum of three (3) should be used at each location called for in the plans. approval of the Engineer. 8. R9-9, R9-10, R9-11 and R9-11a Sidewalk Closed signs which are 24 inches wide may be mounted on plastic drums, with Vertical Panel 12" x 24" ON PLASTIC DRUMS SIGNS, CHEVRONS, AND VERTICAL PANELS MOUNTED by Engineer R4 series or other signs as approved GENERAL DESIGN REQUIREMENTS GENERAL NOTES 1. The stripes used on drums shall be constructed of sheeting meeting the 1. Unballasted bases shall be large enough to hold up to 50 lbs. of sand. This base, when filled with the ballast material, should weigh between 35 lbs (minimum) and 50 lbs (maximum). The ballast may be sand in one to three sandbags separate from the base, sand in a sand-filled plastic base, or other ballasting devices as approved by the Engineer. Stacking of sandbags will be allowed, however height of sandbags above pavement surface may not exceed 12 inches. 2. Bases with built-in ballast shall weigh between 40 lbs. and 50 lbs. Built-in ballast can be constructed of an integral crumb rubber base or a solid rubber base. would become hazardous to motorists, pedestrians, or workers when the drum is struck by a vehicle. holes in the bottoms so that water will not collect and freeze becoming a hazard when struck by a vehicle. color and retroreflectivity requirements of Departmental Materials 2. The sheeting shall be suitable for use on and shall adhere to the drum surface such that, upon vehicular impact, the sheeting shall remain adhered in-place and exhibit no delaminating, cracking, or loss of retroreflectivity other than that loss due to abrasion of the sheeting surface. 24" 36"8" 12" 4" White 4" Orange 45o CW1-6L 18" minHandle 36" min42" max4" max 4" max(typ) 8" max 4" min (typ.) 2" max dia. max) Base (36" drums minimum of 5 for stacking a Taper to allow debris of water or allow collection Top should not warning lights signs and for mounting 9/16" dia. (typ) DIRECTION INDICATOR BARRICADE DETECTABLE PEDESTRIAN BARRICADES BALLAST RETROREFLECTIVE SHEETING 10.Drum and base shall be marked with manufacturer's name and model number. sections by vertical panels, two-piece cones or one-piece cones as plastic drums substrates shall NOT be used on Plywood, Aluminum or Metal sign 36" Barricades Detectable Pedestrian providers of approved and the CWZTCD list for for fabrication. See note 3 This detail is not intended rail for hand trailing Continuous smooth Detectable Edge 2" Max. trailing with no splinters, burrs, or sharp edges. rail provides a smooth continuous rail suitable for hand barricade rails as shown on BC(10) provided that the top 6. Detectable pedestrian barricades may use 8" nominal barricades. 5. Warning lights shall not be attached to detectable pedestrian as a control for pedestrian movements. for Buildings and Facilities (ADAAG)" and should not be used "Americans with Disabilities Act Accessibility Guidelines detectable, do not comply with the design standards in the 4. Tape, rope, or plastic chain strung between devices are not path. detectable edging can satisfactorily delineate a pedestrian barriers, and wood or chain link fencing with a continuous above, longitudinal channelizing devices, some concrete 3. Detectable pedestrian barricades similar to the one pictured shall be placed across the full width of the closed sidewalk. with a visual disability traveling with the aid of a long cane closed sidewalk, a device that is detectable by a person 2. Where pedestrians with visual disabilities normally use the the features present in the existing pedestrian facility. detectable and include accessibility features consistent with relocated in a TTC zone, the temporary facilities shall be 1. When existing pedestrian facilities are disrupted, closed, or 9. Drum body shall have a maximum unballasted weight of 11 lbs. for this type of ballast on the CWZTCD list. 3. Recycled truck tire sidewalls may be used for ballast on drums approved 4. The ballast shall not be heavy objects, water, or any material that 5. When used in regions susceptible to freezing, drums shall have drainage 6. Ballast shall not be placed on top of drums. 7. Adhesives may be used to secure base of drums to pavement. series signs discussed in note 8 below. 18 inches in width or 24 inches in height, except for the R9 Specification DMS-8300, "Sign Face Materials." Type A reflective sheeting shall be supplied unless otherwise specified in the plans. FL the intended traveled lane. Diagonal stripes on Vertical Panels shall slope down toward sheeting meeting the requirements of DMS-8300 Type A FL Ballast shall be as approved by the manufacturers instructions. 5. Approved manufacturers are shown on the CWZTCD List. allowed. 4. Double arrows on the Direction Indicator Barricade will not be shall be as per DMS 8300. 45 degrees in the direction road users are to pass. Sheeting types white and orange stripes sloping downward at an angle of above a rail with Type A retroreflective sheeting in alternating 4" on a background of Type B or Type C Orange retroreflective sheeting Large Arrow (CW1-6) sign in the size shown with a black arrow 3. The Direction Indicator Barricade shall consist of One-Direction the intended travel lane. in series to direct the driver through the transition and into 2. If used, the Direction Indicator Barricade should be used guidance to drivers is necessary. transitions, and other areas where specific directional 1. The Direction Indicator Barricade may be used in tapers, FL FL specified in the plans. of DMS-8300, "Sign Face Material," unless otherwise sheeting meeting the color and retroreflectivity requirements shall be manufactured with Type B or Type C Orange being orange. with the top stripe reflective sheeting using Type A retro- and 2 white stripes a minimum of 2 orange Each drum shall have 7-13 CHANNELIZING DEVICES BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION FILE:DATE:102 Standard Division Operations Traffic 25 Pre-qualified plastic drums shall meet the following requirements:of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER: affect their appearance or serviceability. BC(8)-14 8-14 DENTON of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:24 PMSHEET 9 OF 1224" min.36" min. distance above travel way45 VP-1L VP-1R o 45o 36" 12" 36" 18" 18" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4" 4" DRIVEABLE PORTABLE FIXED (Rigid or self-righting) (Rigid or self-righting) 1. Work Zone channelizing devices illustrated on this sheet may be installed in close proximity to traffic and are suitable for use on high or low speed roadways. The Engineer/Inspector shall ensure that spacing and placement is uniform and in accordance with the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" (TMUTCD). 2. Channelizing devices shown on this sheet may have a driveable, fixed or portable base. The requirement for self-righting channelizing devices must be specified in the General Notes or other plan sheets. 3. Channelizing devices on self-righting supports should be used in work zone areas where channelizing devices are frequently impacted by errant vehicles or vehicle related wind gusts making alignment of the channelizing devices difficult to maintain. Locations of these devices shall be detailed else- where in the plans. These devices shall conform to the TMUTCD and the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD). damaged, nonreflective, faded, or broken devices and bases as required by the Engineer/Inspector. The Contractor shall be required to maintain proper device spacing and alignment. 5. Portable bases shall be fabricated from virgin and/or recycled rubber. The 6. Pavement surfaces shall be prepared in a manner that ensures proper bonding between the adhesives, the fixed mount bases and the pavement surface. Adhesives shall be prepared and applied according to the manufacturer's recommendations. 7. The installation and removal of channelizing devices shall not cause detrimental effects to the final pavement surfaces, including pavement permitted on final pavement surfaces. The Engineer/Inspector shall approve all application and removal procedures of fixed bases. 1. Opposing Traffic Lane Dividers (OTLD) are delineation devices designed to convert a normal one-way roadway section to two-way operation. OTLD's are used on temporary centerlines. The upward and downward arrows on the sign's face indicate the direction of traffic on either side of the divider. The 3. Spacing between the OTLD shall not exceed 500 the OTLD's should not exceed 100 foot spacing. 4. The OTLD shall be orange with a black non- reflective legend. Sheeting for the OTLD shall 1. The chevron shall be a vertical rectangle with a minimum size of 12 by 18 inches. 2. Chevrons are intended to give notice of a sharp change of alignment with the direction of travel and provide additional emphasis and guidance for vehicle operators with regard to changes in horizontal alignment of the roadway. 3. Chevrons, when used, shall be erected on the out- side of a sharp curve or turn, or on the far side of an intersection. They shall be in line with and at right angles to approaching traffic. Spacing should be such that the motorist always has three in view, until the change in alignment eliminates its need. 4. To be effective, the chevron should be visible for at least 500 feet. 5. Chevrons shall be orange with a black nonreflec- tive legend. Sheeting for the chevron shall be 6. For Long Term Stationary use on tapers or transitions on freeways and divided highways self-righting chevrons may be used to supplement plastic drums but not to replace plastic drums. 4. The Contractor shall maintain devices in a clean condition and replace surface discoloration or surface integrity. Driveable bases shall not be 1. Vertical Panels (VP's) are normally used to channelize traffic or divide opposing lanes of traffic. 2. VP's may be used in daytime or nighttime situations. They may be used at the edge of shoulder drop-offs and other areas such as lane transitions where positive daytime and nighttime delineation is required. The Engineer/Inspector shall refer to the Roadway Design Manual Appendix B "Treatment of Pavement Drop-offs in Work Zones" for additional guidelines on the use of VP's for drop-offs. 3. VP's should be mounted back to back if used at the edge of cuts adjacent to two-way two lane roadways. Stripes are to be reflective orange and reflective white and should always slope downward toward the travel lane. of retroreflective area facing traffic. 5. Self-righting supports are available with portable base. See "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD). CW6-4 8" to 12"8" to 12"8" to 12"8" to 12" 8" to 12" WATER BALLASTED SYSTEMS USED AS BARRIERS 1. Water ballasted systems used as barriers shall not be used solely to channelize road users, but also to protect the work space per the appropriate NCHRP 350 crashworthiness requirements based on roadway speed and barrier application. 2. Water ballasted systems used to channelize vehicular traffic shall be supplemented with retroreflective delineation or channelizing devices to improve daytime/nighttime visibility. They may also be supplemented with pavement markings. 3. Water ballasted systems used as barriers shall be placed in accordance to application and installation requirements specific to the device, and used only when shown on the CWZTCD list. 4. Water ballasted systems used as barriers should not be used for a merging taper except in low speed (less than 45 MPH) urban areas. When used on a taper in a low speed urban area, the taper shall be delineated and the taper length should be designed to optimize road user operations considering the available geometric conditions. 5. When water ballasted systems used as barriers have blunt ends exposed to traffic, they should be attenuated Surface Roadway Base Mount Surface min. 24" min. 24" Adhesive w/ Approved Fixed Base depth embedment 12" minimum min. 36" Support Self-righting Support Rigid Support can be used) (Driveable Base, or Flexible Fixed Base w/ Approved Adhesive on drums. mounted or may be may be used, Driveable Base Fixed or Portable, back to back mounted Panels speed roadways, may have more than 270 square inches unless noted otherwise. conforming to Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300, GENERAL NOTES Taper lengths have been rounded off. S=Posted Speed (MPH) L=Length of Taper (FT.) W=Width of Offset (FT.) ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed On a Tangent On a Taper 12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Minimum Desirable Taper Lengths Suggested Maximum Spacing of Channelizing Devices Formula L=WS 80 800'880'960'80'160' LONGITUDINAL CHANNELIZING DEVICES (LCD) 2. LCDs may be used instead of a line of cones or drums. used only when shown on the CWZTCD list. 3. LCDs shall be placed in accordance to application and installation requirements specific to the device, and 4. LCDs should not be used to provide positive protection for obstacles, pedestrians or workers. connected together. They are not designed to contain or redirect a vehicle on impact. 1. LCDs are crashworthy, lightweight, deformable devices that are highly visible, have good target value and can be adhesive or rubber weight to minimize movement base is secured to the pavement with an caused by a vehicle impact or wind gust. portable bases shall weigh a minimum of 30 lbs. 6. Sheeting for the VP's shall be retroreflective Type A FL FL as per manufacturer recommendations or flared to a point outside the clear zone. of the unit shall not be less than 32 inches in height. systems must have a continuous detectable bottom for users of long canes and the top If used to channelize pedestrians, longitudinal channelizing devices or water ballasted 2. The OTLD may be used in combination with 42" cones or VPs. feet. 42" cones or VPs placed between the requirements of DMS-8300. unless noted otherwise. The legend shall meet to Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300, be retroreflective Type B or Type C conforming FL requirements of DMS-8300. unless noted otherwise. The legend shall meet the Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300, retroreflective Type B or Type C conforming to FL Min. 18" 12" note 7 See note 7 See note 7 See CHEVRONS VERTICAL PANELS (VPs) HOLLOW OR WATER BALLASTED SYSTEMS USED AS LONGITUDINAL CHANNELIZING DEVICES OR BARRIERSOPPOSING TRAFFIC LANE DIVIDERS (OTLD) MINIMUM DESIRABLE TAPER LENGTHS CHANNELIZING DEVICES AND SUGGESTED MAXIMUM SPACING OF 7. Where the height of reflective material on the vertical 6 inches shall be used. panel is 36 inches or greater, a panel stripe of 4. VP's used on expressways and freeways or other high 7-13 CHANNELIZING DEVICES BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT BC(9)-14 CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 103 Standard Division Operations Traffic 9-07 26 LCD along the full length of the device. sheeting meeting the requirements for barricade rails as shown on BC(10) placed near the top of the 6. LCDs used as barricades placed perpendicular to traffic should have at least one row of reflective on BC(7) when placed roughly parallel to the travel lanes. 5. LCDs shall be supplemented with retroreflective delineation as required for temporary barriers 8-14 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT bc-14.dgn November 2002 c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:25 PM104 SHEET 10 OF 12 9-07 2" max.3"-4" 1. Where positive redirectional 2. Plastic construction fencing safety as required in the plans. 3. Vertical Panels on flexible support capability is provided, drums may be omitted.SB SB SB SB 6" min. 4" min. 3" min. 3" min. may be used with drums for may be omitted if drums are used. Detour Roadway R11-2 M4-10L DETOUR ROAD CLOSED NAME ADDRESS CITY STATE CONTRACTOR 30 feet 2" min. 3"-4" 6" min. 4" min. 2" min. shoulder width is less than 4 feet. than 12 feet, steady-burn lights 42" 4" 4" 4" 4" 2" 2" 2"EDGELINE CHANNELIZER PLAN VIEW PLAN VIEW 2. Advance signing shall be as specified elsewhere in the plans. PERSPECTIVE VIEW PERSPECTIVE VIEW 3"-4" 2" min. 10' may be substituted for drums when the 4. When the shoulder width is greater 1. This device is intended only for use in place of a vertical panel to 2" min. 2" min. 4" min. orange 4" min. white 4" min. orange 4" min. white Drums, vertical panels or 42" cones STOCKPILE channelize traffic by indicating the edge of the travel lane. It is not intended to be used in transitions or tapers. 2. This device shall not be used to separate lanes of traffic (opposing or otherwise) or warn of objects. 3. This device is based on a 42 inch, two-piece cone with an alternate striping pattern: four 4 inch retroreflective bands, with an approximate 2 inch gap between bands. The color of the band should correspond to the color of the edgeline (yellow for left edgeline, white for right edgeline) for which the device is substituted or for which it supplements. The reflectorized bands shall be retroreflective at 50' maximum spacing omitted here or barricade may be downstream drums On one-way roads within 30' from travel lane. should be used when stockpile is Channelizing devices parallel to traffic Two-Piece cones One-Piece cones Tubular Marker G20-6T SB CONES 3" to 4" 2" to 6" Alternate Alternate clear zone. is outside stockpile location Desirable Plastic Drum Typical min. 28" min. 28" min. 28"min. 42" on one-way roadway are not required These drums barricaded in the same manner. divided highway shall be Each roadway of a and maximum of 4 drums) width makes it necessary. (minimum of 2 side of approaching traffic if the crown Increase number of plastic drums on the be used across the work area.A minimum of two drums shall50' Approx. 50' Approx. 1. Refer to the Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List (CWZTCD) projects closed to all traffic. 3. Barricades extending across a roadway should have stripes that slope downward in the direction toward which traffic must turn in detouring. When both right and left turns are provided, the chevron striping may slope downward in both directions from the center of the barricade. Where no turns are provided at a closed road striping should slope downward in both directions toward the center of roadway. 4. Striping of rails, for the right side of the roadway, should slope downward to the left. For the left side of the roadway, striping should slope downward to the right. 5. Identification markings may be shown only on the back of the barricade rails. The maximum height of letters and/or company logos used for identification shall be 1". 6. Barricades shall not be placed parallel to traffic unless an adequate clear zone is provided. 7. Warning lights shall NOT be installed on barricades. 8. Where barricades require the use of weights to keep from turning over, the use of sandbags with dry, cohesionless sand is recommended. The sandbags will be tied shut to keep the sand from spilling and to maintain a constant weight. Sand bags shall not be stacked in a manner that covers any portion of a barricade rails reflective sheeting. Rock, concrete, iron, steel or other solid objects will NOT be permitted. Sandbags should weigh a minimum of 35 lbs and a maximum of 50 lbs. Sandbags shall be made of a durable material that tears upon vehicular impact. Rubber (such as tire inner tubes) shall not be used for sandbags. Sandbags shall only be placed along or upon the base supports of the device and shall not be suspended above ground level or hung with rope, wire, chains or other fasteners. be used as a sign support. Barricades shall NOT 10' max.10' max.10' max.4. The base must weigh a minimum of 30 lbs. or yellow warning reflector Steady burn warning light or yellow warning reflector Plastic drum with steady burn light Plastic drum LEGEND of the culvert widening. 5. Drums must extend the length 30 lbs. including base. 42" 2-piece cones shall have a minimum weight of 28" Cones shall have a minimum weight of 9 1/2 lbs. CULVERT WIDENING OR OTHER ISOLATED WORK WITHIN THE PROJECT LIMITS TRAFFIC CONTROL FOR MATERIAL STOCKPILES TYPICAL PANEL DETAIL FOR SKID OR POST TYPE BARRICADES TYPICAL STRIPING DETAIL FOR BARRICADE RAIL 8' max. length Type 3 Barricades downward in the direction of detour. Barricade striping should slant for two-way traffic. facing one-way traffic and both sides reflective white stripes on one side shall be reflectorized orange and The three rails on Type 3 barricades barricade or 1 Type 3 Min. 2 drums barricade or 1 Type 3 Min. 2 drums TYPE 3 BARRICADES 2. Type 3 Barricades shall be used at each end of construction TYPE 3 BARRICADE (POST AND SKID) TYPICAL APPLICATION minimum of 10 feet behind Type 3 Barricades. mounting height in center of roadway. The signs should be a 1. Signs should be mounted on independent supports at a 7 foot 1. Traffic cones and tubular markers shall be predominantly orange, and meet the height and weight requirements shown above. 2. One-piece cones have the body and base of the cone molded in one consolidated unit. Two-piece cones have a cone shaped body and a separate rubber base, or ballast, that is added to keep the device upright and in place. height shown, in order to aid in retrieving the device. 3. Two-piece cones may have a handle or loop extending up to 8" above the minimum reflective bands as shown above. The reflective bands shall have a smooth, sealed 7. Cones or tubular markers used on each project should be of the same size and shape. to maintain them in their proper upright position. for intermediate-term or long-term stationary work unless personnel is on-site short-term stationary work as defined on BC(4). These should not be used 5. 28" cones and tubular markers are generally suitable for short duration and durations. 6. 42" two-piece cones, vertical panels or drums are suitable for all work zone 4. Cones or tubular markers used at night shall have white or white and orange DMS-8300 Type A. outer surface and meet the requirements of Departmental Material Specification unless otherwise noted. Type A conforming to Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300, 45o 6"6"7 inches. Sheeting Reflective Width of Minimum nominal 8" 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic PROJECTS LET AFTER MARCH 2014. THIS DEVICE SHALL NOT BE USED ON BC(10)-14 CHANNELIZING DEVICES BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTIONof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:27 to Departmental Material Specification DMS-8300 unless otherwise noted. 9. Sheeting for barricades shall be retroreflective Type A conforming for details of the Type 3 Barricades and a list of all materials used in the construction of Type 3 Barricades.20"20"48"Flat rail Stiffener 2 stiffeners shall be allowed on one barricade. Stiffener may be inside or outside of support, but no more than 4' min., 8' max. 8-14 DENTON of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:25 PMSHEET 11 OF 12 TOP VIEW FRONT VIEW SIDE VIEW Adhesive pad 4"+ ‚" 2" GENERAL REMOVAL OF PAVEMENT MARKINGS 1. The Contractor shall be responsible for maintaining work zone and within the CSJ limits unless otherwise stated in the plans. 2. Color, patterns and dimensions shall be in conformance with the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" (TMUTCD). 3. Additional supplemental pavement marking details may be found in the plans or specifications. 4. Pavement markings shall be installed in accordance with the TMUTCD and as shown on the plans. 5. When short term markings are required on the plans, short term markings shall conform with the TMUTCD, the plans and details as shown on the Standard Plan Sheet WZ(STPM). 6. When standard pavement markings are not in place and the roadway is opened to traffic, DO NOT PASS signs shall be erected to mark the beginning of the sections where passing is prohibited and PASS WITH CARE signs at the beginning of sections where passing is permitted. 7. All work zone pavement markings shall be installed in accordance with Item 662, "Work Zone Pavement Markings." RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS 1. Raised pavement markers are to be placed according to the patterns on BC(12). 2. All raised pavement markers used for work zone markings shall meet PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS 1. Removable prefabricated pavement markings shall meet the requirements of DMS-8241. 2. Non-removable prefabricated pavement markings (foil back) shall meet the requirements of DMS-8240. MAINTAINING WORK ZONE PAVEMENT MARKINGS 1. The Contractor will be responsible for maintaining work zone pavement markings within the work limits. 2. Work zone pavement markings shall be inspected in accordance with the frequency and reporting requirements of work zone traffic control device inspections as required by Form 599. 3. The markings should provide a visible reference for a minimum distance of 300 feet during normal daylight hours and 160 feet when illuminated by automobile low-beam headlights at night, unless sight distance is restricted by roadway geometrics. 4. Markings failing to meet this criteria within the first 30 days after placement shall be replaced at the expense of the Contractor as per Specification Item 662. days, where flaggers and/or sufficient channelizing devices are used in lieu of markings to outline the detour route. 3. Pavement markings shall be removed to the fullest extent possible, so as not to leave a discernable marking. This shall be by any method approved by TxDOT Specification Item 677 for "Eliminating Existing Pavement Markings and Markers". 4. The removal of pavement markings may require resurfacing or seal 5. Subject to the approval of the Engineer, any method that proves to be successful on a particular type pavement may be used. 6. Blast cleaning may be used but will not be required unless specifically 7. Over-painting of the markings SHALL NOT BE permitted. 8. Removal of raised pavement markers shall be as directed by the Engineer. 9. Removal of existing pavement markings and markers will be paid for directly in accordance with Item 677, "ELIMINATING EXISTING PAVEMENT MARKINGS AND MARKERS," unless otherwise stated in the plans. 10.Black-out marking tape may be used to cover conflicting existing markings for periods less than two weeks when approved by the Engineer. 1. Temporary flexible-reflective roadway marker tabs used as guidemarks shall meet the requirements of DMS-8242. 2. Tabs detailed on this sheet are to be inspected and accepted by the Engineer or designated representative. Sampling and testing is not normally required, however at the option of the Engineer, either "A" or "B" below may be imposed to assure quality before placement on the roadway. B. Select five (5) tabs and perform the following test. Affix five (5) tabs at 24 inch intervals on an asphaltic pavement in a straight line. Using a medium size passenger vehicle or pickup, run over the markers with the front and rear tires at a speed of 35 to 40 miles per hour, four (4) times in each direction. No more than one (1) out of the five (5) reflective surfaces shall be lost or displaced as a result of this test. 3. Small design variances may be noted between tab manufacturers. 4. See Standard Sheet WZ(STPM) for tab placement on new pavements. See 1. Raised pavement markers used as guidemarks shall be from the approved product list, and meet the requirements of DMS-4200. 3. Adhesive for guidemarks shall be bituminous material hot applied or butyl rubber pad for all surfaces, or thermoplastic for concrete surfaces. Guidemarks shall be designated as: YELLOW - (two amber reflective surfaces with yellow body). WHITE - (one silver reflective surface with white body). Standard Sheet TCP(7-1) for tab placement on seal coat work. TABS TO THE PAVEMENT SURFACE TEMPORARY FLEXIBLE-REFLECTIVE ROADWAY MARKER STAPLES OR NAILS SHALL NOT BE USED TO SECURE 1/4" and less than 1". is usually more than Height of sheeting WORK ZONE PAVEMENT MARKINGS Roadway Marker Tabs Temporary Flexible-Reflective DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS DMS-6130 EPOXY AND ADHESIVES DMS-6100 DMS-4300 DMS-8240 DMS-8241 DMS-8242 DMS-4200 TRAFFIC BUTTONS PERMANENT PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS PAVEMENT MARKINGS TEMPORARY REMOVABLE, PREFABRICATED ROADWAY MARKER TABS TEMPORARY FLEXIBLE, REFLECTIVE A list of prequalified reflective raised pavement markers, non-reflective traffic buttons, roadway marker tabs and other pavement markings can be found at the Material Producer List web address shown on BC(1). BITUMINOUS ADHESIVE FOR PAVEMENT MARKERS PAVEMENT MARKERS (REFLECTORIZED) RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS USED AS GUIDEMARKS project shall be of the same manufacturer. 2. All temporary construction raised pavement markers provided on a the requirements of Item 672, "RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS" and Departmental Material Specification DMS-4200 or DMS-4300. shown in the plans. existing pavement markings, in accordance with the standard specifications and special provisions, on all roadways open to traffic 1. Pavement markings that are no longer applicable, could create confusion or direct a motorist toward or into the closed portion of the roadway shall be removed or obliterated before the roadway is opened to traffic. Section to determine specification compliance. and submit to the Construction Division, Materials and Pavement A. Select five (5) or more tabs at random from each lot or shipment 2. The above shall not apply to detours in place for less than three coating portions of the roadway as described in Item 677. 7-13 PAVEMENT MARKINGS BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTION DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT BC(11)-14 CONT bc-14.dgn February 1998 105 Standard Division Operations Traffic 9-07 11-02 1-02 2-98 288-14 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT bc-14.dgn February 1998 c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\bc-14.dgn8/5/20201:45:25 PM106 SHEET 12 OF 12 9-071-97 2-98 11-02 10 to 12" PAVEMENT MARKING PATTERNS Yellow Yellow White White Yellow Yellow Yellow Type II-A-A Type II-A-A Type Y buttons Type Y buttons Type II-A-A Type II-A-A Type I-A Type I-A Type W buttons Type I-C Type Y buttons Type Y buttons Type W buttons Type I-C Type I-C or II-C-R Type I-C or II-C-R 10'30' - - - DISCOURAGE LANE CHANGING.) EDGE LINE OR SINGLE Yellow White White or Yellow White or Yellow NO-PASSING LINE WIDE LINE (FOR LEFT TURN CHANNELIZING LINE OR CHANNELIZING LINE USED TO Type Y buttons Type I-C , I-A or II-A-A Type W or Y buttons Type I-C Type W buttons Type I-C or II-A-A STANDARD WORK ZONE PAVEMENT MARKINGS DETAILS Type II-A-A REMOVABLE MARKINGS WITH RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS Type I-C or II-A-A (when required) Raised Pavement Markers If raised pavement markers are used to supplement REMOVABLE markings, the markers shall be applied to the top of the tape at the approximate mid length of tape used for broken 60" + 3" -REFLECTORIZED PAVEMENT MARKINGS - PATTERN B REFLECTORIZED PAVEMENT MARKINGS - PATTERN A REFLECTORIZED PAVEMENT MARKINGS 10 to 12" 4 to 8"6 to 8" 60" + 3" 60" + 3" 4" 4 to 12" 4 to 12" 4" 8" 1-2" 10' 10'30' 40' + 1' 5' + 6" 20' + 1' 30' RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS - PATTERN A RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS - PATTERN B RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS Pattern A is the TXDOT Standard, however Pattern B may be used if approved by the Engineer. lines or at 20 foot spacing for solid lines. This allows an easier removal of raised pavement markers and tape. Centerline only - not to be used on edge lines Prefabricated markings may be substituted for reflectorized pavement markings. Prefabricated markings may be substituted for reflectorized pavement markings. MARKINGS PAVEMENT REFLECTORIZED MARKINGS PAVEMENT REFLECTORIZED LINE NO-PASSING DOUBLE MARKINGS PAVEMENT REFLECTORIZED MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISED MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISED MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISED MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISED Type II-A-A 3'9' 5'5' 8" 3'9' Type I-C or II-C-R MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISED MARKERS PAVEMENT RAISEDLINE LANEDROP OR AUXILIARY LINE LANE OR LINE CENTER Item 672 "RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS." products list and meet the requirements of pavement markings shall be from the approved Raised pavement markers used as standard TWO-WAY LEFT TURN LANE LANE & CENTER LINES FOR MULTILANE UNDIVIDED HIGHWAYS EDGE & LANE LINES FOR DIVIDED HIGHWAY CENTER LINE & NO-PASSING ZONE BARRIER LINES FOR TWO-LANE, TWO-WAY HIGHWAYS LINES SOLID LINES BROKEN 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic PAVEMENT MARKING PATTERNS BARRICADE AND CONSTRUCTIONof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:Yellow White White Type Y buttons Type I-C Type II-A-A Type I-C REFLECTORIZED PAVEMENT MARKINGS RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS Prefabricated markings may be substituted for reflectorized pavement markings. Yellow White White Type Y buttonsType II-A-A Type I-C Type I-C REFLECTORIZED PAVEMENT MARKINGS RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS Prefabricated markings may be substituted for reflectorized pavement markings. 298-14 BC(12)-14 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\csb110.dgn8/5/20201:45:27 PMSHEET 1 OF 2 TxDOT 9 • ""ƒ4 "3"3"7"10"R 12" Concrete Safety Barrier CL 6"4"accordingly. dimensions shall be adjusted for lateral support these When 1" ACP is not used ƒ" 1•" Min Max 1" ACP 1'-7" 5‚" 1ƒ"8 †"2‚" S1 Bar S3 Bar LC 1'- 9"5"4 Spaces @ 9" = 3'- 0" 20 Spaces at 12" = 20' Max.Spacing (Typ) (#5) R Bars R Bars (#5) + 5"13" 1 •" 12"2 …" BARRIER (F-SHAPE) CONCRETE SAFETY 7"1'- 7"1'- 7 •"4‚"2 •2'- 3"5ƒ"1'-9‚"2'- 3"Cov. Connection w/Type X Joint (#4)S1 Bar S3 Bar (#4) S1 Bars required with WWR reinforcement option. (#4) S1 Bars (2) w/Type X Joint Connection, S3 Bars (#4) S3 Bars (#4) #4 Bar (Joint Type X) #4 Bar (2) CSB(1)-10 Precast Barrier End View 3 †" Bending Pin2" Dia.3" 9"used, See CSB(6) sheet. of attaining the equivalent lateral support may be permanent barrier placement. A permissible method When 1" ACP is "not" used as lateral support for 6" 30'- 0" barrier segment. 6'- 0" from each end of the 36" Long x 3"Deep, beginning (Required) Two Drainage Slots 1'- 4"90 9 …"11 „" 11 „"9 …" …" 3 ƒ" 1 …" 11 " 10 " • • Upper Leave-out Lower Leave-out 2'- 0"Lower Leave-out Upper Leave-out Joint connection. See Sheet 2 of 2 for details. 5'- 0", Typical at each end of precast CSB, with Type X Joint connection Type X See sheet 2 of 3 for Showing reinforcement for Joint Type X GENERAL NOTES 4" 2"2"2 ‚"2 ‚"4 •"†"†"3 ‚"1 ‚-1 ƒ ‚ Typ„" Max C 1 †" Diam Hole CONNECTION PLATE DETAILS PLATE DIMENSIONS WELDING DETAILS PL … x 4 x 4 •" Connection Pipe L Threaded Rod in Assemblies required per Joint. Four (4) [2 Upper & 2 Lower] TYPICAL WELDED ASSEMBLY ISOMETRIC OF C dimensions not shown for clarity. Barrier reinforcing and Type X Joint Leave-Out TYPE X JOINT INSTALLATION DETAIL 3'-3"2 „"6"UPPER CONNECTION PIPE DETAILS LOWER CONNECTION PIPE DETAILS "Š 70° 1 •" Std PipeConnection Plate Connection Plate 1 •" Std Pipe Š 70° " DEFORMED BAR ANCHOR DETAILS Eight (8) required per Joint. Two (2) Bars required per assembly. 70° & Typ) 1"(Min & Typ) 1"(Min Plate Washer (Typ) PL … x 3 x 3 Threaded Rod (or equivalent) ‡" Diam A325 Nut (Typ) Std ‡" Hex Two (2) required per Joint. One (1) Steel Pipe required per Upper Assembly. Two (2) required per Joint. One (1) Steel Pipe required per Lower Assembly. Stl Connection Pipe Connection Pipe 1 •" Std Steel Steel Connection Plate after fabrication in accordance with Item 445. fittings for joint Type X shall be galvanized Four (4) required per Joint. All steel One (1) Plate required per assembly. …(‚) …(‚) L #5 Deformed Bar Anchors Grade 60 (3'-8" lgth) #5 Reinforcing Bar THREADED ROD DETAIL CONNECTION BOLT OR required per Joint. Plate Washers & Two (2) Std Hex Nuts) (w/ Two (2) PL … x 3 x 3 Hex Hd. Bolts) Two (2) Threaded Rods (Or Equivalent of the barrier. beyond the concrete face hardware shall not extend The upper connection Note: (WWR) General Notes Bar Anchors #5 Deformed(WWR) Option for Bars R and S3 Welded Wire Reinforcement 3. All reinforcement shall comply with Item 440, "Reinforcing Steel." joint connection and drainage slots, as directed by the Engineer. 2. Welded wire cage may be cut or bent to accommodate the Type X to ASTM A497. 1. Deformed Welded Wire Reinforcement (WWR) shall conform 1 ƒ"( Typ) Top & Sides 6"11"Cover 2" Conduit Trough 2'- 5" Connection Plate (Typ) Upper Connection Pipe Lower Connection Pipe Adjacent Barrier Segments Lower Assembly (Typ) Upper Assembly (Typ)Bar Anchors (Typ) 2 ea #5 Deformed Connection Pipe (Typ) Washers & 2 Nuts) within Threaded Rod (w/ 2 Plate 10 •"12 •" 10 † " 6" Pin (Typ) 2" Dia. Bending 6" General Note 7) Sch. 40 PVC. (See dia. Steel pipe or Lifting Pipes, 2" nom. BARRIER PLAN AT END JOINTS Equal No. Spaces (Typ)10 ~ D31 Horiz.(WWR) Spacing shown above D20 Vertical (WWR) csb110.dgn December 2010 AM BD should be verified. may be provided. The proper length of all hardware the concrete face of the barrier. Hex head bolts The connection hardware shall not extend beyond LC 5‚" 4‚" LC by the Engineer. attachments to barrier sections shall be approved the ends of the barrier. Lifting devices and lifting points shall be approx. 7.5 feet from 7. Regardless of the method of handling, barrier "Galvanizing." after fabrication in accordance with Item 445, 6. All steel assemblies for joint shall be galvanized Engineer. elsewhere on the plans, or as directed by the 9. Conduit trough when required shall be shown bid items involved. shall be considered subsidiary to the various assure a smooth surface. Surface finishing Grouting shall be done in a manner that will enough water to make the mixture plastic. shall be two parts sand one part cement with 8. Surface finishing and grouting (where required) (See Note General 9) or tooled radius. have a ƒ " chamfer Barrier edges shall 24"32"22"15"(TYPE 1) PRECAST BARRIER Concrete Safety Barrier (Type 1) Reinforcement for Precast (CSB) Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1") or 440 lbs per ft. (CSB) segment = Approx. 6.5 Tons Weight of one Precast 30 ft. the barrier section to the first wire shall not exceed 3". as directed by the Engineer. The dimension from the end of 4. Combinations of reinforcing steel and WWR will be permitted, as part of the barrier payment. systems, grout etc. as shown, are considered 5. All concrete, reinforcement, joint connection or tooled radius. 4. All precast barrier edges shall have a ƒ " chamfer otherwise specified on the plans. 3. Precast barrier length shall be 30 ft. unless Grade 60 and conform to ASTM A615. 2. Where used, rebar reinforcement shall be compressive strength of 3,600 psi. 1. Concrete shall be Class H with a minimum Precast Barrier Length (30'- 0") Standard Division Design 30 VPTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\csb110.dgn8/5/20201:45:27 PMSHEET 2 OF 2 TxDOT BARRIER (F-SHAPE) CONCRETE SAFETY 6"3"12"8"Rebar & Mesh TOP VIEW 11" †" 1…" Plate Connector Rebar 9 •" Joint Connection (Type J) #5 Rebar(5) #6 Rebar(2) #4 Stirrup(4) + 9 •"9 •"1'-1"" Angle 2"x 2"x ‰ " 10 ‹ threaded bolt with plate Joint Connection (Type Q) + CSB(1)-10 12" Long 2 •" Dia. PVC Sleeve Bolt retraction cavity J-J HOOK CONNECTION VIEW FROM ABOVE Proprietary Joint Connections (CSB) to the Engineer. on the manufacturer's shop drawing(s) furnished reinforcement for these systems, will be shown Details of the connection components and barrier approval for sole source use must be obtained. exclusively specified in the plans, prior If one of these connection systems are Quick-Bolt by Bexar Concrete, (210)497-3773 J-J Hooks by Easi-Set Industries, (800)547-4045 connections types are: connection shown, here on. These joint acceptable as alternates to the (Type X) Two proprietary joint connections are csb110.dgn December 2010 AM BD (TYPE 1) PRECAST BARRIER J-J HOOK CONNECTION END VIEW32"24"32"24"24"24" PRECAST (CSB) WITH J-J HOOKS Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1") Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1") LC ELEVATION VIEW SHOWING JOINT CONNECTION washer and nut on each end. "QUICK-BOLT" " DIA. x 25" Long rolled 872 ~ See Manufacturer's shop drawing for additional details " PVC Sleeve211 for reinforcement details See Manufacturer's shop drawings QUICK-BOLT POCKET LOCATIONS ELEVATION (CSB) QUICK-BOLTEND VIEW (CSB) QUICK-BOLT See Manufacturer's shop drawing for additional details Standard Division Design 31 VPTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: Standard Division Design DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\sled19.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT VP PLAN VIEW 27" 32 sled19.dgn C TxDOT: DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.(TEMPORARY, WORK ZONE) TL-3 MASH COMPLIANT CRASH CUSHION SLED SLED-19 DECEMBER 2019 KM TRANSITION FRAME,GALVANIZED TRANSITION PANEL,GALVANIZED KEEPER PIN, GALVANIZED TRANSITION SHORT DROP PIN W/ KEEPER PIN, GALVANIZED TRANSITION LONG DROP PIN W/ MODULE SLED YELLOW WATER FILLED SLED), GALVANIZED CIS (CONTAINMENT IMPACT FLOAT INDICATOR FILL CAP W/ "DRIVE BY" ANCHOR BOLTS45050 45032-DPT DRAIN PLUG REMOVAL TOOL 45033-RC-B DRAIN PLUG 18009-B-I 45043-CP T-PIN W/ KEEPER PIN 45044-S 45044-YH SLED YELLOW "NO FILL" MODULE 45044-Y 12060 WASHER, 3/4" ID X 2" OD 45148-CP 45147-CP 45150 MODULE LENGTH SYSTEM LENGTH - ( TL-3 - 25-3" ) WATER FILLED SECONDARY MODULES PRIMARY MODULE NON WATER FILLED 45-‡" HEIGHT MAX 45" 45-…" 6'-3ƒ" 1 2 4 1 1 3 9 9 1 2 1 3 3 BILL OF MATERIAL DESCRIPTIONPART NUMBER QTY:TL-3 45131 SLED TRANSITION COMPONENTS FOR ATTACHMENT TO CMB SECONDARY MODULES NUMBER OF SYSTEM LENGTHTEST LEVEL TL-3 3 25' 3" SACRIFICIAL TRANSITION OPTIONS SLED TRANSITION TO PLASTIC TRAFFIC BARRIER (CONTACT MFGR FOR PROPER TRANSITION) SLED TRANSITION TO W-BEAM OR THRIE BEAM GUARD RAIL (CONTACT MFGR FOR PROPER TRANSITION) SLED TRANSITION TO CONCRETE TRAFFIC BARRIER (TEMPORARY OR PERMANENT) SLED TRANSITION TO STEEL TRAFFIC BARRIER (CONTACT MFGR FOR PROPER TRANSITION) SLED TRANSITION TO CONCRETE BRIDGE ABUTMENT A A GENERAL NOTES THE INSTALLATION INSTRUCTIONS MANUAL. THE SLED, IT IS NOT INTENDED TO REPLACE THIS STANDARD IS A BASIC REPRESENTATION OF NOTE: ELEVATION VIEW SECTION A-A 27" 45-‡" SIDE B SIDE A 90 DEGREES ROTATED SIDE A BARRIER BOTH SIDES OF TRAFFIC FLOW ON BARRIER RIGHT-SIDE OF TRAFFIC FLOW ON BARRIER LEFT-SIDE OF TRAFFIC FLOW ON NOSE SHEETING PANEL DELINEATION NOSE SHEETING FOR DECAL PLACEMENT. SEE INSTALLATION MANUAL FOR CUSTOMIZED DELINEATION NOTE: SEE MANUFACTURER'S INSTALLATION MANUAL FOR FURTHER DETAILS. NOTE: THRIE BEAM GUARD RAIL W-BEAM GUARD RAIL CONCRETE BRIDGE ABUTMENTS PLASTIC BARRIER STEEL BARRIER CONCRETE BARRIER, TEMPORARY OR PERMANENT, 45" MAXIMUM HEIGHT 5. THE SLED SYSTEM CAN BE ATTACHED TO: OBJECTS, OR DEPRESSIONS. 4. THE INSTALLATION AREA SHOULD BE FREE FROM CURBS, ELEVATED 3. MAXIMUM PERMISSIBLE CROSS SLOPE IS 8°(DEGREES)(14%). ON CONCRETE, ASPHALT, GRAVEL OR COMPACTED SOIL. NOT NEED TO BE ATTACHED TO THE GROUND AND CAN BE INSTALLED SYSTEM IS A NON-REDIRECTIVE, GATING CRASH CUSHION THAT DOES CUSHION APPROVED FOR USE IN TEMPORARY WORK ZONES. THE SLED 2. THE SLED SYSTEM IS A MASH APPROVED TEST LEVEL 3 (TL-3) CRASH TRAFFIX, INC. AT (949) 361-5663. AND MODULE ORIENTATION. FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION, CONTACT 1. REFER TO THE INSTALLATION MANUAL FOR SPECIFIC SYSTEM ASSEMBLY DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\sscb210.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT3"12" #4 Rebar 6" General Notes V1 Bar 4 •"20 Spaces at 12" = 20' Max.Spacing Note: + 4 •" 1 •" 12"2" Ends at Barrier 2"Cover V1 Bars (#4) V1 Bars (#4) A A Section A-A Slot Drainage 3"Cov. Single Slope Concrete Traffic Barrier 4" 2"2"2 ‚"2 ‚"4 •"†"†"3 ‚"1 ‚-1 ƒ ‚ Typ„" Max C 1 †" Diam Hole CONNECTION PLATE DETAILS PLATE DIMENSIONS WELDING DETAILS PL … x 4 x 4 •" Connection Pipe L Threaded Rod in Assemblies required per Joint. Four (4) [2 Upper & 2 Lower] TYPICAL WELDED ASSEMBLY ISOMETRIC OF C R Bars (#5)7"9 ‚"9 ƒ"5'- 0", Typical at each end of precast SSCB with Type X joint dimensions not shown for clarity. Barrier reinforcing and Type X Joint Leave-Out Connection Plate (Typ) Upper Connection Pipe Lower Connection Pipe Adjacent Barrier Segments Lower Assembly (Typ) Upper Assembly (Typ) TYPE X JOINT INSTALLATION DETAIL 3'-3"2 „"6"UPPER CONNECTION PIPE DETAILS LOWER CONNECTION PIPE DETAILS "Š 70° 1 •" Std PipeConnection Plate Connection Plate 1 •" Std Pipe Š 70° " DEFORMED BAR ANCHOR DETAILS Eight (8) required per Joint. Two (2) Bars required per assembly. 70° & Typ) 1"(Min & Typ) 1"(Min Plate Washer (Typ) PL … x 3 x 3 Threaded Rod (or equivalent) ‡" Diam A325 Nut (Typ) Std ‡" Hex 1'-5 ƒ"1'-2 ‚" 1'-2 ‚" BARRIER PLAN AT JOINT Leave-Out Leave-Out C 1'-1 …"2 " 3 ‚ " L Pipes 12"12"70°(Typ) 1'-1 ‡" 1'- 3 •"1'- 7 •" Type X connection Pipe locations for Joint Showing reinforcement for Joint Connection (Type X) 4" + to accommodate side leave-outs The first bar space may be decreased CL (Typ) (#5) R Bars V1 Bar (#4) 1 ƒ"(Typ) Top & Sides 1'- 5"2'- 0"8"1'- 5"8" 8" Two (2) required per Joint. One (1) Steel Pipe required per Upper Assembly. Two (2) required per Joint. One (1) Steel Pipe required per Lower Assembly. Stl Connection Pipe Connection Pipe 1 •" Std Steel Steel Connection Plate after fabrication in accordance with Item 445. fittings for joint Type X shall be galvanized Four (4) required per Joint. All steel One (1) Plate required per assembly. …(‚) …(‚) Bar Anchors (Typ) 2 ea #5 Deformed L #5 Deformed Bar Anchors Grade 60 (3'-8" lgth) #5 Reinforcing Bar THREADED ROD DETAIL CONNECTION BOLT OR required per Joint. Plate Washers & Two (2) Std Hex Nuts) (w/ Two (2) PL … x 3 x 3 Hex Hd. Bolts) Two (2) Threaded Rods (Or Equivalent Connection Pipe (Typ) Washers & 2 Nuts) within Threaded Rod (w/ 2 Plate of the barrier. beyond the concrete face hardware shall not extend The upper connection Note: (WWR) General Notes BARRIER SINGLE SLOPE CONCRETE 3'- 2"1'- 7 †"3"Pin2" Bending5" SSCB(2)-10 Bar Anchors #5 Deformed (WWR) Option for Bars R and V1 Welded Wire Reinforcement ƒ" min. 1 •" max.Pin2" Bending7 •"by the Engineer. 1 • " clear cover as directed slots may bent to accomadate V1 Bars above the drainage at Bottom 1 • " Clear Cover for R Bars, Equal Spaces1'- 7" Spacing shown above (WWR)for V1 Bars, D20 Vertical 4 Spaces @ 9" = 3'- 0"3'- 2"5" end of the 30'- 0" barrier segment. 3'Lg x 3"Dp beginning 6'- 0" from each (Required) Two Drainage Slots 3. All reinforcement shall comply with Item 440, "Reinforcing Steel." joint connection and drainage slots, as directed by the Engineer. 2. Welded wire cage may be cut or bent to accommodate the Type X to ASTM A497. 1. Deformed Welded Wire Reinforcement (WWR) shall conform 10 ~ D31 Horiz.(WWR) PRECAST BARRIER (TYPE 1) two per barrier.(See Note 7) Lifting Pipe or Sch. 40 PVC, 2" nom. dia. Sch.40 Galv. Steel December 2010 AM BD 3'- 6" length of all hardware should be verified. Hex head bolts may be provided. The proper beyond the concrete face of the barrier. The connection hardware shall not extend 1'- 7 †" 7 …" 7 …" CL fabrication in accordance with Item 445,"Galvanizing." 9. All steel assemblies shall be galvanized after bid items. shall be considered subsidiary to the various assure a smooth surface. Surface finishing Grouting shall be done in a manner that will enough water to make the mixture plastic. shall be two parts sand one part cement with 8. Surface finishing and grouting (where required) by the Engineer. attachments to barrier sections shall be approved the ends of the barrier. Lifting devices and lifting points shall be approx. 7.5 feet from 7. Regardless of the method of handling, barrier (Required) Drainage Slots Steel Placement at bent at drain slots. Bars may be cut or (#4)V1 Bars 42"24" 8" Precast Barrier End View or tooled radius. shall have a ƒ " chamfer All precast barrier edges the barrier section to the first wire shall not exceed 3". as directed by the Engineer. The dimension from the end of 4. Combinations of reinforcing steel and WWR will be permitted, Note 6) Trough (See General (Optional) Conduit on the plans, or as directed by the Engineer. 6. Conduit trough when required shall be shown elsewhere as part of the barrier payment. systems, grout etc. as shown, are considered 5. All concrete, reinforcement, joint connection or a tooled radius. 4. All precast barrier edges shall have a ƒ " chamfer otherwise specified on the plans. 3. Precast barrier length shall be 30 ft. unless Grade 60 and conform to ASTM A615. 2. Where used, rebar reinforcement shall be compressive strength of 3,600 psi. 1. Concrete shall be Class H with a minimum Single Slope Concrete Barrier (Type 1) Reinforcement for Precast (SSCB) or 717 lbs per ft. (SSCB) segment = Approx. 10.5 Tons Weight of one precast 30 ft. Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1") connection. cast-in-place barrier, to match the precast barrier SSBC. The joint connection "Types" may be used in the Precast SSCB barrier may be connected to cast-in-place sscb210.dgn Standard Division Design SHEET 1 OF 2 33TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\sscb210.dgn8/5/2020SHEET 2 OF 2 TxDOT Proprietary Joint Connections (SSCB) to the Engineer. on the manufacturer's shop drawing(s) furnished reinforcement for these systems, will be shown Details of the connection components and barrier approval for sole source use must be obtained. exclusively specified in the plans, prior If one of these connection systems are Quick-Bolt by Bexar Concrete, (210)497-3773 J-J Hooks by Easi-Set Industries, (800)547-4045 connections types are: connection shown, here on. These joint acceptable as alternates to the (Type X) Two proprietary joint connections are 12"Rebar & Mesh END VIEW TOP VIEW 11" †" 1…" Plate Connector Rebar Joint Connection (Type R) +2'- 0"9 •"1'-1"" Angle 2"x 2"x ‰ " 10 ‹ threaded bolt with plate Joint Connection (Type Q) + 12" Long 2 •" Dia. PVC Sleeve Bolt retraction cavity J-J HOOK CONNECTION VIEW FROM ABOVE PRECAST (SSCB) WITH J-J HOOKS 8" 8" CL BARRIER SINGLE SLOPE CONCRETE December 2010 AM Stirrup bars (4) #4 (TYPE 1) PRECAST BARRIER Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1")42"24" 24" 24"42"Precast Barrier (30'- 0" 1") SSCB(2)-10 18"7 ƒ"17 •"24"3" Rebar Grid 33 •"V2 bars A A ELEVATION42"Barrier Height3~(#8) Bars 2~(#6) Bars WELDED REBAR GRID3"Slot for rebar grid 10 •" 30'- 0" precast section JOINT CONNECTION TOP VIEW Typical at both ends of barrier segment (#4) V2 BARS3 ‚"33 •"barrier segment 6 ~ two piece bars per SECTION A-A 1 ƒ" V2 Bar (#4) H1 Bars (#5) V1 Bars (See Sheet 1) H1 bars 12" C-C V1 Bars (See Sheet 1) Showing (Type R) Rebar Grid 6"6"12"4"4" sscb210.dgn ELEVATION VIEW SHOWING JOINT CONNECTION washer and nut on each end. "QUICK-BOLT" " DIA. x 25" Long rolled 872 ~ See Manufacturer's shop drawing for additional details " PVC Sleeve211 for reinforcement details See Manufacturer's shop drawings "QUICK-BOLT" POCKET LOCATIONS ELEVATION VIEW "QUICK-BOLT" (SSCB) END VIEW See Manufacturer's shop drawing for additional details Standard Division Design VP 34TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp2-1-18.dgn8/5/20201:45:32 PMStandard Division Operations TrafficWork SpaceShoulderShoulderShoulderTCP (2-1b)TCP (2-1c) WORK SPACE ON SHOULDER WORK VEHICLES ON SHOULDER See note 1) 48" X 48" (Flags- CW20-1D CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- (See note 2) G20-2 48" X 24"ShoulderShoulder See note 1) 48" X 48" (Flags- CW20-1D 48" X 24" (See note 2) G20-2 See note 1) 48" X 48" (Flags- CW20-1D (See note 2) G20-2 48" X 24" 48" X 24" (See note 2) G20-2 Right-of-way LineApprox.100'ShoulderShoulderMin.30'Work Space100'Min.30' 1/3 LB 1/3 LBWork SpaceMin.30'Min. 10'100'ShoulderShoulderShoulderShoulderShoulderApprox.100' See note 1) 48" X 48" (Flags- CW20-1DMin.30'Min.30'Min.30'Min. 10'x for 50 mph or less3x for over 50 mphor lessx for 50 mph 50 mph3x for over 50 mph3x for over or lessx for 50 mph (See notes 4 & 5) (See notes 4 & 5) CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- nearest traveled way. of 30' from the work area is a minimum may be omitted if the Channelizing devices at all times. channelizing devices lanes of traffic by areas separated from etc., shall remain in moveable cranes, such as trucks, work operation, necessary for the or other equipment Work vehicles TCP (2-1a) WORK SPACE NEAR SHOULDER Conventional Roads Conventional Roads Conventional Roadsor lessx for 50 mph or lessx for 50 mph or lessx for 50 mph 50 mph3x for over 50 mph3x for over 50 mph3x for over (See Note 7) work vehicle Inactive (See notes 4 & 5) Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X" TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT GENERAL NOTES SHOULDER WORK CONVENTIONAL ROAD TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 2-94 8-95 1-97 4-98 161 2-12 December 1985 TCP(2-1)-18 2-18 DN:tcp2-1-18.dgn 35 "ROAD WORK AHEAD" signs for shoulder work on conventional roadways. 8. CW21-5 "SHOULDER WORK" signs may be used in place of CW20-1D right-of-way line and not parked on the paved shoulder. 7. Inactive work vehicles or other equipment should be parked near the freeways. 6. See TCP(5-1) for shoulder work on divided highways, expressways and surface, next to those shown in order to protect a wider work space. 5. Additional Shadow Vehicles with TMAs may be positioned off the paved substituted for the Shadow Vehicle and TMA. place, Type 3 Barricades or other channelizing devices may be but road or work conditions require the traffic control to remain in performance or quality of the work. If workers are no longer present the area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the used anytime it can be positioned 30 to 100 feet in advance of oscillating or strobe lights. A Shadow Vehicle with a TMA should be 4. Shadow Vehicle with TMA and high intensity rotating, flashing, nearest traveled way. 3. Stockpiled material should be placed a minimum of 30 feet from plans, or for routine maintenance work, when approved by the Engineer. denoted with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated in the 2. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED, except those 1. Flags attached to signs where shown, are REQUIRED. DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp2-2-18.dgn8/5/20201:45:34 PMStandard Division Operations TrafficXXXWork SpaceBMin.30'Min.100'TCP (2-2a) 2-LANE ROADWAY WITHOUT PAVED SHOULDERS 48" X 24" G20-2 (See Note 2) Yield Line Temporary Approx.100'100' Max.50' Min.48" X 48" CW20-4D 48" X 48" 48" X 48" CW20-1D See note 1) (Flags- 42" X 42 " X 42" R1-2 48" X 24" G20-2 15'(See Note 2) Yield Line Temporary W3-2 R1-2 42" X 42 " X 42" Same as Below in Opposite Direction Warning Sign Sequence lights.(See notes 6 & 7) oscillating or strobe rotating, flashing, TMA and high intensity Shadow Vehicle with CONTROL WITH YIELD SIGNS ONE LANE TWO-WAY (Less than 2000 ADT - See Note 9)100'200'Min.30'BWork SpaceXXX 50'Min.100' Max.Temporary (See Note 2)Min.100' 48" X 24" G20-2 CW20-4 48" X 48" 48" X 24" G20-2 48" X 48" CW20-1D See note 1) (Flags- CW20-4 48" X 48" 24" X 18"XXXX 48" X 48" (See note 2) X 24" Stop Line at night illuminated shall be flagger stations emergencies, Except in at night illuminated shall be flagger stations emergencies, Except in Temporary (See Note 2) 24" Stop Line 2-LANE ROADWAY WITHOUT PAVED SHOULDERS ONE LANE TWO-WAY CONTROL WITH FLAGGERS TCP (2-2b) (See notes 6 & 7) strobe lights. oscillating or flashing, rotating, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle 24" X 18" CW16-2P CW20-7 48" X 48" CW20-7 48" X 48" CW16-2P CW3-4 48" X 48" (See note 2) CW3-4 R1-2aP 48" X 36" (See note 9) 48" X 36" R1-2aP (See note 9) 20' spacing Devices at 100' Approx. spacing on the Taper Devices at 20' spacing on the Taper Devices at 20' on the Taper 20' spacing Devices at GENERAL NOTES TCP (2-2b) TCP (2-2a) TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X" 48" X 48" CW20-1D See note 1) (Flags- Distance Sight Stopping 200' 250' 305' 360' 425' 495' 570' 645' 730' 820' mounting height. 9. The R1-2aP "YIELD TO ONCOMING TRAFFIC" sign shall be placed on a support at a 7 foot minimum In rural areas, roadways with less than 2000 ADT, work space should be no longer than 400 feet. distance. For projects in urban areas, work space should be no longer than one half city block. 8. The R1-2 "YIELD" sign traffic control may be used on projects with approaches that have adequate sight in order to protect a wider work space. 7. Additional Shadow Vehicles with TMAs may be positioned off the paved surface, next to those shown Vehicle and TMA. to remain in place, Type 3 Barricades or other channelizing devices may be substituted for the Shadow the work. If workers are no longer present but road or work conditions require the traffic control in advance of the area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the performance or quality of 6. A Shadow Vehicle with a TMA should be used anytime it can be positioned 30 to 100 feet 5. Length of work space should be based on the ability of flaggers to communicate. 4. Flaggers should use two-way radios or other methods of communication to control traffic. ROAD XXX FT" sign, but proper sign spacing shall be maintained. 3. The CW3-4 "BE PREPARED TO STOP" sign may be installed after the CW20-4 "ONE LANE by the Engineer. may be omitted when stated elsewhere in the plans, or for routine maintenance work, when approved 2. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED, except those denoted with the triangle symbol 1. Flags attached to signs where shown, are REQUIRED. emergency situtations. 12.Flaggers should use 24" STOP/SLOW paddles to control traffic. Flags should be limited to (See table above). increased in order to maintain stopping sight distance to the flagger and a queue of stopped vehicles. 11.If the work space is located near a horizontal or vertical curve, the buffer distances should be approved by the Engineer. 10.Channelizing devices on the center line may be omitted when a pilot car is leading traffic and TRAFFIC CONTROL ONE-LANE TWO-WAY TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 8-95 1-97 4-98 3-03 2-12 162 December 1985 2-18 tcp2-2-18.dgn TCP(2-2)-18 36 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp2-3-18.dgn8/5/20201:45:36 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic Paved ShoulderPaved Shoulder 1/2 L 1/2 L 1/2 L 1/2 LBWork SpaceB 1/2 LWork SpaceWork Space 1/2 LBBTCP (2-3a)TCP (2-3b)XXXX48" X 24" G20-2 24" X 30" R4-2 24" X 30" R4-1 48" X 48" CW20-1D See note 1) (Flags- lights. (See notes 7 & 8) oscillating or strobe rotating, flashing, TMA and high intensity Shadow Vehicle with CW1-4R 48" X 48"XXXXMin.30'100' Approx.24" X 30" R4-1 See note 1) (Flags- 48" X 48" CW20-1D ONE LANE CLOSED 2-LANE ROADWAY WITH PAVED SHOULDERS 24" X 24" CW1-4L 48" X 48"XXX100' Approx.100'50'-30'Min.30'Min.1/2 L 1/3 LXXX48" X 48" CW20-1D See note 1) (Flags- 24" X 30" R4-1 CW1-4R 48" X 48" G20-2 Edgeline White 4" Solid Island in Buffer Yellow 4" Double Yellow Line 4" Double +4" 40' C-C. Markers on Pavement Raised Type II-A-A 1"-2"Paved ShoulderPaved Shoulderlights. (See notes 7 & 8) oscillating or strobe rotating, flashing, TMA and high intensity Shadow Vehicle with CW1-4L 48" X 48" G20-2 48" X 24" CW1-4L 48" X 48" 2-LANE ROADWAY WITH PAVED SHOULDERS ONE LANE CLOSED INADEQUATE FIELD OF VIEWADEQUATE FIELD OF VIEW XCW1-4L CW20-1D 48" X 48" CW1-4R CW1-4R X 1/3 L24" X 24" CW13-1P 24" X 24" CW13-1P CW1-6aT 36" X 36" (See note 2)CW13-1P CW1-6aT 36" X 36" (See note 2) 24" X 24" CW13-1P CW1-6aT 36" X 36" 24" X 24" CW13-1P CW1-6aT 36" X 36" 24" X 24" CW13-1P CW13-1P CW1-6aT 36" X 36" (See note 2) If applicable If applicable 24" X 30" R4-2 G20-2 48" X 24" If applicable 24" X 30" R4-2 GENERAL NOTES 48" X 24" 24" X 30" R4-2 24" X 24" 48" X 48" 24" X 30" R4-1 TCP (2-3a) 48" X 48" TCP(2-3b)ONLY TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted Markers Ty II-AA Raised Pavement L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WS L= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X" 24" X 24" CW13-1P If applicable work spaces areas betweem recurrent 1/4 to 1/2 mile in rural 1000' in urban areas, or Devices spaced at 500' to Transverse Channelizing is intended for the area of the conflicting markings, not the entire work zone. sections, at 1/2(S) where S is the speed in mph. This tighter device spacing tapers at 20' or 15' if posted speeds are 35 mph or slower, and for tangent channelizing devices which separate two-way traffic should be spaced on For shorter durations where traffic is directed over a yellow centerline, 9. Conflicting pavement markings shall be removed for long-term projects. next to those shown in order to protect a wider work space. 8. Additional Shadow Vehicles with TMAs may be positioned off the paved surface, in place, Type 3 Barricades or other channelizing devices may be substituted. present but road or work conditions require the traffic control to remain affecting the performance or quality of the work. If workers are no longer 30 to 100 feet in advance of the area of crew exposure without adversely 7. A Shadow Vehicle with a TMA should be used anytime it can be positioned 6. Conflicting pavement marking shall be removed for long term projects. AHEAD" signs. Proper spacing of signs shall be maintained. regulatory speed zone signs may be installed within CW20-1D "ROAD WORK 5. The R4-1 "DO NOT PASS," R4-2 " PASS WITH CARE" and construction be positioned at end of traffic queue. volume require additional emphasis to safely control traffic. Flagger should 4. Flagger control should NOT be used unless roadway conditions or heavy traffic traffic. markings may remain in place. Channelizing devices shall be used to separate 3. When work space will be in place less than three days existing pavement or for routine maintenance work, when approved by the Engineer. with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated elsewhere in the plans, 2. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED, except those denoted 1. Flags attached to signs where shown, are REQUIRED. See note 1) (Flags- 48" X 48" TWO-LANE ROADS TRAFFIC SHIFTS ON TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 8-95 1-97 2-12 4-98 3-03 163 December 1985 TCP(2-3)-18 37 tcp(2-3)-18.dgn 2-18 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp2-4-18.dgn8/5/20201:45:37 PMStandard Division Operations TrafficShoulder30'MIN.XTCP (2-4b)TCP (2-4a)ShoulderShoulder200'Approx. 1/2 LShoulderShoulderXXX 1/3 LLLWork SpaceMin.30'B 1/2 LXXXXLBONE LANE CLOSED TWO LANES CLOSEDX XShoulderShoulder100'Approx.XWork SpaceLB 48" X 24" G20-2 3X for over 50 MPHX for 50 MPH or lessCW20-5TL 48" X 48" 48" X 24" G20-2 CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- 48" X 24" G20-2 CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- CW1-4L 48" X 48" 36" X 36" CW1-4R 48" X 48" 48" X 24" G20-2 XXX 1/3 L(See note 4) 30" X 12" CW16-3aP CW20-5TR 48" X 48" CW20-5TR 48" X 48" (See note 4) 30" X 12" CW16-3aP CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- 24" X 24"Shoulderlights.(See notes 5 & 6) oscillating or strobe rotating, flashing, TMA and high intensity Shadow Vehicle with (See note 8) (See notes 5 & 6) strobe lights. oscillating or rotating, flashing, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle CW20-1D 48" X 48" See note 1) (Flags- note 4) (See 30" X 12" CW16-3aP CW1-6aT 36" X 36" 24" X 24" CW13-1P CW1-6aT CW13-1P Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X" TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT TCP (2-4a) TCP (2-4b) GENERAL NOTES the area of conflicting markings, not the entire work zone. 1/2(S) where S is the speed in mph. This tighter devices spacing is intended for at 20' or 15' if posted speeds are 35 mph or slower, and for tangent sections, at channelizing devices which separate two-way traffic should be spaced on tapers 8. For shorter durations where traffic is directed over a yellow centerline, closed lane near the end of the merging taper. protect the work space from opposing traffic with the arrow board placed in the shall be used and channelizing devices shall be placed on the centerline to 7. If this TCP is used for a left lane closure, CW20-5TL "LEFT LANE CLOSED"signs to protect a wider work space. lane, on the shoulder or off the paved surface, next to those shown in order 6. Additional Shadow Vehicles with TMAs may be positioned in each closed Vehicle and TMA. Barricades or other channelizing devices may be substituted for the Shadow or work conditions require the traffic control to remain in place, Type 3 the performance or quality of the work. If workers are no longer present but road 30 to 100 feet in advance of the area of crew exposure without adversely affecting 5. A Shadow Vehicle with a TMA should be used anytime it can be positioned plaque. legend may be shown on the sign face rather than on a CW16-3aP supplemental 4. For short term applications, when post mounted signs are not used, the distance length per lane. 3. The downstream taper is optional. When used, it should be 100 feet minimum or for routine maintenance work, when approved by the Engineer. with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated elsewhere in the plans, 2. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED, except those denoted 1. Flags attached to signs where shown, are REQUIRED. CONVENTIONAL ROADS LANE CLOSURES ON MULTILANE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN December 1985 2-12 8-95 1-97 4-98 3-03 164 TCP(2-4)-18 38 tcp2-4-18.dgn 2-18 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. Texas Department of Transportation C TxDOT TCP(6-2)-12of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp6-2.dgn8/5/20201:45:39 PMTraffic Operations Division Standard M TCP (6-2a)500'TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT GENERAL NOTES Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted Taper lengths have been rounded off. ** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'540' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 450' 500' 550' 600' 495' 550' 605' 660' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 540' 700'770'840' 45 50 55 60 65 70 Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Taper Lengths "L" Desirable Minimum 800'880'960'80'615'160'80 ** L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) ENTRANCE RAMP OPEN WORK WITHIN 500' OF RAMP1/3 L48" X 48" CW20RP-3D strobe lights oscillating or rotating, flashing, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle XXXX XXXX XXXX (See note 3) PHASE 2PHASE 1 TO BE CLOSEDShoulderShoulderShoulderShoulder500'L48" X 30" R11-2bT (See note 1) 48" X 48" CW25-1T 500'strobe lights oscillating or rotating, flashing, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle 48" X 24" G20-2 (See note 2) 48" X 48" CW4-3R CW20-1D 48" X 48" CW13-1P See note 1) (Plaque 24" X 24"ShoulderShoulderWork SpaceBLWork SpaceB1/3 LTCP (6-2b) ENTRANCE RAMP CLOSED 10' 48" X 24" G20-2 Signing. Additional Details and Lane Closure See TCP(6-1)for shall be as shown on TCP (6-1) or as directed by the Engineer. Additional requirements for lane closures and advance signing Min.30' Signing. Additional Details and Lane Closure See TCP(6-1)for Min.30' performance. area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the work be used if it can be positioned 30' to 100' in advance of the typically required. A shadow vehicle equipped with a TMA shall A shadow vehicle equipped with a Truck Mounted Attenuator is (See Note 4) (See Note 4) * * past entrance to freeway until work space is 1500' Ramp to remain closed * WORK AREA NEAR RAMP TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 1-97 4-98 8-98 tcp6-2.dgn February 1994 202 39 ENT RAMP 8-12 conflicts with G20-2 signs already in place on the project. 4. The END ROAD WORK (G20-2) sign may be omitted when it and time formatting options for PCMS Phase 2 message. 3. See "Advance Notice List" on BC(6) for recommended date between ramp and mainlane can be seen from both roadways. 2. ADDED LANE Symbol (CW4-3) sign may be omitted when sign elsewhere in the plans. denoted with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated 1. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED. Devices DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. Texas Department of Transportation C TxDOT TCP(6-3)-12of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp6-3.dgn8/5/20201:45:40 PMTraffic Operations Division Standard February 1994 203ShoulderShoulderShoulderShoulderMLSee TCP(6-1) for Lane Closure Details and Additional Signing. GENERAL NOTES: in the plans. denoted with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated elsewhere Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted Taper lengths have been rounded off. ** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'540' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 450' 500' 550' 600' 495' 550' 605' 660' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 540' 700'770'840' 45 50 55 60 65 70 Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Taper Lengths "L" Desirable Minimum 800'880'960'80'615'160'80 ** L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) shall be as shown on TCP (6-1) or as directed by the Engineer. Additional requirements for lane closures and advance signing ENTRANCE RAMP OPEN TCP (6-3a)Min.30' Work Space1/3 LL2LSee TCP(6-1) for Lane Closure Details and Additional Signing.LB48" X 48" CW4-6 CW20-1D CW13-1P See note 1) (Plaque 24" X 24" 48" X 48" 48" X 30" R11-2bT 48" X 48" CW20RP-3D 1000'Min.30' Work Space strobe lights oscillating or rotating, flashing, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle TCP (6-3b) strobe lights oscillating or rotating, flashing, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle BUSE STREET A Existing STREET B TRAFFIC EXITS PRIOR TO CLOSED RAMP EXIT RAMP CLOSED TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT 1/3 L48" X 30" R11-2bT exit. in advance of Street A Place 1 mile (approx.) 48" X 48" CW4-3R CLOSED USE EXIT XX EXIT XY CLOSED EXIT EXIT exits are numbered Or, as an option when EXIT XX XX EXIT XY XY performance. area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the work be used if it can be positioned 30' to 100' in advance of the typically required. A shadow vehicle equipped with a TMA shall A shadow vehicle equipped with a Truck Mounted Attenuator is 10' * * * 1. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED. Devices Existing EXISTING Existing 1-97 4-98 8-98 WORK AREA BEYOND RAMP TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN tcp6-3.dgn 408-12 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. Texas Department of Transportation C TxDOT TCP(6-4)-12of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp6-4.dgn8/5/20201:45:42 PMTraffic Operations Division Standard Feburary 1994 204ShoulderTCP (6-4b)1000'GENERAL NOTES TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted Taper lengths have been rounded off. ** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'540' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 450' 500' 550' 600' 495' 550' 605' 660' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 540' 700'770'840' 45 50 55 60 65 70 Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Taper Lengths "L" Desirable Minimum 800'880'960'80'615'160'80 ** L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) shall be as shown on TCP (6-1) or as directed by the Engineer. Additional requirements for lane closures and advance signing TCP (6-4a) EXIT RAMP CLOSED CLOSED USE EXIT XY EXIT XX ShoulderShoulderL1000'1/3 LBstrobe lights oscillating or flashing, rotating, high intensity with TMA and Shadow VehicleShoulder M in advance of closed ramp. Place 1 mile (approx.) strobe lights oscillating or flashing, rotating, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle 48" X 48" CW20RP-3D 48" X 30" R11-2bT Existing Existing 1/3 LLBWork SpaceEXIT RAMP OPEN 48" X 36" E5-2 See TCP(6-1)for Lane Closure Details and Signing. Additional See TCP(6-1)for Lane Closure Details and Signing. Additional 48" X 30" R11-2bT Work SpaceTRAFFIC EXITS PAST CLOSED RAMP Min.30'Min.30'Min.30'(CDs) Channelizing Devices 200' approx. gap spacing 3 CDs at 60' spacing 5 CDs at 60' USE STREET B STREET A exits are numbered Or, as an option when CLOSED EXIT EXIT XY EXIT XY XX EXIT XX performance. area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the work be used if it can be positioned 30' to 100' in advance of the typically required. A shadow vehicle equipped with a TMA shall A shadow vehicle equipped with a Truck Mounted Attenuator is 10' ** 2. See BC Standards for sign details. in the plans. denoted with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated elsewhere 1. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED. Devices Sign Exit Gore Existing Existing Existing * 48"X42" E5-4T * 1-97 4-98 8-98 tcp6-4.dgn WORK AREA AT EXIT RAMP TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 8-12 41 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. Texas Department of Transportation C TxDOT TCP(6-5)-12of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT tcp6-5.dgn FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp6-5.dgn8/5/20201:45:43 PMTraffic Operations Division Standard Feburary 1998 205 TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 1-97 4-98 8-98 WORK AREA BEYOND EXIT RAMP TCP (6-5a) TCP (6-5b) TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT GENERAL NOTES Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted Taper lengths have been rounded off. ** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'540' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 450' 500' 550' 600' 495' 550' 605' 660' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 540' 700'770'840' 45 50 55 60 65 70 Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Taper Lengths "L" Desirable Minimum 800'880'960'80'615'160'80 * L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) shall be as shown on TCP (6-1) or as directed by the Engineer. Additional requirements for lane closures and advance signing ShoulderShoulderShoulderShoulderSee TCP(6-1) for Lane Closure Details and Additional Signing.L1/3 Lstrobe lights oscillating or flashing, rotating, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicle 300'150' +Work SpaceBNote 3)(See 48" X 36" E5-2 See TCP(6-1) for Lane Closure Details and Additional Signing. 48" X 36" E5-2Work SpaceNote 3)(See BL1/3 L300'150'L2L Min. 1500' PAST EXIT RAMP TWO LANE CLOSURE WITHIN EXIT RAMP OPEN EXIT RAMP OPEN 300'Min.30'Min.30'performance. area of crew exposure without adversely affecting the work be used if it can be positioned 30' to 100' in advance of the typically required. A shadow vehicle equipped with a TMA shall A shadow vehicle equipped with a Truck Mounted Attenuator is * * * * the ramp. work space and the exit ramp, consideration should be given to closing 3. If adequate longitudinal buffer length "B" does not exist between the 2. See BC standards for sign details. in the plans. denoted with the triangle symbol may be omitted when stated elsewhere 1. All traffic control devices illustrated are REQUIRED. Devices 48"X42" E5-4T Gore Sign Existing Exit 500'500'strobe lights oscillating or flashing, rotating, high intensity with TMA and Shadow Vehicles Gore Sign Existing Exit 48"X42" E5-4T 500'500'428-12 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\tcp7-1.dgn8/5/20201:45:44 PM210 TCP(7-1)-13 10'30' 40'+1' March 1991 tcp7-1.dgn 4-92 1-97 4-98NO PASSING ZONES ON TWO-LANE TWO-WAY ROADS 7-13 SURFACING OPERATIONS FOR TRAFFIC CONTROL DETAILS 43 Standard Division Operations Traffic roadway marker tabs temporary flexible-reflective calendar days after to be placed within 14 Standard pavement markings roadway marker tabs flexible-reflective Type Y-2 temporary no passing zones indicate beginning and end of roadway marker tabs placed to Temporary flexible-reflective markings existing Previous TABS ON CENTERLINES OF TWO-LANE TWO-WAY ROADS For seal coat, micro-surface or similar operations TERM STATIONARY INTERMEDIATE STATIONARY LONG TERM STATIONARY SHORT TERM TYPICAL USAGE MOBILE DURATION SHORT NO PASSING ZONE40'+1' ZONE PASSING NO MARKING PAVEMENT SHORT TERM (TABS) SURFACING ENDS SURFACING BEGINS XX XXX48" X 48" CW20-1D Min. 36" X 36" CW8-7 Min. 36" X 36" CW8-12 24" X 30" R4-1 24" X 18" R20-1TP 24" X 30" R4-1 24" X 18" R20-1TP 24" X 30" R4-1 24" X 18" R20-1TP MAJOR RURAL ROAD 2 MILES REPEAT EVERY Min. 36" X 36" CW8-12 2 MILES REPEAT EVERY Min. 36" X 36" CW8-7 24" X 30" R4-1 24" X 18" R20-1TP Min. 36" X 18" G20-2 direction of travel only. Signing shown for one NOTE 24" x 30" R4-2 24" x 30" R4-2 COORDINATION OF SIGN LOCATIONS "DO NOT PASS" SIGN (R4-1) and NO-PASSING ZONES B. The LOOSE GRAVEL signs are to remain in place until the condition no longer exists. and repeated at intervals of approximately 2 miles in rural areas and closer in urban areas. A. When construction begins, a LOOSE GRAVEL (CW8-7) sign should be erected at each end of the work area "NO CENTER LINE" SIGN (CW8-12) "LOOSE GRAVEL" SIGN (CW8-7) PAVEMENT MARKINGS C. The NO CENTER LINE signs are to remain in place until standard pavement markings are installed. and other locations deemed necessary by the Engineer. of the work area, at approximately 2 mile intervals within the work area, beyond major intersections not have an existing centerline), a NO CENTER LINE (CW8-12) sign should be erected at the beginning B. At the time construction activity obliterates the existing center line markings(low volume roads may markings. have opposite directions of travel on a roadway. Divided highways do not typically have center line A. Center line markings are yellow pavement markings that delineate the separation of travel lanes that C. Tab placement for overlay/inlay operations shall be as shown on the WZ(STPM) standard sheet. B. Tabs shall not be used to simulate edge lines. the cover over the reflective strip shall be removed. no more than two (2) days before the surfacing is applied. After the surfacing is rolled and swept, should be applied to the pavement striping crews or as directed by the Engineer. Tabs will be placed at the spacing indicated. Tabs unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. Tabs are to be installed to provide true alignment for A. Temporary markings for surfacing projects shall be Temporary Flexible-reflective Roadway Marker Tabs be repeated as described above. typically located at or near the limits of surfacing. LOOSE GRAVEL and NO CENTER LINE signs will then TRAFFIC FINES DOUBLE (R20-5T) sign, and one "X" sign spacing prior to the CONTRACTOR (G20-6T)sign should be placed in the sequence shown following the OBEY WARNING SIGNS STATE LAW (R20-3T) and the B. Where possible the ROAD WORK AHEAD (CW20-1D), LOOSE GRAVEL (CW8-7), and NO CENTER LINE (CW8-12) signs adequate sign spacing. signing typically shown on the Barricade and Construction Standards for project limits to ensure A. The location of warning signs at the beginning and end of a work area are to be coordinated with other GENERAL NOTES D. R4-1 and R4-2 are to remain in place until standard pavement markings are installed. the beginning and end of the no-passing zones where the surfacing operation has stopped for the day. length of such combined zones, appropriate DO NOT PASS and PASS WITH CARE signs should be placed at conflict with the existing pavement markings. Also, unless one days operation completes the entire covered until the surfacing operation has passed this location so as not to have the DO NOT PASS sign to be combined into one individual no-passing zone, the sign at the beginning of the zone should be should be used and repeated as often as necessary for this purpose. Where several existing zones are the project to prevent damage to windshield and lights. The DO NOT PASS sign and NEXT XX MILES plaque C. Depending on traffic volumes and length of sections, it may be desirable to prohibit passing throughout signed with a PASS WITH CARE sign and a NEXT XX MILES plaque. where there is considerable distance between no-passing zones, the end of the no-passing zone may be and the NEXT XX MILES plaque should be repeated every mile to the end of the no-passing zone. In areas and a NEXT XX MILES (R20-1TP) plaque may be used at the beginning of such zones. The DO NOT PASS sign as a single zone. If passing is to be prohibited over one or more lengthy sections, a DO NOT PASS sign B. At the discretion of the Engineer, in areas of numerous no-passing zones, several zones may be combined markings. no-passing zones need not be covered prior to construction if the signs supplement the existing pavement for each direction of travel except as otherwise provided herein. Signs marking these individual DO NOT PASS (R4-1) signs and PASS WITH CARE (R4-2) signs placed at the beginning and end of each zone A. Prior to the beginning of construction, all currently striped no-passing zones shall be signed with the the Engineer. roadway based on roadway conditions as directed by will be placed on both right and left sides of the 5. Signs on divided highways, freeways and expressways be 48" x 48". diamond shaped construction warning signs shall highways, freeways or expressways, the size of 4. When surfacing operations take place on divided Work Zone Sign Supports. approved for Long-Term / Intermediate-Term Control Devices List (CWZTCD) on supports Standards or the Compliant Work Zone Traffic 3. Signs shall be erected as detailed on the BC others required elsewhere in the plans. supplement those required by the BC Standards or 2. The devices shown on this sheet are to be used to cover or obliterate the existing pavement markings. placed prior to the surfacing operation which will Engineer on sections of roadway where tabs must be will be furnished and erected as directed by the 1. The traffic control devices detailed on this sheet 900'75 800'70 700'65 600'60 500'55 400'50 320'45 240'40 160'35 120'30 Distance "X" Spacing Sign Minimum X Speed Posted X Conventional Roads Only DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzbrk-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:46 PM116 6-96 8-96 5-98 3-03 LEGEND DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS PLYWOOD SIGN BLANKS DMS-7100 ALUMINUM SIGN BLANKS DMS-7110 DMS-8300 COLOR USAGE SHEETING MATERIAL ORANGE BLACK BACKGROUND LEGEND & BORDERS NON-REFLECTIVE ACRYLIC FILM Sign Traffic Flow Large Sign 48" X 48" CW21-1T * (See Note 3) 48" X 48" CW21-1T SIGN FACE MATERIALS TYPE B OR TYPE CFLFL WORK ZONE "GIVE US A BRAKE" SIGNS August 1995 GENERAL NOTES UNDIVIDED HIGHWAYDIVIDED HIGHWAY SIGNS ARE SHOWN FOR ONE DIRECTION OF TRAVEL SUMMARY OF LARGE SIGNS SIGN DESIGNATION SIGN DIMENSIONS REFLECTIVE SHEETING GALVANIZED DRILLED SHAFT Size 1 2 (LF) (LF) BACKGROUND COLOR 24" DIA. STEEL STRUCTURAL SQ FT See Note 6 Below 32OrangeG20-7T 96" X 48" W8x18 16 17 12128 Orange 192" X 96" SIGN FLType B or CFL FLType B or CFL Limit Signs Project Limit Signs Project (See Note 3) 48" X 48" CW21-1T Area Work Area Work * before the sign is manufactured. shall be shown in the plans or the Engineer shall provide a detail to the Contractor Highway Sign Designs for Texas," latest edition. Sign details not shown in this manual 8. All signs shall be constructed in accordance with the details found in the "Standard Item 416 - Drilled Shaft Foundations Item 647 - Large Roadside Sign Supports and Assemblies. Item 636 - Aluminum Signs under the following specification items: 7. The Working For You Give Us A BRAKE (G20-7T) 192" X 96" sign shall be paid for subsidiary to Item 502. 4" x 6" wood posts with drilled holes for breakaway as per BC(5) and will be plywood substrate or 0.125" aluminum sheeting substrate and may be supported by two 6. The 96" X 48" Working For You Give Us A BRAKE (G20-7T) may use a 1/2" or 5/8" subsidiary to Item 502, "Barricades, Signs and Traffic Handling." 5. Give Us a Brake (CW21-1T) signs and supports shall be considered speed zone signing when required. US A BRAKE signing. See BC(3) for location and spacing of construction 4. Work zone speed limits are sometimes used in conjunction with GIVE used for this purpose. repeated halfway through the project. The Give Us a Brake (CW21-1T) may be 3. For projects more than two miles in length, Give Us a BRAKE signs should be 2. Sign locations shall be approved by the Engineer. 1. See BC and SMD sheets for additional sign support details. (Optional- See Note 7) 192" X 96" or 96" X 48" (See Note 6) G20-7T 7-13 WZ(BRK)-13 wzbrk-13.dgn 44 Standard Division Operations Traffic elsewhere in the plans. 192" x 96" sign is required, the locations shall be noted When the optional larger WORKING FOR YOU GIVE US A BRAKE (G20-7T) G20-7T DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONTApril 1992 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzbts-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:47 PMSHEET 1 OF 2 114 2-98 4-98 10-99 3-03 10' min. 10' min. Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X"XXXXXXXXXXX X X LLLSee Note 8 NEAR SIDE LANE CLOSURE FAR SIDE LEFT LANE CLOSUREFAR SIDE RIGHT LANE CLOSURE OPERATIONS IN THE INTERSECTION SHORT DURATION SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARY SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARY SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARYMin.30'48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TL 48" x 48" CW20-5TL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 30" R4-7 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 30" R4-7 24" x 30" R4-7 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 Typical 24" x 30" R4-7 Typical X •L X •L 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 GENERAL NOTES 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 Note 7SeeBX XX XX48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 WORK ABOVE OPEN LANES OF TRAFFIC. WORKERS IN BUCKET TRUCKS SHALL NOT TYPICAL DETAILS TRAFFIC SIGNAL WORK opposing traffic. channelizing devices on the centerline to protect the work space from a left lane closure by using a LEFT LANE CLOSED (CW20-5TL) and adding 9. Signs and devices for the NEAR SIDE LANE CLOSURE may be altered for the closed lane if space is not available at the beginning of the taper. option, the arrow board may be placed at the end of the taper in work if the work vehicle has an arrow board in operation. As an 8. The arrow board at this location may be omitted for Short Duration safety of the setup. (less than 1 hour) any buffer space provided will enhance the table should be used if field conditions permit. For Short Duration 7. For Short-Term Stationary work the buffer space "B" from the above signs may be implemented when approved by the engineer. If existing signals do not have power, All-Way Stop (R1-1 and R1-3P) may be placed in flashing red mode when approved by the engineer. 6. When work operations are performed on existing signals, the signals the vehicle. 5. High level warning devices (flag trees) may be used at corners of high intensity rotating, flashing, oscillating or strobe type lights. 4. Vehicles parked in roadway shall be equipped with at least two to field conditions. 3. Flaggers and Flagger Symbol (CW20-7) signs may be required according and delineated at all times. 2. Obstructions or hazards at the work area shall be clearly marked the device must be left unattended at night. cones, drums, vertical panels or barricades will be required when 1. The minimum size channelizing device is the 28" cone. 42" Two-piece wzbts-13.dgn WZ(BTS-1)-13 45 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzbts-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:47 PMSHEET 2 OF 2 115 2-98 4-98 10-99 3-03 April 1992 X X X FILE: REFLECTIVE SHEETING X WORK AREA TYPICAL ADVANCE SIGNAL PROJECT SIGNING 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 24" G20-5T 36" x 24" G20-5aP 36" x 36" R20-5T 36" x 18" R20-5aTP 48" x 42" R20-3T 48" x 42" R20-3T 48" x 24" G20-5T 48" x 30" G20-6T 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 36" x 18" G20-2 48" x 30" G20-6T 10' Min. SIDEWALK DIVERSION SIDEWALK DETOUR CROSSWALK CLOSURES 4' Min.(See Note 7 below) See Note 4 below Temporary Traffic Barrier 24" x 12" R9-9 24" x 12" R9-11aR 24" x 12" R9-11aL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 See Note 6 36" x 36" CW11-2 24" x 12" CW16-9P 24" x 12" R9-10DBL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 12" R9-11L 24" x 12" R9-11aR 24" x 12" R9-9 See Note 6 36" x 36" CW11-2 24" x 12" CW16-7PL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 36" x 24" G20-5aP 36" x 36" R20-5T 36" x 18" R20-5aTP 36" x 18" G20-2 MINOR STREETMAJOR STREET FOR LONG TERM and INTERMEDIATE-TERM STATIONARY WORK OPERATIONS NOTES GENERAL NOTES FOR WORK ZONE SIGNS 9 feet, above the paved surface regardless of work duration. 3. Regulatory signs shall be mounted at least 7 feet, but not more than shown on Figure 6F-2 of the TMUTCD. 2. Sign height of Short-term/Short Duration warning signs shall be as shown on Figure 6F-1 of the TMUTCD. 1. Sign height of Long-term/Intermediate-term warning signs shall be as DURATION OF WORK SIGN MOUNTING HEIGHT REMOVING OR COVERING the requirements of the DMS and color usage table shown on this sheet. 1. All signs shall be retroreflective and constructed of sheeting meeting will not be allowed. 10. Damaged wood posts shall be replaced. Splicing wood posts for identification shall be 1". substrate. The maximum height of letters and/or company logos used 9. Identification markings may be shown only on the back of the sign directed by the Engineer. damaged or marred reflective sheeting shall be replaced as 8. Temporary signs that have damaged or cracked substrates and/or installed as per the manufacturer's recommendations. the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Device List" (CWZTCD), 7. The Contractor shall furnish sign supports and substrates listed in in the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas" (SHSD). 6. The Contractor shall furnish the sign design shown in the plans or directed by the Engineer. 5. All signs shall be installed in accordance with the plans or as 4. Nails shall NOT be used to attach signs to any support. 3. Barricades shall NOT be used as sign supports. 2. Wooden sign posts shall be painted white. condition. 1. Signs shall be installed and maintained in a straight and plumb SIGN SUPPORT WEIGHTS level sign supports placed on slopes. 8. Sandbags shall NOT be placed under the skid and shall not be used to sign support. shall be placed along the length of the skids to weigh down the level or hung with rope, wire, chains or other fastners. Sandbags of the traffic control device and shall not be suspended above ground 7. Sandbags shall only be placed along or laid over the base supports list. manufactured with rubber bases may be used when shown on the CWZTCD for ballast on portable sign supports. Sign supports designed and 6. Rubber ballasts designed for channelizing devices should not be used vehicular impact. Rubber, such as tire inner tubes, shall not be used. 5. Sandbags shall be made of a durable material that tears upon 4. Sandbags should weigh a minimum of 35 lbs and a maximum of 50 lbs. permitted for use as sign support weights. 3. Rock, concrete, iron, steel or other solid objects will not be to maintain a constant weight. 2. The sandbags will be tied shut to keep the sand from spilling and filled with dry, cohesionless material. 1. Weights used to keep signs from turning over should be sandbags DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS WHITE COLOR USAGE SHEETING MATERIAL ORANGE BLACK BACKGROUND BACKGROUND SIGN FACE MATERIALS FL FL FLEXIBLE ROLL-UP REFLECTIVE SIGNS DMS-8300 DMS-8310 LEGEND & BORDERS Sign Channelizing Devices LEGEND Only pre-qualified products shall be used. A copy of the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD) http://www.txdot.gov/txdot_library/publications/construction.htm Type 3 Barricade Work Area Work Area Work Area describes pre-qualified products and their sources and may be found at the following web address: X X warning sign spacing. 5. See the Table on sheet 1 of 2 for Typical directions. 4. Warning sign spacing shown is typical for both under way, as directed by the Engineer. construction operations are no longer 3. Advance signs shall be removed when signal locations will be as directed by the Engineer. intersections at the project limits. Actual intersection, but only in advance of the may not be required in advance of each 2. For closely adjoining projects, advance signing whenever signal contract work is in progress. 1. Project signing as shown shall be in place Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (TMUTCD). 1. Work zone durations are defined in Part 6, Section 6G.02 of the See Note 8 BARRICADES AND SIGNS TRAFFIC SIGNAL WORK 7-13 WZ(BTS-2)-13 wzbts-13.dgn Standard Division Operations Traffic 46 TYPE A SHEETING ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE SHEETING TYPE B OR TYPE C SHEETING 2. "CROSSWALK CLOSURES" as detailed above will require the Engineer's approval prior to installation. 3. R9 series signs shown may be placed on supports detailed on the BC standards or CWZTCD list, or when fabricated from approved lightweight plastic substrates, they may be mounted on top of a plastic drum at or near the location shown. 4. For speeds less than 45 mph longitudinal channelizing devices may be used instead of traffic barriers when approved by the Engineer. Attenuation of blunt ends and installation of water filled devices shall be as per BC(9) and manufacturer's recommendations. 5. Location of devices are for general guidance. Actual device spacing and location must be field adjusted to meet actual conditions. 7. The width of existing sidewalk should be maintained if practical. 6. Where pedestrians with visual disabilities normally use the closed sidewalk Barricades shown. Detectable Pedestrian Barricades should be used instead of the Type 3 facility. features consistent with the features present in the existing pedestrian temporary facilities shall be detectable and shall include accessibility 9. When crosswalks or other pedestrian facilities are closed or relocated, appropriate bid items. 8. Pavement markings for mid-block crosswalks shall be paid for under the 1. Holes, trenches or other hazards shall be adequately protected by covering, delineating or surrounding the hazard with orange plastic pedestrian fencing or longitudinal channelizing devices, or as directed by the Engineer. completion of the work. 4. Signs and anchor stubs shall be removed and holes back filled upon sign face. 3. Duct tape or other adhesive material shall NOT be affixed to a be used to cover signs. Burlap, or heavy materials such as plywood or aluminum shall not automobile headlights at night without damaging the sign sheeting. the entire sign face and maintain their opaque properties under as heavy mil black plastic, or other materials which will cover 2. When signs are covered, the material used shall be opaque, such approved by the Engineer. shall be removed or completely covered, unless otherwise 1. When sign messages may be confusing or do not apply, the signs DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzrcd-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:49 PM113500'500'500'1000'10' Min.10' Min.200' Approx.10' Min.200' Approx.X'X'1-97 2-98 4-98 3-03 See Note 6 See Note 8 August 1995 ROAD CLOSURE BEYOND THE INTERSECTION ROAD CLOSURE AT THE INTERSECTION Signing for a Numbered Route with an Off-Site Detour Signing for an Un-numbered Route with an Off-Site Detour 48" x 48" CW20-3B 48" x 18" M4-10L 24" x 12" M4-8 24" x 24" M1-6T 48" x 30" R11-2 30" x 24" M4-9S See Note 7 Var x 12" M4-12T 21" x 15" M6-1 24" x 24" M1-6T 24" x 12" M4-8 24" x 24" M1-6T 21" x 15" M5-1L 48" x 48" CW20-2A 48" x 48" CW20-3D 48" x 48" CW20-2D 24" x 24" R3-1 48" x 18" M4-10L 48" x 30" R11-2 WZ(RCD)-13 47 wzrcd-13.dgn Work Area Work Area 24" x 12" M3-4 See Note 8 48" x 48" CW20-3C See Note 8 60" x 30" R11-3a 24" x 12" M4-8 GENERAL NOTES LEGEND Varies24" x 24" R3-2 DETAILS ROAD CLOSURE WORK ZONE 7-13 shown elsewhere in the plans. Locations where these details will be required shall be as 9. Signs and barricades shown shall be subsidiary to Item 502. 500 FT (CW20-3C) signs. replace the ROAD CLOSED 1000 FT (CW20-3B) and ROAD CLOSED CLOSED AHEAD (CW20-3D) sign spaced as per the table above may between the intersection and the closure a single ROAD TO THRU TRAFFIC (R11-4) sign. If adequate space does not exist XX MILES AHEAD (R11-3a) sign may be replaced with a ROAD CLOSED intersection and the actual closure location, the ROAD CLOSED 8. For urban areas where there is a shorter distance between the DETOUR (M4-9S) sign. 7. The Street Name (M4-12T) sign is to be placed above the location should be located at the edge of the traveled way. beyond the intersection, the signs and barricades at this intersection or there are significant origin/destination points 6. If the road is open for a significant distance beyond the the plans. required. Detour routes should be signed as shown elsewhere in labeled. It does not indicate the full extent of detour signing that is appropriate for numbered routes or un-numbered routes as 5. Detour signing shown is intended to illustrate the type of signing pavement edge. 4. Barricades at the road closure should extend from pavement edge to barricades. 3. Stockpiled materials shall not be placed on the traffic side of Traffic Control Devices list (CWZTCD). Construction Standard BC(10) and listed on the Compliant Work Zone 2. Barricades used shall meet the requirements shown on Barricade and D&OM standards. road closures. For permanent road closure details see the 1. This sheet is intended to provide details for temporary work zone Standard Division Operations Traffic 900' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 75 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 Conventional Roads Only* Type 3 Barricade Sign Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X" Speed Posted * DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzstpm-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:51 PM111 DOUBLE Yellow Yellow Yellow White White Yellow White White 4" to 12" 4" to 12" -Type Y-220'+6" NO-PASSING LINE TABS -20'+6"4.5'+6"- 4" TABS TABS White White TABS TABS Type Y-2 Type W Type W Type W Type W Type Y-2 Type Y-2 Type W Type W SINGLE NO-PASSING LINE or CHANNELIZATION LINE TABS -20'+6" 4" -20'+6" TABS 4.5'+6"- - 4" -4.5'+6"- 40'+1' -1'+3" Yellow or White Yellow or White Type Y-2 or W Type Y-2 or W Raised Pavement Marker L •L If raised pavement markers are used to supplement REMOVABLE short term markings, the markers shall be applied to the top of the tape at the approximate mid length of the tape. This allows an easier removal of raised markers and tape. TAPE TAPE TAPE TAPE NOTES: reflective roadway marker tabs unless otherwise specified elsewhere in plans. 2. Short term pavement markings shall NOT be used to simulate edge lines. 3. Dimensions indicated on this sheet are typical and approximate. Variations in size and height may occur be- tween markers or devices made by manufacturers, by as much as 1/4 inch, unless otherwise noted. 4. Temporary flexible-reflective roadway marker tabs will require normal maintenance replacement when used on roadways with an ADT per lane of up to 7500 vehicles with no more than 10% truck mix. When roadways exceed these values, additional maintenance replacement of devices should be planned. 5. No segment of roadway open to traffic shall remain without permanent pavement markings for a period greater than 14 calendar days. The Contractor will be responsible for maintaining short term pavement markings until permanent pavement markings are in place. When the Contractor is responsible for placement of permanent pavement markings, no segment of roadway shall remain without permanent pavement markings for a period greater than 14 calendar days unless weather conditions prohibit placement. Permanent pavement markings shall be placed as soon as weather permits. 6. For two lane, two-way roadways, DO NOT PASS signs shall be erected to mark the beginning of sections where passing is permitted. Signs shall be in accordance with the "Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices" (TMUTCD) and may be used to indicate the limits of no-passing zones for up to 14 calendar days. Permanent 7. For low volume two lane, two-way roadways of 4000 ADT or less, no-passing lines may be omitted when approved by the Engineer. DO NOT PASS and PASS WITH CARE signs shall be erected (see note 6). 1. Temporary flexible-reflective roadway marker tabs detailed on this sheet will be designated Type Y-2 (two amber reflective surfaces with yellow body); Type Y (one amber reflective surface with yellow body); and 2. Tabs shall meet requirements of Departmental Material Specification DMS-8242. 3. When dry, tabs shall be visible for a minimum distance of 200 feet during normal daylight hours and when illuminated by automobile low-beam head light at night, unless sight distance is restricted by roadway geometrics. 4. No two consecutive tabs nor four tabs per 1000 feet of line shall be missing or fail to meet the visual performance requirements of Note 3. TAPE TAPE TAPE pavement markings should then be placed. TEMPORARY FLEXIBLE, REFLECTIVE ROADWAY MARKER TABS (TABS) PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS TABS TAPE 40'+1' 20'+6" 3'+3" 12" White 4"+1" 12'+6"3'+3"Type W TABS TAPE 20'+6" 4"+1" Type W White 4.5'+6"- Wide Dotted Lines Wide Gore MarkingsType W Wide Dotted Lines Wide Gore Markings 1-97 3-03 R4-1 R4-2R4-2 R4-1 Type W (one white or silver reflective surface with white body). Additional details may be found on BC(11). 1. Short term pavement markings may be prefabricated markings (stick down tape) or temporary flexible- OR LANE LINE) (FOR CENTER LINE (FOR LANE DROP LINES) April 1992 DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS (DMS) & MATERIAL PRODUCER LISTS (MPL) RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS http://www.txdot.gov/business/contractors_consultants/material_specifications/default.htm TWO-WAY LEFT TURN LANE LANE & CENTER LINES FOR MULTILANE UNDIVIDED HIGHWAYS LANE LINES FOR DIVIDED HIGHWAY CENTER LINE & NO-PASSING ZONE BARRIER LINES FOR TWO LANE TWO-WAY HIGHWAYS WIDE DOTTED LINES WIDE GORE MARKINGS BROKEN LINES SOLID LINES WORK ZONE SHORT TERM PAVEMENT MARKINGS PATTERNSWORK ZONE SHORT TERM PAVEMENT MARKINGS DETAILS Marking (Tape) Pavement Short Term Removable Item 672, "RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS" and DMS-4200. 1. All raised pavement markers used for work zone markings shall meet the requirements of respective MPLs at the following website: 1. DMSs referenced above can be found along with embedded links to their Prefabricated Pavement Markings." "Permanent Prefabricated Pavement Markings" or DMS-8243 "Temporary Costruction-Grade 2. Non-removable Prefabricated Pavement Markings shall meet the requirements of either DMS-8240 1. Temporary Removable Prefabricated Pavement Markings shall meet the requirements of DMS-8241. 12'+6" noted elsewhere in the plans. One piece cones are not allowed for this purpose. devices to guide motorist through the exit. If channelizing devices are to be used it should be 8. For exit gores where a lane is being dropped place wide gore markings or retroreflective channelizing 12" passing is prohibited and PASS WITH CARE signs shall be erected to mark the beginning of sections where 7-13 wzstpm-13.dgn WZ(STPM)-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic 48 PAVEMENT MARKINGS WORK ZONE SHORT TERM DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256252\wzul-13.dgn8/5/20201:45:52 PM April 1992 112 Edge Condition D 1•" (typical-overlay) CW8-11 CW8-11 CW8-11 CW8-11 X D >3 1 0" to 3/4" D 1 2 3 Notched Wedge Joint 12" 8-95 1-97 2-98 3-03 See Table 1* X X XX CW8-12 Conventional roads divided roadways Freeways/expressways, 36" x 36" 48" x 48" ARE SHOWN ELSEWHERE IN THE PLANS. OVERLAY AND LEVELING OPERATIONS TRAFFIC CONTROL DURING PLANING, CW8-12 CW8-11 X DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS COLOR USAGE SHEETING MATERIAL ORANGE BLACK BACKGROUND SIGN FACE MATERIALS FL FL DMS-8300 LEGEND & BORDERS PERMANENT PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS DMS-8241 DMS-8240 TEMPORARY (REMOVABLE) PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS TABLE 1 MINIMUM WARNING SIGN SIZE open to traffic when "D" is greater than 3". work operations cease. Uneven lanes should not be with edge condition 2 or 3 are open to traffic after Distance "D" may be a maximum of 3" if uneven lanes after work operations cease. lanes with edge condition 1 are open to traffic operations and 2" for overlay operations if uneven Distance "D" may be a maximum of 1 1/4 " for planing X Warning DevicesEdge Height (D) Table 1 X See (See Note 4) "X" distance (See Note 4) "X" distance (See Note 4) "X" distance GENERAL NOTES TWO LANE CONVENTIONAL ROAD DIVIDED ROADWAY FOUR LANE CONVENTIONAL ROADTWO LANE CONVENTIONAL ROAD X (See Note 4) "X" distance (See Note 4) "X" distance 1‚" (maximum-planing) Less than or equal to: Less than or equal to 3" Condition exists Area where Edge Condition exists Area where Edge Condition exists Area where Edge Line markings Area missing Center UNEVEN LANES NO CENTER LINE UNEVEN LANES UNEVEN LANES the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas," latest edition. 8. All signs shall be constructed in accordance with the details found in 7. Short term markings shall not be used to simulate edge lines. list. standards and/or listed on the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices" 6. Signs shall be fabricated and mounted on supports as shown on the BC subsidiary to Item 502 "BARRICADES, SIGNS AND TRAFFIC HANDLING." remain in place until final surface is applied. Signs shall be considered 5. Additional signs may be required as directed by the Engineer. Signs shall 4. Signs shall be spaced at the distances recommended as per BC standards. installed. and markings shall remain in place until permanent pavement markings are every two miles where the center line markings are not in place. The signs way traffic are obscured or obliterated. Repeat NO CENTER LINE signs WZ(STPM) standard shall be installed if yellow centerlines separating two 3. NO CENTER LINE (CW8-12) signs and temporary pavement markings as per the plaque or Advisory Speed (CW13-1P) plaque. lane condition may be supplemented with the NEXT XX MILES (CW7-3aP) condition and repeated every mile. Signs installed along the uneven 2. UNEVEN LANES (CW8-11) signs shall be installed in advance of the condition persists. advance of the condition and be repeated every two miles where the 1. If spalling or holes occur, ROUGH ROAD (CW8-8) signs should be placed in *See Table 1 X See Table 1 Sign: CW8-11 Sign: CW8-11 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic WZ(UL)-13 UNEVEN LANES SIGNING FOR 49 wzul-13.dgn TYPE B OR TYPE C SHEETING ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE SHEETING 50 1 0 0 +001 01+00102+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 POT 100+00.00PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:08 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAYE UNI VERSI TY DRNOTTINGHAM DR NOTTINGHAM DR [ XUNIV [ XNOTT [ XNOTT [ XUNIV TYP64 SQYD DRIVEWAY REMOVE CONC REMOVE CONC CURB TO REMAIN EXIST SIDEWALK 49 SQYD REMOVE SIDEWALK 27 SQYD REMOVE SIDEWALK 21 SQYD REMOVE SIDEWALK FACE OF CURB 1' FROM SAWCUT LINE FACE OF CURB 1' FROM SAWCUT LINE TO REMAIN EXIST SIDEWALK E UNI VERSI TY DR22 SQYD REMOVE SIDEWALK EXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW OF CURB 1' FROM FACE SAWCUT LINE 1' 22.84' LT, STA 100+90.95 [ XNOTT 0.00' RT [ XNOTT STA 100+91.58, BEGIN MILL AND OVERLAY 0.00' LT [ XNOTT STA 102+22.54' END MILL AND OVERLAY FOR PROPOSED SIDEWALK DETAILS SEE ROADWAY PLAN SHEETS THE NEAREST JOINT LINE. REMOVE SIDEWALK TO FOR PROPOSED SIDEWALK DETAILS SEE ROADWAY PLAN SHEETS THE NEAREST JOINT LINE. REMOVE SIDEWALK TO 671 SQYD MILL AND OVERLAY 20.95' RT, [ XNOTT STA 100+92.00, BEGIN REMOVE ASPHALT PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE C&G 10 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE CONCRETE 12 SQYD REMOVE CONCRETE PAVEMENT 14 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 23.59' RT STA 102+24.50, [ XSHERM ASPHALT PAVEMENT END REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE 23 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE CONC 2 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE CONCRETE 2 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE CONCRETE 48.42' LT [ XUNIV STA 102+47.99, BEGIN REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE C&G 23.04' RT [ XNOTT STA 104+66.28, END REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT END REMOVE C&G 22.66' LT [ XNOTT STA 104+49.72, END REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT END REMOVE C&G Off 48.38 LT [ XUNIV STA 101+33.49, BEGIN REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE C&G 53.26' RT [ XUNIV STA 100+95.72, END REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT END REMOVE C&G 32.94' LT [ XNOTT STA 102+84.55, BEGIN REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE C&G 48.73'RT [ XUNIV STA 102+42.65, END REMOVE CONCRETE PAVEMENT END REMOVE C&G 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 1 OF 3 51EXIST ROW55+00 60+00 50+0051+00POT 50+00.00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:15 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS [ XSHERM SHERMAN DRIVE [ XEB288EXIT 14.61' LT STA 100+98.23, [ XEB288ENTER [ XEB288ENTER 21.89' RT [ XSHERM STA 56+00.00, SAWCUT LINE 18.75' RT STA 100+98.32, [ XEB288ENTER PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROWEXIST ROWRANDALL STREET23.67' LT [ XSHERM STA 58+01.39, SAWCUT LINE 14.76' RT STA 100+75.92, [ XEB288EXIT 17.90' LT STA 100+89.04, [ XEB288EXIT 1'TYP1' TYPICAL SAWCUT LINE EB RAMPEB RAMP23.56' RT STA 59+87.66, [ XSHERM 24.84' RT STA 59+87.62, [ XSHERM 27.44' LT STA 60+71.86, [ XSHERM 55.18' RT STA 61+54.67, [ XSHERM 22.89' RT [ XSHERM STA 56+00.00, BEGIN REMOVE ASPHALT PAVEMENT 24.67' LT [ XSHERM STA 58+01.39, BEGIN REMOVE ASPHALT PAVEMENT PAVEMENT 4 SQYD REMOVE CONC PAVEMENT 7 SQYD REMOVE CONC 10 SQYD PAVEMENT ASPHALT REMOVE 50 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 7 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 27 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 0.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 59+64.00 BEGIN MILL AND OVERLAY 1176 SQYD MILL AND OVERLAY DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAY 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 2 OF 3 52 65+0050+0051+00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 PC 50+00.00 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:27 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS [ XSHERM 14.61' LT STA 100+98.23, [ XEB288ENTER [ XWB288ENTER 18.52' RT STA 100+67.14, [ XWB288EXIT 19.08' LT STA 100+67.23, [ XWB288EXIT 13.88' RT STA 100+67.25, [ XWB288EXIT [ XWB288EXIT PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROW 14.76' RT STA 100+75.92, [ XEB288EXIT 2832 SQYD MILL AND OVERLAY WB RAMPWB RAMP1' TYPICAL SAWCUT LINE SHERMAN DRIVE 27.44' LT STA 60+71.86, [ XSHERM 14.00' LT STA 50+89.29, [ XWB288ENTER 18.48' RT STA 50+99.43, [ XWB288ENTER 65.99' RT STA 61+95.50, [ XSHERM 72.44' RT STA 61+51.38, [ XSHERM 77.91' RT STA 62+73.14, [ XSHERM 65.82' RT STA 62+29.20, [ XSHERM 55.18' RT STA 61+54.67, [ XSHERM 58.90' RT STA 61+97.44, [ XSHERM 84.52' RT STA 62+75.22, [ XSHERM 69.73' RT STA 62+31.38, [ XSHERM US 288US 288US 288US 28833 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 35 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 34 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 289 SQYD RIPRAP REMOVE 263 SQYD RIPRAP REMOVE 35 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT PAVEMENT 6 SQYD REMOVE CONC 0.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 64+92.00, END MILL AND OVERLAY DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND RIPRAP REMOVAL SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAY 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00SHEET 3 OF 3 53 70+00 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:41 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS [ XSHERM SHERMAN DRIVE PROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 1' TYPICAL SAWCUT LINE 23.46' LT [ XSHERM STA 68+89.24, END REMOVE PAVEMENT 36 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 21 SQYD PAVEMENT REMOVE ASPHALT 24.83' RT [ XSHERM STA 70+25.46, END REMOVE ASPHALT PAVEMENT DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAY 8/5/2020 SHEET 1 OF 3 54 MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00HHHH100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00PC 100+00.00POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+00VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:47 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAYPLUM HOLLOWN LOCUST ST [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 24 SQYD REMOVE PAVEMENT 13.72' RT STA 103+83.22, [ XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 14.45' RT STA 103+82.54, [ XLOCUS 14.63' RT STA 104+40.56, [XLOCUS 14.08' RT [XPLUM STA 50+40.54, SAWCUT LINE 13.67' RT STA 105+98.26, [XLOCUS 21 SQYD REMOVE PAVEMENT 14.41' RT STA 106+50.77, [XLOCUSPLUM HOLLOW1'T YP 12.52 RT [ XLOCUS STA 101+85.00, SAWCUT LINE 1'TYP1' TYPICAL SAWCUT LINE 13.63' RT [ XLOCUS STA 104+40.53, SAWCUT LINE 24.94 RT [ XPLUM STA 50+60.86, SAWCUT LINE 14.44' RT STA 50+42.98, [XPLUM 14.61' RT STA 50+40.54, [XPLUM14.00' LT [ XPLUM STA 50+34.80, SAWCUT LINE 14.00' LT [ XPLUM STA 50+39.96, SAWCUT LINE 19.23' LT [ XPLUM STA 50+54.60, SAWCUT LINE [ XPLUM 13.52' RT [ XLOCUS STA 101+85.00, ASPHALT PAVEMENT BEGIN REMOVE 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SHEET 2 OF 3 55MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00SSSS 51+0052+0053+0054+00106+00 107+00 108+00 109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00PT 108+00.00POT 54+61.41 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:46:56 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAY N LOCUST ST HERCULES LN[ XLOCUS [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW 14.41' RT STA 106+50.77, [XLOCUS 56 SQYD REMOVE PAVEMENT 11.51' RT STA 108+15.43, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 13.51' RT STA 108+16.91, [XLOCUS EXIST ROW 1'TYP 63 SQFT REMOVE SIDEWALK 1'T YP 11.50' RT STA 109+03.79, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 13.46' RT STA 109+02.77, [XLOCUS 159 SQFT REMOVE SIDEWALK 82 SQYD REMOVE PAVEMENT 14.96' RT STA 111+51.90, [XLOCUS 22.09' RT STA 112+39.84, [XLOCUS EXIST ROW1'TYP13.40' RT STA 106+85.00, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 11.50' RT STA 106+85.00, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 23.07' LT STA 52+57.67, [XHERCU 23.03' LT STA 52+20.60, [XHERCU 22.99' RT STA 52+51.83, [XHERCU 23.00 RT STA 52+20.60, [XHERCU [ XHERCU [ XHERCU 11.50' RT STA 111+50.00, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 13.92' RT STA 111+50.00, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE FOR PROPOSED SIDEWALK DETAILS SEE ROADWAY PLAN SHEETS THE NEAREST JOINT LINE. REMOVE SIDEWALK TO FOR PROPOSED SIDEWALK DETAILS SEE ROADWAY PLAN SHEETS THE NEAREST JOINT LINE. REMOVE SIDEWALK TO 8/5/2020 SHEET 3 OF 3 56MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SS 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00PC 116+39.30VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' REMOVAL PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:47:04 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS DRIVEWAY REMOVAL PAVE REMOVAL LEGEND SIDEWALK REMOVAL PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW MILL & OVERLAY N LOCUST ST [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 22.09' RT STA 112+39.84, [XLOCUS 1'TYP11.50' RT STA 111+50.00, [XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 25.31' RT STA 115+04.00, [ XLOCUS SAWCUT LINE 34 SQYD REMOVE PAVEMENT 24.93' RT STA 112+93.22, [ XLOCUS 26.31' RT STA 115+04.00, [ XLOCUS ASPHALT PAVEMENT END REMOVE 8/5/2020 57 DETAILS FOR MORE INFORMATION 4. REFER TO CITY OF DENTON STANDARD DRIVE APPROACH 1 0 0+00101+0 0 102+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88POT 108+50.0025'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:47:20 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW NOTTINGHAM DRE UNI VERSI TY DRE UNI VERSI TY DRC [ XNOTT [ XUNIV STA 101+75.62 [ XNOTT STA 103+74.13 = LINE SAWCUT TANGENT = 185.59 LENGTH = 370.89 RADIUS = 3,800.00 TANGENT = 62.43 LENGTH = 123.69 RADIUS = 370.00 XNOTT CURVE DATA XUNIV CURVE DATA A1 B1 A1 NOTTINGHAM DR B1 [ XUNIV 34.50' RT STA 101+91.08, [ XNOTT 1'TYP1'30'R50'R30'R 30'R 49.03' RT STA 102+24.12, [ XUNIV (TYPE 1) PED RAMP MATCH EXIST STA 102+47.99, [ XUNIV BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) [ XNOTT C MATCH EXIST STA 102+42.65, [ XUNIV END CONC CURB (TY II) END WIDENING FOC EXIST JOINT LINE TO NEAREST SIDEWALK RECONSTRUCT MATCH EXIST STA 100+95.75, [ XUNIV END CONC CURB (TY II) JOINT LINE TO NEAREST SIDEWALK RECONSTRUCT MATCH EXIST STA 104+49.72, [ XUNIV BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) EXIST TO REMAIN (TYPE 1) PED RAMP MATCH EXIST STA 104+49.72, [ XNOTT END CONC CURB (TY II) (TYPE 1) PED RAMP MATCH EXIST STA 102+84.62, [ XNOTT BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) EXIST TO REMAIN (TY II) CONC CURB 34.50' RT STA 102+11.19, [ XNOTT 34.50' RT STA 103+03.21, [ XNOTT (TYPE 1) PED RAMP MATCH EXIST STA 104+66.28, [ XNOTT END CONC CURB (TY II) EXIST TO REMAIN EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWEXIST TO REMAIN REMAIN EXIST TO E 2,394,830.4639 N 7,136,329.3838 PI STATION = 102+73.62 E 2,394,850.3205 N 7,136,270.2009 PC STATION = 102+11.19 E 2,394,831.1240 N 7,136,391.8056 PT STATION = 103+34.88 E 2,394,840.0581 N 7,136,437.7241 PI STATION = 101+85.59 E 2,394,661.7085 N 7,136,386.3879 PC STATION = 100+00.00 E 2,395,022.5614 N 7,136,471.4363 PT STATION = 103+70.89 0.00' RT STA 100+91.58 L XNOTT BEGIN PROJECT 0.00' RT STA 108+30.50 L XNOTT END PROJECT 10'RTYPMATCH EXIST STA 100+91.87, [ XNOTT CURB (TY II) BEGIN CONC BEGIN WIDENING 38.23' RT STA 101+52.33, [ XNOTT 43.15' RT STA 101+52.41, [ XNOTT 42.90' RT STA 101+66.41, [ XNOTT 28.49' RT STA 101+43.58, [ XNOTT END CONC CURB (TY II) 32.80' RT STA 101+77.67, [ XNOTT BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) SEE NOTE 4 TO REMAIN EXIST 49.45'RT STA 102+30.51, [ XUNIV 23'23'33'PROP ROW(TYPE 1) PED RAMP TO REMAIN EXIST CURB STA 100+91.58 [ XNOTT BEGIN MILL AND OVERLAY STA 102+22.54 [ XNOTT END MILL AND OVERLAY &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND MILL AND OVERLAY 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 1 OF 3 58 55+00 60+00 50+0051+00POT 50+00.00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:47:27 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 37.21' LT [ XSHERM STA 59+68.89, 29.00' LT STA 60+98.35 [ XSHERM 27.36' LT [ XSHERM STA 59+75.89, 50'R 50'R 50'R 5 0'RSHERMAN DRIVE 12.00' RT STA 100+88.37, [ XEB288ENTER 14.00' LT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER L LINE SAWCUT PAVE MATCH EXIST 12.00' LT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER LINE SAWCUT [ XSHERM TYPEXIST ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROW PROP ROWRANDALL STREETEXIST ROWSGT 22.00' RT [ XSHERM STA 56+00.00, MATCH EXIST BEGIN TAPER [ XEB288EXIT STA 50+00.00 [ XEB288ENTER STA 100+00.00 = [ XSHERM STA 60+37.95 = 35.71' LT [ XSHERM STA 59+01.39, END TAPER 1'[ XEB288EXIT [ XEB288ENTER 14.00' LT STA 100+89.00, [ XEB288ENTER BEGIN MOW STRIP BEGIN SLOTTED SSTR69'71'79'79'XSHERM CURVE DATA BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = XEB288EXIT CURVE DATA BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = XEB288ENTER CURVE DATA E 2,394,515.0936 N 7,145,734.1750 POT STA 76+34.37 E 2,393,236.4814 N 7,143,430.8992 POT STA 50+00.00 E 2,393,332.0244 N 7,144,563.6835 POT STA 104+66.27 E 2,393,740.2562 N 7,144,338.3927 POT STA 100+00.00 E 2,393,897.1768 N 7,144,251.2817 POT STA 101+79.48 E 2,393,740.2562 N 7,144,338.3927 POT STA 100+00.00 MATCH EXIST C SHERM STA 56+00.00 BEGIN PROJECT 14.06' RT STA 100+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT TRANS BEGIN MOW STRIP BEGIN SLOTTED SSTREB RAMPEB RAMP33.00' RT STA 57+00.00, [ XSHERM 43.00' RT STA 57+00.00, [ XSHERM END TAPER 38.39' RT STA 59+77.06, [ XSHERM 48.23' RT STA 59+70.06, [ XSHERM 13.06' RT STA 50+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT 19.95' LT STA 50+87.24, [ XEB288EXIT 23.67' LT [ XSHERM STA 58+01.39, MATCH EXIST BEGIN TAPER 19.94' LT STA 50+89.05, [ XEB288EXIT 12.97' LT STA 50+77.38, [ XEB288EXIT MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 50+89.03, [ XEB288EXIT 11.03' RT STA 50+78.97, [ XEB288EXIT 12.00' LT STA 100+79.00, [ XEB288ENTER 0.00' RT STA 57+35.00, [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER 19.00' RT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER 14.00' LT STA 100+89.00, [ XEB288ENTER 40.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 61+40.00, BEGIN RIPRAP END MOW STRIP 39.00' LT STA 61+00.78, [ XSHERM 33'22'MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 50+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT STA 59+64.00, [ XSHERM MILL AND OVERLAY BEGIN ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW SLOTTED SSCB 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP MILL AND OVERLAY &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: 8/5/2020 65+0050+0051+00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 PC 50+00.00 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:47:39 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW SLOTTED SSCB 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP MILL AND OVERLAY &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES:MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 2 OF 3 59 [ XSHERM 29.00' LT STA 60+98.35 [ XSHERM 50'R 50 'R50'R 50'R 14.00' LT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER [ XWB288ENTER 14.00' LT [ XWB288ENTER STA 50+89.29 LINE SAWCUT PAVE MATCH EXIST 12.00' LT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER SHERMAN DR 29.00' RT STA 63+30.21 [ XSHERM EXIST ROW PROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW 14.00' LT STA 100+89.00, [ XEB288ENTER BEGIN MOW STRIP BEGIN SLOTTED SSTR SGT [ XWB288EXIT TYP1'XWB288ENTER CURVE DATA BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = XEB288ENTER CURVE DATA A1 TANGENT = 233.61 LENGTH = 465.98 RADIUS = 2,612.37 E 2,393,911.0837 N 7,144,646.1192 PC STATION = 50+00.00 E 2,393,491.5193 N 7,144,847.4334 PT STATION = 54+65.98 E 2,393,710.3027 N 7,144,765.5359 PI STATION = 52+33.61 E 2,394,057.2422 N 7,144,565.9048 POT STA 101+66.75 E 2,393,912.8613 N 7,144,649.3215 POT STA 100+00.00 XSHERM CURVE DATA BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = E 2,394,515.0936 N 7,145,734.1750 POT STA 76+34.37 E 2,393,236.4814 N 7,143,430.8992 POT STA 50+00.00 14.06' RT STA 100+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT TRANS BEGIN MOW STRIP BEGIN SLOTTED SSTR LINE SAWCUT LINE SAWCUTWB RAMPWB RAMP39.00' RT STA 61+01.95, [ XSHERM 29.00' RT STA 60+99.95, [ XSHERM 39.00' RT STA 63+28.04, [ XSHERM 12.00' RT [ XWB288EXIT STA 100+80.07, 39.00' RT STA 66+00.17, [ XSHERM 29.00' RT STA 66+00.17, [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER 14.00' LT [ XWB288ENTER STA 50+99.44, 15.00' LT STA 50+89.31, [ XWB288ENTER END MOW STRIP END SLOTTED SSTR 12.00' LT [ XWB288ENTER STA 50+79.04, 29.00' LT STA 63+29.07, [ XSHERM 39.00' LT STA 63+27.04, [ XSHERM 13.06' RT STA 50+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT A1 40.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 62+90.00, BEGIN MOW STRIP END RIPRAP 10'10'10'10'40.00' LT STA 62+90.00, [ XSHERM BEGIN MOW STRIP END RIPRAP 12.00' LT STA 100+79.00, [ XEB288ENTER 40.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 61+40.00, BEGIN RIPRAP END MOW STRIP 40.00' LT [ XSHERM STA 61+30.00, BEGIN RIPRAP END MOW STRIP 14.00' LT STA 100+89.00, [ XWB288EXIT END MOW STRIP END SLOTTED SSTR [ XWB288EXIT STA 100+00.00 [ XSHERM STA 63+93.57= [ XWB288ENTER STA 50+00.00 [ XSHERM STA 63+89.91= TRANS 14.00' RT STA 100+90.11, [ XWB288EXIT 19.00' LT STA 100+87.83, [ XWB288EXIT 19.00' LT STA 100+90.11, [ XWB288EXIT 12.00' LT STA 100+77.95, [ XWB288EXIT 39.00' RT STA 64+61.06, [ XSHERM 29.00' RT STA 64+54.23, [ XSHERM MATCH EXIST PAVE [ XWB288ENTER STA 50+99.44, 12.00' RT STA 50+89.54, [ XWB288ENTER 19.00' RT STA 50+99.44, [ XWB288ENTER MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 50+99.44, [ XWB288ENTER 29.00' LT STA 64+54.00, [ XSHERM 50.00' LT STA 64+59.98, [ XSHERM 40.00' LT STA 64+53.04, [ XSHERM 48.96' LT STA 66+80.19, [ XSHERM BEGING TAPER 38.98' LT STA 66+79.00, [ XSHERM 39.00' LT STA 61+00.78, [ XSHERM US 288US 288MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 100+90.11, [ XWB288EXIT MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 100+90.00, [ XWB288EXIT MATCH EXIST PAVE STA 50+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT 29'29'STA 64+92.00, [ XSHERM MILL AND OVERLAY BEGIN 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00SHEET 3 OF 3 60 70+00 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:47:51 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 15.03' LT [ XSHERM STA 68+29+00, [ XSHERM SHERMAN DRIVE L LINE SAWCUT11'11'11'EXIST ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROW PROP ROWTYP 25.02' LT [ XSHERM STA 68+29.98, END TAPER 1'XSHERM CURVE DATA BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = E 2,394,515.0936 N 7,145,734.1750 POT STA 76+34.37 E 2,393,236.4814 N 7,143,430.8992 POT STA 50+00.00 MATCH EXIST C XSHERM STA 71+40.00 END PROJECT MATCH EXIST PAVEMENT [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00, END TAPER MATCH EXIST PAVEMENT [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00, MATCH EXIST PAVEMENT [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00, MATCH EXIST PAVEMENT [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00,10'10'22.46'LT STA 68+89.25, [ XSHERM SAWCUT 23.83'RT STA 70+25.43, [ XSHERM SAWCUT &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW 8/5/2020 SHEET 1 OF 3 61 MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00HHHH100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00PC 100+00.00POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+00VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:48:03 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: N LOCUST ST N LOCUST ST PLUM HOLLOWA1 TANGENT = 400.01 LENGTH = 800.00 RADIUS = 45,500.00 XLOCUS CURVE DATA A1 [ XLOCUS C STA 108+30.50 L XLOCUS BEGIN PROJECT [ XPLUM EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW [ XPLUM STA 50+75.68 [ XLOCUS STA 104+08.64 = 20'R20'RLINE SAWCUT LINE SAWCUT 15.50' RT STA 101+85.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN WIDENING 19.53' RT STA 103+73.86, [ XLOCUS 15.00' LT STA 50+35.97, [ XPLUM MATCH EXIST STA 50+34.80, [ XPLUM MATCH EXIST STA 50+34.78, [ XPLUM 21.07' RT STA 104+43.92, [ XLOCUS 24.22' RT STA 105+84.91, [ XLOCUS11'11'BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = E 2,387,120.4949 N 7,142,563.2670 PI STATION = 104+00.01 E 2,387,122.6930 N 7,142,163.2627 PC STATION = 100+00.00 E 2,387,125.3298 N 7,142,963.2480 PT STATION = 108+00.00 XPLUM CURVE DATA E 2,387,045.3424 N 7,142,572.5460 POT STA 51+52.63 E 2,387,197.9634 N 7,142,571.2734 POT STA 50+00.00 8/5/2020 SHEET 2 OF 3 62MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SSSS 51+0052+0053+0054+00106+00 107+00 108+00 109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00PT 108+00.00POT 54+61.41 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:48:11 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: N LOCUST ST N LOCUST ST HERCULES LNLINE SAWCUT 26.50' RT STA 106+85.00, [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW[ XHERCU STA 52+95.79 [ XLOCUS STA 108+59.12 = [ XHERCU 50'R 50'R [ XLOCUS REMAIN EXIST TO (TYPE 1) PED RAMP (TYPE 1) PED RAMP JOINT LINE TO NEAREST SIDEWALK RECONSTRUCT JOINT LINE TO NEAREST SIDEWALK RECONSTRUCT 26.50' RT STA 107+76.75, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER 26.50' RT STA 109+44.79, [ XLOCUS END TAPER LINE SAWCUT BEGIN ALIGN = END ALIGN = E 2,386,960.4161 N 7,143,020.5982 POT STA 54+61.41 E 2,387,421.7984 N 7,143,025.5168 POT STA 50+00.00A1 TANGENT = 400.01 LENGTH = 800.00 RADIUS = 45,500.00 XLOCUS CURVE DATA E 2,387,120.4949 N 7,142,563.2670 PI STATION = 104+00.01 E 2,387,122.6930 N 7,142,163.2627 PC STATION = 100+00.00 E 2,387,125.3298 N 7,142,963.2480 PT STATION = 108+00.00 A1 XHERCU CURVE DATA 23.50' RT [ XLOCUS STA 107+86.75, END TAPER BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) 24.03' LT [ XHERCU STA 52+20.61, END CONC CURB (TY II) 24.00' RT [ XHERCU STA 52+20.60, BEGIN CONC CURB (TY II) 23.50' RT [ XLOCUS STA 109+34.79, END CONC CURB (TY II) BEGIN TAPER 11.50' RT STA 106+85.00, [ XLOCUS 13.90'RT STA 111+50.00, [ XLOCUS 8/5/2020 SHEET 3 OF 3 63MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SS 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00PC 116+39.30VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50' ROADWAY PLANSCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:48:22 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS ROAD PAVEMENT LEGEND LANE ARROWS PROPERTY LINE EXIST ROW PROP ROW &/OR PROTECT IN PLACE. ALL UTILITIES TO REMAIN. 3. EXISTING UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR SHALL EXPOSE EXIST EDGE OF PAVEMENT OR FACE OF CURB. 2. LIMITS OF WIDENING ARE TYP 1' FROM OF CURB UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. 1. ALL DIMENSIONS ARE TO FACE NOTES: [ XLOCUS 26.50' RT STA 115+04.00, [ XLOCUS END WIDENING STA 115+33.00, L XLOCUS END PROJECT C 26.50' RT STA 112+24.40, [ XLOCUS LINE SAWCUT N LOCUST ST TANGENT = 119.81 LENGTH = 239.62 RADIUS = 73,350.00 XLOCUS CURVE DATA A2 A2 EXIST ROW EXIST ROW E 2,387,136.6626 N 7,143,922.2910 PI STATION = 117+59.11 E 2,387,135.2467 N 7,143,802.4871 PC STATION = 116+39.30 E 2,387,138.4699 N 7,144,042.0896 PT STATION = 118+78.92 23.93'RT STA 112+93.25, [XLOCUS 8/5/2020 64 GRADING PLAN 1 0 0+00101+0 0 102+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88POT 108+50.00652651 64 9 648 647 646 644 642641643652 65 1649648647 646646 644 643 6 42 6 41 641 643 642 641 644 644 644643 643 642 6426 4 2 643644 650 650 6 50650 651652 651 649 648 647646645 645645 6 45645 649 648 647 646645645645645 640 640 640639639 639 6 41 641641641642642 642 642 643 6 4 3 6 43 64 3644644644 644 6 4 3 6426 4 263 6638 638639639 639639639640640 640641 641641 642 6426 4364364 46 44644644644644645 6 4 5 646 647 647 648 648 648 648649645VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:48:46 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LONG ROAD & STUART ROAD SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND ROW LINE PROPOSED GRADING EXISTING GRADING FINISHED GRADE FLOW LINE FG FL TP TOP OF PAVEMENT BOTTOM OF DITCHBD BP FLOW ARROW BOTTOM OF PONDE UNI VERSI TY DRNOTTINGHAM DR NOTTINGHAM DR E UNI VERSI TY DR644.31 FL 643.68 FL 643.43 FL 644.34 FL 649.09 FL 647.01 FL 646.10 FL 647.56 FL 639.73 FL 639.04 FL 639.58 FL 639.88 FL 638.67 FL 638.57 FL 639.31 FL 640.67 FL 641.36 FL 642.24 FL 643.37 FL 644.48 FL 645.03 FL EXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXI ST ROWE UNI VERSI TY DRE UNI VERSI TY DR[ XUNIV [ XNOTT STRUCTURES UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROTECT ALL EXISTING TREES, FENCES, AND2. BE BROUGHT TO THE ENGINEERS ATTENTION. BY THE CONTRACTOR IN THE FIELD. ANY DISCREPANCIES SHALL ALL GRADES ARE APPROXIMATE AND SHALL BE CONFIRMED1. NOTES: 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 64+00.00MATCHLINE STA. 64+00.0065 GRADING PLAN VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:49:10 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 645.71 TP 37.82'LT, STA 50+49.05, [XEB288EXIT 645.51 TP 19.01'RT, STA 50+65.19, [XEB288EXIT 648.12 TP 18.90' LT, STA 50+67.36 [XWB288ENTER 648.83 TP 19.00' RT, STA 50+99.44, [XWB288ENTER 649.35 TP 19.00' RT, STA 100+90.11, [XWB288EXIT 645.40 TP 22.61'RT, STA 56+02.93, 645.72 TP 42.99'RT, STA 57+00.00 646.12 TP 44.46'RT, STA 58+00.00 645.69 TP 46.68'RT, STA 59+00.00 645.24 TP 48.23'RT, STA 59+70.06 643.03 TP 37.95'RT, STA 100+59.03 646.27 TP 35.54'LT, STA 59+00.00 645.30 TP 42.00'RT, STA 61+01.95,646.83 TP 39.00'RT, STA 63+00.00, 647.56 TP 39.00'RT, STA 63+28.04, 645.79 TP 39.01'LT, STA 61+00.00, 645.75 TP 39.00'LT, STA 62+00.00, 647.58 TP 39.00'LT, STA 63+27.00, 644.00 BD 24.19' LT, STA 50+70.50, [XEB288ENTER 647.27 BD 39.96'RT, STA 50+72.49, [WB288ENTER 644.77 BD 46.51'LT, STA 63+00.00, 643 BD 46.06'LT, STA 61+00.00, 643.87 BD 46.51'LT, STA 62+00.00, 643.33 BD 30.01'LT, STA 50+83.83, [EB288EXIT 643.70 BD 37.80'LT, STA 50+63.5820, [EB288EXIT 649.02 TP 14.00' RT, STA 100+90.11, [XWB288EXIT 645.70 BD 52.00'RT, STA 63+30.00, 645.54 BD 52.00'RT, STA 63+00.00, 643.08 TP 52.00'RT, STA 61+00.00,644.89 BD 52.00'RT, STA 62+00.00, 643.99 BD 21.65'RT, STA 50+79.00 [XEB288EXIT 646.96 BD 21.55' LT, STA 50+86.40, [XWB288ENTER 646.36 TP 39.00'RT, STA 62+00.00, PROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW SHERMAN RDRANDALL STREET[XWB288ENTRANCE [XEB288ENTRANCE [XEB288EXIT [XSHERM [XWB288EXIT 54+00 55+00 56+00 57+00 58+00 59+00 60+00 61+00 62+00 63+00 64+00100+00101+0050+0051+0050+0051+00100+00101+00PC 50+00.00POT 101+66.75POT 50+00.00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 640 645645645645645645645645645 645 645 645645645 645 645645645 6 45 645650650650650650650 650 650655655655655 655 660660 660665665 647 647 645645 645 645 645 645 6 4 5 645 6 50 6506456456456 4 56 4 5 64564564+00 65+00 66+00 67+00 68+00 69+00 70+00 71+00 72+00 73+0050+0051+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 TX DOT MON TYPE2 MON TYPE 2 BUSTED TX DOT 650 650650 6506 5 0 6 50 655655655 660660 665665670670675 675 680680650 655 660 665 670 675650655660665665 LEGEND ROW LINE PROPOSED GRADING EXISTING GRADING FINISHED GRADE FLOW LINE FG FL TP TOP OF PAVEMENT BOTTOM OF DITCHBD BP FLOW ARROW BOTTOM OF POND 648.12 TP 18.90' LT, STA 50+67.36 [XWB288ENTER 648.83 TP 19.00' RT, STA 50+99.44, [XWB288ENTER 649.35 TP 19.00' RT, STA 100+90.11, [XWB288EXIT 650.68 TP 40.00'LT, STA 64+53.04, 654.83 TP 40.00'LT, STA 66+00.00, 658.81 TP 35.63'LT, STA 67+00.00, 663.82 TP 29.81'LT, STA 68+00.00, 674.29 TP 25.68'RT, STA 70+00.00. 668.85 TP 29.01'RT, STA 69+00.00, 663.74 TP 32.34'RT, STA 68+00.00, 658.96 TP 35.67'RT, STA 67+00.00, 655.25 TP 29.00'RT, STA 66+00.00, 651.59 TP 39.00'RT, STA 65+00.00, 650.80 TP 39.00'RT, STA 64+61.06 650.59 BD 44.03'RT, STA 65+00.00, 661.80 BD 39.93'LT, STA 68+00.00, 656.20 BD 55.85'LT, STA 67+00.00, 652.28 BD 60.00'LT, STA 66+00.00, 653.76 BD 43.38'RT, STA 66+00.00, 648.50 BD 60.00'LT, STA 64+59.95, 647.27 BD 39.96'RT, STA 50+72.49, [WB288ENTER 647.27 BD 39.96'RT, STA 50+72.49, [WB288ENTER PROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROWSHERMAN RD [XWB288ENTRANCE [XSHERM [XWB288EXIT STRUCTURES UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROTECT ALL EXISTING TREES, FENCES, AND2. BE BROUGHT TO THE ENGINEERS ATTENTION. BY THE CONTRACTOR IN THE FIELD. ANY DISCREPANCIES SHALL ALL GRADES ARE APPROXIMATE AND SHALL BE CONFIRMED1. NOTES: 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.00MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.0066 GRADING PLAN VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:49:35 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS PC 116+39.30PT 118+78.9252+0053+0054+00109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00 SSSS SS 675675 675 675675 675 675 673 673 674 674 672 672 673674 673673 673 674 674 673673 673 672 671 67267 3673674 671 671 672672 672 672 672 673673 673 673674674674674 674674675 675 675675 675 LEGEND ROW LINE PROPOSED GRADING EXISTING GRADING FINISHED GRADE FLOW LINE FG FL TP TOP OF PAVEMENT BOTTOM OF DITCHBD BP FLOW ARROW BOTTOM OF PONDPC 100+00.00PT 108+00.00POT 54+61.41 POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+0051+00100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 HHHH 665 665 665 665 67 0670 670 670 667666 664 664 667 668 667 668 671 672 6726736 73 673 664665 666 667 6676686 68668 669 670 671672 672 672673 673673 673673 674 674EXIST ROW [ XLOCUS PLUM HOLLOWN LOCUST ST HERCULES LNEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 668.15 TP 20.74' LT, STA 50+50.00, [XPLUM 673.74 FL 40.32' LT, STA 52+60.89, [XHERCU 673.49 FL 32.85' LT STA 52+52.34, [XHERCU 19.53'RT,668.10 TP STA 103+73.86, 667.86TP 19.02'RT, STA 103+50.00, 672.58 TP 26.50'RT, STA 107+00.00 673.31 TP 26.50'RT, STA 107+50.00 672.84 FL 23.50'RT, STA 107+86.75, 671.14 TP 24.56'RT, STA 106+00.00, 671.94 TP 25.70'RT, STA 106+50.00, 670.67 TP 23.43' RT, STA 105+50.00, 666.26 TP 16.87'RT, STA 102+50.00 665.80 TP 15.50'RT, STA 101+85.00, 666.93 TP 17.94'RT, STA 103+00.00, 669.95 TP 22.31' RT, STA 105+00.00, 668.96 TP 21.07' RT, STA 104+43.92, 668.77 TP 20.99' RT, STA 50+49.05, [XPLUM EXIST ROW HERCULES LNEXIST ROW [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW N LOCUST ST HERCULES LN674.12 FL 37.92'RT, STA 52+55.21, XHERCU 673.63 FL 30.55'RT, STA 52+45.34, XHERCU XHERCU 675.16 TP 26.50'RT, STA 109+50.00, 674.83 TP 26.50'RT, STA 111+00.00 674.86 TP 26.50'RT, STA 110+00.00 675 FL 35.94'RT, STA 109+01.79 675.13 TP 26.50'RT, STA 113+00.00 674.64 TP 26.50'RT, STA 114+00.00 674.18 TP 26.50'RT, STA 115+04.00 674.53 TP 26.50'RT, STA 114+50.00 674.60 TP 26.50'RT, STA 113+50.00 675.14 TP 26.50'RT, STA 112+50.00 675.55 TP 26.50'RT, STA 111+50.00 675.55 TP 26.50'RT, STA 111+50.00 675.18 TP 26.50'RT, STA 110+50.00 675.00 FL 23.50'RT, STA 109+34.79, STRUCTURES UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROTECT ALL EXISTING TREES, FENCES, AND2. BE BROUGHT TO THE ENGINEERS ATTENTION. BY THE CONTRACTOR IN THE FIELD. ANY DISCREPANCIES SHALL ALL GRADES ARE APPROXIMATE AND SHALL BE CONFIRMED1. NOTES: 8/5/2020 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\cccg12.dgn8/5/20201:49:36 PMTxDOT Bar B 2"6" 3" •T T 3" 24" 2"6"2"RT 3" •T 3" 24" 2"6"6"R2"6"2"RT 8" •T T •T 3" 8"6"R2"6"6"R2" to 4" 8" 2"6"2"R8" •T 2 •" 2 •" 3 •"•" 2" to 4"2" to 4" T Bar C Bar C 3" 2" - 4" HEIGHT TYPE I CURB (MONOLITHIC)2" - 4" HEIGHT TYPE I CURB AND GUTTER 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE II CURB 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE II CURB AND GUTTER 5" or 5 ƒ"5" or 5 ƒ" 5" or 5 ƒ" 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE II CURB (MONOLITHIC) (See Note 12) Joint Construction Permissible (See Note 12) Steel Usual Pavement (See Note 12) Joint Construction Permissible 2" - 4" HEIGHT TYPE I CURB (See Note 12) Steel Usual Pavement (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line plans,or as directed by the Engineer. shall be shown elsewhere in the longer or shorter transition, and Field conditions may require a Curb Transition Note: General Notes reinforcing bars shall be placed at four feet C~C. 8. Vertical and horizontal dowel bars and transverse at locations directed by The Engineer. provided at structures, curb returns at streets, and to concrete pavement, expansion joints shall be placement of curb or curb and gutter is not adjacent gutter adjacent to jointed concrete pavement. Where to match pavement joints in all curbs and curb and 7. Expansion and contraction joints shall be constructed reinforcing bars grouted in place. pavement, the pavement shall be drilled and the 6. Where concrete curb is placed on existing concrete sawed or removed at existing joints. 5. All existing curbs and driveways to be removed shall be minimum radius of ‚inch. 4. Round exposed sharp edges with a rounding tool, to a Construction Division. the Department Producer List (MPL), maintained by TxDOT, reinforcing is acceptable, provided the fiber producer is on otherwise shown. The use of synthetic fiber in lieu of steel 3. When reinforcing bars are used, they shall be No.4 unless 2. Concrete shall be Class A. Curb and Gutter." with Item 529, "Concrete Curb, Gutter, and Combined 1. All materials and construction shall be in accordance conform to that required for concrete curb. joints. Reinforcing steel for curb section shall then elsewhere in the plans for longitudinal construction placed in accordance with pavement details shown pavement, the longitudinal pavement steel shall be resulting in a longitudinal construction joint in the 12. When vertical permissible construction joints are used, or riprap. where curb or curb and gutter is adjacent to sidewalk 11. One-half inch expansion joint material shall be provided and plan-profile sheets for exact locations. 10. Usual profile grade line. Refer to typical sections pavement dimension 'T' is 8" maximum. pavement. When curb is installed adjacent to flexible 9. Dimension 'T' shown is the thickness of concrete BAR C BAR B Varies 12" CURB TRANSITION T Top of Curb Top of Pavement Height Change in (See Curb Transition Note) 10'-0" Curb Transition (0" to 2"), Note: To be paid for as Highest Curb 3" 2" 3" 2" 3"•T T 6" T •T Bar C 7"1" 2" 8"3"R3"R8" 6" 7" 2" 1"3"R3"R24" for curb height= 5 ƒ" for curb height= 5" 5" or 5 ƒ" for curb height= 5" for curb height= 5 ƒ" 5" or 5 ƒ" (See Note 12) Joint Construction Permissible (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE IIa CURB 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE IIa CURB AND GUTTER 2"6" 2" to 4" 8" 2"2"R8" 5" or 5 ƒ" (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line (See Note 10) Profile Grade Line 6"R 6" 5" 5" 1" 1" Concrete Pavement Asphalt or 2" - 4" HEIGHT TYPE III CURB (KEYED) Concrete Pavement Asphalt or Joint Construction Permissible Joint Construction Permissible 5" - 5 ƒ" HEIGHT TYPE IV CURB (KEYED) 2" 3" 3" 2 •" 2 •" 1995 AM VP 67 Standard Division Design cccg12.dgn C TxDOT: UPDATED 2012 - VPEXPANSION JOINT DETAIL •T Joint Material •" Wide Expansion T 10"14"1•" to wrap bars and plug end Use 2 layers of roofing felt Top of Pavement Smooth Dowels 2 ea ~ ‡"x 24" Top of Curb CCCG-12 CURB AND GUTTER VPTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\cpcd14.dgn8/5/20201:49:38 PMDN:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT SHEET 1 OF 2 TxDOT Standard Division Design HCDN:HC AN C TxDOT:DECEMBER 2014 cpcd14.dgn 68 /T 2 •DOWEL LENGTH TO PREVENT BOND DOWELS, COATED METHOD A OR B MATERIAL JOINT SEALING SECTION X-X TRANSVERSE CONTRACTION JOINT T/3 T T /T 2 METHOD A OR B MATERIAL JOINT SEALING L 2 /T 2 METHOD A OR B MATERIAL JOINT SEALING SECTION Z-Z CL OF LONGITUDINAL WARPING JOINT SAWCUT L 2 T/3 T Z ZYYOR OR SHOULDER TRAVEL LANE TRAVEL LANETRAVEL LANE 15 FT. JOINT SPACING18"JOINT CONTRACTION TRANSVERSE TYPICAL PAVEMENT LAYOUT PLAN VIEW (NOT TO SCALE) JOINT CONTRACTION TRANSVERSE 18" @ 12" DOWEL SPACING 18" BARS DOWEL XX @ 24"TIE BAR SPACING18"MULTIPLE-PIECE SINGLE OR TIE BARS SINGLE PIECE TIE BARS TIE BARS L = 42" FOR #5 BAR L = 50" FOR #6 BAR L = 42" FOR #5 BAR L = 50" FOR #6 BAR 6 to 7.5 #5 #6>= 8 24 24 (IN.) T THICKNESS SLAB BAR SIZE (IN.) SPACING AVERAGE TABLE NO.2 TIE BARS (DEFORMED BARS) >= 10.5 (IN.) SPACING AVERAGE 1" X 18"12 12 12 1 ‚" X 18" 1 •" X 18" TABLE NO.1 DOWELS (SMOOTH BARS) (IN.) T THICKNESS SLAB 6 to 7.5 8 to 10 LENGTH AND BAR DIA. LONGITUDINAL CONSTRUCTION JOINT SECTION Y-Y LONGITUDINAL CONTRACTION JOINT CONTRACTION JOINT OR CONSTRUCTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL GENERAL NOTES NOT COVERED BY THIS STANDARD. WIDER THAN 100 FT. WITHOUT A FREE LONGITUDINAL JOINT ARE CROSS-SLOPE SHALL BE SHOWN ELSEWHERE IN THE PLANS. PAVEMENTS DETAILS FOR PAVEMENT WIDTH, PAVEMENT THICKNESS AND THE CROWN1. SPECIFICATION FOR "CONCRETE PAVEMENT". AND LOAD TRANSFER DEVICES REFER TO THE GOVERNING FOR FURTHER INFORMATION REGARDING THE PLACEMENT OF CONCRETE2. 15 FT. UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS. THE SPACING BETWEEN TRANSVERSE CONTRACTION JOINTS SHALL BE3. METHODS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. OR WOOD FORMS EQUAL IN DEPTH TO THE DEPTH OF PAVEMENT, OR BY TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINTS MAY BE FORMED BY USE OF METAL4. CONCRETE ADJACENT TO ALL THE FORMED JOINTS. USE HAND-OPERATED IMMERSION VIBRATORS TO CONSOLIDATE THE5. LOCATION IS SHOWN ELSEWHERE ON THE PLANS. LOCATED WITHIN 6 IN. OF THE LANE LINE UNLESS THE JOINT JOINT (SECTION Z-Z OR SECTION Y-Y). THESE JOINTS SHALL BE PAVEMENT WIDTHS OF MORE THAN 15 FT. SHALL HAVE A LONGITUDINAL6. CONCRETE COVER FROM THE BACK OF GUTTER TO THE END OF TIE BAR. BAR LENGTH OR POSITION MAY BE ADJUSTED. PROVIDE 3 IN. OF WHEN TYING CONCRETE GUTTER AT A LONGITUDINAL JOINT, THE TIE8. REQUIREMENTS IN ITEM 361. BARS WITH TYPE III, CLASS C EPOXY. MEET THE PULL-OUT TEST COMPENSATION BY DRILLING MIN. 10 IN. DEEP AND GROUTING TIE REPLACE MISSING OR DAMAGED TIE BARS WITHOUT ADDITIONAL9. MEANS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. SHALL COINCIDE WITH PAVEMENT JOINTS AND MAY BE FORMED BY ANY 10. WHEN AN MONOLITHIIC CURB IS SPECIFIED, THE JOINT IN THE CURB STANDARD SHEET "CONCRETE PAVING DETAILS, JOINT SEALS." THE DETAIL FOR JOINT SEALANT AND RESERVOIR IS SHOWN ON12. SLABTHICKNESS (T/3). CONTRACTION JOINT (SECTION Z-Z) SHALL BE ONE THIRD OF THE SHOWN IN THE PLANS. THE SAW CUT DEPTH FOR THE LONGITUDIANL LONGITUDINAL CONTRACTION JOINT (SECTION Z-Z) UNLESS OTHERWISE THE JOINT BETWEEN OUTSIDE LANE AND SHOULDER SHALL BE A7. BASKETS ARE USED, REMOVE THE SHIPPING WIRES. AND VERTICALLY UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED.WHERE DOWEL BAR DOWEL BAR PLACEMENT TOLERANCE SHALL BE +/- 1/4 IN. HORIZONTALLY11. CONTRACTION DESIGN CPCD-14 CONCRETE PAVEMENT DETAILS T-6 to 12 INCHESTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\cpcd14.dgn8/5/20201:49:38 PMDN:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT SHEET 2 OF 2 TxDOT Standard Division Design HCDN:HC AN C TxDOT: cpcd14.dgn 69 FREE LONGITUDINAL JOINT DETAIL SIDE OF THE JOINT. BARRIER SHALL BE ON THE SAME PIECE OF CONCRETE TRAFFIC ALL TIE BARS IN ANY CONTINUOUS FOR ANCHORAGE DETAILS. SEE CONCRETE BARRIER STANDARD BARRIER CONCRETE TRAFFIC CAST-IN-PLACE SIDE OF JOINT. BE USED ON THE FREE FIBER MATERIAL MAY PREFORMED BITUMINOUS ROOFING FELT OR 1/2" TWO LAYERS OF 30 LB LONGITUDINAL WIDENING JOINT DETAIL T EXISTING PAVEMENT EDGE PROPOSED PAVEMENT EDGE MATERIAL JOINT SEALINGREMOVE(IF APPLICABLE) CONCRETE CURB TO BE /T 2 MIN. 1O" 25" FOR #6 BARS 21" FOR #5 BARS EXISTING PAVEMENT JOINTS UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS. THE TRANSVERSE JOINTS OF PROPOSED PAVEMENT SHALL COINCIDE WITH3. SLABS, USE #5 BARS FOR LESS THAN 8" THICK SLABS.THICKER SPACE TIE BARS AT 24" SPACING. USE #6 BARS FOR 8" AND 2. PULL-OUT TEST SPECIFIED IN ITEM 361. OF THE EPOXY-GROUTED TIE BARS MEETS THE REQUIREMENTS OF BEFORE WIDENING WORK, DEMONSTRATE THAT THE BOND STRENGTH1. CLASS C EPOXY. DRILL & GROUT WITH TYPE III, TIE BARS AT 24" SPACING. AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. LOCATION OF THE JOINT WILL BE (JOINT WITHOUT TIE BARS) FREE LONGITUDINAL JOINT CONFORMING TO ASTM D 994. IMPREGNATED FIBERBOARD 1/2" MIN. ASPHALT VARIES (SEE NOTE 12) 1•" EXPANSION JOINT TRANSVERSE EXPANSION JOINT DETAIL AT BRIDGE APPROACH T T HMAC(UNDERLAYMENT) SLAB BRIDGE APPROACH 15 FT 30 LB ROOFING FELT TWO LAYERS CPCD TRANSVERSE JOINT DETAIL EXISTING CPCD TO NEW CPCD PLAN VIEW (NOT TO SCALE) EXISTING CPCD NEW CPCD JOINT CONSTRUCTION TRANSVERSE TRAVEL LANEAT 12 IN. SPACING. DOWEL BARS PER WHEEL PATH PLACE FOUR EPOXY COATED CLASS C EPOXY. *GROUT WITH TYPE III, SPECIFIED FOR NEW CPCD. *USE SAME DOWEL SIZE AS SLAB MIDDLE DEPTH. *DRILL THE HOLES AT EXISTING CPCD CONCRETE PAVEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT CONCRETE PAVEMENT DETAILS CONTRACTION DESIGN CPCD-14 T-6 to 12 INCHES DECEMBER 2014TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\crcp120.dgn8/5/20201:49:40 PMFILE:DATE: DENTON DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT TxDOT CONTINUOUSLY REINFORCED CRCP(1)-20 Standard Division Design crcp120.dgn REVISIONS 10/10/2011 ADD GN #12 04/09/2013 REMOVE 6" AND 6.5" ADD CTE REQUIREMENTS CONCRETE PAVEMENT T - 7 to 13 INCHES ONE LAYER STEEL BAR PLACEMENT SHEET 1 OF 2 REGULAR AND BAR SIZE SLAB THICKNESS (IN.) T SIZE BAR SPACING 2 x c (IN.) SPACING c (IN.) LENGTH L (IN.) #6 8.5 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 #5 6.0 3 TO 4 #5 3 TO 4 TABLE NO.1 LONGITUDINAL STEEL 13 12 18 17 STEEL BARS OR JOINT AT EDGE SPACING FIRST 50 50 50 50 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5 #6 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 16 15 50 50 9.0 9.5 6.5 9.0 8.0 7.5 #6 3 TO 4 #6 6.25 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 14 50 50 50 50 50 10.0 10.5 11.0 11.5 12.0 7.0 6.75 6.5 6.0 12.5 #6 3 TO 4 #6 3 TO 4 11 50 50 12.5 13.0 5.75 5.5 13.5 13 12 11.5 Z Y YZ TRAVEL LANE OR SHOULDER TRAVEL LANE TRAVEL LANE TRAVEL LANE OR SHOULDER PAVEMENT OR SHOULDER EDGE PAVEMENT OR TRANSVERSE LONGITUDINAL cc c c SHOULDER EDGE X X STEEL STEEL TIE BARS SINGLE PIECE TIE BARS (SECTION X-X) CONSTRUCTION JOINT BARS AT TRANSVERSE ADDITIONAL STEEL 8.0 - 13.0 STEEL TRANSVERSE TABLE NO.2 TRANSVERSE STEEL AND TIE BARS (SECTION Y-Y) CONSTRUCTION JOINT AT LONGITUDINAL TIE BARS (SECTION Z-Z) CONTRACTION JOINT AT LONGITUDINAL TIE BARS #5 #5 48 48 SIZE BAR (IN.) SPACING (IN.) THICKNESS SLAB SIZE BAR SIZE BAR (IN.) SPACING (IN.) SPACING 48 48 24 24 7.0 - 7.5 c (IN.) SPACING TRANSVERSE BARS L2 T2 T STEEL BARS ADDITIONALL=50" LONGITUDINAL BARS NO SPLICES ALLOWED WITHIN 10 FT OF THE JOINT. MATERIAL JOINT SEALING cc T2 T c c LONGITUDINAL BARS TRANSVERSE BARS TRANSVERSE BARS IN SAME PLANE AS TIE BARS MAY BE 21" FOR #5 BAR 25" FOR #6 BAR 50" FOR #6 BAR, 42" FOR #5 BAR OR MULTIPLE-PIECE TIE BARS,SINGLE MATERIAL JOINT SEALING SAW CUT T2 T cccc TRANSVERSE BARS 50" FOR #6 BAR, 42" FOR #5 BAR 21" FOR #5 BAR 25" FOR #6 BAR LONGITUDINAL BARS FOR 10.0 IN. TO 13.0 IN. SLABS. 7.0 IN. TO 9.5 IN. SLABS. MAY BE PLACED ABOVE SHOULD BE IN SAME PLANE AS TRANSVERSE BARS FOR SINGLE PIECE TIE BARS MATERIAL JOINT SEALING c2 2/2/c c LONGITUDINAL CONTRACTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL CONSTRUCTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL CONTRACTION JOINT SECTION Z - Z #5 #6 #5 #6 3T BARS LONGITUDINAL LONGITUDINAL c/2 c/2 TYPICAL PAVEMENT LAYOUT PLAN VIEW (NOT TO SCALE) LONGITUDINAL STEEL BARS ADDITIONAL TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINT 48"24"48"24"24"48"MIN.CLEAR 2" LONGITUDINAL CONSTRUCTION JOINT SECTION Y - Y TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINT SECTION X - X CONTRACTION JOINT CONSTRUCTION JOINT 70TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:GENERAL NOTES C TxDOT: 05/05/2017 CoTE AS RATED 4.3 aa a aa a AN APRIL 2020 KM VP c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\crcp120.dgn8/5/20201:49:40 PMFILE:DATE:DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT TxDOT CONTINUOUSLY REINFORCED CRCP(1)-20 Standard Division Design crcp120.dgn REVISIONS CONCRETE PAVEMENT T - 7 to 13 INCHES ONE LAYER STEEL BAR PLACEMENT EXPOSED EXISTING STEEL BARS JACK HAMMERS AS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. CONCRETE WILL BE ACCOMPLISHED BY LIGHTWEIGHT IN THIS AREA, THE BREAKING OF THE EXISTING OPTION B: BREAKBACK AND LAP PARTIAL DEPTH SAWCUT NEW LONGITUDINAL STEEL BARS EXISTING CRCP NEW CRCP T T/2 EXISTING CRCP TO NEW CRCP TRANSVERSE TIE JOINT DETAIL MIN.36" EDGE OF CRCP PAVEMENT OR LONGITUDINAL JOINT EXISTING CRCP MIN.10" NEW CRCP MIN.30" TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINT PLAN VIEW ( NOT TO SCALE) OPTION A: DRILL AND EPOXY FREE LONGITUDINAL JOINT DETAIL CONCRETE PAVEMENT VARIES SIDE OF THE JOINT. BARRIER SHALL BE ON THE SAME PIECE OF CONCRETE TRAFFIC ALL TIE BARS IN ANY CONTINUOUS FOR ANCHORAGE DETAILS. SEE CONCRETE BARRIER STANDARD SIDE OF JOINT. BE USED ON THE FREE FIBER MATERIAL MAY PREFORMED BITUMINOUS ROOFING FELT OR 1/2" TWO LAYERS OF 30 LB BARRIER CONCRETE TRAFFIC CAST-IN-PLACE CONFORMING TO ASTM D 994. IMPREGNATED FIBERBOARD 1/2" MIN. ASPHALT LONGITUDINAL WIDENING JOINT DETAIL CONCRETE CURB TO BE REMOVED (IF APPLICABLE) MIN EXISTING PAVEMENT EDGE PROPOSED PAVEMENT SEALING MATERIAL JOINT 10"25" FOR #6 BAR 21" FOR #5 BAR TIE BARS TPYE III,CLASS C EPOXY DRILL & GROUT WITH THICKER SLABS, USE #5 TIE BARS FOR LESS THAN 8" THICK SLABS. 2.SPACE TIE BARS AT 24" SPACING. USE #6 TIE BARS FOR 8" AND PULL-OUT TEST SPECIFIED IN ITEM 361. OF THE EPOXY-GROUTED TIE BARS MEETS THE REQURIMENTS OF 1.BEFORE WIDENING WORK, DEMONSTRATE THAT THE BOND STRENGTH T T/2 (SEE NOTE 12) 1•" EXPANSION JOINT TRANSVERSE EXPANSION JOINT DETAIL AT BRIDGE APPROACH PAVEMENT CONCRETE T T HMAC(UNDERLAYMENT) SLAB BRIDGE APPROACH T/3 SAW CUT DEPTH JOINTS SAWED CONTRACTION 10 FT 15 FT 30 LB ROOFING FELT TWO LAYERS 2" AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. LOCATION OF THE JOINT WILL BE (JOINT WITHOUT TIE BARS) FREE LONGITUDINAL JOINT OR LONGITUDINAL JOINT EDGE OF CRCP PAVEMENT 12-FT WIDTH BY 2-FT LENGTH 12-FT WIDTH BY 2-FT LENGTH CONFIGURATION MEETING THIS REQUIREMENT WILL BE ALLOWED. AND 2-FT. LENGTH OF THE PAVEMENT. ANY OTHER LAP LONGITUDINAL STEEL IS SPLICED IN ANY GIVEN 12-FT. WIDTH STAGGER THE LAP LOCATIONS SO THAT NO MORE THAN 1/3 OF THE EXAMPLES OF LAP CONFIGURATION PLAN VIEW ( NOT TO SCALE) SPLICES REINFORCING STEEL LONGITUDINAL ITEM 361. REQUIREMENTS OF PULL-OUT TEST SPECIFIED IN EPOXY-GROUTED LONGITUDINAL BARS MEETS THE DEMONSTRATE THAT THE BOND STRENGTH OF THE DRILL AND GROUT WITH TYPE III, CLASS C EPOXY. SHEET 2 OF 2 DENTON 71DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.C TxDOT: AN 03/16/2020 REMOVED TABLE 1A APRIL 2020 KM VP DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\crrstde1-19.dgn8/5/20201:49:42 PMStandard Division Bridge DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT AT BRIDGE ENDS EMBANKMENTS SHOULDER DRAINS CONCRETE RIPRAP AND CONTApril 2019 CRR of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE: (TYPES RR8 & RR9) 72 See Layout for slope C urbRipra p 2'-0"Bridge LayoutVariable ~ See4" Curb1'-0" See Layout for slope ~ ~ 2 4 crown line. See Roadway DetailsApex and riprap break usually atSee Layout for limits drain if required. location of shoulder See Layout for 2 R R 8R R 9 5"4" Varies " Slope219 1"~ of cap face at edge Form vertical 1'-0" Min RR8RR95"4""21+-1'-0"3'-0"1'-6"9"RR8RR99" PLAN ELEVATION SEC C-C 5 Steel WWR or Reinf Reinf 5 Min 9" ~~~~ Weep holes Reinf slope Toe of See Layout for slopefence rail poststo fit space between guardPosition drain and depressionor as directed by the Engineer of granular material under riprap only placed continuously along periphery Loose graded gravel or crushed stone 1 Add 2 #5 Bars length of curb) #5 Bar (Full 6 SHOWING KEYWAY OPTION 6 ~3 2 3 3 3 ~ traffic rail Showing conc 3 for drain ~ 3" Depression 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 See elsewhere in plans for rail transition Approach slab or pavement Weep holes 14 14 1 1 14 14 INTERMEDIATE TOEWALL1'-6"Reinf MinMinMax 6"6"12" Bars Reinf WWR WWR Const Jt 5"4"RR8RR9REINFORCEMENT DETAILS Jt Mat'l " Exp43 "43"87"87"81"43 sealer or joint compound Caulking "216 9 Reinf 6" 9 Reinf 6" 9 2" CAP OPTION C CAP OPTION A CAP OPTION B GENERAL NOTES: joint sealer side of wingwalls with along ends of cap and Plug ends and seal joint 11 12 13 AT WINGWALL SECT THRU RIPRAP Reinf Min "211 15 SECTIONS THRU RIPRAP AT CAP 4"1'-0"9"3"1'-0"9" 9" 9"1'-6"1'-6"3"2'-6" Min 3"~~ Column Riprap ACP 2 2 SEC A-A SEC B-B SEC B-B SEC D-D (No drain)(Shoulder drain) RIPRAP DETAIL AT COLUMNS~8 8 Reinf Reinf Reinf Reinf Reinf Reinf 6" Typ 1 (As directed by the Engineer) #5 Bar wingwall Bars along Add 2 #5 7 3"2'-6" Min 7 4" 4"4" 2'-6" Min 7 3"Curb 10 10 72'-6" Min drip line outside of Bridge Curb must be 11 12 13 14 15 with ACP. (Subsidiary to riprap) Riprap blockout to be filled C C A A D D B B 16 16 1'-0" 16 6x6-D3xD3 = 0.408 Lbs/SF #3 Reinf at 18" c-c = 0.501 Lbs/SF 4" of RR9 = 0.012 CY/SF 5" of RR8 = 0.015 CY/SF FOR CONTRACTOR'S INFORMATION ONLY: with joint sealer or wingwall and seal Nail flashing to cap 17 17 See General Notes for optional synthetic fiber reinforcement.slabEdge of bridgeabut cap Face of of cap flashing full length 8"X 18 Gage galvanized of cap flashing full length 8"X 18 Gage galvanized asphalt coat with in abut cap, Keyway formed wingwall abutment Face of at 12" c-c anchor screw Galvanized "43" Dia x 81(when specified) Granular material reinf steel WWR or integral with riprap) (Shoulder drain crrstde1-19.dgn construction joint even if synthetic reinforcing fiber is utilized. extends 1'-1" minimum into adjacent riprap on each side of construction joints. Provide WWR or reinforcing steel that WWR or reinforcing steel is continuous through riprap Provide WWR or #3 bars, with 1'-0" extension into slope. 8" x 18 Gage Galv Sheet Metal weep holes at 10' c-c backed by galvanized hardware cloth. If granular material is specified, provide upper level of 2" Dia the ends of reinforcing bars. of a minimum 6 inches, measured from the transverse wire of WWR, and and reinforcing bars may be used if both are permitted. Use lap splices Reinforcement (WWR) as 6x6-D2.9xD2.9 or D3xD3. Combinations of WWR Provide #3 reinforcing bars at 18" Spa c-c. Provide Welded Wire Engineer. addition to Exp Jt Mat'l if shown on plans or directed by the Flashing (shown in Cap Option A) may be used at wingwall in on plans. riprap as designated by the Engineer or as shown elsewhere Provide sealing option for joint between the face of cap and reinforcing option is selected. #5 bars shown are required even when synthetic fiber and 1'-6" for slab span, box beam, or slab beam bridges. the Engineer. Should be 9" Min for beam/slab type bridges Top of cap to top of riprap dimension varies as directed by optional intermediate toewall is called for in the plans. the Engineer. Increase wall extension to 1'-6" whenever the Wall extension may be reduced or modified if approved by elsewhere in plans or if directed by the Engineer. Use wider or other drain configurations if shown locations unless directed by the Engineer to eliminate. 1 CF packet of gravel and galvanized hardware cloth at all Provide lower level of 2" Dia weep holes at 10' c-c backed by in the plans or included in the specifications. Provide intermediate toewall only when designated elsewhere posts through concrete riprap. See details elsewhere in plans for installation of guard fence joints between approach slab and concrete pavement. by rail transition. Do not locate shoulder drains at expansion Location of shoulder drain must consider limitations imposed shown elsewhere in plans or as directed by the Engineer. Limits and configuration of drains and depressions are as eliminate 4" curb. layout, extend slab and toewall as shown and When riprap is shown extended around header on RR9 is to be used on other embankments. RR8 is to be used on stream crossings. See Layout for limits of riprap. other sealing material are subsidiary to the bid item "Riprap". Hardware cloth, loose grade stone behind weep holes, flashing, or directed by the Engineer. slope height at intervals of approximately 20 feet unless otherwise Install construction joints or grooved joints extending the full slant Producer List (MPL) in lieu of steel reinforcing in riprap concrete. Provide synthetic fibers listed on the "Fibers for Concrete" Material Optionally synthetic fibers may be used if approved by the Engineer. plans. of both types for riprap reinforcing, unless specified elsewhere in the Provide reinforcing bars, deformed WWR, or any suitable combination ASTM A1064, unless otherwise shown. Provide deformed welded wire reinforcement (WWR) meeting Provide Grade 60 reinforcing steel. in plans. Provide Class "B" concrete (f'c = 2,000 psi) unless noted elsewhere DENTON FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\gf31ms19.dgn8/5/2020MOW STRIP DETAIL SECTION A-A A A Pavement Edge of 9" 3" W-Beam PLAN Pavement Edge of3'-6"usualTypical 7" min usual Curb shown on top of mow strip CURB OPTION (2) CURB OPTION (1) usual 7" usualmin 7" usualmin CURB OPTION (3) 7" usualmin Mow Strip or Asphaltic Pavement Reinforced Concrete Curb Types Standard for See CCCG Curb Types Standard for See CCCG Curb Types Standard for See CCCG 15" 15" 15" 15"Varies3'-6" Typical posts guard fence Minimum 1'-10" beyond 5'-0" 5'-10" Approx. 2'-0" Mow Strip (1V : 10H or Flatter) Grading or approved 50' Approach Taper of Grading or Mow Strip W-Beam 3'-6"1'-6"1'-6"9" Pavement Edge of min minusual of need requirements. proper installation and length Note: See SGT standard sheets for (See General Note 4) Approved Post min7"(See General Note 4) Approved Post MBGF or MBGF Transition Pavement Edge of GRADING AND MOW STRIP AT GUARDRAIL END TREATMENTS 4"4" 4" 4"25"25"25"25"proper installation) (See GF(31) standard sheet for GF(31) shown with Mow Strip Length varies. Adjust Mow Strip width accordingly when offset is used. (offset "option" shown)OffsetSlope to drain Slope to drain Slope to drain Slope to drain Note: Site Condition(s) or eliminated, as directed by the Engineer. Approach grading or mow strip may be decreased end treatments. for the proper installation of metal guard fence and Site conditions may exist where grading is required Direction of Traffic GENERAL NOTES Standard Division Design TXDOT ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE CONVERSION OF THIS STANDARD TO OTHER FORMATS OR FOR INCORRECT RESULTS OR DAMAGES RESULTING FROM ITS USE.THE USE OF THIS STANDARD IS GOVERNED BY THE "TEXAS ENGINEERING PRACTICE ACT". NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND IS MADE BY TXDOT FOR ANY PURPOSE WHATSOEVER. DISCLAIMER:GF(31)MS-19 leave-out 18" dia. min. 18" x 18" min. or leave-out 18" dia. min. 18" x 18" min. or 73 embedment throughout the system. This option will increase the post (See General Note 8) Grout mixture (See General Note 8) Grout mixture Fill leave-out with (See General Note 8) Grout mixture (See General Note 8) Grout mixture (See General Note 8) Grout mixture TL-3 MASH COMPLIANT40" (STEEL)36" (WOOD)Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete 18" Dia. minimum leave-out. with 18" x 18" Square or Mow Strip Reinforced Concrete will be subsidiary to the pay item of riprap mow strip. (Suggested Maximum leave-out of 20"). Payment for furnishing and placing the grout mixture dimensions are acceptable from both an impact performance and maintenance repair standpoint that will flow into and completely fill all voids. Due to auger size, larger leave-out compressive strength of approximately 230 psi or less. Provide grout with a consistency 188 pounds Type 1 or II cement, and 550 pounds of water per cubic yard, with a 28-day 8. The leave-outs shall be filled with a Grout mixture consisting of: 2719 pounds sand, 7. The limits of payment for reinforced concrete will include leave-outs for the posts. 6. Thickness of the mow strip will be 4". mow strip and will be paid for under other pertinent bid item. 5. Other curb placement options may be used. Curbs are not considered part of the in the mow strip. See GF(31) Standard for additional details. 4. Only steel (W6 x 8.5 or W6 x 9.0), or 7 •" Dia. round wood posts are acceptable for use 3. The leave-out behind the post shall be a minimum of 7". Producer List (MPL), maintained by TxDOT, Construction Division. steel reinforcing is acceptable, provided the fiber producer is on the Department Material placed in accordance with Item 432, "Riprap." The use of the synthetic fiber in lieu of the plans and will be paid for under the pertinent bid item. Reinforced concrete shall be 2. Mow strips shall be reinforced concrete with (wire mesh or synthetic fiber), as shown on sheet for additional information. and guard fence end treatments. See applicable GF(31) MBGF or GF(31) Transition Standard 1. This mow strip design is for use with metal beam guard fence, guard fence transitions, DENTON DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONTC TxDOT: KM VP NOVEMBER 2019 TxDOT gf31ms19.dgn CGL/AG METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE (MOW STRIP) c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\gf31trtl319.dgn8/5/2020FILE:DATE:Standard Division DesignTXDOT ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE CONVERSION OF THIS STANDARD TO OTHER FORMATS OR FOR INCORRECT RESULTS OR DAMAGES RESULTING FROM ITS USE.THE USE OF THIS STANDARD IS GOVERNED BY THE "TEXAS ENGINEERING PRACTICE ACT". NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND IS MADE BY TXDOT FOR ANY PURPOSE WHATSOEVER. DISCLAIMER:GENERAL NOTES 2'-6" 1'-9" 7 ‚"11 B A ELEVATION VIEW A CB LC 3 SPACES AT 3'-1•"5 SPACES AT 18 ƒ" 2"+ TRANSITION TO W-BEAM 6'-3" NON-SYMMETRICAL 18'- 9" THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION (EA) 1 2 3 4 31" 6'- 3"3'-1•" SEE CURB TABLE (4) #5 REBAR STAKES 18" LONG C DIRECTION OF TRAFFIC 4" (4) (1" DIA. HOLES) IN CURB: SEE CURB TABLE (ASTM A325 OR A449) (5) ‡" DIA. HEAVY HEX HEAD BOLTS (ASTM A194 OR A563) (5) ‡" DIA. HEAVY HEX NUTS HEX BOLT HEAD AND NUT. (10) 1 ƒ" O.D. WASHER UNDER EACH TO CONCRETE RAIL THRIE-BEAM CONNECTOR FACE OF GUARDRAIL TRANSITION. RAILS THAT EXTEND BEYOND THE CHAMFER REQUIRED ON CONCRETE 3'-1•" ‡" HEX NUT. TRIM AS REQUIRED. LEAVE 1" OF BOLT LENGTH PAST THE DEPENDING ON WIDTH CONCRETE RAIL, HEAVY HEX BOLT LENGTH WILL VARY NOTE: HIGH-SPEED TRANSITION 4'- 5"4"3"4'- 2" TRANSITION NON-SYMMETRICAL PLAN VIEW LC 22" 1 2 3 4 THRIE-BEAM (NESTED) CURB TYPE II FOR PRECAST - SEE CURB TABLE (1) 18" LONG CONNECTING REBAR W-BEAM GUARD FENCE TL-3 MASH COMPLIANT THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE GF(31)TR TL3-19 20" TERMINAL CONNECTOR 10GA. THRIE-BEAM SIDE-VIEW DIRECTION LAP (2) 12'-6" NOTE: SEE GENERAL NOTE:9 PART DESIGNATOR RTE01b PART DESIGNATOR RTM10a 2'-6" PLATE WASHERS ARE INSTALLED UNDER THE BOLT HEAD AGAINST OUTSIDE OF CONNECTOR. BRIDGE EXIT - DOWNSTREAM: THE TERMINAL CONNECTOR LAPS OVER THE NESTED RAIL. PLATE WASHERS ARE INSTALLED UNDER THE SPLICE NUTS AGAINST INSIDE OF CONNECTOR. BRIDGE APPROACH - UPSTREAM: THE NESTED RAIL LAPS OVER THE TERMINAL CONNECTOR. (12) RECTANGULAR GUARDRAIL PLATE WASHERS:(FWR03) (12) †" X 2" BUTTON HEAD SPLICE BOLTS WITH RECESSED NUTS:(FBB02) INSTRUCTIONS PLATE WASHER NESTED THRIE-BEAM RAIL SPLICE BOLTS:(FBB01) (8) †" X 1 ‚" BUTTON HEAD 6'-3" DIRECTION LAP SPLICE BOLTS:(FBB02) (12) †" X 2" BUTTON HEAD TRANSISTION 10GA. W-BEAM TO THRIE-BEAM NON-SYMMETRICAL (SEE GENERAL NOTES:5-7) 7'-0" LONG POST (ALL TYPES) 7 T S O P NOTE: "WOOD" INDICATES DIMENSIONS FOR BOTH ROUND AND RECTANGULAR WOOD POST SYSTEMS.** TYPE II CURB DETAILS SEE GENERAL NOTES:2-4 AND 16-17. THE TRANSITION TO FUNCTION PROPERLY. CURB IS A REQUIRED COMPONENT FOR NOTE: CURB SHEET 1 OF 2 RWT02a OR RWT02b PART DESIGNATOR (1) †" FLAT WASHER:(FWC14a) UNDER EACH NUT. (2) †" BUTTON HEAD POST BOLT & NUT:(FBB04) WITH TRANSITION SECTIONS NOTE: ALL POST TYPES, SEE GENERAL NOTE:5 & 6 SECTION C-C 7" 32"6'-0" (STEEL)36" (WOOD)40" (STEEL)5'-8" (WOOD)32"6'-0" (STEEL)40" (STEEL)SECTION B-B36" (WOOD)5'-8" (WOOD)7'-0" SECTION A-A 52" CURB TYPE II 32" NESTED SEE GN:4 AT THIS POST LOCATION. NOTE: ONLY (1) †" BOLT REQUIRED THRIE-BEAM TERMINAL - CURB TABLE CURB (1) LENGTH 5'- 8" CURB (2) LENGTH 6'- 6" TAPER CURB (2) TO A HEIGHT OF 4" AT POST 7 USE (1) #5 GR.60 REBAR 18" LONG TO CONNECT BOTH CURBS. FORM OR CORE (1" DIA. HOLE 9" LONG) INTO EACH CURB END. FILL HOLES WITH APPROVED GROUT MIXTURE. LONG INTO THE GROUND AND •" BELOW TOP OF CURB. HOLE LOCATIONS. DRIVE (4) #5 GR.60 REBAR STAKES 18" FORM OR CORE FOUR (1" DIA. HOLES), SEE BOTH VIEWS FOR THE PRECAST CURB MAY BE FORMED INTO TWO SECTIONS. PRECAST CURB FULL LENGTH EQUALS 12'- 2" CONNECTING PRECAST CURB SECTIONS (1) & (2): SECURING PRECAST OR CAST-IN-PLACE TO FINISHED GRADE: 6" 5ƒ" 6"MIN. 8" 24" 2"R 1 •" TYPE II CURB (2) #3 REBARS (WITH 1 •" END COVER) REQUIRED WITH PRECAST CURB APPROACHING PAVEMENT SECTION. ADD WHEN GUTTER IS USED IN TYPE II CURB, BRIDGE RAIL OR CONCRETE TRAFFIC RAIL. PERCUSSION DRILLING IS NOT PERMITTED WITH: SEE TYPE II CURB DETAIL FOR REBAR AND COVER REQUIREMENTS. NOTES: NOT NEEDED FOR CAST-IN-PLACE. * 2. CAST-IN-PLACE 1. PRECAST NOTE: OPTIONS FOR TYPE II CURB: DENTON DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONTC TxDOT: KM VP NOVEMBER 2019 TxDOTgf31trtl319.dgn CGL/AG 74 APPLICABLE FOR POST TYPE. SEE SHT.2 FOR ADDITIONAL INFORMATION. (NESTED)(TIM POST)" OR "540 6XXX MTL W-BEAM GD FEN (NESTED)(STEEL POST)" AS THIS 25' SECTION WILL BE BY LINEAR FOOT, PAY ITEM "0540 6XXX MTL W-BEAM GD FEN BEYOND THE PAY LIMITS OF THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION SECTION, (SEE SHT.2). PAYMENT FOR 17. IF CURB EXTENDS BEYOND POST 7, 25' OF NESTED W-BEAM GUARDRAIL SHALL BE INSTALLED THE CONCRETE RAIL AND IS REQUIRED TO MEET MASH CRASH TEST CRITERIA. THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION SYSTEM. THE CURB PREVENTS (VEHICLE WHEEL SNAGGING) AT 16. THE INSTALLATION OF THE TYPE II CURB IS CRITICAL FOR THE PERFORMANCE OF THE 15. REFER TO GF(31)STANDARD SHEET & BRIDGE RAILING DETAILS FOR ADDITIONAL DETAILS. MATERIAL BLOCKS. MATERIALS CONFORMING TO DMS-7210. ONLY PRODUCERS ON THE MPL CAN FURNISH COMPOSITE CONSTRUCTION DIVISION MAINTAINS A MATERIAL PRODUCER LIST (MPL) FOR PRODUCERS OF GUARD FENCE" MAY BE SUBSTITUTED FOR BLOCKS OF SIMILAR DIMENSIONS. TXDOT'S REQUIREMENTS OF DMS-7210, "COMPOSITE MATERIAL POSTS AND BLOCKS FOR METAL BEAM 14. UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS, A COMPOSITE MATERIAL BLOCK THAT MEETS THE GUIDANCE. (512) 416-2678 13. WHERE SOLID ROCK IS ENCOUNTERED, CONTACT THE DESIGN DIVISION FOR ADDITIONAL 12. CROWN SHALL BE WIDENED TO ACCOMMODATE TRANSITIONS. ITEM 445,"GALVANIZING". FITTINGS SHALL BE SUBSIDIARY TO THE BID ITEM. 11. FITTINGS (BOLTS, NUTS, AND WASHERS) SHALL BE GALVANIZED IN ACCORDANCE WITH BOLT LENGTH TO MEET REQUIRED LENGTH. NUT AND †" WASHER (FWC16a) AND NOT MORE THAN 1" BEYOND IT. TRIM REMAINING AND SHALL BE OF SUFFICIENT LENGTH TO EXTEND THROUGH THE FULL THICKNESS OF THE 10. BUTTON HEAD "POST BOLTS & NUTS" SHALL MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF (ASTM A307), MATCH THOSE IN THE THRIE-BEAM TERMINAL CONNECTOR PRIOR TO ORDERING MATERIALS. BE LESS THAN 10 GAUGE. CONTRACTOR SHALL VERIFY THAT THE LOCATIONS OF BOLT HOLES THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION TO W-BEAM SHALL BE OF THE SAME MATERIAL, BUT SHALL NOT EXCEPT AS MODIFIED ON THE PLANS. THE THRIE-BEAM TERMINAL CONNECTOR AND THE 9. RAIL ELEMENTS SHALL MEET THE REQUIREMENTS OF ITEM 540,"METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE" 8. POSTS SHALL NOT BE SET IN CONCRETE, OF ANY DEPTH. AND STEEL POSTS WITH A STENCIL BEFORE GALVANIZING. HEIGHT, AND VISIBLE AFTER INSTALLATION. WOODEN POSTS SHALL BE MARKED WITH A BRAND, MARK SHALL BE LOCATED WITHIN THE TOP 1 FT. REGION OF THE POST, AT LEAST †" IN 7. THE POST LENGTH SHALL BE MARKED ON ALL 7'- 0" LONG POSTS BY THE MANUFACTURER. THE AS SHOWN IN THE PLANS. REFER TO GF(31) STANDARD SHEET. 6. THE TYPE OF POST (ROUND WOOD POST, RECTANGULAR WOOD POST OR STEEL POST) WILL BE THROUGHOUT THE THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION. 5. FOR ROUND WOOD POST SYSTEMS, ALL ROUND WOOD POSTS SHALL BE 7 •" DIA. MINIMUM FACE IN FRONT OF OR DIRECTLY ABOVE THE CURB FACE. SEE SECTION A-A. 4. UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS, TRANSITIONS SHALL BE PLACED WITH THE BLOCKOUT GUARDRAIL WILL BE PAID FOR BY THE LINEAR FOOT. OF 4" AT POST 7. IF SHOWN ELSEWHERE IN THE PLANS, ADDITIONAL CURB UNDERNEATH THAN 4" WILL BE TAPERED DOWN BEGINNING AT THE LAST 7 FT. POST TO A MAXIMUM HEIGHT ADDITIONAL CURB IS INDICATED BEYOND THE TRANSITION, THEN ANY CURB HEIGHT GREATER 3. CONCRETE CURB TYPE II SUBSIDIARY TO "METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE TRANSITION". IF NO CIRCUMSTANCES WHERE CURB CONTINUES PAST POST 7. TO THE SEVENTH POST UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS. SEE GENERAL NOTE:17 FOR FROM 4" TO 8" WITH A RELATIVELY VERTICAL FACE. CONCRETE CURB SHALL BE CONTINUOUS ARE SHOWN IN THE PLANS IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE TRANSITION, THE CURB HEIGHT MAY BE HEIGHT; SEE CURRENT CCCG STANDARD SHEET FOR FURTHER DETAILS. IF OTHER CURB HEIGHTS IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE THRIE-BEAM TRANSITIONS, CURB SHALL BE TYPE II (5- ƒ") 2. CONCRETE CURB MAY BE CAST-IN-PLACE OR PRECAST AS SHOWN ON THIS SHEET. WHEN USED CURB SECTION OF THE THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION. (512) 416-2678 1. CONTACT THE DESIGN DIVISION FOR DRAINAGE CUT OUT OPTIONS NEEDED WITHIN THE END PAYMENT FOR THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION. (SEE GF(31)STANDARD BEGIN PAYMENT FOR METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE. (IF CURB CONTINUES PAST POST 7 SEE SHT.2 AND GN:17) 31" 6'- 3"3'-1 •" 25'-0" Nested W-Beam Guardrail D D THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION (SEE SHT.1)STANDARD GUARDRAIL(NON-NESTED) (SEE GENERAL NOTE 17) (See GF(31) Standard Sheet) SPACING AT 6'-3" POSTS REMAINING c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\gf31trtl319.dgn8/5/2020FILE:DATE:Standard Division DesignTXDOT ASSUMES NO RESPONSIBILITY FOR THE CONVERSION OF THIS STANDARD TO OTHER FORMATS OR FOR INCORRECT RESULTS OR DAMAGES RESULTING FROM ITS USE.THE USE OF THIS STANDARD IS GOVERNED BY THE "TEXAS ENGINEERING PRACTICE ACT". NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND IS MADE BY TXDOT FOR ANY PURPOSE WHATSOEVER. DISCLAIMER:HIGH-SPEED TRANSITION TL-3 MASH COMPLIANT THRIE-BEAM TRANSITION METAL BEAM GUARD FENCE GF(31)TR TL3-19 SHEET 2 OF 2 PAST POST 7 (SEE SHT. 1 GENERAL NOTE 17) REQUIRED ALTERNATIVE FOR CONTINUOUS CURB EXTENDING CURB CURB DENTON DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONTC TxDOT: KM NOVEMBER 2019 gf31trtl319.dgn CGL/AGKMTxDOT 75 32" SECTION D-D 25" Begin payment for Metal Beam Guard Fence. End payment for Metal Beam Guard Fence Transition. NESTED DN:DW:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\js14.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT Standard Division Design HCDN:CK:AN DECEMBER 2014 js14.dgn C TxDOT: 76 HC COMPOUND SEALING JOINT /T-‚"„"3‚"‚"TO•"COMPOUND SEALING JOINT -‚"„"‚"‚"TO•"JOINT SEALING COMPOUND CONSTRUCTION JOINT ˆ"- ‚" LONGITUDINAL OR TRANSVERSE†"†" CONTRACTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL SAWED FORMED ISOLATION JOINT BACKER ROD •" ‚" …"- •"1•"OR EQUIVALENT. MATERIAL BOARDS BITUMINOUS FIBER PREFORMED COMPOUND SEALING JOINT T1 •"„"‚"--3"ROD BACKER1ƒ""EXPANSION JOINT TRANSVERSE FORMED COMPOUND SEALING JOINT OR EQUIVALENT. MATERIAL BOARDS BITUMINOUS FIBER PREFORMED CONTRACTION JOINT/T3•" MIN.1…" „"‚"-‚TO"•"ROD BACKER ˆ"- ‚" TRANSVERSE SAWED COMPOUND SEALING JOINT METHOD B: JOINT SEALING COMPOUND GENERAL NOTES 1. UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS, EITHER METHOD "A" OR METHOD "B" MAY BE USED. 2. THE LOCATION OF JOINTS SHALL BE AS SHOWN ELSEWHERE IN THE PLANS. SEALANT CLASS 5 OR 8 UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLAN OR APPROVED. USE JOINT SEALANT CLASS 5 OR 8 AT NEW JOINTS. USE JOINT SEALANT CLASS 4,5,7,OR 8 FOR MAINTAINING EXISTING JOINTS. ITEM 713 "CLEANING AND SEALING JOINTS AND CRACKS (CONCRETE PAVEMENT)". GUTTER, OLD AND NEW PAVEMENTS, OR AROUND DRAINAGE INLETS, MANHOLES, FOOTINGS AND LIGHTING 4. DIMENSIONS d1, d2, AND d3 SHOWN IN METHOD A SHALL BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE PREFORMED 3. THE JOINT RESERVOIR FOR SEALANT OR PCS SHALL BE SAWED UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN ON THE PLANS FOR THE LONGITUDINAL AND TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINTS AND THE SAWED JOINTS. 5. REFER TO DMS-6310 "JOINT SEALANTS AND FILLERS" FOR THE CLASSIFICATIONS. 6. FOR SAWED LONGITUDINAL JOINT, LONGITUDINAL OR TRANSVERSE CONSTRUCTION JOINT, USE JOINT 7. FOR TRANSVERSE SAWED CONTRACTION, TRANSVERSE FORMED EXPANSION JOINT, AND ISOLATION JOINT 8. THE JOINTS SHALL BE CLEANED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE ITEM 438 "CLEANING AND SEALING JOINTS" OR STRUCTURES./TCONSTRUCTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL3d1T‚"‚"d1d2d2d3 d3 ˆ"- ‚" PCSPCS CONTRACTION JOINT TRANSVERSE SAWED/T3…" d3 d1d2ˆ"- ‚" PCS (PCS)(DMS-6310 CLASS 6) METHOD A: PREFORMED COMPRESSION SEALS Td3 d1d21 •"-1 †" EQUIVALENT MATERIAL BOARDS BITUMINOUS FIBER PREFORMED TRANSVERSE FORMED PCS EXPANSION JOINT CONTRACTION JOINT LONGITUDINAL SAWED CONCRETE PAVING DETAILS JOINT SEALS JS-14 COMPRESSION SEAL MANUFACTURER'S RECOMMENDATION. AND A STRUCTURE. ISOLATION JOINTS MAY BE USED FOR BRIDGE ABUTMENTS, INTERSECTIONS, CURB AND 9. ISOLATION JOINTS ACCOMMODATE HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL MOVEMENTS THAT OCCUR BETWEEN A PAVEMENTTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\ped18.dgn8/5/2020 DENTON 77 SPACE TURNING MAX. 8.3%MAX.MAX.RAMP 8. 3 %RAMP 8. 3 % TURNING SPACE S IDEWALK 5' MAX. SPACE TURNING 8.3% MAX. 5' MIN.5' MI N. 5' MI N. 5' MIN. MAX. 8.3% 8.3 %2 %TYPE 5 5'MIN. 8.3% MAX. S IDEWALK EQUAL RAMPSLOPE SPACE TURN ING WITH CROSSWALK. ALIGN CURB PARALLEL GUTTER LINE FLARE FLARE MAX. 8.3% MAX. 8.3% MAX. 2%4' MIN. 5'PREFERRED 6'DESIRABLE 5'MIN. FLARE TYPE 7 OF CURB PROJECTED BACK PUSH BUTTON (TYP) OF PEDESTRIAN PREFERRED LOCATION 5'MIN. 2'MIN. TYPE 2 TYPE 3 (SIDEWALK SET BACK FROM CURB) TYPE 21 TYPE 22 ELSEWHERE IN THE PLANS. NOTE: CURB DETAILS ARE SHOWN PERPENDICULAR CURB RAMP 6'DESIRABLE 5'MIN.8.3% Max. 8.3% Max. 6'DESIRABLE 5'MIN. SEE GENERAL NOTES ON SHEET 2 OF 4 FOR MORE INFORMATION. GUTTER LINE BREAK LINE BOTTOM GRADE GUTTER LINE SLOPEEQUAL RAMP S IDEWALK SPACE TURNING 8.3% MAX. GUTTER LINE > 5'SLOPEEQUAL RAMP 5'M IN. SIDEWALK W IDTH RAMP W IDTH =6' PREFERRED,5'M IN. S IDEWALK W IDTH RAM P W IDTH = 4' MIN. 5' PREFERRED 8.3% 5' MIN. 5' MIN. MAX. RAMP TYPE 6 2% MAX .PUSH BUTTON (TYP) OF PEDESTRIAN PREFERRED LOCATION FILE:DATE:DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.SHEET 1 OF 4 JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT PED-18 CURB RAMPS PEDESTRIAN FACILITIES GUTTER LINE GRADE BREAK OF PAYMENT RAMP LIMITS NOTES / LEGEND: CIRCULATION PATH. NOT PART OF PEDESTRIAN NON-WALKING SURFACE DENOTES PLANTING OR DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE IF APPLICABLE. OF PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON DENOTES PREFERRED LOCATION CURB RAMP AT CONNECTION TO ROADWAY TYPICAL SECTION OF PERPENDICULAR WARNING SURFACES. THAN 6' WIDE, ELIMINATE DETECTABLE SURFACE BETWEEN. IF MEDIAN IS LESS WITH A MINIMUM 2' USUAL SIDEWALK AT EACH END OF THE CUT-THROUGH RAMP INSTALL DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE COMBINATION ISLAND RAMPS 8.3% MAX. RAMP FLARE 5' MIN. 8.3% MAX. RAMP 8.3% MAX. RAMP FLARE FLARE FLARE CURB RAMPS AT MEDIAN ISLANDS TYPE 20 TYPE 1 SPACE OR TRANSITION TO STREET. ON ANY PORTION OF RAMP, TURNING CROSS SLOPE NOT TO EXCEED 2% DIRECTIONAL RAMPS WITHIN RADIUS TYPE 10 (SIDEWALK ADJACENT TO CURB) 5'MIN.S IDEWALK W IDTH RAMP WIDTH = RAMP SLOPE SHALL BE FLUSH. SURFACE SLOPES AT GRADE BREAKS WILL NORMALLY BE AT GUTTER LINE. BOTTOM GRADE BREAK OF CURB RAMP COMBINATION CURB RAMPS BREAK LINE BOTTOM GRADE 2% MAX . (TYP) GRADE BREAK 8.3% MAX.EQUAL RAMPSLOPE SPACE TURNING GUTTER LINE BREAK LINE BOTTOM GRADE S IDEWALK TYPE 10 F OR REF UGE6' MI N. 5' MIN. TYPE 7 > 5' > 5' MAX4' MIN. 5' PREFERRED 8.3 %8.3% Max. 8.3% Max. BREAK LINE BOTTOM GRADE BEYOND CONTINUOUS CURB > 5' 5' MAX. SURFACE OR PROTECT DROP OFF (TYP) PLANTING OR OTHER NON-WALKING 5'MIN.5'MIN. SPACE OR TRANSITION TO STREET. ON ANY PORTION OF RAMP, TURNING CROSS SLOPE NOT TO EXCEED 2% 8.3% MAX. PARALLEL CURB RAMP COUNTER SLOPE 5% MAX.MAX. 2%MAX. RAMP RAMP RAMP RAMP RAMP RAMPRAMP VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 BLENDED TRANSITION (FLUSH LANDING) 2%Max.2%MAX FLARE MAX.2 %PATH CIRCULATION PEDESTRIAN VARIES Standard Division Design FILE: C TxDOT: ped18 MARCH,2002 DN:TxDOT DW:VP CK:KM CK:PK&JG SPACETURNING SPACETURNING PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON. FOR CLEAR SPACE AT EXTRA WIDTH MAY BE REQUIRED TURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) SPACE TURNING TURNING SPACE 5'MIN.6' PREFERRED,5'M IN. S IDEWALK W IDTH RAM P W IDTH = PUSH BUTTON WITHOUT PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON WITH PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON WITH PEDESTRIAN REVISED 08,2005 REVISED 06,2012 REVISED 01,2018 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 01-2018 2% M ax. 2% MAX .2% M ax. 2% M ax. c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\ped18.dgn8/5/2020 DENTON 78FILE:DATE:DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.SHEET 2 OF 4 JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT PED-18 CURB RAMPS PEDESTRIAN FACILITIES CURB BACK OF 2' MIN. 5' MAX. (TYP) SIDE CURB DIRECTION PEDESTRIAN TRAVEL SPACE TURNING SURFACE DETECTABLE WARNING WARNING SURFACE ON SLOPING RAMP RUN. TYPICAL PLACEMENT OF DETECTABLE DIRECTIONAL CURB RAMP CURB BACK OFPERPENDICULAR CURB RAMP WARNING SURFACE ON SLOPING RAMP RUN. TYPICAL PLACEMENT OF DETECTABLE (TYP) SIDE FLARE 2'(MIN.) SURFACE DETECTABLE WARNING DIRECTION PEDESTRIAN TRAVEL SPACE TURNING CURB BACK OF RAMPRAMP SPACE TURNING DIRECTION PEDESTRIAN TRAVEL SURFACE ON LANDING AT STREET EDGE. TYPICAL PLACEMENT OF DETECTABLE WARNING PARALLEL CURB RAMP 2'(Min.) SURFACE DETECTABLE WARNING DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE DETAILS * FROM BACK OF CURB. SHALL BE 5' OR LESS DETECTABLE WARNING SURFACE BOTH ENDS OF THE NOTE: Standard Division Design SPECIFICATIONS CONFORM TO APPLICABLE CLASS A CONCRETE - SHALL WARNING PANEL PREFABRICATED DETECTABLE WITH TRUNCATED DOMES DETECTABLE WARNING PAVER (TYP) SIDE FLARE BOTH WAYS OR AS DIRECTED NO.3 REBAR AT 18" (MAX) ON-CENTER OF DETECTABLE WARNING (MIN.) 5" DEPTH EXCLUSIVE CURB RAMP AT DETECTIBLE WARNINGS SECTION VIEW DETAIL DETECTABLE WARNING PAVERS (IF USED) DETECTABLE WARNING MATERIAL CURB RAMPS GENERAL NOTES SIDEWALKS RAMP RAMP 34. Sidewalk details are shown elsewhere in the plans. in accordance with Item, "Sidewalks". "Intersections, Driveways and Turnouts". Sidewalks shall be constructed and paid for 33. Driveways and turnouts shall be constructed and paid for in accordance with Item pedestrian routes. 32. Handrail extensions shall not protrude into the usable landing area or into intersecting shall comply with PROWAG R409. needed to protect pedestrians from potentially hazardous conditions. If provided, handrails provided, handrails may be desirable to improve accessibility. Handrails may also be the parallel roadway. Where a continuous grade greater than five percent (5%) must be of sidewalks and crosswalks within the public right of way may follow the grade of 31. The least possible grade should be used to maximize accessibility. The running slope 30. Changes in level greater than 1/4 inch are not permitted. 29. Street grades and cross slopes shall be as shown elsewhere in the plans. or clear ground space. drainage facilities and other items so as not to obstruct the pedestrian access route 28. Place traffic signal or illumination poles, ground boxes, controller boxes, signs, PROWAG section R406. Operable parts shall be placed within unobstructed reach range specified in Provide clear ground space at operable parts, including pedestrian push buttons.27. (25%) of a full unit. Cut detectable warning paver units using a power saw. 26. Lay full-size units first followed by closure units consisting of at least 25 percent Lay in a two by two unit basket weave pattern or as directed. 25. Furnish detectable warning paver units meeting all requirements of ASTM C-936, C-33. warning surface for each curb ramp type. 24. Shaded areas on Sheet 1 of 4 indicate the approximate location for the detectable back of curb. Detectable warning surfaces may be curved along the corner radius. is at the back of curb and neither end of that edge is greater than 5 feet from the 23. Detectable warning surfaces shall be located so that the edge nearest the curb line pedestrian access route enters the street. of pedestrian travel, and extend the full width of the curb ramp or landing where the 22. Detectable warning surfaces shall be a minimum of 24 inches in depth in the direction 21. Detectable warning surfaces must be firm, stable and slip resistant. with manufacturer's specifications. DMS 4350 and be listed on the Material Producer List. Install products in accordance 20. Detectable Warning Materials must meet TxDOT Departmental Materials Specification adjacent to uncolored concrete, unless specified elsewhere in the plans. cast-in-place dark brown or dark red detectable warning surface material adjoining surfaces, including side flares. Furnish and install an approved truncated domes complying with PROWAG. The surface must contrast visually with Curb ramps must contain a detectable warning surface that consists of raised19. VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 FILE: C TxDOT: ped18 MARCH,2002 DN:TxDOT DW:VP CK:KM CK:PK&JG REVISED 08,2005 REVISED 06,2012 REVISED 01,2018 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 01-2018 * otherwise shown on the plans. 18. Existing features that comply with applicalble standards may remain in place unless ramp for payment, whether it is concrete curb, gutter, or combined curb and gutter. 17. Curbs shown on sheet 1 within the limits of payment are considered part of the curb 16. Provide a smooth transition where the curb ramps connect to the street. unless otherwise directed. 15. Furnish and install No. 3 reinforcing steel bars at 18" o.c. both ways, otherwise directed. 14. Place concrete at a minimum depth of 5" for ramps, flares and landings, unless "Sidewalks". 13. Curb ramps and landings shall be constructed and paid for in accordance with Item 531 crossing. Handrails are not required on curb ramps. 12. Provide curb ramps to connect the pedestrian access route at each pedestrian street curb ramps shall align with theoretical crosswalks unless otherwise directed. elsewhere in the plans. At intersections where crosswalk markings are not required, 11. Crosswalk dimensions, crosswalk markings and stop bar locations shall be as shown top of curb ramps, shall be cut through level with the surface of the street. 10. Small channelization islands, which do not provide a minimum 5'x 5' landing at the passage over or through them. measured from back of curbs. Medians should be designed to provide accessible 9. To serve as a pedestrian refuge area, the median should be a minimum of 6' wide, U.S. Architectural and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board (Access Board). Pedestrian Facilities in the Public Right of Way (PROWAG) as published by the texture may be found in the latest draft of the Proposed Guidelines for 8. Additional information on curb ramp location, design, light reflective value and or otherwise protected. the ramp, either because the adjacent surface is planted, substantially obstructed, Returned curbs may be used only where pedestrians would not normally walk across Flared sides shall be sloped at 10% maximum, measured parallel to the curb. 7. Provide flared sides where the pedestrian circulation path crosses the curb ramp. within the crosswalk and wholly outside the parallel vehicular travel path. 6. Clear space at the bottom of curb ramps shall be a minimum of 4'x 4' wholly contained 5. Turning Spaces shall be 5'x 5' minimum. Cross slope shall be maximum 2%. 5'x 5' passing areas at intervals not to exceed 200' are required. constraints, sidewalk width may be reduced to 4' for short distances. a 6' sidewalk width is desirable. Where a 5' sidewalk cannot be provided due to site 4. The minimum sidewalk width is 5'. Where the sidewalk is adjacent to the back of curb, 3. Maximum allowable cross slope on sidewalk and curb ramp surfaces is 2%. should be used. Adjust curb ramp length or grade of approach sidewalks as directed. 2. All slopes shown are maximum allowable. Cross slopes of 1.5% and lesser running 1. Install a curb ramp or blended transition at each pedestrian street crossing. c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\ped18.dgn8/5/2020 DENTON 79FILE:DATE:DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.SHEET 3 OF 4 JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT PED-18 CURB RAMPS PEDESTRIAN FACILITIES 5'-0" BETWEEN OBSTRUCTIONS MIN. DISTANCE (POLE, HYDRANT, ETC.) OBSTRUCTIONCURB 2'-0" OBSTRUCTION MAX. LENGTH OF CABINET, MAILBOX, ETC.) OBSTRUCTION (CONTROLLER OBSTRUCTION 4'MIN. AT MIN. 5'SIDEWALKOBSTRUCTION 4'MIN. AT MIN. 5'SIDEWALK REQUIRED AT PUBLIC USE FIXTURES. MINIMUM 4' X 4' CLEAR GROUND SPACE NOTE: ITEMS NOT INTENDED FOR PUBLIC USE. RANGE CANE DETECTABLE ZONE PROTECTED PROTECTED ZONE 53" PROJECTION 4" MAX. WALL 27" 80" PROTECTED ZONE CAFE PROJECTION 4" MAX. POST OR WALL MOUNTED OBJECTS BETWEEN 27" AND 80" ABOVE THE SURFACE. NOTE: IN PEDESTRIAN CIRCULATION AREA, MAXIMUM 4" PROJECTION FOR POST 4' MI N. 4' MIN. SIDEWALK TREATMENT AT DRIVEWAYS MAX.PHONE4" GUIDE CANE PEDESTRIAN WITH 27" REQUIRE ADDITIONAL TREATMENT. ARE DETECTABLE BY CANE AND DO NOT PROTRUDING OBJECTS OF A HEIGHT 27" AT THE BOTTOM TO PROVIDE A MAXIMUM 4" OVERHANG. AREA, CONSTRUCT ADDITIONAL CURB OR FOUNDATION OF MORE THAN 4" INTO THE PEDESTRIAN CIRCULATION 27" FROM THE SURFACE WOULD CREATE A PROTRUSION WHEN AN OBSTRUCTION OF A HEIGHT GREATER THAN 27"MAX. 5'Min. SETBACK SIDEWALK VERTICAL CLEARANCE 80" DETECTION BARRIER FOR PLACEMENT OF STREET FIXTURES PLAN VIEW Standard Division Design DRIVEWAY PAYMENT MI N. 5'APRON OFFSET SIDEWALK APRONDRIVEWAY DRIVEWAY PAYMENT SIDES SHALL BE FLARED AT 10% MAX SLOPE. WHERE DRIVEWAYS CROSS THE PEDESTRIAN ROUTE,* VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 FILE: C TxDOT: ped18 MARCH,2002 NON-WALKING SURFACE PLANTING OR OTHER NON-WALKING SURFACE PLANTING OR OTHER APRONDRIVEWAY 2 % MAX4'MI N.5'USUAL2 % MAX4'MI N.5'USUALDN:TxDOT DW:VP CK:KM CK:PK&JG REVISED 08,2005 REVISED 06,2012 REVISED 01,2018 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 01-2018 * * 5'USUALWIDE SIDEWALK APRONDRIVEWAY 4'MI N. DRIVEWAY PAYMENT 2 %MAX. 8.3% MAX APRONDRIVEWAY MI N. 5'MI N. 5' DRIVEWAY PAYMENT 8.3% MAX 2 %MAX.4'MI N.5'US UALRAMP SIDEWALK * * ** ** ** DETECTABLE WARNING ARE NOT REQUIRED. GRADE LESS THAN OR EQUAL TO 5%. HANDRAIL AND IF CURB HEIGHT IS GREATER THAN 6 INCHES, USE NOTES: TO PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON CLEAR SPACE ADJACENT CROSS SLOPE MAXIMUM 2% c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\ped18.dgn8/5/2020 DENTON 80FILE:DATE:DISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.SHEET 4 OF 4 JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT PED-18 CURB RAMPS PEDESTRIAN FACILITIES W/FREE RIGHT TURN & ISLAND AT INTERSECTION MIN.5' STOP BAR CROSSWALK CROSSWALKSI DEWALKTURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) TURNING SPACE SHARED 5'X 5'(MIN.) PUSH BUTTON (IF APPLICABLE). DENOTES PREFERRED LOCATION OF PEDESTRIAN NOT PART OF PEDESTRIAN CIRCULATION PATH. DENOTES PLANTING OR NON-WALKING SURFACE SHOWS DOWNWARD SLOPE. LEGEND: RAMP PLACEMENT SPLIT RADIAL SIDEWALK CROSSWALK SIDEWALK SKEWED INTERSECTION WITH "LARGE" RADIUS STOP BAR TURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON (TYP) PREFERRED LOCATION OF SPACES MANEUVERING 4'X 4'(MIN.) SIDEWALK SIDEWALK CROSSWALK SKEWED INTERSECTION WITH "SMALL" RADIUS STOP BAR TURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) SPACES MANEUVERING 4'X 4'(MIN.) SIDEWALK CROSSWALK SIDEWALK TURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) NORMAL INTERSECTION WITH "SMALL" RADIUS STOP BAR FROM CURB SIDEWALK REMOTE 5'MIN.SIDEWALK TO CURB SIDEWALK ADJACENT SIDEWALK TURNING SPACE 5'X 5'(MIN.) OBSTRUCTION 4'(MIN.) AT PERPENDICULAR RAMPS MID-BLOCK PLACEMENT TO CURB SIDEWALK ADJACENT TO CURB SIDEWALK ADJACENT FROM CURB SIDEWALK REMOTE FROM CURB SIDEWALK REMOTE TO CURB SIDEWALK ADJACENT TO CURB SIDEWALK ADJACENT MANEUVERING SPACES 4'X 4'(MIN.) 6' PREFERRED. 5' MIN. Standard Division Design SEE SHEET 1 OF 4 FOR DETAILS AND DIMENSIONS TYPICAL CROSSING LAYOUTS VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 06-29-2017 FILE: C TxDOT: ped18 MARCH,2002 DN:TxDOT DW:VP CK:KM CK:PK&JG REVISED 08,2005 REVISED 06,2012 REVISED 01,2018 VINCENT J. PARKER: TXDOT ROADWAY CAD STANDARDS MANAGER 01-2018 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\repcp14.dgn8/5/2020DN:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT SHEET 1 OF 2 TxDOT Standard Division Design HCDN:HC AN C TxDOT: GENERAL NOTES * USE 12" SPACING AS FIRST AND LAST SPACING AT END OR SIDE FOR ALL BARS. AND BAR SIZE SLAB THICKNESS (IN.) T SIZE BAR 8.5 6.0 #5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 8.5 9.0 9.5 7.5 7.0 6.5 9.0 8.0 7.5 TIEBARSPAVEMENT TYPE JRCP 6.0 6.5 #610.0 10.5 11.0 11.5 #5<8.0 7.0 6.75 6.25 24.0 CRCP (IN.) SPACING (IN.) SPACING 8.5 6.0 7.5 7.0 6.5 9.0 8.0 7.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 6.75 6.25 12.0 >12.0 TABLE NO.1 STEEL BAR SIZE AND SPACING LONGITUDINAL*TRANSVERSE* REGULAR BARS >8.0 #6 24.0 12.0 #5<8.0 >8.0 #6 CPCD NONE 12.0 NONE 12.0 BARS (IN.) SPACING TIEBARS (IN.) SPACING 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24 NONE NONE 24 24 EXTENDED INTO THE REPAIR PATCH. EXISTING CONCRETE. MIN.25" MIN.10" EPOXY-GROUTED INTO TOP OF DRILLED HOLES AT T/2. TRANSVERSE TIEBARS - 10" MIN. T/2 T/2 MIN.25" EXTENDED INTO THE REPAIR PATCH. MIN.10" EPOXY-GROUTED INTO EXISTING CONCRETE. BOTTOM OF DRILLED HOLES AT T/2. LONGITUDINAL TIEBARS - PLACED IN ONE LAYER AND TIED TO TIEBARS. BAR LENGTH IS LENGTH OF REPAIR MINUS 2". LONGITUDINAL BARS - REPAIR PATCH 6' MIN. NOTES SEE GENERAL HALF OR FULL LANE WIDTHPLAN VIEW SEE DETAIL A BASE RECOMPACTED AND TIED TO TIEBARS. MINUS 2". PLACED IN ONE LAYER BAR LENGTH IS WIDTH OF REPAIR TRANSVERSE BARS - 1.ITEM 361,"REPAIR OF CONCRETE PAVEMENT"SHALL GOVERN FOR THIS WORK. "CONCRETE PAVING DETAILS, JOINT SEALS." OPERATION SHOULD BE RESTORED IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD SHEET 3.EXISTING LONGITUDINAL AND TRANSVERSE JOINTS REMOVED DUE TO REPAIR 1.ITEM 361,"REPAIR OF CONCRETE PAVEMENT"SHALL GOVERN FOR THIS WORK. BE PLACED IN TWO STAGES DUE TO SEQUENCE OF CONSTRUCTION. 2.MULTIPLE PIECE TIEBARS SHALL BE USED WHEN THE REPAIR AREA MUST PAVEMENT EDGE AND TO THE CENTER LINE OF THE PAVEMENT. TO BE REPAIRED. THE CUT SHALL BE MADE AT A RIGHT ANGLE TO THE 3.FULL DEPTH SAW CUTS SHALL BE MADE AROUND THE PERIMETER OF THE AREA EXISTING LONGITUDINAL JOINT. 4.AT LEAST ONE LONGITUDINAL FULL DEPTH SAW CUT SHALL BE AT AN THE FULL DEPTH SAW CUT AT THE REPAIR EDGE. TO FACILITATE REMOVAL OF THE CONCRETE OR TO ALLEVIATE BINDING OF 5.ADDITIONAL SAW CUTS MAY BE REQUIRED WITHIN THE AREA OF THE REPAIR ENGINEER. CLEANED AND FILLED WITH A CEMENTITIOUS GROUT APPROVED BY THE 6.THE SAW CUTS WHICH EXTEND OUTSIDE THE AREA OF THE REPAIR WILL BE "CONCRETE PAVING DETAILS, JOINT SEALS." OPERATION SHOULD BE RESTORED IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD SHEET 7.EXISTING LONGITUDINAL AND TRANSVERSE JOINTS REMOVED DUE TO REPAIR GENERAL NOTES ENGINEER. CLEANED AND FILLED WITH A CEMENTITIOUS GROUT APPROVED BY THE 2.THE SAW CUTS WHICH EXTEND OUTSIDE THE AREA OF THE REPAIR WILL BE GROUTED TIEBARS & REINFORCEMENT DETAIL A FULL-DEPTH REPAIR OF CRCP, JRCP, AND CPCD A A PLAN VIEW SECTION A-A T 12" MIN.12" MIN.DISTRESSED CONCRETE SAW CUT REPAIR BOUNDARIES SOUND CONCRETE SOUND CONCRETE SOUND CONCRETE LONGITUDINAL STEEL BARS: DO NOT SAW-CUT STEEL BARS. SAW CUT DEPTH: MIN.1 1/2" DO NOT SAW-CUT STEEL BARS. SAW CUT DEPTH: MIN.1 1/2" BE MADE. THE REMOVAL OPERATIONS. NO ADDITIONAL COMPENSATION WILL AS DIRECTED IF LONGITUDINAL STEEL BARS WERE DAMAGED BY *INCREASE THE REPAIR AREA AND PERFORM A FULL-DEPTH REPAIR VOLUMES OF REPAIR AREAS OR CHANGES IN SCOPE OF WORK. AS APPROVED. COMPENSATION WILL BE MADE FOR UNEXPECTED REPAIR IF EXPOSED EXISTING LONGITUDINAL BARS ARE DEFICIENT, CONCRETE. SWITCH THE HALF-DEPTH REPAIR TO FULL-DEPTH *REPAIR AREAS MAY BE ADJUSTED AFTER REMOVING DISTRESSED ONLY SOUND CONCRETE IS LEFT IN PLACE. CLEAN THE AREA BY APPROVED METHODS. REMOVE ALL LOOSE MATERIALS AND REPAIR OF CONCRETE PAVEMENT HALF-DEPTH REPAIR DECEMBER 2014 repcp14.dgn REPCP-14TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:81 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\repcp14.dgn8/5/2020DN:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT SHEET 2 OF 2 TxDOT Standard Division Design HCDN:HC AN C TxDOT: A A PLAN VIEW SECTION A-A LENGTH T • DOWEL TO PREVENT BOND COAT ENTIRE DOWEL 38" MIN.38" MIN.HALF OR FULL LANE WIDTHPATCH REPAIR PATCH REPAIR EXTENDED INTO THE REPAIR PATCH. EXISTING CONCRETE. MIN.25" MIN.10" EPOXY-GROUTED INTO TOP OF DRILLED HOLES AT T/2. TRANSVERSE TIEBARS - STOP TIEBARS ABOUT 4" FROM THE DOWEL ASSEMBLY. WHICH WILL PREVENT BONDING TO THE CONCRETE. JOB SITE.COAT ENTIRE DOWEL BAR WITH A MATERIAL DELIVER PREFABRICATED DOWEL ASSEMBLIES TO THE SEE TABLE NO.2 FOR DOWEL BAR SIZE AND SPACING. SMOOTH DOWEL BARS T/2 T/2 T/2 38" MIN.JOINT TRANSVERSE 10" MIN. MIN.25" EXTENDED INTO THE REPAIR PATCH. MIN.10" EPOXY-GROUTED INTO EXISTING CONCRETE. BOTTOM OF DRILLED HOLES AT T/2. LONGITUDINAL TIEBARS JOINT SEALS: METHOD A OR B SAW CUT DEPTH: T/3 TIEBARS SMOOTH DOWEL BARS NOTES SEE GENERAL BE PLACED IN TWO STAGES DUE TO SEQUENCE OF CONSTRUCTION. 2.MULTIPLE PIECE TIEBARS SHALL BE USED WHEN THE REPAIR AREA MUST PAVEMENT EDGE AND TO THE CENTER LINE OF THE PAVEMENT. TO BE REPAIRED. THE CUT SHALL BE MADE AT A RIGHT ANGLE TO THE 3.FULL DEPTH SAW CUTS SHALL BE MADE AROUND THE PERIMETER OF THE AREA EXISTING LONGITUDINAL JOINT. 4.AT LEAST ONE LONGITUDINAL FULL DEPTH SAW CUT SHALL BE AT AN THE FULL DEPTH SAW CUT AT THE REPAIR EDGE. TO FACILITATE REMOVAL OF THE CONCRETE OR TO ALLEVIATE BINDING OF 5.ADDITIONAL SAW CUTS MAY BE REQUIRED WITHIN THE AREA OF THE REPAIR ENGINEER. CLEANED AND FILLED WITH A CEMENTITIOUS GROUT APPROVED BY THE 6.THE SAW CUTS WHICH EXTEND OUTSIDE THE AREA OF THE REPAIR WILL BE "CONCRETE PAVING DETAILS, JOINT SEALS." OPERATION SHOULD BE RESTORED IN ACCORDANCE WITH STANDARD SHEET 7.EXISTING LONGITUDINAL AND TRANSVERSE JOINTS REMOVED DUE TO REPAIR 1.ITEM 361,"REPAIR OF CONCRETE PAVEMENT"SHALL GOVERN FOR THIS WORK. BASE RECOMPACTED BASE RECOMPACTED TRANSVERSE JOINT GROUTED TIEBARS & DOWELS DETAIL B REPAIR OF TRANSVERSE JOINT OF CPCD SEE DETAIL B > PAVEMENT THICKNESS LENGTH TABLE NO. 2 DOWELS (SMOOTH BARS) SPACINGSIZE AND DIA. #8 (1 IN.) #10 (1‚IN.)10 (INCHES) <10 (IN.)(IN.) 18.0 12.0 BASKETS ARE USED, REMOVE THE SHIPPING WIRES. AND VERTICALLY UNLESS OTHERWISE SPECIFIED. WHERE DOWEL BAR 8.DOWEL BAR PLACEMENT TOLERANCE SHALL BE +/- 1/4 IN. HORIZONTALLY GENERAL NOTES REPAIR OF CONCRETE PAVEMENT DECEMBER 2014 REPCP-14 repcp14.dgnDISCLAIMER:The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.82 DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\rlstd027-18.dgn8/5/20201:49:53 PMStandard Division Bridge DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT MPM JTR TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONTMarch 2018 of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:ACP Base Material Optional casting against4" Max2'-9" Min1'-0" MinConst Jt soil, top 6" formed H(#5) R(#4) at 8"Min6""211 1'-0" Min SSTR Rail except as noted 1 T551 Rail TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION 2 3 (Showing T551 & SSTR Rails, other Bridge Rails similar) 4 5 5 5Reinforcing Anchorage Rail 2" (Typ) 3" Min RLB1 LB2RB RCC1L C2LAA1L A2L DEVELOPED SURFACE-A DEVELOPED SURFACE-B 1.845'0.705'3.056' (T551 Type Rail) (T551 Type Rail) DEVELOPED SURFACE-C (SSTR Rail) 1 2 3 4 5 Abut WingwallOR to O.S.of RailRand other end treatment. typical MBGF connection See Railing details for See Plan Sheets for length. for connection to MBGF. 4'-0" is recommended Minimum straight extension of Surface C (SSTR Rail) Bridge Type Rails) Surface A (T551 Type Rails) Surface B (T551 Between joints 33'-0" Max 15'-0" Min CURVED T551 & SSTR TYPE RAILING AT BRIDGE ENDS 10 16.69 17.61 ft ft ft ft ft ft ft ft ft 15 24.54 25.46 20 32.40 33.31 25 40.25 41.17 30 48.11 49.02 Reference to back of Rail Radius R L L L L Arc Length Arc LengthRadius RAAA21B B B12 TABLE OF DEVELOPED SURFACES DIMENSIONS FOR = 90O L L Arc LengthRadius RC C C12 Radius R (ft) A R A1 R A2 R B R B1 R B2 R C R C1 R C2 R 8 9A1R R 1.021' 1.417' 0.813' LA1 LA2 LB2 LB1 1.845' Surface A Reference RRadius R SECTION A-A (T551 Type Rails) vertical Form toe 95.76 140.04 184.32 228.60 272.88 16.99 24.84 32.69 40.55 48.40 17.31 25.17 33.02 40.87 48.73 19.63 28.54 37.44 46.35 55.25 17.31 25.17 33.02 40.87 48.73 17.93 25.79 33.64 41.50 49.35 55.66 81.86 108.05 134.25 160.44 R =8.8560(R +0.813')R =1.7811(R +1.021')R =5.2389(R +0.625') an aid in constructing forms for curved SSTR & Type T551 Railing. for included 0 angles other than 90°. The dimensions are intended as The linear ratio may be used to obtain the above arc length dimensions T551 TYPE RAILS SSTR RAIL DESIGN GUIDANCE: GENERAL NOTES: MATERIAL NOTES: SECTION A-A LC1 LC2 3.056' Surface C 1.208' 0.625' Reference RRadius R 0.705' Surface B (SSTR Rail) TRAFFIC RAIL FOUNDATION AND MISCELLANEOUS DETAILS TRF L =1.5708(R +0.813') L =1.5708(R +1.021') L =1.5708(R +1.021') L =1.5708(R +1.417') L =1.5708(R +0.625') L =1.5708(R +1.208') Example: For R = 10' & 80° ~ L = 16.99( / ) 83 may be added as shown in plans. Additional tangent extension on foundation A A conditions. must be appropriate for the speed and site The use of curved rail sections at bridge ends Cover dimensions are clear dimensions, unless noted otherwise. Excavation will be subsidiary to other Items. foot which includes the concrete and reinforcement. The associated bridge railing will be paid for by the linear information only. Reinforcing steel quantities shown are for contractor's Class "C" (HPC) concrete. Payment for railing foundations will be by CY of Class "C" or project. as necessary to apply to specific installations required on the anchorage situations but may be included in the plans, modified This detail is intended for use as a guide to unusual railing grade intersections. necessity of curved MBGF at the ends of bridges adjacent to The primary use of the curved railing detail is to avoid the See Railing standards for details not shown. Poor soil conditions will require suitably deeper foundations. with the assumption of fair to good soil support conditions. is based on the current AASHTO bridge railing requirements concrete bridge barrier type railings. The design resistance The foundations indicated are suitable for mounting typical Epoxy coated ~ #5 = 3'-6" Uncoated or galvanized ~ #5 = 2'-4" Provide bar laps, where required, as follows: elsewhere. Epoxy coat or galvanize all reinforcing steel if required Provide Grade 60 reinforcing steel. elsewhere. Provide Class "C" concrete. Provide Class "C" (HPC) if required See applicable bridge rail standard. extending rail anchorage 12" Min, vertically, into traffic rail foundation. Modify reinforcement on standard bridge rail anchorage if necessary by 1'-9" for Bridge Rail Types: T224, C412, T66, C66, T80HT and T80SS. 1'-6" for Bridge Rail Types: All rails except for T224, C412, T66, C66, T80HT and T80SS. Approximate Footing Concrete = 0.16 CY/LF and Reinforcement = 12.0 LB/LF. 1'-7" for Bridge Rail Types: T224, C412, T66, C66, T80HT and T80SS. Approximate Footing Concrete = 0.14 CY/LF and Reinforcement = 11.5 LB/LF. 1'-4" for Bridge Rail Types: All rails except for T224, C412, T66, C66, T80HT and T80SS. Stirrup hook length is 5". (Typ) rlstd027-18.dgn MBGF STANDARD BEGIN END PAYMENT FOR SGT 16" 50'-9 •" STANDARD INSTALLATION LENGTH (MASH TL-3 SoftStop) 6'-3"6'-3"6'-3"6'-3"6'-3"5'-8"4'-7"B B 6'-1…" PLAN VIEW MASH TEST LEVEL 3 (TL-3) LENGTH OF SoftStop TERMINAL (50'-9 •") LINE AT THE BACK OF POST #2 THRU #8 BEGIN LENGTH OF NEED 31" HEIGHT RAIL ELEVATION VIEW PN:15204A ANCHOR PADDLE (4 PLIES) W-BEAM FLATTENED PN: 15202G ANGLE STRUT PN: 15204A ANCHOR PADDLE APPROACH GRADING AT GUARDRAIL END TREATMENTS 6'- 1 …" PN:15202G ANGLE STRUT PN:3340G †" HEX NUTS PN:3360G GR BOLTS (8) †"x 1- ‚" HARDWARE FOR POST(2) THRU POST(8) SEE NOTE:C 25'-0" DOWNSTREAM W-BEAM GUARDRAIL PN:61G 3'-1 •" 6 "‚ (2)•" X 6'-9 †" OUTSIDE SLOTS CUTOUT DEPTH POST PN:3340G †" HEX NUTS PN:3360G HGR BOLTS (8) †"x 1- ‚" (1) †" HGR HEX NUT PN:3340G (1) †"x 10" HGR BOLT PN:3500G POST(3) POST(3) POST(8)POST(7)POST(6)POST(5)POST(4) POST(8)POST(7)POST(6)POST(5)POST(4) AT (POSTS 2 THRU 8) STANDARD WOOD BLOCKOUTS (6"X8"X14") PN:4076B NOTE: STEEL I-BEAM POST W6 X 8.5 (6'-0") PN:533G †" HGR NUT PN:3340G †" X 10" HGR BOLT PN:3500G A A MASH - TL-3 SOFTSTOP END TERMINAL TRINITY HIGHWAY DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\sgt10s3116.dgn8/5/2020DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:KM Standard Division Design C TxDOT: VPTxDOT 1 1 7 1 HARDWARE 1 2 6777B 15204A 15207G 15206G 15201G 15202G 1 2 4 2 1 3 6 1 2 7 1 1 4 16 25 4902G 3908G 3717G 3701G 3704G 3360G 3340G 3500G 3391G 4489G 4372G 105285G 105286G 3240G 3245G 15852B 4076B 7 1 1 1 6 1 1 1 15208A 15215G 61G 15205A 15203G 15000G 533G 1 QTY MAIN SYSTEM COMPONENTSPART TRAFFIC FLOW TRAFFIC FLOW HEIGHT POST 40" 32" REPLACE THE PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ASSEMBLY MANUAL. SoftStop END TERMINAL, IT IS NOT INTENDED TO THIS STANDARD IS A BASIC REPRESENTATION OF THE NOTE: PN:15204A PADDLE ANCHOR ANCHOR KEEPER PLATE (24 GA) ANCHOR PLATE WASHER ( •" THICK ) ANCHOR PADDLE ANGLE STRUT ANCHOR POST ANGLE (10" LONG) POST #1 - (SYTP) (4'- 9 •") POST #2 - (SYTP) (6'- 0") SoftStop HEAD (SEE MANUAL FOR RIGHT-LEFT APPROACH) PN:15215G ANCHOR RAIL END OF GENERAL NOTES PN:15215G RAIL 25'-0" DEPTH POST (TYP 1-8) 31" HEIGHT RAIL PN:61G RAIL 25'-0" ANCHOR RAIL WITH SLOTS - (THREADED THRU HEAD) SEE SoftStop MANUAL FOR COMPLETE DETAILS MBGF LAPPED IN DIRECTION OF TRAFFIC FLOW GENERAL NOTE:6 SEE BLOCKOUT ALTERNATE †" x 9" HEX HD BOLT A325 1" ROUND WASHER F436 ƒ" x 2 •" HEX BOLT A325 Š" x 2 •" HEX HD BOLT GR-5 Š" x 1 •" HEX HD BOLT GR-5 †" WASHER F436 †" x 1 ƒ" HEX HD BOLT A325 †" x 10" HGR POST BOLT A307 ƒ" ROUND WASHER F436 Š" ROUND WASHER (WIDE) HIGH INTENSITY REFLECTIVE SHEETING - SEE NOTE:B & NOTE:B SEE GN(3) SoftStop FACE FROM THE CENTERLINE OF POST(1) & POST(0) DETAIL SEE 2 DETAIL SEE 3 PN: 15205A 6'-5 …" POST(0) PN: 15000G 6'-0" (SYTP) POST(2) PN: 15203G 4'-9 •" SYTP POST(1) NOTE: DO NOT BOLT ANCHOR RAIL PANEL TO POST(2) Ž " HOLES YIELDING DIA.Ž " HOLES YIELDING DIA. 3 AT POST(0) DETAIL PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ASSEMBLY MANUAL (LATEST REV.) NOTE: SEE A NOTE: SEE A JULY 2016 RAIL OFFSET 2'-0" MAX. MBGF STANDARD 5'-0" 50' APPROACH GRADING 2'-0" APPROX 5'-10" EDGE OF PAVEMENT Š" HEX NUT A563 GR.DH ƒ" HEAVY HEX NUT A563 GR.DH 1" HEAVY HEX NUT A563 GR.DH NOTE: ADJUST WIDTH ACCORDINGLY WHEN OFFSET IS USED. (OFFSET "OPTION" SHOWN) FOR ADDITIONAL GUIDANCE. SEE PRODUCT ASSEMBLY MANUAL (1V:10H OR FLATTER) APPROACH GRADING 3'-1 •"(+/-) ELIMINATED FOR SPECIFIC INSTALLATIONS, IF DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. FROM ENCROACHING ON THE SHOULDER. THE FLARE MAY BE DECREASED OR A FLARE RATE OF UP TO 25:1 MAY BE USED TO PREVENT THE TERMINAL HEAD 12. BE CURVED. 11. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES SHALL THE GUARDRAIL WITHIN THE SoftStop SYSTEM 10. DO NOT ATTACH THE SoftStop SYSTEM DIRECTLY TO A RIGID BARRIER. GRADE LINE OR WITH AN UPWARD TILT. 9. IT IS ACCEPTABLE TO INSTALL THE SoftStop IMPACT HEAD PARALLEL TO THE 8. POSTS SHALL NOT BE SET IN CONCRETE. AND REFER TO THE LATEST ROADWAY MBGF STANDARD FOR INSTALLATION GUIDANCE. 7. IF SOLID ROCK IS ENCOUNTERED SEE THE MANUFACTURER'S INSTALLATION MANUAL DIVISION MATERIAL PRODUCER LIST (MPL) FOR CERTIFIED PRODUCERS. MAY BE SUBSTITUTED FOR BLOCKOUTS OF SIMILAR DIMENSIONS. SEE CONSTRUCTION 6. A COMPOSITE MATERIAL BLOCKOUT THAT MEETS THE REQUIREMENTS OF DMS-7210, ITEM 445,"GALVANIZING". FITTINGS SHALL BE SUBSIDIARY TO THE BID ITEM. 5. HARDWARE (BOLTS, NUTS, & WASHERS) SHALL BE GALVANIZED IN ACCORDANCE WITH ROADWAY MOW STRIP STANDARD. 4. FOR POST (LEAVE-OUT) INSTALLATION AND GUIDANCE SEE TXDOT'S LATEST OBJECT MARKER SHALL CONFORM TO THE STANDARDS REQUIRED IN TEXAS MUTCD. FRONT FACE OF THE DEVICE PER MANUFACTURER'S RECOMMENDATIONS. 3. APPLY HIGH INTENSITY REFLECTIVE SHEETING, "OBJECT MARKER" ON THE SoftStop END TERMINAL, PRODUCT DESCRIPTION ASSEMBLY MANUAL. PN:620237B 2. FOR INSTALLATION, REPAIR AND MAINTENANCE REFER TO THE; 2525 N. STEMMONS FREEWAY, DALLAS, TX 75207 OF THE SYSTEM, CONTACT: TRINITY HIGHWAY AT 1(888)323-6374. 1. FOR SPECIFIC INFORMATION REGARDING INSTALLATION AND TECHNICAL GUIDANCE (1) 1 ƒ" X 6'-10 ‚" MIDDLE SLOT CUTOUT 6'-3"6'-3" I-BEAM POST PN:15205A 6'-5 …" (W6 X 15) 6'-3" †" x 1 ‚" W-BEAM RAIL SPLICE BOLTS HGR †" W-BEAM RAIL SPLICE NUTS HGR BLOCKOUT - COMPOSITE (4" x 7 •" x 14") BLOCKOUT - WOOD (ROUTED) (6" x 8" x 14") POST #0 - ANCHOR POST (6'- 5 ‡") POST #3 THRU #8 - I-BEAM (W6 x 8.5) (6'- 0") SoftStop DOWNSTREAM W-BEAM RAIL (12GA) (25'- 0") (TYP) PN:3704G (2) ƒ" HEX NUT (TYP) PN:3701G (4) ƒ" FLAT WASHER (TYP) PN:3717G (2) ƒ" x 2 •" HEX BOLT PN:15201G POST ANGLE (2) ANCHOR I-BEAM POST PN: 533G 6'-0" (W6 X 8.5) 32" 40" PN:3340G †" HGR NUT PN:3500G HGR POST BOLT †" X 10" 31" HEIGHT RAILHEIGHT POST GRADE FINISHED 6, 7 & 8) (3, 4, 5, LINE POST HEIGHT POST POST(2) 32" 40" PN:3340G †" HGR NUT PN:3500G HGR POST BOLT †" X 10" 31" HEIGHT RAIL GRADE FINISHED B-BSECTION VIEW 25'-0" W-BEAM RAIL 25'-0" W-BEAM RAILBLOCKOUT WOOD 6" X 8" X 14" BLOCKOUT WOOD 6" X 8" X 14" (SYTP) I-BEAM POST PN:15000G 6'-0" (W6 X 8.5) NOTE: DO NOT BOLT ANCHOR RAIL PANEL TO POST(2) A-ASECTION VIEW STANDARD WOOD BLOCKOUT W6 X 8.5 I-BEAM POST SHOWING NOTE: NO BLOCKOUT INSTALLED AT POST(1) POST(1 & 2) ISOMETRIC VIEW PN:15207G PLATE (24 GA) ANCHOR KEEPER Ž " HOLES YIELDING DIA. (SYTP) I-BEAM POST PN:15203G 4'-9 •" (W6 X 8.5) FRONT VIEW POST(1) NOTE: NO BLOCKOUT INSTALLED AT POST(1) HEIGHT POST 17"- •" 4'- 9 •" POST(1) 40" PN 3340G HGR HEX NUT (1) †" DETAIL PN 3391G HEX HD BOLT (1) †" x 1 ƒ" PN 4372G (2) †" WASHERS PN: 15202G ANGLE STRUT NEAR GROUND SHOWN AT POST(1) 1 PN:3240G ROUND WASHERS (2) Š" PN:105286 HD BOLT-GR-5 (1) Š" x 1- •" HEX HEX NUT (1) Š" DETAIL 2 SHOWN AT POST(1) PN:105285G HD BOLT GR-5 (2) Š" x 2 •" HEX (WIDE) PN:3240G (2) Š" ROUND WASHER F463 PN:4902G 1" ROUND WASHER PN:3245G A563 GR.DH (2) Š" HEX NUT •" THICK PN:15206G ANCHOR PLATE WASHER SGT(10S)31-16 84 sgt10s3116 620237B SoftStop ANCHOR RAIL (12GA) WITH CUTOUT SLOTS SoftStop ANCHOR RAIL (12GA) PN:15215G KEEPER PLATE. BUT NOT DEFORMING THE AFTER FINAL ASSEMBLY, BE SECURELY TIGHTENED 1" NUT PN:3908G SHALL NOTE:A NOTE:B NOTE:C PART PN:5851B LEFT-SIDE (HIGH INTENSITY REFLECTIVE SHEETING) PART PN:5852B RIGHT-SIDE (HIGH INTENSITY REFLECTIVE SHEETING) LAP GUARDRAIL IN DIRECTION OF TRAFFIC FLOW. ANCHOR RAIL 25'-0" PN:15215G GUARDRAIL PANEL 25'-0" PN:61G W-BEAM SPLICE LOCATED BETWEEN LINE POST(4)AND LINE POST(5) VARY FROM 3-ƒ" MIN. TO 4" MAX. ABOVE FINISHED GRADE. THE INSTALLATION HEIGHT OF FULLY ASSEMBLED ANCHOR POST WILL MB/VP CREATED BY VINCENT PARKER MANAGER FOR TxDOT STATEWIDE CAD STANDARDS [7-13-2016] CREATED BY VINCENT PARKER MANAGER FOR TxDOT STATEWIDE CAD STANDARDS [7-13-2016] POST(1)POST(0) DETAIL SEE 1 DO NOT BOLT ANCHOR RAIL TO - POST (2) 14" 8"6"POST(2) ANCHOR RAIL TO DO NOT BOLT NOTE: Ž " GRADE FINISHED PN:3340G †" HGR NUT PN:4076B WOOD BLOCKOUT 6" X 8" X 14" PN:6777B COMPOSITE BLOCKOUT 4" X 7 •" X 14" SEE GENERAL NOTE:6 ALTERNATE BLOCKOUT PN:3500G HGR POST BOLT †" X 10" LOCATED IN FLANGES DIAMETER YIELDING HOLES AT FINISHED GRADE) (HOLES APROXIMATELY CENTERED POST(2) ANCHOR RAIL TO DO NOT BOLT TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\sscb1f10.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT #4 Rebar V1 Bar 8" CL GENERAL NOTES Barrier is Symmetrical About the Center Line Ends at Barrier 2"Cover Spaced @ 1'- 0" C-C V1 Bars (#4) (See General Note 6). Drainage Slots, as required 3'Long X 3"Deep (Min.) 1 •" BARRIER SINGLE SLOPE CONCRETE SINGLE SLOPE CONCRETE BARRIER (SSCB)(42") (#5) H1 Bars(#4) V1 Bar ELEVATION VIEW END VIEW if required Conduit Pin2" Bending 5" 3" min. from V1 Bars The weight of Cast-in-Place (SSCB)42" is approx. 717 lbs per ft. Cast-in-Place (SSCB)(Type 2)on Roadway for lateral support equivalent required 1" of ACP (Typ) or (Top & Sides)1 ƒ "2"LC SECTION E-ED D E E ELEVATION (#4) V1 Bars SECTION D-D ANCHOR DETAIL for reinforcement See Anchor Detail No. 2 spiral at 6" pitch (one flat turn top and bottom) 6 bars 2" clear cover reinforcement See Elevation Detail for 5'- 0" open joint 1 ƒ" max 1" min Dia 1'- 6" 4'- 0" Usual6" pitchinside of concrete barrier reinforcement required to clear field bend as 6 bars1'- 0"2"Conduit if required 1'- 6" DiaANCHOR DETAIL SSCB(1F)-10 SSCB (Type 1) Cast-in-Place ANCHOR LOCATION (WWR) General Notes (WWR) Option for Bars V1 and H1 Welded Wire Reinforcement Equal Spaces of 3"5" ƒ " Min. 1 • " Max.Pin2" BendingD20 Horizontal(WWR) 1'- 8 • "(4" min, to 6" max)at 12" C-C. D14 Vertical wires 100 ft.(max). Placed at Expansion Joints 1" min. 1 ƒ " max. every open joint. shaft required on each side of over 1" ACP key-in. One drill the equivalent lateral support Drilled Shaft Anchors are Note: (FLEXIBLE PAVEMENT) (TYPE 1) or #8 Galv. Bars Galv. Smooth Dowels (3) 1" Dia. x 36" Lg. Bridge Deck or CRCP Material Compressive 2" 1" Min Dowel locations END VIEW21"14"7"EXPANSION JOINT (Dowel Connection) cap end of PVC (Sch. 80), Tape or 1 ‚ " PVC Pipe December 2010 AM BD LC 1ƒ "Max Embed 1'- 8" PVC Pipe 1'- 6" where the barrier could be laterally displaced. Dowels may be used, as directed by the Engineer, in locations edge and top clearances. may be cut or bent to accommodate the Reinforcement around the drainage slots of the finished grade. Bottom of reinforement cage may rest on top Note:3'- 4 ‚ "CAST-IN-PLACE A LC42"24" for the proper reinforcement and anchorage. 8. For locations where lighting is required, see the SSCB(4) sheet Do not weld to anchorage. tack welded to the reinforcement cage to provide cage stability. 7. Cast-in-place barrier may be slip formed. Bracing may be tied or geometric changes to the barrier face. on the SSCB may be increased to a maximum of 5 inches, without elsewhere, or as directed by the Engineer. Drainage slot heights 6. Drainage slot locations (12'- 0", C-C Min. Spacing) are shown 5. Top edges of CIP barrier shall have a ƒ " chamfer or tooled radius. 4. The Anchorage shown is considered subsidiary to the bid item. Traffic Barrier". 3. These details cover barrier per Item 514,"Permanent Concrete conform to ASTM A615. 2. Where used, rebar reinforcement shall be Grade 60 and the plans. 1. Concrete shall be Class C. Unless otherwise specified in or tooled radius. shall have ƒ " chamfer Top edges of CIP barrier sscb1f10.dgn lap length of 12". 3. Weled wire spilce locations shall have a "minimum" splice drainage slots, as directed by the Engineer. 2. Welded wire cage may be cut and bent to accommodate the to ASTM A497. 1. Deformed Welded Wire Reinforcement (WWR) shall conform the barrier section to the first wire shall not exceed 3". as directed by the Engineer. The dimension from the end of 4. Combinations of reinforcing steel and WWR will be permitted, (See required connection "Type" elsewhere in the plans) barrier, to match the precast barrier connection. Joint connection "Types" may be used in Cast-in-Place Cast-in-Place barrier may be connected to precast SSCB. 85 CAST-IN-PLACE (CIP) BARRIER 6" Cast-In-Place (CIP) or Slip-Formed (SSCB) depending on barrier height H1 Bars (#5) Equally spaced Longitudinal Reinforcement (IN.) HEIGHT BARRIER A B C DIMENSIONS (IN.) 42 48 54 40 ‚ 46 ‚ 52 ‚ 22 ƒ 25 ˆ 24 26 ‚ 28 • 20 • and reinforcement dimensions accordingly. to 48" or 54". This would increase the barrier (SSCB)(42") Barrier height may be increased B C Standard Division DesignTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT tehmac11.dgn FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\tehmac11.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT (NOT TO SCALE) January 2011 RL KB TE(HMAC)-11 86 GENERAL NOTES : SCREED IS NOT REQUIRED. SURFACE. ADDITIONAL COMPACTING EFFORT BEHIND THE ATTACHMENT CAPABLE OF PRODUCING A SMOOTH COMPACTED 5. THE TAPERED EDGE SHALL BE PRODUCED BY USE OF A SCREED FLATTER. 4. THE SLOPE OF THE TAPERED EDGE SHALL BE 1.75H 1V OR APPLICABLE ITEMS IN THE CONTRACT. 3. PAYMENT FOR TAPERED EDGE WILL BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH PAVEMENT DETAILS, SEE TYPICAL SECTIONS. 2. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION REGARDING THE ROADSIDE AND THAN 2.5". THE EDGE OF PAVEMENT AND FOR THICKNESS OF HMAC LESS IS PERMISSIBLE FOR HMAC PLACED GREATER THAN 5" BELOW 1. UNLESS OTHERWISE SHOWN IN THE PLANS, A VERTICAL EDGE LANE OR SHLDR SUBGRADE LAYER HMAC LAYER TOTAL THICKNESS EXIST. PVMT OR BASE LAYER SEE TYPICAL SECTION FOR ROADSIDE DETAILS 2.5" OR LESS REQUIRED NO TAPERED EDGE THIN HMAC SURFACES OR HMAC OVERLAY WITH THICKNESS OF 2.5" OR LESS LANE OR SHLDR BASE LAYER SUBGRADE LAYER HMAC LAYER SEE TYPICAL SECTION FOR ROADSIDE DETAILS OF ALL HMAC LAYERS TOTAL THICKNESS(T) NEW OR RECONSTRUCTED PAVEMENT HMAC THICKNESS 2.5" TO 5" TAPERED EDGE 1.75 (T) MAX. LANE OR SHLDR HMAC LAYER TAPERED EDGE EXISTING PAVEMENT SEE TYPICAL SECTION FOR ROADSIDE DETAILS OF ALL HMAC LAYERS TOTAL THICKNESS(T) OVERLAY OF EXISTING PAVEMENT HMAC THICKNESS 2.5" TO 5" 1.75 (T) MAX. THE VARIOUS BID ITEMS. OF TAPERED EDGE. THIS WORK IS SUBSIDIARY TO PRODUCE A SMOOTH LEVEL SURFACE FOR PLACEMENT EXISTING ROADSIDE EMBANKMENT TO BE GRADED TO LANE OR SHLDR BASE LAYER SUBGRADE LAYER HMAC LAYER OF ALL HMAC LAYERS TOTAL THICKNESS SEE TYPICAL SECTION FOR ROADSIDE DETAILS NEW OR RECONSTRUCTED PAVEMENT HMAC THICKNESS 5" OR GREATER TAPERED EDGE : OR FLATTER 1.75H 1V 9" Standard Division Design HMAC PAVEMENT TAPERED EDGE DETAILSTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:CONDITION - 1 CONDITION - 2 CONDITION - 4 CONDITION - 3 DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\rlstd014-19.dgn8/5/20201:49:59 PMStandard Division Bridgeof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT JTR TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONTSeptember 2019 SHEET 1 OF 2 Wingwall of Abut Limits (Varies) Wingwall Length 5'-0" Min " Min41 " Max43 Same as Slab Same as Slab Jt Opening Jt Opening for payment End of Bridge Rail ROADWAY ELEVATION OF RAIL Joint (See Detail) L Intermediate WallC Opening 6"INTERMEDIATE WALL JOINT DETAIL Tool V groove Form to here. C Connector Terminal L Thrie-Beam 1 2 3'-6" Vertical Taper1'-1"3'-0" 1'-8"8" Rail Offset End of Back of 5" R "16133 1'-9"Taper Height(Varies)ELEVATION C Slab or CRCP Approach~~Wingwall Top of Abut SECTION Connector Terminal L Thrie-Beam 1 4 2 2 3 4 TERMINAL CONNECTION DETAILS R(#4) Bars S Spa ~ 2"2"2" Joint Opening Same as Slab ELEVATION SHOWING TYPICAL REINFORCING PLACEMENT " Min41 " Max43 2" at taper 1" cover to maintain as necessary reinforcing Field bend Joint (See Detail) L Intermediate WallC2" (Typ) 6" Max Spa 6" Max Spa S(#4) S(#4) Wingwall Top of Abut2" (Typ) at 6" Max WU(#4)U(#4) at 6" Max R(#4)4 1 2 3 4 TRAFFIC RAIL SINGLE SLOPE TYPE SSTR Concrete Panel Length Concrete Panel Length AT ABUTMENTS AT BENTS WITH SLAB EXP JOINTS AT BENTS WITHOUT SLAB EXP JOINTS or Controlled Joint Construction JointJoint (See Detail) Intermediate Wall Provide at all interior bents without slab expansion joints. or Controlled Joint Construction Joint 87 beyond nut. Paint ends of cut-off bolts with Zinc-rich paint. "43the MBGF Transition. Cut bolts off after installation so as to extend no more than distributed pattern so to prevent damage or distortion of the Thrie-Beam Connection and sidewalks are adjacent to back of rail. Tighten the 5 Terminal Connection Bolts in a well to avoid bolt holes and recesses. Bolt recesses are only required when pedestrian Percussion drilling is not permitted. Adjust placement of reinforcing steel as necessary " Dia x 2" deep recesses. Form or core holes and recesses.21� 5 ~ 1" Dia holes and 2 when Terminal Connections are required. Bars S(#4) and centered 2'-0" from end of rail Place 4 additional Bars R(#4) 3'-8" in length inside be continued to the end of the railing. Back of rail offset may, with Engineer's approval, Increase 2" for structures with Overlay. unless otherwise shown in the plans. to the bridge rail and extend along the embankment Fence". Attach Metal Beam Guard Fence Transitions to be paid for under the Item "Metal Beam Guard Terminal Connectors and associated hardware are rlstd014-19.dgnFootprintJoint Expansion L Slab C C of Slab. Outside Edge Abut Wingwall of Slab or Outside Edge Traffic Side of Rail L Concrete Rail FootprintC RailExample showing Slab Expansion Joints without breakbacks. PLAN OF RAIL AT EXPANSION JOINTS L Rail Footprint and perpendicular to slab outside edge. must be at the intersection of L Slab Expansion Joint,Joint L Concrete Rail Expansion Joint. Location of Rail Expansion C C rail, as shown. Fiber Material under concrete " Preformed Bitumuminous21 Cross-hatched area must have recycled tire rubber " Rebonded21 DENTON c:\pwworking\central01\d1256286\rlstd014-19.dgn8/5/20201:50:00 PMStandard Division Bridgeof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT JTR TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONTSeptember 2019 SHEET 2 OF 2~"414 "211 1'-0"2'-0"3'-0"1'-0"7" 1'-0" or CRCP Slab Approach "217 (Typ) SECTIONS THRU RAIL "211'-2 Chamfer 1" R or ON BRIDGE SLAB "414 "416 8"Min"211 1'-0"2'-0"3'-0"R(#4) 7" 1'-0" "217 (Typ) "211'-2 Chamfer 1" R or (Typ)(Typ) OR CIP RETAINING WALLS ON ABUTMENT WINGWALLS Equal SpacesFace of Rail Nominal Equal Spaces" ~ R Bar Spa432 " ~ R Bar Spa414 Face of Rail Nominal Equal Spaces" ~ R Bar Spa432 " ~ R Bar Spa414 Equal SpacesR(#4) S(#4) WU(#4) U(#4) S(#4) 2 2 5 2 2 6 7 10 2 5 6 7 8 9 "432'-10 "439 Pin Bending " Dia 212 "412'-10 "21of slab or wall may rest on top Installed bar Equal SpacesREINFORCEMENT (WWR) OPTIONAL WELDED WIRE " Min43 " Max211 DESCRIPTION LONGITUDINAL WIRES VERTICAL WIRES Total) Wire Area Minimum (Cumulative Minimum Maximum Size Differential Maximum Wire No. of Wires Spacing 4"Equal Spaces"214 " Min43 " Max211 1.067 Sq In.0.267 Sq In. per Ft 8 10 8" of 40% or more of the larger wire. The smaller wire must have an area 8 8 2 9 8 2 BARS WU (#4) "434 Pin Bending " Dia433 "434 Pin Bending " Dia433 8" BARS U (#4)"432'-10 "439 Pin Bending " Dia 212 "412'-10 "21of slab or wall may rest on top Installed bar BARS S (#4) R(#4) 2'-0"2'-0"6'-0" Min (Typ) 2" (Typ) 2" Slot Slot OPTIONAL SIDE SLOT DRAIN DETAIL Bars S Spa ~ 2" over slots. 2" cover to maintain as required bars R(#4) Adjust bottom and a sidewalk surface, side drain slots will not be permitted. When this rail is used as a separator between a roadway surface be placed over railroad tracks, lower roadways, or sidewalks. the plans or as directed by the Engineer. Drains should not Note: Side Slot Drains may be used where shown elsewhere on R(#4) S(#4) U(#4) at 6" Max S(#4) (Typ) 6" Max Spa required at slots. cut bars S(#4) as Field bend or10U(#4) slot drains with side panel length end region of 3'-0" Min 2 2 2 9 2 Wall Joint Intermediate Joint or Slab Expansion Opening3" SlotOPTIONAL SIDE SLOT DRAIN SECTION THRU"411'-10 "211 "211 1" MinGENERAL NOTES: CONSTRUCTION NOTES: MATERIAL NOTES: TRAFFIC RAIL SINGLE SLOPE TYPE SSTR Reinforcing Steel Vertical is 6'-0" and greator to side slot drain. U(#4) bars at 6" Max when end region of panel length length is less than 6'-0" to side slot drain. Space Space U(#4) bars at 4" Max when end region of panel Bend or cut as required to clear drain slots. No longitudinal wires may be within upper bend. 3" plus or minus to tie reinforcing. Top longitudinal slab bar may be adjusted laterally expense. Such bars must be furnished at the Contractor's in the slab with the approval of the Engineer. additional longitudinal bars may be used As an aid in supporting reinforcement, traffic side of wall. abutment wingwalls or retaining walls on clear cover over horizontal reinforcing in " when vertical reinforcing has closer415 Increase 2" for structures with Overlay."432 88 rlstd014-19.dgn"211'-4 recycled tire rubber " Rebonded21 Reinforcing bar dimensions shown are out-to-out of bar. otherwise. Cover dimensions are clear dimensions, unless noted Average weight of railing with no overlay is 376 plf. Shop drawings will not be required for this rail. details elsewhere in plans for these modifications. modification for select structure types. See appropriate Rail anchorage details shown on this standard may require providing more than 5" movement. Do not use this railing on bridges with expansion joints speeds of 45 mph and less. fence transition is used, this rail can only be used for guard fence transition is used. When a TL-2 rated guard used for speeds of 50 mph and greater when a TL-3 rated crash test to meet MASH TL-4 criteria. This rail can be This rail has been successfully evaluated by full-scale Epoxy coated ~ #4 = 2'-5" Uncoated or galvanized ~ #4 = 1'-7" Provide bar laps, where required, as follows: laps as required for reinforcing bars. conditions in the table are satisfied. Provide the same configurations of WWR other than shown are permitted if shown. Combinations of reinforcing steel and WWR or (ASTM A1064) may be substituted for Bars R and S, as and WU unless noted otherwise. Deformed WWR of equal size and spacing may be substituted for Bars U Deformed Welded Wire Reinforcement (WWR) (ASTM A1064) are epoxy coated or galvanized. Epoxy coat or galvanize all reinforcing steel if slab bars Provide Grade 60 reinforcing steel. required elsewhere. Provide Class "C" concrete. Provide Class "C" (HPC) if shown in the plans or approved by the Engineer. The back of railing must be vertical unless otherwise Type III, Class C or a Type V epoxy. ” tall heavy epoxy bead with41" width x 83forming. Provide a toe of traffic side of rail to concrete deck just prior to slip If rail is slipformed, apply an heavy epoxy bead 1” behind in accordance with Item 445 “Galvanizing”. and/or galvanized reinforcing with an organic zinc rich paint two thirds of the cage. Paint welded areas on epoxy coated provide additional anchorage devices and weld in the upper at any location on the cage. If increased bracing is needed, anchorage. It is permissible to weld to bars U, WU and S a minimum spacing of 3 ft between the cage and the operations is acceptable. Welding may be performed at grade. Tack welding to provide bracing for slipform by the Engineer. Provide sensor control for both line and when approved by the Engineer, with equipment approved This railing may be constructed by the slipform process STANDARD DETAIL CONCRETE PAVING CROSS SECTION DETAILS 89 SCALE HOR 1"=NTS VER 1"=NTSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:50:04 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 8/5/2020 STANDARD DETAIL 90 SCALE HOR 1"=NTS VER 1"=NTS INTERSECTION/HEADER DETAIL CURB & GUTTER/JOINTSCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:50:08 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 8/5/2020 STANDARD DETAIL 91 SCALE HOR 1"=NTS VER 1"=NTS DRIVEWAY APPROACH DETAILSCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:50:13 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 8/5/2020 STANDARD DETAIL 92 SCALE HOR 1"=NTS VER 1"=NTS SIDEWALK DETAILSSCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:50:17 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DATE 8/5/2020 DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 8/5/2020 93 SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN 1 0 0+00101+0 0 102+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88POT 108+50.00ONLY ONLYONLY R3-8b R3-5R R3-5f RIGHT LANE ONLY W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT R3-8 MR ONL Y R3-7R E. UNIVERSITY DR. RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT ONLY ONLYONLY R3-8b R3-7R E. UNIVERSITY DR 224.2 2.3 2 17.6 2 3.7 636 Identifier : D3-1(2) 3in ; 1.0" Radius, 0.3" Border, 0.3" Indent, Black on White; E. UNIVERSITY DR; E. UNIVERSITY DR RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT 25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:50:50 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS NOTTINGHAM DRE UNI VERSI TY DRE UNI VERSI TY DRC [ XNOTT NOTTINGHAM DR [ XUNIV 11' .5'11' 1 1' 1'30'R50'R30'R 30'R 1 1' [ XNOTT C 10'11'11'1'11'EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXI ST ROW0.00' RT STA 100+92.00 L XNOTT BEGIN PROJECT 0.00' RT STA 108+30.50 L XNOTT END PROJECT 10'RTYP(W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I TY 1(W)8"(DOT)(090MIL) 100 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 198 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)12"(SLD)(090 MIL) 199 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 52 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TYP 1 (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 189 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 18 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 352 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)12"(SLD)(090 MIL) 222 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 32 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)12"(SLD)(090 MIL) 96 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 60 LF OF REFL PAV MRK TY 1(W)8"(DOT)(090MIL) 194 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 33 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)12"(SLD)(090 MIL) 148 LF OF REFL PAV MRK MARKS PAV EXIST MATCH PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST 48"X30" 48"X30" 36"X36" 10.50' RT STA 106+43.97, [ XNOTT BEGIN TAPER 0.00' RT STA 108+01.48, [ XNOTT END TAPER 11.00' LT STA 107+44.00, [ XNOTT END TAPER22.00' LT STA 106+44.00, [ XNOTT BEGIN TAPER (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 55 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 345 LF OF REFL PAV MRK TY I-C TY I-C (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 200 LF OF REFL PAV MRK LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGNRELOCATE 8/5/2020 55+00 60+00 50+0051+0052+00POT 50+00.00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 STOP R1-1 DO NOT ENTER R5-1 ONEWAY R6-1R ONEWAY R6-1L ONEWAY R6-1R ONEWAY R6-1L WEST M3-4 M1-6F 428 M6-1 EAST M3-2 M1-6F 428 M6-1 SOUTH M3-3 M1-6L 882 OOLP M6-1 NORTH M3-1 M1-6L 882 OOLP M6-1 STOP R1-1 DO NOT ENTER R5-1 428 WEST M1-6F M3-4 RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT R3-7R MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 1 OF 3 94 SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:51:12 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS SHERMAN DRIVE L [ XSHERM EXIST ROW EXIST ROWRANDALL STREETEXIST ROWSGT [ XEB288EXIT [ XEB288ENTER MATCH EXIST C SHERM STA 56+00.00 BEGIN PROJECT EB RAMPEB RAMPPROP ROW PROP ROW (Y)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 135 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 93 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 150 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 465 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 240 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 98 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 30 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (090 MIL) (W)4"(SLD) REFL PAV MRK 90 LF OF (090 MIL) (W)24"(SLD) REFL PAV MRK 69 LF OF (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 72 LF OF REFL PAV MRK(W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 331 LF OF REFL PAV MRK 36"X12"36"X12" 0.00' RT STA 57+35.00, [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER 22.00' RT [ XSHERM STA 56+00.00, MATCH EXIST BEGIN TAPER STA 57+00.00, 33.00' RT END TAPER [ XSHERM PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+88.97, [ XEB288EXIT PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+89.03, [ XEB288EXIT PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST 12.00' LT STA 100+98.22, [ XEB288ENTER PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 57+34.51 [XSHERM 5.33' RT & 5.33' LT STA 59+75.00, [ XSHERM END TAPER 50'R 50'R 50'R 50'R 10'11'11'11'11'11'10'TY I-C TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 480 LF OF REFL PAV MRK LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGN RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE 8/5/2020 65+0050+0051+0052+00100+00101+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 PC 50+00.00 ONEWAY R6-1R ONEWAY R6-1L TRUCK M4-4 EAST M3-2 M5-1L 380 M1-4 TRUCK M4-4 WEST M3-4 M6-1 380 M1-4ONEWAY R6-1R ONEWAY R6-1L EAST M3-2 380 M1-4 M6-1 R6-1R EAST M3-2 M1-6L 882 OOLP M6-1 M1-6F 428 EAST M3-2 STOP R1-1 DO NOT ENTER R5-1 STOP R1-1 DO NOT ENTER R5-1 WEST M3-4 M1-6F 428 M6-1 EAST M3-2 M1-6F 428 M6-1 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:51:38 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGN [ XSHERM [ XWB288ENTER SHERMAN DR EXIST ROWWB RAMPWB RAMP10'US 288US 288EXIST ROW PROP ROW PROP ROW (W)4"(SLD) (090 MIL) 663 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (090 MIL) (W)24"(SLD) REFL PAV MRK 107 LF OF (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 72 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (090 MIL) (W)8"(SLD) REFL PAV MRK 72 LF OF (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 120 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD) (090 MIL) 655 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 90 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 231 LF OF REFL PAV MRK [ XWB288EXIT PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 100+90.00, [ XWB288EXIT PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 100+90.11, [ XWB288EXIT PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+99.44, [ XWB288ENTER PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+99.44, [ XWB288ENTER 38.98' LT STA 66+79.00, [ XSHERM BEGIBN TAPER 50'R 5 0'R50'R 50'R 29.00' RT STA 66+00.17, [ XSHERM BEGIN TAPER10'11'11'14'11'11'11'11'10'11'11'11'10'(090 MIL) (W)8"(SLD) REFL PAV MRK 188 LF OF TY II-A-A TY 1-C TY 1-C TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 1373 LF OF REFL PAV MRK MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00MATCHLINE STA. 61+00.00SHEET 2 OF 3 95 SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 16 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 314 LF OF REFL PAV MRK RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE RELOCATE 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 67+00.00SHEET 3 OF 3 96 SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN 70+00 M3-2 M1-6L M6-3 882 OOLP EAST M3-4 M1-6L M6-1 882 OOLP WEST RIGHT LANE MUST TURN RIGHT R3-7R VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:52:06 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS [ XSHERM SHERMAN DRIVE11'TYP1'10'10'EXIST ROW EXIST ROW PROP ROW PROP ROW (W)4"(SLD) (090 MIL) 882 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 175 LF OF REFL PAV MRK PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00, PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST [ XSHERM STA 71+40.00, END TAPER 15.03' LT STA 68+29+00, [ XSHERM END TAPER L MATCH EXIST C XSHERM STA 71+40.00 END PROJECT11'11'TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 1760 LF OF REFL PAV MRK LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGNRELOCATE 8/5/2020 SHEET 1 OF 3 97 MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN N LOCUST ST N LOCUST ST PLUM HOLLOW[ XLOCUS C STA 108+30.50 L XLOCUS BEGIN PROJECT [ XPLUM EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW 20'R20'R11'11'(W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 642 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 146 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 14 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 193 LF OF REFL PAV MRK 9.21' RT STA 105+85.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER PAVE MARKS MATCH EXIST 0.50'LT & 0.50' RT STA 101+85.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER PAVE MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+34.78, [ XPLUM PAVE MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 50+34.80, [ XPLUM TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 1662 LF OF REFL PAV MRK VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:52:17 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00PC 100+00.00POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+00HHHH LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGNRELOCATE 8/5/2020 SHEET 2 OF 3 98MATCHLINE STA 106+00.00MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN51+0052+0053+0054+00106+00 107+00 108+00 109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00PT 108+00.00POT 54+61.41 SSSS ONLY R3-8 STOP R1-1 N. LocustSt 3800 Hercules Ln 100 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:52:25 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGN N LOCUST ST N LOCUST ST HERCULES LNEXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXIST ROW[ XHERCU 50'R 50'R [ XLOCUS 11'11'11'11'11'11'(W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 612 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 186 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 265 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)8"(SLD)(090 MIL) 109 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)12"(SLD)(090 MIL) 104 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (W)(ARROW)(090MIL) REFL PAV MARK TYP 1 (W)(WORD)(090MIL) REFL PAV MRK TY I (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 88 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 27 LF OF REFL PAV MRK PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST (W)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 24 LF OF REFL PAV MRK 0.50' RT STA 106+85.00, [ XLOCUS END TAPER 10.50' RT STA 110+33.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER 0.50' RT STA 111+33.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER TY II-A-A TY I-C TY I-C TY I-C TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 774 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 107 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 1098 LF OF REFL PAV MRK RELOCATE RELOCATE 8/5/2020 SHEET 3 OF 3 99MATCHLINE STA 112+00.00SIGNING AND STRIPING PLAN 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00PC 116+39.30SS VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:52:33 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT INSTALL NEW SIGN W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT W4-1aL THRU TRAFFIC MERGE LEFT REMOVE EXIST SIGN EXIST SIGN TO REMAIN RELOCATE EXIST SIGN [ XLOCUS STA 115+33.00, L XLOCUS END PROJECT C N LOCUST ST11'12'11'EXIST ROW EXIST ROW (W)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 637 LF OF REFL PAV MRK (Y)24"(SLD)(090 MIL) 249 LF OF REFL PAV MRK 11.50' RT STA 114+33.00, [ XLOCUS BEGIN TAPER STA 115+33.00, L XLOCUS END PROJECT CPAVE MARKS MATCH EXIST 0.50' LT & 0.50' RT STA 115+33.00, [ XLOCUS END TAPER PAV MARKS MATCH EXIST STA 115+04.00 [XLOCUS TY II-A-A (Y)(DBL)4"(SLD)(090 MIL) 1334 LF OF REFL PAV MRK RELOCATE 8/5/2020 DENTON of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\pm1-20.dgn8/5/20201:52:35 PMFILE:NOTES WITH OR WITHOUT SHOULDERS FOUR LANE TWO-WAY ROADWAY CENTERLINE AND LANE LINES Yellow Line 4" Solid 48' only) greater than traveled way (12" max. for 3" min.-4" usual Lane Line 4" White WITH OR WITHOUT SHOULDERS ONE-WAY ROADWAY EDGE LINE AND LANE LINES Lane Line 4" White Shoulder Edge Line Yellow 4" Solid Edge Line White 4" Solid Edge Line White 4" Solid Edge Line 4" Solid White Edge of Pavement Edge of Pavement 30'10' 30'10' 100 FOUR LANE DIVIDED ROADWAY CROSSOVERS Pavement Edge 12" max. 10" min.- 4" White Lane Line WidthMedianYellow Line 4" Solid line stop/yield line to from edge 48" min. Note 2 See Taper Deceleration Storage See note 3 White Line 8" Solid Edge Line 4" Solid White Edge Line 4" Solid Yellow Edge Line 4" Solid White Edge Line 4" Solid Yellow 30'10' YIELD LINES MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS DMS-6130 PAVEMENT MARKERS (REFLECTORIZED) EPOXY AND ADHESIVES DMS-6100 DMS-4200 DMS-8200 DMS-8220 DMS-8240 All pavement marking materials shall meet the required Departmental Material Specifications as specified by the plans. BITUMINOUS ADHESIVE FOR PAVEMENT MARKERS TRAFFIC PAINT HOT APPLIED THERMOPLASTIC PERMANENT PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS 3 to 12" 24" 36" DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT Standard Division Safety Traffic PM(1)-20 pm1-20.dgn 22B 5-00 8-00 2-12 8-95 PAVEMENT MARKINGS TYPICAL STANDARD November 1978 3-03 6" min. 6" min. 30'10' may vary (typ.) Shoulder width WITH OR WITHOUT SHOULDERS TWO LANE TWO-WAY ROADWAY exists no shoulder 6" min. when 4" max. 3" min.-12" max. 10" min.- Yellow Line 4" Solid may vary (typ) Shoulder width Centerline 4" Yellow Edge Line 4" Solid White Yellow Line 4" Solid Edge Line 4" Solid White Edge of Pavement ONLYWhite Lane Line OR DRIVEWAY ALLEY, PRIVATE ROAD OR DRIVEWAY ALLEY, PRIVATE ROAD MARKINGS THROUGH INTERSECTIONS TYPICAL TWO-LANE, TWO-WAY PAVEMENT MARKINGS THROUGH INTERSECTIONS TYPICAL MULTI-LANE, TWO-WAY PAVEMENT greater than 45 MPH. being marked equal to or For posted speed on road Lane Line 4" White Yellow Line 4" Solid Yellow Line 4" Solid Line Extension 8" White Dotted Optional STOP LINES Solid White Width: 12" min. 24" max. EDGE LINE 4" Solid White Gap: 30' on approaches to intersections (500' min.) 30' max. 4' min. 30' max. 4' min. 4" Yellow 4" Solid Yellow line (typ.) 6" min. Width 16' W 20' Edgelines Pavement for Centerlines without Minimum Requirements Way Width 20' for Edgelines Traveled Minimum Requirements CENTERLINE for Undivided Highways Based on Traveled Way and Pavement Widths Length: 10' OPTIONAL EDGE LINE & CENTERLINE GUIDE FOR PLACEMENT OF STOP LINES, Triangles Yield GENERAL NOTES ROADWAY PUBLIC ROADWAY PUBLIC ROADWAY PUBLIC ROADWAY PUBLIC Edge Line White 4" Solid Edge Line White 4" Solid Edge Line White 4" Solid 6-20 Note 1 See WidthMedianNote 1 See inside of edgeline of a two lane roadway. shall be measured from the inside of edgeline to the lanes, sidewalks, berms and shoulders. The traveled ways used for vehicular travel. It does not include the parking 2. The traveled way includes only that portion of the roadway gutter sections of roadways. conditions. Edgelines are not required in curb and distance may vary due to pavement raveling or other less less than 6 inches from the edge of pavement. This directed by the Engineer. The edgeline should not be placed 1. Edgeline striping shall be as shown in the plans or as Edge Line White 4" Solid 3 to 12" 18" 12" less than 40 MPH. being marked equal to or For posted speed on road directed by the Engineer. storage lengths shall be as shown on the plans or as 3. Length of turn bays, including taper, deceleration, and yield signs. with stop signs. Yield traingles shall only be used with centerline can be placed. Stop bars shall only be used stop bars/yield triangles) when a 50' or greater median 2. Install median striping (double yellow centerlines and are optional as determined by the Engineer. Yield signs are the typical intersection control. Stop signs be the controlling width to determine if signs are required. measurement for each approach. The narrow median width will Each median opening has two width measurements, with one openings shall be signed as two separate intersections. at the median opening itself of 30 feet or more, median 1. Where divided highways are separated by median widths DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\pm2-20.dgn8/5/20201:52:36 PMPM(2)-20 pm2-20.dgn 22B April 1977 FILE:5-00 8-00 2-10 2-12 4-92 Standard Division Safety Traffic 80' 1"-4" 1"-4" 80'40'40'40' 40'40'40' Type II-A-A Type I-C Type II-A-A Type II-A-A Type I-C Type II-A-A Centerline Symmetrical around centerline Continuous two-way left turn lane DETAIL "A"DETAIL "B" Type I-C or II-C-R Type I-C or II-C-R 1"-4" 4" 10'30' USING REFLECTIVE PROFILE PAVEMENT MARKINGS 12"+ 1" 6" 18"+ 1" REFLECTORIZED PROFILE PATTERN DETAIL 12"+ 1" 4" OR 80' 1"-2" 1"-2"Type II-A-A Type II-A-A DETAIL "C" 4" 4" 4" 2 to 3"2 to 3" 4" 4" 3-4" with a posted speed limit of 45 MPH or less. Profile markings shall not be placed on roadways CENTERLINE AND LANE LINES FOR TWO-WAY LEFT TURN LANE CENTERLINE FOR ALL TWO LANE ROADWAYS GENERAL NOTES LANE LINES FOR ONE-WAY ROADWAY (NON-FREEWAY FACILITIES) Surface Reflectorized AA MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS All pavement marking materials shall meet the required Departmental Material Specifications as specified by the plans. DMS-6130 EPOXY AND ADHESIVES DMS-6100 DMS-4200 DMS-8200 DMS-8220 DMS-8240 TRAFFIC PAINT HOT APPLIED THERMOPLASTIC PERMANENT PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS BITUMINOUS ADHESIVE FOR PAVEMENT MARKERS PAVEMENT MARKERS (REFLECTORIZED) SECTION A o o Adhesive AA Surface Reflectorized RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS Type I (Top View) Type II (Top View) 25 min 35 max- Surface Roadway joints. should be placed to one side of the longitudinal 2. On concrete pavements the raised pavement markers the stripes. shall be placed in line with and midway between 1. All raised pavement markers placed in broken lines quarters to a maximum height of 7 quarters. approximately equal to a stack of 5 of base line and profile marking is A quick field check for the thickness in height 300 to 500 mil NOTE FOR VEHICLE POSITIONING GUIDANCE REFLECTIVE RAISED PAVEMENT MARKERS See Detail A See Detail B See Detail C FOR FOUR LANE TWO-WAY HIGHWAYS CENTERLINE & LANE LINES CENTER OR EDGE LINE BROKEN LANE LINE toward normal traffic and red face toward wrong-way traffic. Raised pavement markers Type II-C-R shall have clear face 5•"+ •" MARKINGS RELECTORIZED PROFILE RAISED MARKERS POSITION GUIDANCE USING 101 3‚" ƒ"+ OR LANE LINE CENTER LINE 4" EDGE LINE, OR LANE LINE LINE, CENTER LINE OPTIONAL 6" EDGE 80' 6-20 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\pm3-20.dgn8/5/20201:52:42 PMPM(3)-20 pm3-20.dgn April 1998 FILE:5-00 8-00 3-03 2-10 2-12 GENERAL NOTES SEE DETAIL A 9'3' 1 Mile (Auxiliary Lane)(ONE-WAY, NON-SIGNALIZED)MINOR CROSS STREETONLYONLY*** (typ.) 24" White ***Typically equal to • the length of storage lane Varies 1 Mile (Lane Drop)(TWO-WAY, NON-SIGNALIZED)MINOR CROSS STREETMAJOR CROSS STREETSTREET TWO-WAY MINOR ONLYONLY48'Type I-C spaced at 20' Type II-C-R Type I-C or 9'3' Type I-C48' Standard Division Safety Traffic 22D Varies (See general note 2) TYPICAL TWLTL AT ONE-WAY STREET AND RIGHT TURN AUXILIARY LANE TYPICAL TWLTL AT TWO-WAY CROSS STREET AND RIGHT TURN LANE DROP 4" White Lane Line 4" Solid Yellow Line Lane Line 4" White Dotted 8" White Lane Line Broken 4" Yellow Broken 4" Yellow Dotted 8" White Lane Line (Typ) 8" Solid White spaced at 20' Type II-A-A 4" Solid Yellow4" Yellow Broken 4" White Lane Line SEE DETAIL B 102 MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS DMS-6130 EPOXY AND ADHESIVES DMS-6100 DMS-4200 DMS-8200 DMS-8220 DMS-8240 TRAFFIC PAINT HOT APPLIED THERMOPLASTIC PERMANENT PREFABRICATED PAVEMENT MARKINGS PAVEMENT MARKERS (REFLECTORIZED) BITUMINOUS ADHESIVE FOR PAVEMENT MARKERS as specified by the plans. required Departmental Material Specifications All pavement marking materials shall meet the SEE DETAIL A 20' 20' Type II-A-A Markers 20' TYPICAL TWO-LANE HIGHWAY INTERSECTION WITH LEFT TURN BAYS 30-45° Yellow Line 4" Solid D/4 D 3'9'9' Paved Shoulder Arrow Lane-Reduction 300'-500' Edge Pavement D/2 D/4 L SEE DETAIL B LANE REDUCTION NOTES (Optional) W9-1R W9-2TL Extension Line 4" Dotted White Varies (See general note 2) PAVEMENT MARKINGS AND LANE REDUCTION RURAL LEFT TURN BAYS, TWO-WAY LEFT TURN LANES, note 3 See general 1"(Typ)ONLY(typ.) White Line 8" Solid or as directed by the Engineer. and storage lengths shall be as shown on the plans 4. Length of turn bays, including taper, deceleration, divided highways and raised medians. lanes. Use raised pavement marker Type II-C-R with highways, flush medians and two way left turn 3. Use raised pavement marker Type I-C with undivided near the upstream end of the full-width turn lane. for a short turn lane, it should be located at or lane use arrow or word and arrow marking is used the bay is greater than 180 feet. When a single two sets of arrows should be used if the length of 2. When lane-use words and arrow markings are used, Highway Sign Designs for Texas. words and arrows are as shown in the Standard lanes and turn bays for emphasis. Details for or word and arrow markings may be used in other of substantial length. Lane use arrow markings arrow markings should be used in auxiliary lanes become mandatory turn lanes. Lane use word and where through lanes approaching an intersection 1. Lane use word and arrow markings shall be used ONLY32' Type I-C 20' White Line 8" Solid DETAIL B Typ. 32' DETAIL A 3-4" 3-4" 20' Markers Type II-A-A Yellow Line 4" Solid TYPICAL TRANSITION FOR TWLTL AND DIVIDED HIGHWAY 20' Type II-A-A Markers not required unless stated elsewhere in the plans. marking after each intersection or dedicated turn bay is a two-way left-turn lane within a corridor. Repeating the should be used at or just downstream from the beginning of A two-way left-turn (TWLT) lane-use arrow pavement marking 8'-16' 30 MPH 35 MPH 40 MPH 45 MPH 50 MPH 55 MPH 60 MPH 65 MPH 70 MPH 75 MPH 460 565 670 775 885 990 1,100 1,200 1,250 1,350 D (ft)L (ft)Speed Posted L=WS L=WS 2 60 Yellow Line 4" Solid Line. 8" White Extension Optional Dotted 6-20 shall conform to the TxDOT Freeway Signing Handbook. 4. For lane reductions on Freeways and Expressways, signing last lane reduction arrows. lane reduction arrow should be centered between the first and based on engineering judgement. If used, the optional third greater. An optional third lane reduction arrow may be added 3. Lane reduction arrows are required for speeds of 45 mph or sign on the right side of the highway. sign may be installed in the median aligned with the W9-1R 2. On divided highways, an additional W9-1R "RIGHT LANE ENDS" see TS2(PL) standard sheets. otherwise be a through lane. For Texas Super 2 Passing Lanes, or because of a section of on-street parking in what would through lanes is reduced because of narrowing of the roadway 1. Lane reduction pavement markings are used where the number of Stub pipe 12 Dia for FRP Support with Single Sign Typical Sign Mounting Detail A A View A-A Compression Ring 6" min or joint to edge 10" 10"Pipe Stub Plate Base Coupler .080" Aluminum Sign - Sign Face Post FRP for FRP Support with Back-to-Back Signs Typical Sign Mounting Detail (FRP) Pipe Plastic Reinforced Fiberglass 3" O.D. (FRP) Pipe Plastic Reinforced Fiberglass spaced) equally slots (4 1/4 x 2 7/8" 10" 14"30" 3/4" dia. 1/2" 3 1/2" 5/16 x 4" Hex Bolt sign face support and in FRP (Max.) hole Drill 3/8" .080" Aluminum Sign - Sign Face Post FRP Sign Face Nylon Washer Plastic or sign face support and in FRP (Max.) hole Drill 3/8" 5/16 x 4 1/2" Hex Bolt (3" Nominal) Stub Pipe Schedule 40 3 1/2" (3" Nominal) Stub Pipe 3 1/2" Schedule 40 Concrete anchor consists of 5/8" diameter stud bolt with UNC series bolt threads on the upper end. A heavy hex nut washers shall be galvanized per Item 445, "Galvanizing." Adhesive type anchors shall have stud bolts installed with Adhesive anchors may be loaded after adequate epoxy cure 2.0 cf of concrete. should take approx. plans). Foundation elsewhere in the unless noted (shall be used Concrete Footing Non-reinforced or adhesive type. min. of 50 ft-lbs). Anchor may be expansion (embed a min. of 3 3/8" and torque to 5/8" diameter Concrete Anchor - 4 places lock washer and nut Flat washer, lock washer and nut Flat washer, per ASTM A563 and hardened washer per ASTM F436. The time per the manufacturer's recommendations. allowable tension and shear of 2450 and 1525 psi, respectively. Top of bolt shall extend at least flush with top of nut when installed. The anchor, when installed in 4000 psi normal-weight concrete with a 3 3/8" minimum embedment, shall have a minimum with Fiberglass Reinforced Plastic (FRP) Post Universal Anchor System stud bolt shall have minimum yield and ultimate tensile Type III epoxy per DMS-6100, "Epoxies and Adhesives." Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp and flat washer Plastic or nylon washer,and flat washer Plastic or nylon washer, SM RD SGN ASSM TY FRP(X)UB(P)SM RD SGN ASSM TY FRP(X)UA(P) A A BOLT-DOWN DETAILS WITH FRP POST UNIVERSAL ANCHOR SYSTEM SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS strengths of 50 and 75 ksi, respectively. Nuts, bolts and (Slip-2) detail on SMD or Plug. See Friction Cap SMD(FRP)-08 the foundation. and prevents stub from turning in Acts as a "stop" for the sign post 1/2 x 7 1/2" Steel Rod Concrete Class A GENERAL NOTES: 1. FRP sign supports for a single type sign support may be used for signs up to and including 16 square feet. Dual post installation may be used for signs up to and including 32 square feet. 2. All nuts, bolts and washers shall be galvanized per Item 445, "Galvanizing." 3. See the Traffic Operations Division website for detailed drawings of sign clamps. The website address is: http://www.txdot.gov/publications/traffic.htm FRP POST REQUIREMENTS 1. Materials shall conform to the requirements of Departmental Material Specification DMS-4410 and will be furnished in a yellow or gray color as specified elsewhere in the plans. 2. Thickness of FRP sign support is 0.125" + 0.031", - 0.0". 3. FRP sign supports are prequalified by the Traffic Operations Division. Prequalification procedures are obtained by writing: Texas Department of Transportation Traffic Operations Division 125 East 11th Street Austin, Texas 78701-2483 UNIVERSAL ANCHOR SYSTEM INSTALLATION PROCEDURES 1. Dig foundation hole. Where solid rock is encountered at ground level, the foundation shall be a minimum depth of 18". When solid rock is encountered below ground level, the foundation shall extend in the solid rock a minimum depth of 18" or provide a minimum foundation depth of 30". If solid rock is encountered, the socket/stub may be reduced in length as required to a minimum length of 18". Any material removed from the socket/stub shall be from the bottom and the clearance requirements given on SMD(GEN) must be followed. The inner surfaces of the socket/stub must remain free of concrete or other debris. 2. The Engineer may permit batches of concrete less than 2 cubic yards to be mixed with a portable, motor driven concrete mixer. For small placements less than 0.5 cubic yards, hand mixing in a suitable container may be allowed by Engineer. Concrete shall be Class A. 3. Insert base post in foundation hole to depths shown and fill hole with concrete. Cut base post from bottom and ensure a minimum of 18" embedment if installed in solid rock. 4. Level and plumb the base post with coupler using a torpedo level and let concrete set a minimum of 4 days, unless otherwise directed by Engineer. Bottom of base post slots shall be above the concrete footing. 5. Attach sign to FRP post. 6. Insert sign post into base post. Lower until the post comes to rest on the steel rod. 7. Use hammer to ensure the coupler is firmly seated. Top of coupler should be level with top of base post in most instances. 8. Check sign to ensure there is no twist. If loose, increase the tightening of coupler. BOLT DOWN SIGN SUPPORT 1. Position base plate with coupler on existing concrete. 2. Drill holes into concrete and insert the 5/8" diameter bolts with wedge anchors, and tighten nuts. 3. Attach sign to FRP post. 4. Insert bottom of sign post into pipe stub. 5. Use hammer to ensure the coupler is firmly seated. Top of coupler should be level with top of base post in most instances. 6. Check sign to ensure there is no twist. If loose, increase the tightening of coupler. 9-08 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any FILE:DATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26F TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT1:52:43 PM8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smdfrp.dgn DENTON 103 SIGN LOCATION PAVED SHOULDERS LESS THAN 6 FT. WIDE HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD GREATER THAN 6 FT. WIDE min 12 ft 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max Lane Travel Shoulder Paved Lane Travel Shoulder Paved 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max 0 to 6 ft than 6 ft Greater 6 ft min the edge of the travel lane. the sign must be placed at least 12 ft. from When the shoulder is 6 ft. or less in width, edge of the shoulder. the sign must be placed at least 6 ft. from the When the shoulder is greater than 6 ft in width, HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD BEHIND CONCRETE BARRIER 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max Lane Travel Shoulder Paved Lane Travel Shoulder Paved 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max BEHIND GUARDRAIL BEHIND BARRIER 5 ft min**2 ft min** HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD HIGHWAY INTERSECTION AHEAD EASTWEST 259 259 SIGNS WITH PLAQUES 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max Lane Travel Shoulder Paved or secondary sign. the supplemental plaque measured to the bottom of the 7 ft sign height is or secondary sign is used, When a supplemental plaque Curb Face of7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max min 2 ft min 2 ft Curb Face of 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max Lane Travel Shoulder Paved T-INTERSECTION 7.0 ft min * 7.5 ft max 6 ft min Lane Travel Shoulder Paved ROW Paved Shoulder Edge of Travel Lane that results in the greatest sign elevation: * Signs shall be mounted using the following condition (1) (2) the Engineer. The maximum values may be increased when directed by Post Type Number of Posts (1 or 2) Anchor Type Sign Mounting Designation TYPICAL SIGN ATTACHMENT DETAIL Signs Back-to-Back 3" 12 ft min U-bolt Sign Panel Sign Post Sign Post Sign PanelClamp Bolt Single Signs SIGN SUPPORT DESCRIPTIVE CODES RESTRICTED RIGHT-OF-WAY (Descriptive Codes correspond to project estimate and quantities sheets) edge of the travel lane or a minimum of 7 to a maximum of 7.5 feet above the Pipe Diameter Approximate Bolt Length 3 or 3 1/2" 3 or 3 1/2" 4 1/2" 2" nominal 2 1/2" nominal 3" nominal 3 1/2 or 4" 3 1/2 or 4" Rail Guard Barrier Concrete REQUIRED CLEARANCE (i.e., typical space between wheel paths). more than 4 inches above a 60-inch chord when it is broken away, should not project substantial remains of a breakaway support, To avoid vehicle undercarriage snagging, any Clamp Sign Clamp Sign or the universal clamp. Sign clamps may be either the specific size clamp Sign Panel Specific Clamp Universal Clamp Sign Bolt nut washer, lock washer, Nylon washer, flat nut washer, lock washer, Nylon washer, flat nut washer, lock washer, Nylon washer, flat washer Nut, lock washer Nut, lock Not Acceptable Not AcceptableNot Acceptable Acceptable within a 7 ft. circle. posts should be located No more than 2 sign circle diameter 7 ft. circle diameter 7 ft. circle diameter 7 ft. circle diameter 7 ft. **Sign clearance based on distance required for proper guard rail or concrete barrier performance. *** installed on the backslope. grade at the base of the support when sign is a minimum of 7 to a maximum of 7.5 feet above the STOP Surface Ground TX-DOT TEXAS (i.e., stub). support portion of Non-breakaway 4" max. 60" FOR BREAKAWAY SUPPORT depending upon field conditions. right. The bolt length may need to be adjusted sizes and sign clamp types are given in the table at washer. The approximate bolt lengths for various post head per ASTM A307 with nut and helical-spring lock back-to-back, use a 5/16-18 UNC galvanized hex When two sign clamps are used to mount signs (When 6 ft min. is not possible.) possible Maximum slope. post could not be hit due to extreme guardrail or if Engineer determines the *** Post may be shorter if protected by lane as practical. should be placed as far from the travel from the edge of the travel lane, signs prevents the minimum horizontal clearance In situations where a lateral restriction factors. buildings, a narrow island, or other by rocks, water, vegetation, forest, Right-of-way restrictions may be created as close to ROW as practical. be in line with the centerline of the roadway. Place two way roadway, the right edge of the sign should When this sign is needed at the end of a two-lane, SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(X)XX(X-XXXX) GENERAL NOTES & DETAILS SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS http://www.txdot.gov/publications/traffic.htm The website address is: components and Wedge Anchor System components. drawings of sign clamps, Triangular Slipbase System See the Traffic Operations Division website for detailed CURB & GUTTER OR RAISED ISLAND SMD(GEN)-08 FT IN LOW CLEARANCE 14 4 M.P.H. 35 FARM ROAD EAST 3713 FARM ROAD EAST 3713 3 1 6 bolt length is 1 inch for aluminum. nylon washer, flat washer and lock washer. The 5/16-18 UNC galvanized square head with nut, Bolts used to mount sign panels to the clamp are S80 = Schedule 80 Pipe (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) 10BWG = 10 BWG Tubing (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) TWT = Thin-Walled Tubing (see SMD(TWT)) FRP = Fiberglass Reinforced Plastic Pipe (see SMD(FRP)) SB = Slipbase - Bolted Down (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) SA = Slipbase - Concreted (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) WP = Wedge Anchor Plastic (see SMD(TWT)) WS = Wedge Anchor Steel - (see SMD(TWT)) UB = Universal Anchor - Bolted down (see SMD(FRP) and (TWT)) UA = Universal Anchor - Concreted (see SMD(FRP) and (TWT)) EXAL = Extruded Aluminum Sign Panels (see SMD(SLIP-3)) WC = 1.12 #/ft Wing Channel (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) BM = Extruded Wind Beam (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) 1EXT or 2EXT = Number of Extensions (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3), (TWT)) IF REQUIRED U = Prefab. "U" (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3)) T = Prefab. "T" (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3), (TWT)) P = Prefab. "Plain" (see SMD(SLIP-1) to (SLIP-3), (TWT), (FRP)) 9-08 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 1:52:44 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smdgen.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26A TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 104 6" min or joint to edge Stub Keeper Plate Bolt 36" 42" 12" Dia expansion or adhesive type. 50 ft-lbs). Anchor may be 5 1/2" and torque to min. of 8 places (embed a minimum of 5/8" diameter Concrete Anchor - (See General Note 3) Schedule 80 Pipe 10 BWG Tubing or Post TRIANGULAR SLIPBASE SYSTEM SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(X)SA(X-XXXX) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(X)SB(X-XXXX) TRIANGULAR SLIPBASE INSTALLATION GENERAL REQUIREMENTS 2 1/2". Bolt length is Item 445 "Galvanizing." galvanized per or A449 and (6) per ASTM A325 (3), and washers bolts (3), nuts 5/8" structural Slip Base 4" Max. manufacturer if required by Washers SMD(SLIP-1)-08 24" max. 12" min. CONCRETE ANCHOR GENERAL NOTES: 1. Slip base shall be permanently marked to indicate manufacturer. Method, design, and location of marking are subject to approval of the TxDOT Traffic Standards Engineer. 2. Material used as post with this system shall conform to the following specifications: 10 BWG Tubing (2.875" outside diameter) 0.134" nominal wall thickness Seamless or electric-resistance welded steel tubing or pipe Steel shall be HSLAS Gr 55 per ASTM A1011 or ASTM A1008 Other steels may be used if they meet the following: 55,000 PSI minimum yield strength 70,000 PSI minimum tensile strength 20% minimum elongation in 2" Wall thickness (uncoated) shall be within the range of 0.122" to 0.138" Outside diameter (uncoated) shall be within the range of 2.867" to 2.883" Galvanization per ASTM A123 or ASTM A653 G210. For precoated steel tubing (ASTM A653), recoat tube outside diameter weld seam by metallizing with zinc wire per ASTM B833. Schedule 80 Pipe (2.875" outside diameter) 0.276" nominal wall thickness Steel tubing per ASTM A500 Gr C Other seamless or electric-resistance welded steel tubing or pipe with equivalent outside diameter and wall thickness may be used if they meet the following: 46,000 PSI minimum yield strength 62,000 PSI minimum tensile strength 21% minimum elongation in 2" Wall thickness (uncoated) shall be within the range of 0.248" to 0.304" Outside diameter (uncoated) shall be within the range of 2.855" to 2.895" Galvanization per ASTM A123 3. See the Traffic Operations Division website for detailed drawings of sign clamps and Texas Universal Triangular Slipbase System components. The website address is: http://www.txdot.gov/publications/traffic.htm 4. Sign supports shall not be spliced except where shown. Sign support posts shall not be spliced. ASSEMBLY PROCEDURE Foundation 1. Prepare 12-inch diameter by 42-inch deep hole. If solid rock is encountered, the depth of the foundation may be reduced such that it is embedded a minimum of 18 inches into the solid rock. 2. The Engineer may permit batches of concrete less than 2 cubic yards to be mixed with a portable, motor-driven concrete mixer. For small placements less than 0.5 cubic yards, hand mixing in a suitable container may be allowed by Engineer. Concrete shall be Class A. 3. Push the pipe end of the slip base stub into the center of the concrete. Rotate the stub back and forth while pushing it down into the concrete to assure good contact between the concrete and stub. Continue to work the stub into the concrete until it is between 2 to 4 inches above the ground. 4. Plumb the stub. Allow a minimum of 4 days to set, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer. 5. The triangular slipbase system is multidirectional and is designed to release when struck from any direction. Support 1. Cut support so that the bottom of the sign will be 7 to 7.5 feet above the edge of the travelway (i.e., edge of the closest lane) when slip plate is below the edge of pavement or 7 to 7.5 feet above slip plate when the slip plate is above the edge of the travelway. The cut shall be plumb and straight. 2. Attach sign to support using connections shown. When multiple signs are installed on the same support, ensure the minimum clearance between each sign is maintained. See SMD(SLIP-2) for clearances based on sign types. Concrete anchor consists of 5/8" diameter stud bolt with UNC series bolt threads on the upper end. Heavy hex nut per ASTM A563, and hardened washer per ASTM F436. The stud bolt shall have a minimum yield and ultimate tensile strength of 50 and 75 KSI, respectively. Nuts, bolts and washers shall be galvanized per Item 445, "Galvaniz- ing." Adhesive type anchors shall have stud bolts installed with Type III epoxy per DMS-6100, "Epoxies and Adhesives." Adhesive anchors may be loaded after adequate epoxy cure time per the manufacturer's recommendations. Top of bolt shall extend at least flush with top of the nut when installed. The anchor, when installed in 4000 psi normal- weight concrete with a 5 1/2" minimum embedment, shall have a minimum allowable tension and shear of 3900 and 3100 psi, respectively. 2.5 cf of concrete. should take approx. plans). Foundation elsewhere in the unless noted (shall be used concrete footing Non-reinforced rod or #4 rebar. 7" x 1/2" diameter Provide a 3/4 " diameter hole. Class A concrete provided to the Engineer by Contractor. Installation procedures shall be manufacturers' recommendations. The devices shall be installed per http://www.txdot.gov/business/producer list.htm List for approved slip base systems. Please reference the Material Producer for the Triangular Slipbase System. There are various devices approved NOTE 9-08 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 1:52:45 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smds1.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26B TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 105 Detail D Detail F REQUIRED SUPPORT SIGN DESCRIPTION 48x60-inch signs 36x48, 48x36, and 48x48-inch signs RegulatoryWarning48x48-inch signs (diamond or square) 48x60-inch signs Large Arrow sign (W1-6 & W1-7) 1 1 • 4 1 • 1 • W(max)=6FT 8 5W W 39 8 8 H W W-39 2 W(max)=6FT 3838 • 40 1.12 #/ft Wing Channel 1 • 6 1 "U" Extender 11FT 9IN (max) 0.2W H 0.6W 0.2W W W(max)=8FT SUPPORTPost Detail E STOP = 2 - 32 inch pieces YIELD = 1 - 8 inch piece & 1 - 32 inch piece or Extender U-Bracket lock washer. washers and bolt, nut, 2 flat assembly and install (through) after Drill 7/16" hole * 1 1/2" ONE-WAY Street Name Sign (if required) Gap between plaques shall be 4 + 1 PLAQUE = 1 - variable length 2. 3. 4. Sign supports shall not be spliced except where shown. and 0.125 for signs greater than 15 sq. ft. "REQUIRED SUPPORT" table on this sheet. 1. abnormally high due to a fill slope. GENERAL NOTES: when impacted by an errant vehicle. used in place of a 10 BWG where a sign height is The Engineer may require that a Schedule 80 post be Aluminum sign blanks shall conform to Departmental Material Specifications DMS-7110 and shall have the following minimum thicknesses: 0.080 for signs less than 7.5 sq. ft., 0.100 for signs 7.5 to 15 sq. ft., Signs that require specific supports due to reasons When two triangular slipbase supports are used to support a single sign, they shall not be "rigidly" connected to each other except through the sign panel. This will allow each support to act independently off so that it does not extend beyond the sign panel (i.e., excess support shall not be visible when the Additional route markers may be added vertically, maximum allowable amount per Note 1. Detail A Detail B Detail C Side View Top View Top View Item 445, "Galvanizing." galvanized per per ASTM A307 and flat washer nut, lock washer hex bolt with 5/16" x 3 3/4" Channel Wing Channel Wing Channel Wing Panel Sign Aluminum Panel Sign Aluminum Sign support posts shall not be spliced. galvanized per ASTM A 123. provided the total sign area does not exceed the sign is viewed from the front.) Repair galvanized coating at cut support ends per Item 445, "Galvanizing." SIGN SUPPORT # OF POSTS MAX. SIGN AREA 10 BWG 2 32 SF Sch 80 1 32 SF Sch 80 2 64 SF 10 BWG 1 16 SF bottom of sign when possible. Additional sign clamp required on the "T-bracket" post TOP VIEW Post Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp (see SMD(2-1)) Windbeam Aluminum Extruded Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(P) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(P-BM) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(U-WC) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(U) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(U) SM RD SGN ASSM TY S80(1)XX(U-1EXT)SM RD SGN ASSM TY S80(1)XX(U-2EXT) SM RD SGN ASSYM TY XXXXX(2)XX(P) TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(T) SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY S80(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY S80(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TRIANGULAR SLIPBASE SYSTEM SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS in addition to windloading are indicated on the "Galvanizing." Item 445, A307 galvanized per washers per ASTM washer and 2 flat hex bolt, nut, lock 1/2" x 4" heavy "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 2 flat washers nut, lock washer, hex bolt with 5/16" x 1 3/4" Nylon washer, "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 2 flat washers nut, lock washer, hex bolt with 5/16" x 1 3/4" Nylon washer, "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 and 2 flat washers nut, lock washer hex bolt with 5/16" x 3/4" Detail A See Detail B See Detail C See Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp Detail D See Splices shall only be allowed behind the sign substrate. pipe diameter.) clamp type and depending on sign length may vary "Galvanizing." (Bolt per Item 445 per ASTM A307 galvanized washer and lock washer head bolt, nut, flat 3/8" x 3 1/2" square Detail E See Detail F See Item 445 "Galvanizing." A307 galvanized per and 2 flat washers per ASTM bolt with nut, lock washer 3/8" x 3 1/2" heavy hex +.05" +.025"+.010" -.025"+.010" FRICTION CAP DETAIL Skirt Variation Depth engage pipe O.D. Rolled Crimp to Pipe O.D. Pipe O.D. Friction caps may be manufactured from hot rolled or cold rolled steel sheets. The minimum sheet metal The rim edges shall be reasonably straight and smooth. Caps shall be sized and formed in such a manner as to produce a drive-on friction fit and have no tendency to rock when seated on the pipe. The depth shall be sufficient to give positive protection against entrance of rainwater. They shall be free of sharp creases or indentations and show no evidence of metal fracture. Caps shall have an electrodeposited coating of zinc in accordance with the requirements of ASTM B633 Class FE/ZN 8. (R6-1) or STOP (R1-1) YIELD (R1-2) 0.25 H 1.75" max 1" min, SIDE VIEW T&U Bracket 48-inch STOP sign (R1-1) 60-inch YIELD sign (R1-2) 48x16-inch ONE-WAY sign (R6-1) 48-inch School X-ing sign (S2-1) 48-inch Advance School X-ing sign (S1-1) 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. For horizontal rectangular signs fabricated from flat Wing channel shall meet ASTM A 1011 SS Gr 50 and be aluminum, T-brackets are used for signs 24 inches or less in height. U-brackets are used for signs of greater height. SMD(SLIP-2)-08 (* - See Note 12) (See Note 11) 12.Post open ends shall be fitted with Friction Caps. (See SMD(2-1)) Extruded Alum. Windbeam unless detailed otherwise. All dimensions are in english plans. 13.Sign blanks shall be the sizes and shapes shown on the for 24 inch height signs. Place the clamp 3 inches above 9-08 Excess pipe, wing channel, or windbeam shall be cut thickness shall be 24 gauge for all cap sizes. Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 1:52:45 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smds2.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26C TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 106 SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(T-2EXT) 2 8" H W 2 W(max)=15FT * H W 0.7W W(max)=16FT 0.15W 0.15W W(min)>8FT See Detail A 1. GENERAL NOTES: Sign blanks shall be the sizes and shapes shown on Detail A Top View Channel Wing Detail B Channel Wing See Detail B Side View SIGN SUPPORT # OF POSTS MAX. SIGN AREA 10 BWG 1 16 SF 10 BWG 2 32 SF Sch 80 1 32 SF Sch 80 2 64 SF or 1.12 #/ft Wing Channel (See Detail A and Detail B) steel pipe Sch. 80 2 7/8" O.D. clamp Post Sign clamp Slip base 12" 12" .2w 6" variable Universal) (Specific or Clamps Sign details) for additional (See SMD(2-1) post clamps attached with stiffeners S3x5.7 8 1/2"8 1/2" 8" 39"W-39"W-39" Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp bottom of sign when possible. Additional sign clamp required on the "T-bracket" post for 24 inch high signs. Place the clamp 3 inches above SM RD SGN ASSM TY XXXXX(1)XX(U-XX) SM RD SGN ASSM TY S80(2)XX(P-EXAL) REQUIRED SUPPORT SIGN DESCRIPTION 48x60-inch signs 36x48, 48x36, and 48x48-inch signs RegulatoryWarning48x48-inch signs (diamond or square) 48x60-inch signs Large Arrow sign (W1-6 & W1-7) SUPPORT TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) TY 10BWG(1)XX(P-BM) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY S80(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY S80(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TY 10BWG(1)XX(T) TRIANGULAR SLIPBASE SYSTEM SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS "Galvanizing." per Item 445, ASTM A307 galvanized and lock washer per flat washer bolt, nut, square head 3/8" x 4 1/2" "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 2 flat washers nut, lock washer, hex bolt with 5/16" x 2 1/2" Nylon washer, "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 2 flat washers nut, lock washer, hex bolt with 5/16" x 4 1/2" Nylon washer, Detail C Extender T-Bracket lock washer. washers and bolt, nut, 2 flat assembly and install (through) after Drill 7/16" hole 1 1/2" Item 445 "Galvanizing." A307 galvanized per and 2 flat washers per ASTM bolt with nut, lock washer 3/8" x 4" heavy hex Splices shall only be allowed behind the sign substrate. See Detail C Use Extruded Alum. Windbeam as stiffeners 6" the plans. See SMD (2-1) for additional details Panel Sign w variable Panel Sign Typical Sign Mount * * Universal) (Specific or Sign Clamp "Galvanizing." Item 445, galvanized per per ASTM A307 2 flat washers nut, lock washer, hex bolt with 5/16" x 4 1/2" Nylon washer, Aluminum Panel Extruded head bolt and nut 3/8" x 1" square EXTRUDED ALUMINUM SIGN WITH T BRACKET Detail D Slip base T Bracket 6" 12" steel pipe Sch. 80 or 10BWG 2 7/8" O.D. Sign Extruded Aluminum See Detail D Sign Clamp sign for proper mounting. be placed at the top of 6" panel should 2. 3. 4. Sign supports shall not be spliced except where shown. and 0.125 for signs greater than 15 sq. ft. "REQUIRED SUPPORT" table on this sheet. abnormally high due to a fill slope. when impacted by an errant vehicle. used in place of a 10 BWG where a sign height is The Engineer may require that a Schedule 80 post be Aluminum sign blanks shall conform to Departmental Material Specifications DMS-7110 and shall have the following minimum thicknesses: 0.080 for signs less than 7.5 sq. ft., 0.100 for signs 7.5 to 15 sq. ft., Signs that require specific supports due to reasons When two triangular slipbase supports are used to support a single sign, they shall not be "rigidly" connected to each other except through the sign panel. This will allow each support to act independently off so that it does not extend beyond the sign panel (i.e., excess support shall not be visible when the Sign support posts shall not be spliced. galvanized per ASTM A 123. sign is viewed from the front.) Repair galvanized coating at cut support ends per Item 445, "Galvanizing." in addition to windloading are indicated on the 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. For horizontal rectangular signs fabricated from flat Wing channel shall meet ASTM A 1011 SS Gr 50 and be aluminum, T-brackets are used for signs 24 inches or less in height. U-brackets are used for signs of greater height. 10. 11. 48-inch STOP sign (R1-1) 60-inch YIELD sign (R1-2) 48x16-inch ONE-WAY sign (R6-1) 48-inch Advance School X-ing sign (S1-1) 48-inch School X-ing sign (S2-1) of signs when sign width is greater than 10'. Additional stiffener placed at approximate center 0.25 H SMD(SLIP-3)-08 (* - See Note 12) 12.Post open ends shall be fitted with Friction Caps. Detail E for clamp installation See Detail E for clamp installation See Detail E Extruded Alum. Windbeam (See Detail D on SMD (SLIP-2)) greater 24" or With T Bracket Extruded Aluminum Sign 9-08 Excess pipe, wing channel, or windbeam shall be cut Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 1:52:46 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smds3.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26D TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 107 Wedge Stub pipe Plastic Insert See Detail A 27" 30" 12" Dia 10" 14" 30" 12" Dia Post Detail A * 0.2W H 0.6W 0.2W W W(max)=8FT Note 4) (See General Post Note 4) (See General Post Sign Installation Using a Prefabricated T-Bracket for Thin-Wall Tubing Post (* - See General Note 6) T-Bracket SM RD SGN ASSM TY TWT(X)WS(X) SM RD SGN ASSM TY TWT(X)UA(P) View A-A reusability. for optimal ground 1/4" above flush to should be Tubular socket Socket Tubular (Approx.) 3" of concrete. approx. 2.0 cf should take Foundation in the plans). elsewhere unless noted (shall be used Footing Concrete Non-reinforced of concrete. approx. 2.0 cf should take Foundation in the plans). elsewhere unless noted (shall be used Footing Concrete Non-reinforced (3" Nominal) Stub Pipe Schedule 40 Diameter 3 1/2" (3" Nominal) Stub Pipe Schedule 40 Diameter 3 1/2" Ring Compression (2" Nominal) Wall Tube 0.095 Thin 2.375" Diameter Spaced) Slots (4 Equally 1/4 x 2 7/8" A A 6" min or joint to edge 10" 10"Pipe Stub Plate Base Coupler 3/4" dia. 1/2" 3 1/2" Concrete anchor consists of 5/8" diameter stud bolt with UNC series bolt threads on the upper end. A heavy hex nut washers shall be galvanized per Item 445, "Galvanizing." Adhesive type anchors shall have stud bolts installed with Adhesive anchors may be loaded after adequate epoxy cure per ASTM A563 and hardened washer per ASTM F436. The time per the manufacturer's recommendations. allowable tension and shear of 2450 and 1525 psi, respectively. Top of bolt shall extend at least flush with top of nut when installed. The anchor, when installed in 4000 psi normal-weight concrete with a 3 3/8" minimum embedment, shall have a minimum stud bolt shall have minimum yield and ultimate tensile Type III epoxy per DMS-6100, "Epoxies and Adhesives." SM RD SGN ASSM TY TWT(X)UB(P) adhesive type. expansion or Anchor may be to min. of 50 ft-lbs). 3 3/8" and torque (embed a min. of Anchor - 4 places 5/8" diameter Concrete Note 4) (See General Post used with the Bolt Down Universal Anchor System. System. The insert should be cut to approx. 4 1/2" when the bottom of the sign post when using the Universal Anchor cover the tubing from just above the top of the stub pipe to Anchor System. The insert should be approx. 10" long and the Universal Anchor System or the Bolt Down Universal Plastic insert must be used when using the TWT with either with Thin-Walled Tubing Post Universal Anchor System A A WITH THIN WALL TUBING POST WEDGE & UNIVERSAL ANCHOR SMALL ROADSIDE SIGNS SIGN MOUNTING DETAILS SM RD SGN ASSM TY TWT(X)XX(T) 12" bolt. post to accommodate to be drilled through 9/16" hole may need strengths of 50 and 75 ksi, respectively. Nuts, bolts and "Galvanizing." per Item 445, galvanized ASTM A307 washer per and lock flatwashers bolt, nut, 2 heavy hex 1/2" x 4" Wedge 17" 30" SMD RD SGN ASSM TY TWT(X)WP(X) (Approx.) 3" of concrete. approx. 2.0 cf should take Foundation in the plans). elsewhere unless noted (shall be used Footing Concrete Non-reinforced 15" Note 4) (See General Post 12" Dia Steel System Wedge Anchor (HDPE) System Polyethylene High Density Wedge Anchor Anchor (Slip-2) detail on SMD or Plug. See Friction Cap 0.25 H Installation procedures shall be provided to the Engineer by Contractor. The devices shall be installed per manufacturer's recommendations. NOTE SMD(TWT)-08 foundation. turning in the stub from and prevents the sign post as a "stop" for steel rod acts 1/2" x 7 1/2" Concrete Class A Concrete Class A Concrete Class A GENERAL NOTES: 1. The Wedge Anchor System and the Universal Anchor System with thin wall tubing post may be used to support up to 10 square feet of sign area. 2. The tubular socket, wedge and prefabricated T-bracket shall be permanently marked to indicate manufacturer. Method, design, and location of marking are subject to the approval of the TxDOT Traffic Standards Engineer. 3. Except for posts (13 BWG Tubing), clamps, nuts and bolts, all components shall be prequalified. A list of prequalified vendors may be obtained from the Material Producer List web page. The website address is: http://www.txdot.gov/business/producer list.htm 4. Material used as post with this system shall conform to the following specifications: 13 BWG Tubing (2.375" outside diameter) (TWT) 0.095" nominal wall thickness Seamless or electric-resistance welded steel tubing Steel shall be HSLAS Gr 55 per ASTM A1011 or ASTM A1008 Other steels may be used if they meet the following: 55,000 PSI minimum yield strength 70,000 PSI minimum tensile strength 18% minimum elongation in 2" Wall thickness (uncoated) shall be within the range of .083" to .099" Outside diameter (uncoated) shall be within the range of 2.369" to 2.381" Galvanization per ASTM 123 or ASTM A653 G210. For precoated steel tubing (ASTM A653), recoat tube outside diameter weld seam by metallizing with zinc wire per ASTM B833. 5. Sign blanks shall be the sizes and shapes shown on the plans. 6. Additional sign clamp required on the "T-bracket" post for 24" high signs. Place clamp at least 3" above bottom of sign when possible. 7. Sign supports shall not be spliced except where shown. Sign support posts shall not be spliced. 8. See the Traffic Operations Division website for detailed drawings of sign clamps and Wedge Anchor System components. The website address is: http://www.txdot.gov/publications/traffic.htm WEDGE ANCHOR SYSTEM INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Dig foundation hole. Where solid rock is encountered at ground level, the foundation shall be a minimum depth of 18". When solid rock is encountered below ground level, the foundation shall extend in the solid rock a minimum depth of 18" or provide a minimum foundation depth of 30". If solid rock is encountered, the socket/stub may be reduced in length as required to a minimum length of 18". Any material removed from the socket/stub shall be from the bottom and the clearance requirements given on SMD(GEN) must be followed. The inner surfaces of the socket/stub must remain free of concrete or other debris. 2. The Engineer may permit batches of concrete less than 2 cubic yards to be mixed with a portable, motor driven concrete mixer. For small placements less than 0.5 cubic yards, hand mixing in a suitable container may be allowed by Engineer. Place concrete into hole until it is approximately flush with the ground. Concrete shall be Class A. 3. Insert tubular socket into concrete until top of socket is approximaely 1/4 " above the concrete footing. 4. Plumb the socket. Allow a minimum 4 days for concrete to set, unless otherwise directed by Engineer.. 5. Attach the sign to the sign post. 6. Insert the sign post into socket and align sign face with roadway. 7. Drive the wedge into the socket to secure post. This will leave approximately 3 inches of the wedge exposed. UNIVERSAL ANCHOR SYSTEM INSTALLATION PROCEDURE 1. Dig foundation hole. Where solid rock is encountered at ground level, the foundation shall be a minimum depth of 18". When solid rock is encountered below ground level, the foundation shall extend in the solid rock a minimum depth of 18" or provide a minimum foundation depth of 30". If solid rock is encountered, the socket/stub may be reduced in length as required to a minimum length of 18". Any material removed from the socket/stub shall be from the bottom and the clearance requirements given on SMD(GEN) must be followed. The inner surfaces of the socket/stub must remain free of concrete or other debris. 2. Insert base post in hole to depths shown and backfill hole with concrete. 3. Level and plumb the base post using a torpedo level and allow concrete adequate time to set. The bottom of the slots provided in the stub pipe shall remain above the top of the concrete foundation. 4. Attach the sign to the sign post. 5. Install plastic insert around bottom of post. 6. Insert sign post into base post. Lower until the post comes to rest on steel rod. 7. Seat compression ring using a hammer. Typically, the top of compression ring will be approximately level with top of stub post when optimally installed. 8. Check sign post by hand to ensure it is unable to turn. If loose, increase the tightening of the compression ring. 9-08 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 1:52:48 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\smdtwt.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2002 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 26E TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 108 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT REQUIREMENTS TYPICAL SIGN of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\tsr3-13.dgn8/5/20201:52:48 PMDOCUMENT NAMEDATE TIMEOctober 2003 3 12-03 9-08 TSR(3)-13 7-13 tsr3-13.dgn 109 http://www.txdot.gov/ can be found at the following website. The Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas (SHSD) Square Feet 0.080 Less than 7.5 Greater than 15 0.125 0.100 7.5 to 15 Minimum Thickness ALUMINUM SIGN BLANKS THICKNESS USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL WHITELEGEND & BORDERS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS BACKGROUND TYPE A SHEETING LEGEND & BORDERS BLACK ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE FILM ALL OTHERS BACKGROUND TYPE A SHEETINGWHITE TYPE B OR C SHEETING DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS ALUMINUM SIGN BLANKS DMS-7110 SIGN FACE MATERIALS DMS-8300 USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL WHITELEGEND & BORDERS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS TYPE D SHEETING BACKGROUND TYPE B OR C SHEETING & BORDERS LEGEND, SYMBOLS ALL ALL OTHERS TYPE B OR C SHEETING D AND I SERIES GUIDE SIGNS REQUIREMENTS FOR BLUE, BROWN & GREEN F CV-6W Emod CV-5WR E CV-4W D CV-3W C CV-2W B CV-1W TYPE B or C SHEETINGLEGEND & BORDERS ALL OTHERS TYPICAL EXAMPLES GENERAL NOTES ROUTE SIGNS REQUIREMENTS FOR INDEPENDENT MOUNTED Plan Sheets. 8. Mounting details of roadside signs are shown in the "SMD series" Standard Specification requirements of DMS-7110 or approved alternative. 7. Sign substrate shall be any material that meets the Departmental Material widths. The sign area outside the corner radius should be trimmed or rounded. 1 inch. Borders and corner radii within a parent sign must be of matching much as 1/2 inch. Corner radii above 3 inches may vary in width as much as and corner radii on parent sign are nominal. Borders may vary in width as Highway Sign Designs for Texas". Dimensions shown and described for borders 6. Information regarding borders and radii for signs is found in the "Standard colored background sheeting. and borders on all other signs shall be cut-out white sheeting applied to to colored background sheeting, or combination thereof. White legend, symbols colored overlay film to white background sheeting or cut-out white sheeting shall be applied by screening process with transparent color ink, transparent 5. Independent mounted route sign with white or colored legend and borders a balanced appearance when spacing is not shown. and any approved changes thereto. Lateral spacing of legend shall provide 4. Lateral spacing between letters and numerals shall conform with the SHSD, or F). Highway Administration (FHWA) Standard Highway Alphabets B, C, D, E, Emod 3. Route sign legend (ie. IH, US, SH and FM shields) shall use the Federal plans. (FHWA) Standard Highway Alphabets, when not specified in the SHSD, or in the shall be used to replace the existing white Federal Highway Administration 2. White legend shall use the Clearview Alphabet. The following Clearview fonts can be found in the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas" (SHSD). shown on sign tabulation sheet. Standard sign designs and arrow dimensions 1. Signs to be furnished shall be as detailed elsewhere in the plans and/or as TYPICAL EXAMPLES Standard Division Operations Traffic DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1326847\tsr4-13.dgn8/5/20201:52:49 PMDOCUMENT NAMEDATE TIMEOctober 2003 4 REQUIREMENTS FOR SCHOOL SIGNS TYPICAL EXAMPLES 12-03 9-08 TSR(4)-13 110 7-13 tsr4-13.dgn GENERAL NOTES TYPICAL EXAMPLES Square Feet 0.080 Less than 7.5 Greater than 15 0.125 0.100 7.5 to 15 WRONG WAY SIGNS) (STOP, YIELD, DO NOT ENTER AND TYPICAL EXAMPLES WRONG WAY SIGNS) (EXCLUDING STOP, YIELD, DO NOT ENTER AND REQUIREMENTS FOR WARNING SIGNS FL Minimum Thickness BACKGROUND USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL RED LEGEND & BORDERS WHITE BACKGROUND USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL TYPE A SHEETING BLACK WHITE BACKGROUND USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL BLACK WHITE ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE FILM BACKGROUND TYPE B OR C SHEETING http://www.txdot.gov/ can be found at the following website. The Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas (SHSD) BACKGROUND USAGE COLOR SIGN FACE MATERIAL LEGEND & SYMBOLS ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE FILM FL FL FL ALL OTHER BLACK TYPE B OR C SHEETING REGULATORY SIGNS REQUIREMENTS FOR WHITE BACKGROUND REGULATORY SIGNS REQUIREMENTS FOR RED BACKGROUND ALL OTHER BACKGROUND WHITE TYPE B OR C SHEETING LEGEND RED TYPE B OR C SHEETING AND SYMBOLS LEGEND,BORDERS AND SYMBOLS LEGEND,BORDERS TYPE B OR C SHEETING YELLOW FLOURESCENT LEGEND & BORDERS AND SYMBOLS LEGEND,BORDERS YELLOW GREEN FLOURESCENT DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS ALUMINUM SIGN BLANKS THICKNESS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS SHEETING REQUIREMENTS ALUMINUM SIGN BLANKS DMS-7110 SIGN FACE MATERIALS DMS-8300 SPECIFIC SIGNS ONLY REQUIREMENTS FOR FOUR BACKGROUND ALL OTHERS Standard Plan Sheets. 8. Mounting details for roadside mounted signs are shown in the "SMD series" Specification requirements of DMS-7110 or approved alternative. 7. Sign substrate shall be any material that meets the Departmental Material sheeting, or combination thereof. ink, transparent colored overlay film or colored sheeting to background 6. Colored legend shall be applied by screening process with transparent colored cut-out white sheeting to colored background sheeting, or combination thereof. colored ink, transparent colored overlay film to white background sheeting or 5. White legend and borders shall be applied by screening process with transparent thereof. acrylic non-reflective black film to background sheeting, or combination 4. Black legend and borders shall be applied by screening process or cut-out a balanced appearance when spacing is not shown. and any approved changes thereto. Lateral spacing of legend shall provide 3. Lateral spacing between letters and numerals shall conform with the SHSD, Standard Highway Alphabets (B, C, D, E, Emod or F). 2. Sign legend shall use the Federal Highway Administration (FHWA) can be found in the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas" (SHSD). shown on sign tabulation sheet. Standard sign designs and arrow dimensions 1. Signs to be furnished shall be as detailed elsewhere in the plans and/or as TYPE B OR C SHEETING SYMBOLS RED TYPE B OR C SHEETING TYPE B OR C SHEETING TYPE B OR C SHEETING ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE FILM TYPE A SHEETINGTYPE B OR C SHEETING REQUIREMENTS TYPICAL SIGN Standard Division Operations Traffic GENERAL NOTES 111SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:39 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS GENERAL NOTES CABINET TO ALL SIGNAL PHASES & OVERLAPS. 19. CONTRACTOR SHALL HAVE QUALIFIED PERSONNEL TO ENSURE CORRECT WIRING AND PROGRAMMING IN THE CONSTRUCTED AS PART OF ROADWAY CONSTRUCTION. REFER TO ROADWAY PLANS FOR DETAILS. 18. PAVEMENT MARKINGS, INTERSECTION MODIFICATION, SIGN INSTALLATION AND PED RAMPS WILL BE 17. ALL CONDUIT SHALL BE PVC SCHEDULE 40. RECEIVED BY THE CONTRACTOR AND APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. 16. SIGNAL HEADS SHALL NOT BE PLACED OVER THE ROADWAY UNTIL ALL NECESSARY MATERIALS HAVE BEEN 15. ALL SIGNAL HEADS SHALL HAVE 12-INCH L.E.D. INDICATIONS AND FLAT BLACK, POLYCARBONATE BACKPLATES. 14. EXISTING SIGNAL EQUIPMENT WILL REMAIN AS SHOWN IN THE PLAN. OF DENTON'S ENGINEER FOR FINAL APPROVAL. 13. ANY CONFLICTS OF TXDOT STANDARDS AND CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS WILL NEED TO BE BROUGHT TO CITY 12. ALL CONDUIT UNDER ROADWAYS SHALL BE BORED. TO THE DENSITY OF ADJACENT AREA. COMPACT, AND RESTORE THE TRENCHED AREA TO ORIGINAL CONDITIONS AND MATCH EXISTING SURFACE CONDITIONS AS PER TXDOT STANDARD, EXCEPT WHERE NOTED OTHERWISE IN PLANS. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL BACK FILL, 11. ALL PROPOSED CONDUITS UNDER NATURAL GROUND SHALL BE TRENCHED AND BURIED A MINIMUM OF 18 INCHES, PRIOR TO CONSTRUCTION. BE DETERMINED IN THE FIELD. CONTRACTOR SHALL RECEIVE FINAL APPROVAL FROM CITY OF DENTON ENGINEER 10. EXACT LOCATION OF POLES, CONTROLLER, GROUND BOXES, SIGNAL HEADS, SIGNS, ADVANCED RADARS SHALL SIGNAL POLE SHALL BE ADA COMPLIANT. BE MODIFIED TO ACCOMMODATE INSTALLED FIELD CONDITIONS. THE LOCATION OF THE PEDESTAL AND TRAFFIC 9. THE RAMPS LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE AND THE LOCATION OF THE PEDESTAL AND TRAFFIC SIGNAL POLE MAY SIGNAL EQUIPMENT AND EXISTING OVERHEAD POWER LINES. 8. MAINTAIN A MINIMUM CLEARANCE OF 6' RADIUS FROM NEUTRAL AND 10' RADIUS BETWEEN PROPOSED TRAFFIC INSPECTION. 7. CONTRACTOR SHALL RESTORE THE CONSTRUCTION AREA TO ORIGINAL OR FINISHED CONDITION PRIOR TO FINAL NOTICE PRIOR TO ANY EXCAVATION, BORING, TRENCHING OR PUSHING PIPE WITHIN PROJECT LIMITS. 6. CONTRACTOR SHALL CONTACT 811 AND OTHER UTILITY PROVIDERS WITH A MINIMUM OF 48 HOURS ADVANCE PRESERVE AND PROTECT THESE UTILITIES, WHETHER UNDERGROUND, ABOVE GROUND OR OVERHEAD. COMMENCING WORK AND IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THEIR FAILURE TO LOCATE, 5. IT IS THE CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO LOCATE ALL UTILITIES (PUBLIC AND PRIVATE) PRIOR TO EXISTING CONDUIT BEFORE CONSTRUCTION. 4. AS BUILT PLANS ARE NOT ACCURATE BASED ON THE EXISTING CONDITION. CONTRACTOR SHALL IDENTIFY SHALL BE REPLACED TO TXDOT STANDARDS. 3. ANY EXISTING PAVEMENT, CURBS, SIDEWALKS, AND DRIVEWAYS DAMAGED OR REMOVED DURING CONSTRUCTION CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS, AND SPECIFICATIONS AS IDENTIFIED IN THE PLANS. 2. ALL CONSTRUCTION RELATED TO THIS TRAFFIC SIGNAL SHALL BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH TXDOT STANDARDS, ITEM. BUT OMITTED ARE THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE CONTRACTOR AND SHALL BE SUBSIDIARY TO THE APPROPRIATE BID 1. THE INTENTION OF THESE PLANS TO PROVIDE A FULLY OPERATIONAL TRAFFIC SIGNAL. ANY ITEMS REQUIRED SIGNALS AND PROPOSED POLES AS PER THE DIRECTION FROM CITY. 31. FOR NOTTINGHAM DRIVE AND UNIVERSITY DRIVE, EXISTING CONDUITS WILL BE USED TO RUN THE CONDUCTORS FOR PED TXDOT STANDARDS. THIS ITEM WILL BE SUBSIDIARY TO ITEM 680. WIND DAMPERS SHALL NOT BE INSTALLED ON LMA POLES. 30. CONTRACTOR SHALL INSTALL WIND DAMPERS ON MAST ARMS 40 FEET AND LONGER TO MINIMIZE VIBRATION, BASED ON CONFLICT WITH OVERHEAD ELECTRICAL LINES. AND CODY TENORIOAT AT DME (940-349-7532) NEED TO BE INFORMED BEFORE INSTALLATION OF LUMINAIRES TO AVOID ANY LUMINAIRE AT SHERMAN DRIVE AND LOOP 288. CITY ENGINEER CHANDRA MURUGANANDHAM, P.E., P.T.O.E. (940-349-8402) 29. INSTALL 400 W LED LUMINAIRE AT NOTTINGHAM DRIVE AND UNIVERSITY DRIVE AT TWO CORNERS AND INSTALL 240 W LED LED TO AVOID LIGHT SPILLOVER OUTSIDE THE R.O.W. 28. ALL PROPOSED LUMINAIRES AT UNIVERSITY DRIVE AND NOTTINGHAM DRIVE SHALL BE FULL CUTOFF AND PROGRAMMABLE PER THE DIRECTION FROM CITY. 27. A 4" STUB OUT FROM THE CONTROLLER SHALL BE PROVIDED FOR FUTURE INTERCONNECT AT LOOP 288 AND SHERMAN DRIVE TOP OF THE APPLICABLE ROADWAY CROWN. 26. MOUNTING HEIGHT OF 20.5 FT IS REQUIRED FOR MAST ARM SIGNAL HEADS FROM THE BOTTOM OF THE BACK PLATE TO THE FIELD BY THE CITY ENGINEER PRIOR TO INSTALLATION. COMMENCING AND CONSTRUCTION WORK ON THIS SIGNAL. SIGNAL POLE FOUNDATION LOCATIONS SHALL BE APPROVED IN THE 25. CONTACT CITY OF DENTON'S TRAFFIC ENGINEER CHANDRA MURUGANANDHAM, P.E., P.T.O.E. AT 940-349-8402 PRIOR TO 24. SIGNAL FOUNDATION SHALL BE FLUSH WITH SIDEWALK. STREETS AND BRIDGES, AND THE TEXAS MANUAL ON UNIFORM TRAFFIC CONTROL DEVICES FOR STREETS AND HIGHWAYS. ACCORDANCE WITH THE LATEST EDITIONS OF TXDOT STANDARD AND SPECIFICATIONS FOR CONSTRUCTION OF HIGHWAYS, 23. ALL PAVEMENT MARKINGS, MARKERS, PAINT, TRAFFIC BUTTONS, TRAFFIC CONTROLS AND SIGNS SHALL BE INSTALLED IN SIGNAL ACTIVATION. 22. COORDINATE WITH CITY OF DENTON ON SIGNAL TIMING AND PHASING A MINIMUM OF TWO (2) WEEKS PRIOR TO TRAFFIC THE PUSH BUTTONS. 21. SIDEWALKS SHOULD BE EXTENDED UP TO THE SIGNAL/PEDESTAL POLES AS NEEDED TO PROVIDE PEDESTRIAN ACCESS TO THE APS SHALL BE PROGRAMMED BY A MANUFACTURERS REPRESENTATIVE IN ACCORDANCE WITH SPECIFICATIONS AND TMUTCD. iv) A SPEECH PUSH BUTTON INFORMATION MESSAGE. iii) A SPEECH WALK MESSAGE FOR THE WALKING PERSON INDICATION, AND ii) A TACTILE ARROW i) PUSH BUTTON LOCATOR TONE ON SAME POLE, EACH ACCESSIBLE PUSH BUTTON MUST HAVE THE FOLLOWING FEATURES: SIGNAL UNITS CONFORMING TO TXDOT ITEM 688. IF TWO ACCESSIBLE PUSH BUTTONS ARE SPACED LESS THAN 10' APART OR 20. PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTONS SHOULD CONFORM TO CURRENT ADA STANDARDS AND SHOULD BE ACCESSIBLE PEDESTRIAN 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE EXISTING LAYOUT 112SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:40 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND GUY WIRE FENCE WATER VALVE FIRE HYDRANT TRAFFIC FLOW EX. R.O.W. EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC EX. CONDUIT EX. GROUND BOX EX. METER SERVICE EX. PED PUSH BUTTON EX. PREEMPTION EX. PTZ CAMERA EX. LUMINAIRE EX. ANTENNA EX. CONTROLLER CABINET EX. PRESENCE RADAR DETECTOR EX. SIGN ON MAST ARM EX. SIGNAL HEAD EX. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 101+00102+00103+00102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 EXISTING SIGNAL HEADS S6 S2EX. R.O.W. E2 S2 S1 E1 S8 E7 S6 UNIVERSITY DR 1900 E 2000 NOTTINGHAM DR 24002300 UNIVERSITY DR 2000 E 1900 R Y G GY R GY R G YE2 E7 EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. S8 NOTTINGHAM DR 23002400 S4 ON GREEN YIELD LEFT TURN NOTES CAUTION S4 (SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DR (SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DR NOTTINGHAM DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) NOTTINGHAM DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) EXISTING POWER METER TO REMAIN EXISTING PRESENCE RADAR TO BE REMOVED E3* S3* E8* S7* EXISTING CONTROLLER AND CABINET TO REMAIN EXISTING GROUND BOX TO BE REPLACED EXISTING GROUND BOX TO REMAIN EXISTING GROUND BOX TO REMAIN EXISTING SIGNAL POLE TO REMAIN EXISTING SIGNAL POLE TO BE REMOVED EXISTING SIGNAL POLE TO REMAIN BE REPLACED EXISTING OPTICOM TO TO BE REPLACED EXISTING GROUND BOX RADAR TO BE REMOVED EXISTING PRESENCE W1 W2 S5 E6 EPB3** EPB5** W1 W2 W4 EPB4 EPB1 EPB2 EXISTING SIGNS S5*,S7* S1,S3* O HPUS BUTTON F R O HPUS BUTTON FR EPB2 EPB4EPB1EPB3 EPB6*EPB5** **-EXISTING SIGNS TO BE REMOVED *-EXISTING SIGNS TO BE REPLACED EPB6* W3** W4 EXISTING PTZ CAMERA TO REMAIN ***-EXISTING SIGNAL HEAD TO REMAIN **-EXISTING SIGNAL HEAD TO BE REMOVED *-EXISTING SIGNAL HEAD TO BE REPLACED W6** ANY DAMAGED UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR PRIOR TO DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR WILL LOCATE ALL UTILITIES UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE. LOCATION IN THE FIELD. 6. LOCATIONS OF THE EXISTING GROUND BOXES AND CONDUITS ARE APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR TO VERIFY 5. IT IS CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITY TO MAKE SURE THE SIGNAL IS OPERATIONAL AT ALL TIMES. FOR DETAILS. 4. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE MODIFIED. REFER TO ROADWAY PLAN SET OF THE PROPOSED SIGNAL EQUIPMENT AND FINAL SIGNAL TURN -ON. 3. SALVAGE REMOVED EXISTING SIGNAL EQUIPMENT AND RETURN TO CITY OF DENTON AFTER INSTALLATION PROTECT THE UTILITY INCLUDING EXISTING GROUND BOXES AND CONDUITS DURING CONSTRUCTION. 2. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS FAILURE TO LOCATE, PRESERVE AND IT IS CONTRACTORS RESPONSIBILITY TO PRESERVE AND PROTECT THESE ITEMS. 1. AS PER DIRECTION FROM CITY, EXISTING GROUND BOX, CONDUITS, AND CONDUCTORS WILL BE REUSED. W3** E1E3*E6 E8* EXISTING POLE TO BE REMOVED E5*** E4*** E9*** E10*** E4***E5*** E9***E10*** E11*** E11*** W6** W5* W5* 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE PROPOSED LAYOUT 113SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:42 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND FENCE WATER VALVE FIRE HYDRANT TRAFFIC FLOW PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W. EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC EX. CONDUIT EX. GROUND BOX EX. METER SERVICE EX. PTZ CAMERA EX. LUMINAIRE EX. CONTROLLER CABINET EX. SIGN ON MAST ARM EX. PED SIGNAL HEAD EX. SIGNAL HEAD EX. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM PROP. PED PUSH BUTTON PROP. RADAR ADVANCE PROP. ANTENNA PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. OPTICOM PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. VERTICAL POLE PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. PED SIGNAL HEAD PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 101+00102+00103+00102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 P200 NOTES ET400 (NOT TO SCALE) P400EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. PROPOSED SIGNS AR401AR201P300 (SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DR(SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DRH101 S101 H102 H103 S102 PROPOSED SIGNAL HEADS TURNEFT FLASHIN YIEL YELL WO ARROW L D ON G ONLY ONLYONLY P300 TRAVEL DIRECTION SIGN PUSH BUTTON POLE NUMBERP### P301 P200 ET400 P400 P100 T100 PROPOSED ILSN SIGNS* University DRE 1900 2000 INSTALLATION. THEM FROM CITY PRIOR TO SIGNS. CONTRACTOR TO OBTAIN *CITY TO FABRICATE ILSN Y GR H3BH4FL Y GRY FY (SEE NOTE 7) RELOCATED BY DME EX. POWER POLE TO BE T300 S303 30 X 48 R3-8b S102,S302 EX. R.O.W. H104 EX. POLE TO REMAIN H305 REMAIN EX. POWER METER TO H105 P100 H202 H201 H301 H401S201 S40148 X 30 R10-17T S301,S401 S101,S201 (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) NOTTINGHAM DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) NOTTINGHAM DR ET200 H302 S302 S301 H303 University DRE 2000 1900 S103 (1 EA) S303 (1 EA) S103 H304 R .O.W. PR OP . PB7 PB8 PB3 PB5 PB6 P101 ET200 H203 H403 PB4 UTILITIES. RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGED BORING. CONTRACTOR IS FULLY UTILITIES PRIOR TO DRILLING AND CONTRACTOR WILL LOCATE ALL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE. CAUTION P301 T100 H402 PB2 PB1 SEE DETAIL A DETAIL A H302,H303 H102,H103 H301,H401 H101,H201 REMAIN EX. POLE TO SEE DETAIL B DETAIL B AND SIGN LAYOUT PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON CABINET TO REMAIN EX. CONTROLLER AND REMAIN CAMERA TO EX. PTZ CONTRACTORS RESPONSIBILITY TO PRESERVE AND PROTECT THESE ITEMS. 9.AS PER DIRECTION FROM CITY, EXISTING GROUND BOX, CONDUITS, AND CONDUCTORS WILL BE REUSED. IT IS BE REUSED. 8. ALL PED PUSH BUTTONS AND PED SIGNAL HEADS WILL BE REMOVED AND REPLACED. PED DETECT CONTROLLER UNIT WILL INSTALLING. 7. EXISTING POWER ON SE CORNER TO BE RELOCATED BY DME. CONTACT CODY TENORIOAT 940-349-7532 BEFORE TOP OF THE APPLICABLE ROADWAY CROWN. 6. MOUNTING HEIGHT OF 20.5FT IS REQUIRED FOR MAST ARM SIGNAL HEADS FROM THE BOTTOM OF THE BACK PLATE TO THE 18 INCH REACH FROM THE FLAT LANDING AREA. 5. CONTRACTOR TO FIELD ADJUST THE MOUNTING HEIGHT OF THE PUSH BUTTON TO ENSURE THAT IT IS ACCESSIBLE WITHIN 4. THE PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON CONTROLS SHALL HAVE BOTH AUDIBLE AND TACTILE CAPABILITIES. PART OF ROADWAY CONSTRUCTION. REFER TO ROADWAY PLANS FOR DETAILS. 3. PAVEMENT MARKINGS, INTERSECTION MODIFICATIONS, SIGN INSTALLATION AND PED RAMPS WILL BE CONSTRUCTED AS 2. INSTALL 400 W LED LUMINAIRE ON T100 AND T300. COORDINATE WITH CITY AND DME BEFORE INSTALLING. BE REQUIRED. 1. PROPOSED SIGNALS TO BE SWITCHED OVERNIGHT. THE ASSISTANCE OF LAW ENFORCEMENT TO CONTROL THE SIGNAL MAY 9" X 15" R10-3eL PB4,PB8 9" X 15" R10-3eR PB5,PB6,PB7 PB1,PB2,PB3 H304,H305,H402,H403 H104,H105,H202,H203 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE PROPOSED CONDUIT LAYOUT 114SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:44 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS101+00102+00103+00102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 C301 CAUTION UTILITIES. RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGED BORING. CONTRACTOR IS FULLY UTILITIES PRIOR TO DRILLING AND CONTRACTOR WILL LOCATE ALL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE. NOTES EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.EGB300 C1* EGB200 C202 C201* NOTTINGHAM DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) NOTTINGHAM DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH) C106 C101*,C102* EX. R.O.W. C304** C303* P100 P200 T100 ET400 P400 C404 C403* C103* C104,C105 C402** C401*R.O.W .PROP. P101 T300 P300 C302,C305 ET200 GB100*** GB101*** GB400*** P301 LOCATION. REPLACED BY THE PROPOSED AT THE SAME 6.***-THE EXISTING GROUND BOX TO BE WIRING. THE EXISTING CONDUIT FOR LUMINAIRE 5.**-PROPOSED CONDUITS PLACED NEXT TO CONDUCTORS, AS PER DIRECTION FROM CITY. CONDUITS WILL BE USED FOR THE PROPOSED 4. *-CONDUITS ALREADY IN PLACE. EXISTING TO ROADWAY PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE MODIFIED. REFER 3. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND OPERATIONAL DURING ALL THE TIME. 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN THE SIGNAL CONDUITS DURING CONSTRUCTION. INCLUDING EXISTING GROUND BOXES AND PRESERVE AND PROTECT THE UTILITY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS FAILURE TO LOCATE, 1. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DETAIL C T100 C107 C103* C2* C306 P101 DETAIL C SEE (SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DR(SPEED LI MI T = 45 MPH)E UNI VERSI TY DRLEGEND FENCE WATER VALVE FIRE HYDRANT TRAFFIC FLOW PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W. EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC EX. CONDUIT EX. GROUND BOX EX. METER SERVICE EX. PTZ CAMERA EX. LUMINAIRE EX. CONTROLLER CABINET EX. SIGN ON MAST ARM EX. PED SIGNAL HEAD EX. SIGNAL HEAD EX. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM PROP. PED PUSH BUTTON PROP. RADAR ADVANCE PROP. ANTENNA PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. OPTICOM PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. VERTICAL POLE PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. PED SIGNAL HEAD PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE TRAFFIC SIGNAL DETAILS 115SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:45 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS PROPOSED SIGNAL HEADS AND POLE SUMMARY PROPOSED 21C TERMINATION CHART PROPOSED 7C TERMINATION CHART EXISTING ELECTRICAL SERVICE DETAILS*** CORNER NE NW SW SE POLE TYPE T ET P T P ET P POLE #100 200 200 300 300 400 400 HEAD NUMBER H101 H102 H103 H104 H105 H201 H202 H203 H301 H302 H303 H304 H305 H401 H402 H403 HEAD TYPE H4FL H3B H3B P P H4FL P P H4FL H3B H3B P P H4FL P P 1 RED RA(L)RB RB DW DW RA(L)DW DW RA(L)RB RB DW DW RA(L)DW DW 2 ORANGE SPARE YB YB SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE YB YB SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE 3 GREEN SPARE GB GB W W SPARE W W SPARE GB GB W W SPARE W W 4 BLACK YA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE YA(L)SPARE SPARE YA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE YA(L)SPARE SPARE 5 BLUE GA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE GA(L)SPARE SPARE GA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE GA(L)SPARE SPARE 6 BLACK/WHITE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE 7 WHITE/BLACK COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMOM COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON CABLE CONDUCTOR TYPE HEAD IDENTIFIER 1 RED VH MRB 2 ORANGE VH MYB 3 GREEN VH MGB 4 BLACK VH MYA(L) 5 BLUE VH MGA(L) 6 RED/WHITE N/A PED COMMON 7 GREEN/WHITE PH MD 8 BLACK/RED PH MW 9 ORANGE/WHITE PH XD 10 RED/BLACK PH XW 11 ORANGE/BLACK VH XRB 12 GREEN/BLACK VH XYB 13 WHITE/BLACK VH XGB 14 BLUE/BLACK VH XYA(F) 15 BLACK/WHITE VH MRA(L) 16 BLUE/WHITE VH XYA(F) 17 WHITE/RED VH XGA(F) 18 BLUE/RED VH MYA(F) 19 RED/GREEN VH MGA(O) 20 ORANGE/GREEN VH MYA(O) 21 WHITE N/A SIG COMMONDESCRIPTION (SEE ED(5)-14) ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZE (RMC) CONDUIT SERVICE NO./SIZE CONDUCTORS SERVICE SWITCH AMPS SAFETY POLE/AMP CKT. BRK. DISCONNECT MAIN AMPS CONTRACTOR TWO-POLE RATING (MIN) LOADCENTER AMP PANELBD./ NO. CIRCUIT POLE/AMPS CKT. BRK. BRANCH AMPS CIRCUIT BRANCH LOAD KVA D(120/240)100(NS)AL(E)PS(U) ELEC SERV TY 1 1/2"3/#2 N/A 2P/100 30 100 C-ILSN B-LUMINAIRE A-SIGNAL 1P/20 2P/20 1P/50 2 9 40 7.2 ***-EXISTING ELECTRIC SERVICE TO BE REUSED. THE ELECTRIC SERVICE DATA WILL BE CONFIRMED BY THE POWER PROVIDER FOR THE PROPOSED SIGNALS. NE NW SW SE TOTALSCORNER NUMBER 100 200 300 400 POLE TYPE T P P ET P T P P ET P T=2 P=6 POLE NUMBER 100 100 101 200 200 300 300 301 400 400 P POLE HEIGHT STANDARD 5'5'EX 10'STANDARD 10'5'EX 10'48-A=1 36-1=1 24-A=6 FOUNDATION TYPE 48-A X 22'24-A X 4'24-A X 4'EX 24-A X 6'36-A X 13'24-A X 6'24-A X 4'EX 24-A X 6'PF 22'=1 PF 13'=1 PF 4'=3 PF 6'= 3 MAST-ARM LENGTH (FT)55 --EX -48 --EX -55'=1 48'=1 LUMINAIRE VERTICAL POLE 1 --EX-1 -1 --EX-1 -2 LUMINAIRE TRUSS 1 --EX-1 -1 --EX-1 -2 LUMINAIRE 1 --EX-1 -1 --EX-1 -2 EMERGENCY PRE-EMPTION -----DUAL --DUAL -DUAL=2 RADIO ANTENNA 1 ---------1 GRIDSMART CAMERA 1 ---------1 GROUND BOX 2 1-EX 1-EX 1 3 ADVANCE RADAR ---1 ----1 -2 APS -1 1 1 1 -1 1 1 1 8 SIGNAL HEAD NUMBER H101 H102 H103 H104 H105 -- H201 H202 H203 H301 H302 H303 H304 H305 - H401 H402 H403 - SIGNAL HEAD TYPE H4FL H3B H3B P P H4FL P P H4FL H3B H3B P P H4FL P P P=8 H4FL=4 H3B=2 SIGNAL HEAD LENS SIZE (INCH)12 12 12 --12 --12 12 12 --12 --- SIGNAL INDICATIONS -R R ------R R -----4 -Y Y ------Y Y -----4 -G G ------G G -----4 LRA ----LRA --LRA ----LRA --1 LYA ----LYA --LYA ----LYA --1 LFYA ----LFYA --LFYA ----LFYA --1 LGA ----LGA --LGA ----LGA --1 ---DW DW -DW DW ---DW DW -DW DW 3 ---W W -W W ---W W -W W 3 TOTAL LENSES 4 3 3 --4 --4 3 3 --4 --VL=28 PL=8 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE TRAFFIC SIGNAL DETAILS 2 116SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:46 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS POLE DETAILS AND WIRING INSIDE POLES PROPOSED CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE RADAR DETECTION TABLE PROPOSED BACKPLATE QUANTITIES SENSOR TYPE LOCATIONS MOUNTING SERVING PHASE AR201 ADVANCE MAST ARM PHASE 6 AR401 ADVANCE MAST ARM PHASE 2 POLE OFFSET POLE NUMBER ROADWAY STATION OFFSET SIDE T100 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 102+36 67 LT P100 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 102+27 68 LT P101 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 102+42 56 LT P200 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 101+65 76 LT T300 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 101+14 89 RT P300 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 100+97 61 RT P301 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 101+14 76 RT P400 UNIVERISTY DRIVE 102+1 77 RT BACKPLATE TYPE QUANTITY 3 SEC 4 4 SEC 4 RUN CONDUIT (FT) LENGTH EXTRA (FT)(LF) CONDUIT BARE LUM ILSN CAMERA GRIDSMART ADVANCE RADAR ANTENNA RADIO OPTICOM SIGNAL APS TRENCHED 4" PVC BORED 3" PVC TRENCHED 3" PVC TRENCHED 2" PVC No. 6 14 AWG 3 CNDR 14AWG 3 CNDR 4PR 24AWG CAT5E CABLE DETECTION ADVANCE RADAR CAT5E COMM CAT5E COMM 14AWG 21 CNDR 14AWG 7 CNDR 12 AWG 3 CNDR C1*13 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 2 2 CABINET 15 1 2 1 1 2 8 8 C2*3 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 2 1 1 2 8 8 GB100 6 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 8 8 C101*69 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 2 1 1 2 8 8 C102*7 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 2 2 GB101 6 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 8 8 C104 11 11 1 1 1 1 2 C105 11 11 1 1 1 T100 6 1 1 1 1 1 2 C106 4 4 1 1 P100 6 1 C107 19 19 1 1 P101 6 1 C103*7 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 2 2 EGB200 6 1 2 2 C201*15 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 1 1 ET200 6 1 1 1 C202 16 16 1 1 1 P200 6 1 1 C401*125 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 1 1 4 4 C402**125 109 16 1 1 1 GB400 6 1 1 1 1 1 4 4 C403*13 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 1 1 ET400 6 1 1 1 C404 30 30 1 1 1 P400 6 1 1 C303*119 EXISTING CONDUIT IN PLACE 1 1 1 1 2 2 C304**119 83 36 1 1 1 EGB300 6 1 1 1 1 2 2 C302 25 1 1 1 C305 25 25 1 1 1 1 T300 6 1 1 1 1 1 C301 9 9 1 1 1 P300 6 1 1 C306 11 11 1 1 P301 6 1 TOTAL (FT)11 192 52 114 405 487 487 116 382 116 386 502 1770 1757 3. ALL PED PUSH BUTTONS AND PED SIGNAL HEADS WILL BE WIRED WITH NEW CONDUCTORS 2.** - PROPOSED CONDUITS NEXT TO THE EXISTING CONDUITS ALREADY IN PLACE. EQUIPEMENTS. 1.* - CONDUITS ALREADY IN PLACE. CONDUCTORS ARE ONLY PROPOSED TO CONNECT NEW EQUIPMENT. EXISTING CONDUCTORS TO REMAIN FOR EXISTING AND REPLACED NOTE: POLE LUM CAMERA GRIDSMART APS ADVANCE RADAR OPTICOM ANTENNA ILSN SIGNAL 14 AWG 3 CNDR COMM CAT5E 12 AWG 3 CNDR CABLE DETECTION ADVANCE RADAR CABLE OPTICOM COMM CAT5E 14 AWG 3 CNDR 14 AWG 7 CNDR (FT)(FT)(FT)(FT)(FT)(FT)(FT)(FT) T100 30 30 ---25 30 215 ET200 --5 50 ---10 T300 30 ---50 -30 185 ET400 --5 50 ---10 P100 --5 ----- P101 --5 ----- P200 --5 ----10 P300 --5 ----10 P301 -5 -- P400 --5 ----10 TOTAL 60 30 40 100 50 25 60 450 08/05/2020 NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERISTY DRIVE TRAFFIC SIGNAL DETAILS 3 117SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:47 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS E B C D H A PAVEMENT EDGE/CURB YGR F G YGRYGRY APS MESSAGE INFORMATION SIGNAL HEAD SPACING DIMENSION FOR PROPOSED POLE AND MAST ARM**** I BARRIER LINE PROPOSED PHASING PROPOSED PHASING DIAGRAM LOCATION PUSH BUTTON HEAD SIGNAL MOVEMENT PEDESTRIAN FUNCTIONS SPEECH MESSAGE/SOUND DETAILS P100 H104 6 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS NOTTINGHAM AT UNIVERSITY DR. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. P101 H105 4 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS UNIVERSITY DR AT NOTTINGHAM. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. ET200 H202 4 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS UNIVERSITY DR AT NOTTINGHAM. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. P200 H203 2 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS NOTTINGHAM AT UNIVERSITY DR. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. T300 H304 2 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS NOTTINGHAM AT UNIVERSITY DR. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. P300 H305 8 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS UNIVERSITY DR AT NOTTINGHAM. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. ET400 H402 8 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS UNIVERSITY DR AT NOTTINGHAM. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. P400 H403 6 BUTTON PUSH ON DW WAIT. EXTEND BUTTON PUSH WAIT TO CROSS NOTTINGHAM AT UNIVERSITY DR. LOCATOR TONE SLOW TICK. WALK INDICATION RAPID TICK. POLE#A B C D E F G H I T100 13'31'43'55'55'8'22'8'7' TO 10' T300 9'24'36'48'48'8'22'8'7' TO 10' AVOID ANY UTILITY CONFLICTS **** CONTRACTOR TO FIELD ADJUST AS NEEDED AND AS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER TO FY 1 6 2 5 3 8 4 7 4 NOTTINGHAM DR UNIVERSITY DR8 52 16 7 3 PED PEDPED PED08/05/2020 B-B STOP DO NOT ENTER SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 MATCHLINE SHEET 1 OF 2EXISTING LAYOUT 1 118SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:49 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 60+00 50+0051+00100+00101+00B-B STOP DO NOT ENTER B-B STOP DO NOT ENTER US 288EX. R.O.WCAUTION NOTES ANY DAMAGED UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR PRIOR TO DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR WILL LOCATE ALL UTILITIES UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE. EX. R.O.WSHERMAN DRIVE (SPEED LIMIT = 45MPH) EX. R.O.W EX. R.O.W EB RAMP EXISTING STOP SIGN TO BE REMOVED EXISTING STOP SIGN TO BE REMOVED ROADWAY PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. 3. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE MODIFIED. REFER TO SHOWN, UNTIL THE PROPOSED SIGNAL IS OPERATIONAL. 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN TWO-WAY STOP CONTROL SIGNS ON ALL APPROACHES AS PRESERVE AND PROTECT THE EXISTING UTILITIES. 1. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS FAILURE TO LOCATE, LEGEND TRAFFIC FLOW EX. R.O.W. EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC EX. POST MOUNTED SIGN 08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288MATCHLINE SHEET 2 OF 2EXISTING LAYOUT 2 119SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:50 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND TRAFFIC FLOW EX. R.O.W. EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC EX. POST MOUNTED SIGN WB RAMPSEE NOTE 2 NOTES SHERMAN DRIVE (SPEED LIMIT = 45 MPH) CAUTION ANY DAMAGED UTILITIES. CONTRACTOR IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR PRIOR TO DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR WILL LOCATE ALL UTILITIES UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE APPROXIMATE. MODIFIED. REFER TO ROADWAY PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. 3. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE OPERATIONAL. ON ALL APPROACHES AS SHOWN, UNTIL THE PROPOSED SIGNAL IS 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN TWO-WAY STOP CONTROL SIGNS UTILITY. FAILURE TO LOCATE, PRESERVE AND PROTECT THE EXISTING 1. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS 65+0050+0051+00100+00101+00B-B STOP DO NOT ENTER B-B STOP DO NOT ENTERUS 288 BE REMOVED EXISTING STOP SIGN TO REMOVED EXISTING STOP SIGN TO BE EX. R.O.WEX. R.O.W EX. R.O.WEX. R.O.W08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE AND LOOP 288 PROPOSED SIGNAL LAYOUT 1 120SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:52 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 60+00 50+0051+00100+00101+00MATCHLINE SHEET 1 OF 2Y GR CAUTION DAMAGED UTILITIES. IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR LOCATE ALL UTILITIES PRIOR TO APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR WILL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE Y GRY FY NOTES WAY ONE WAY ONE TURNEFT FLASHIN YIEL YELL WO ARROW L D ON G PROPOSED SIGNAL HEADS H3B H4FL H301 30 X 36 R6-2R S101 30 X 36 R6-2L S303 30 X 36 R10-17T S301 PROPOSED SIGNS ON MAST ARM PROPOSED ILSN SIGNS S201 Loop 288 S102,S304 PRIOR TO INSTALLATION. CONTRACTOR TO OBTAIN THEM FROM CITY *CITY TO FABRICATE ILSN SIGNS. ONLY 36 X 30 R3-5 L S302 Sherman Dr H303 H201,H202,H302, H101,H102,H103, 58+00 59+00 61+00 62+00 APPLICABLE ROADWAY CROWN. HEADS FROM THE BOTTOM OF THE BACK PLATE TO THE TOP OF THE 4. MOUNTING HEIGHT OF 20.5FT IS REQUIRED FOR MAST ARM SIGNAL FROM THE FLAT LANDING AREA. BUTTON TO ENSURE THAT IT IS ACCESSIBLE WITHIN 18 INCH REACH 3. CONTRACTOR TO FIELD ADJUST THE MOUNTING HEIGHT OF THE PUSH AND TACTILE CAPABILITIES. 2. THE PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON CONTROLS SHALL HAVE BOTH AUDIBLE ROADWAY CONSTRUCTION. REFER TO ROADWAY PLANS FOR DETAILS. INSTALLATION AND PED RAMPS WILL BE CONSTRUCTED AS PART OF 1. PAVEMENT MARKINGS, INTERSECTION MODIFICATIONS, SIGN H201H202 AR201 AR101 H102 PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W EX. R.O.W. PROP. R.O.W T300 H303 H302 S301 H301 S304 T200 S201 S101 T100 S302 S303 S102 H101EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.(SPEED LIMIT = 45 MPH) SHERMAN DR MODIFIED. REFER TO ROADWAY PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. 3. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE OPERATIONAL. ON ALL APPROACHES AS SHOWN, UNTIL THE PROPOSED SIGNAL IS 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN TWO-WAY STOP CONTROL SIGNS CONSTRUCTION. INCLUDING EXISTING GROUND BOXES AND CONDUITS DURING FAILURE TO LOCATE, PRESERVE AND PROTECT THE UTILITY 1. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS H103 US 288(SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH)EB RAMPLEGEND PROP. 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP TRAFFIC FLOW EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC PROP. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. METER SERVICE PROP. PREEMPTION PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. CONTROLLER CABINET PROP. ADVANCE RADAR DETECTOR PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. ILSN SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE AND LOOP 288 PROPOSED SIGNAL LAYOUT 2 121SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:53 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND PROP. 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP TRAFFIC FLOW EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC PROP. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. METER SERVICE PROP. PREEMPTION PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. CONTROLLER CABINET PROP. ADVANCE RADAR DETECTOR PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. ILSN SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM H401 AR401 H402 H601 H602H502 PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W PROP. R.O.WAR501S501T500 H501S401 S601 H603 T600 S402 S604 S603EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W EX. R.O.W.US 288( SPEED LIMIT = 45 MPH) SHERMAN DR (SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH)WB RAMPH403 T400 S602 AND CABINET PROPOSED CONTROLLER SERVICE METER PROPOSED 65+0050+0051+00100+00101+00MATCHLINE SHEET 2 OF 2Y GR CAUTION DAMAGED UTILITIES. IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR LOCATE ALL UTILITIES PRIOR TO APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR WILL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE NOTES PROPOSED SIGNAL HEADS PROPOSED SIGNS ON MAST ARM 30 x 36 R6-2R S401 30 X 36 R10-17T S601 30 x 36 R6-2L S603 H3B H4FL H601 TURNEFT FLASHIN YIEL YELL WO ARROW L D ON G WAY ONE WAY ONE PROPOSED ILSN SIGNS S501 Sherman Dr Loop 288 S402,S604 PRIOR TO INSTALLATION. CONTRACTOR TO OBTAIN THEM FROM CITY *CITY TO FABRICATE ILSN SIGNS. ONLY 30 X 36 R3-5L S602 Y GRY FY H603 H501,H502,H602, H401,H402,H403, BOTTOM OF THE BACK PLATE TO THE TOP OF THE APPLICABLE ROADWAY CROWN. 4. MOUNTING HEIGHT OF 20.5FT IS REQUIRED FOR MAST ARM SIGNAL HEADS FROM THE AREA. ENSURE THAT IT IS ACCESSIBLE WITHIN 18 INCH REACH FROM THE FLAT LANDING 3. CONTRACTOR TO FIELD ADJUST THE MOUNTING HEIGHT OF THE PUSH BUTTON TO CAPABILITIES. 2. THE PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON CONTROLS SHALL HAVE BOTH AUDIBLE AND TACTILE PLANS FOR DETAILS. RAMPS WILL BE CONSTRUCTED AS PART OF ROADWAY CONSTRUCTION. REFER TO ROADWAY 1. PAVEMENT MARKINGS, INTERSECTION MODIFICATIONS, SIGN INSTALLATION AND PED 63+00 66+0064+00 08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE AND LOOP 288 PROPOSED CONDUIT LAYOUT 1 122SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:55 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS MATCHLINE SHEET 1 OF 2CAUTION DAMAGED UTILITIES. IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR LOCATE ALL UTILITIES PRIOR TO APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR WILL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE NOTES TO ROADWAY PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. 3.EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY GEOMETRY TO BE MODIFIED. REFER AS SHOWN, UNTIL THE PROPOSED SIGNAL IS OPERATIONAL. 2.CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN TWO-WAY STOP CONTROL SIGNS ON ALL APPROACHES LOCATE, PRESERVE AND PROTECT THE EXISTING UTILITIES. 1.CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE CAUSED BY HIS FAILURE TO C203,C204 C201,C202 C303,C304 C301,C302 GB100 GB200 GB300 GB2 US 288(SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH)EB RAMP SHERMAN DR (SPEED LIMIT = 45 MPH)EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W EX. R.O.W PROP. R.O.W C101,C102 C103,C104 C7,C8 LEGEND PROP. 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP TRAFFIC FLOW EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC PROP. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. METER SERVICE PROP. PREEMPTION PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. CONTROLLER CABINET PROP. ADVANCE RADAR DETECTOR PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. ILSN SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 60+00 50+0051+00100+00101+0008/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE AND LOOP 288 PROPOSED CONDUIT LAYOUT 2 123SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:40PENTABLE:4:53:57 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION 0 SHEET 20 40 1"=40' S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 65+0050+0051+00100+00101+00PROP. R.O.W EX. R.O.W EX. R.O.W PROP. R.O.W C603,C604 C501,C502 GB400 GB600 GB500 EX. R.O.W.EX. R.O.W.C503,C504 C401,C402 US 288SHERMAN DR (SPEED LIMIT = 45 MPH)(SPEED LIMIT = 30 MPH)WB RAMP C4 C601,C602 C2 GB1 CONNECTION FOR DME POLE CONDUIT STUB OUT C3 C1 C5,C6 INTERCONNECT FUTURE FIBER CONDUIT STUB OUT FOR TO POWER SERVICE MATCHLINE SHEET 2 OF 2CAUTION DAMAGED UTILITIES. IS FULLY RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DRILLING AND BORING. CONTRACTOR LOCATE ALL UTILITIES PRIOR TO APPROXIMATE. CONTRACTOR WILL UTILITY LOCATIONS ARE NOTES PLAN SET FOR DETAILS. GEOMETRY TO BE MODIFIED. REFER TO ROADWAY 3. EXISTING SIGNING, STRIPING, AND ROADWAY UNTIL THE PROPOSED SIGNAL IS OPERATIONAL. CONTROL SIGNS ON ALL APPROACHES AS SHOWN, 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN TWO-WAY STOP CONSTRUCTION. GROUND BOXES AND CONDUITS DURING AND PROTECT THE UTILITY INCLUDING EXISTING CAUSED BY HIS FAILURE TO LOCATE, PRESERVE 1. CONTRACTOR IS RESPONSIBLE FOR ANY DAMAGE LEGEND PROP. 4" CONC RIPRAP/MOW STRIP TRAFFIC FLOW EX. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC PROP. R.O.W. EX. R.O.W. PROP. CONDUIT (BORED) PROP. CONDUIT (TRENCHED) PROP. GROUND BOX PROP. METER SERVICE PROP. PREEMPTION PROP. LUMINAIRE PROP. CONTROLLER CABINET PROP. ADVANCE RADAR DETECTOR PROP. GRID SMART CAMERA PROP. ILSN SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGN ON MAST ARM PROP. SIGNAL HEAD PROP. PEDESTAL PROP. SIGNAL POLE AND MAST ARM 08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 TRAFFIC SIGNAL DETAILS 1 124SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:58 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS F B C D I A PAVEMENT EDGE/CURB YGR G H YGRYGR E Y GRY POLE DETAILS AND WIRING INSIDE POLES PROPOSED SIGNAL HEADS AND POLE SUMMARY DIMENSION FOR PROPOSED POLE AND MAST ARM** PROPOSED BACKPLATE QUANTITIES PROPOSED 21C TERMINATION CHART SIGNAL HEAD SPACING PROPOSED 7C TERMINATION CHART GROUND BOX SUMMARY GROUND BOX SUMMARY TYPE EACH TYPE D W/APRON 8 BACKPLATE TYPE QUANTITY 3 SEC 14 4 SEC 2 POLE TYPE T T T T T T POLE #100 200 300 400 500 600 HEAD TYPE H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H4FL H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H4FL H3B H3B HEAD NUMBER H101 H102 H103 H201 H202 H301 H1302 H302 H401 H402 H403 H501 H502 H601 H602 H603 1 RED RB RB RB RB RB RA(L)RB RB RB RB RB RB RB RA(L)RB RB 2 ORANGE YB YB YB YB YB SPARE YB YB YB YB YB YB YB SPARE YB YB 3 GREEN GB GB GB GB GB SPARE GB GB GB GB GB GB GB SPARE GB GB 4 BLACK SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE YA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE YA(L)SPARE SPARE 5 BLUE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE GA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE GA(L)SPARE SPARE 6 BLACK/WHITE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE SPARE FYA(L)SPARE SPARE 7 WHITE/BLACK COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMOM COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMON COMMOM COMMON COMMON POLE LUM CAMERA GRIDSMART RADAR ADVANCE OPTICOM SIGNAL ILSN 14 AWG 3 CNDR 4PR 24AWG CAT5E COMM CABLE RADAR CABLE OPTICOM 14 AWG 7 CNDR 14 AWG 3 CNDR FT FT FT FT FT FT T100 30 -51 -113 32 T200 30 -50 47 98 32 T300 30 30 0 116 162 32 T400 30 -50 96 113 32 T500 30 -49 46 98 32 T600 30 30 0 -165 32 TOTAL 180 60 200 305 749 192 CABLE CONDUCTOR TYPE HEAD IDENTIFIER 1 RED VH MRB 2 ORANGE VH MYB 3 GREEN VH MGB 4 BLACK VH MYA(L) 5 BLUE VH MGA(L) 6 RED/WHITE N/A PED COMMON 7 GREEN/WHITE PH MD 8 BLACK/RED PH MW 9 ORANGE/WHITE PH XD 10 RED/BLACK PH XW 11 ORANGE/BLACK VH XRB 12 GREEN/BLACK VH XYB 13 WHITE/BLACK VH XGB 14 BLUE/BLACK VH XYA(F) 15 BLACK/WHITE VH MRA(L) 16 BLUE/WHITE VH XYA(F) 17 WHITE/RED VH XGA(F) 18 BLUE/RED VH MYA(F) 19 RED/GREEN VH MGA(O) 20 ORANGE/GREEN VH MYA(O) 21 WHITE N/A SIG COMMON POLE#A B C D E F G H I T100 6.1'14.0'23.0'32.0'-32.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' T200 6.4'22.0'32.0'--32.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' T300 7.0'20.0'32.0'-44.0'44.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' T400 5.3'14.0'23.0'32.0'-32.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' T500 6.5'22.0'32.0'--32.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' T600 7.0'22.0'33.0'-44.0'44.0'8.0'22.0'8.0' TO AVOID ANY UTILITY CONFLICTS ** CONTRACTOR TO FIELD ADJUST AS NEEDED AND AS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER GEOMETRIC CORNER EB WB TOTALSESWNWNENWNESE CORNER NUMBER 100 200 300 -400 500 600 T=6POLE TYPE T T T -T T T POLE NUMBER 100 200 300 -400 500 600 P POLE HEIGHT STANDARD STANDARD STANDARD -STANDARD STANDARD STANDARD 30-A= 4 36-A=2 FOUNDATION TYPE 30-A X 11'30-A X 11'36-A X 13'-30-A X 11'30-A X 11'36-A X 13'PF 11'= 4 PF 13'=2 MAST-ARM LENGTH (FT)32 32 44 -32 32 44 32'=4 44'=2 LUMINAIRE VERTICAL POLE 1 1 1 -1 1 1 6 LUMINAIRE TRUSS 1 1 1 -1 1 1 6 LUMINAIRE 1 1 1 -1 1 1 6 EMERGENCY PRE-EMPTION -SINGLE DUAL -DUAL SINGLE -SINGLE=2 DUAL=2 GRIDSMART CAMERA --1 ---1 2 ADVANCED RADAR DETECTOR 1 1 --1 1 -4 GROUND BOX 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 8 SIGNAL HEAD NUMBER H101 H102 H103 H201 H202 H301 H302 H303 -H401 H402 H403 H501 H502 H601 H602 H603 - SIGNAL HEAD TYPE H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H4FL H3B H3B -H3B H3B H3B H3B H3B H4FL H3B H3B H3B=14 H4FL=2 SIGNAL HEAD LENS SIZE (INCH)12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 -12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 - SIGNAL INDICATIONS R R R R R -R R -R R R R R -R R 14 Y Y Y Y Y -Y Y -Y Y Y Y Y -Y Y 14 G G G G G -G G -G G G G G -G G 14 -----LRA --------LRA --2 -----LYA --------LYA --2 -----LFYA --------LFYA --2 -----LGA --------LGA --2 TOTAL LENSES 3 3 3 3 3 4 3 3 -3 3 3 3 3 4 3 3 VL=50 FY 08/05/2020 SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 TRAFFIC SIGNAL DETAILS 2 125SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:30PENTABLE:4:53:59 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR100% SUBMITTALDATE 8/5/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS BARRIER LINE PROPOSED CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE RADAR DETECTION TABLE PROPOSED PHASING DIAGRAM PROPOSED PHASING PROPOSED ELECTRICAL SERVICE DETAILS DESCRIPTION (SEE ED(5)-14) ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZE (RMC) CONDUIT SERVICE NO./SIZE CONDUCTORS SERVICE SWITCH AMPS SAFETY POLE/AMP CKT. BRK. DISCONNECT MAIN AMPS CONTRACTOR TWO-POLE RATING (MIN) LOADCENTER AMP PANELBD./ NO. CIRCUIT POLE/AMPS CKT. BRK. BRANCH AMPS CIRCUIT BRANCH LOAD KVA D(120/240)100(NS)AL(E)PS(U) ELEC SERV TY 1 1/2"3/#4 N/A 2P/100 30 100 C-ILSN B-LUMINAIRE A-SIGNAL 1P/20 2P/20 1P/50 11 9 40 8.3 POLE OFFSET POLE NUMBER ROADWAY STATION OFFSET SIDE T100 SHERMAN DRIVE 59+71 44 RT T200 SHERMAN DRIVE 60+11 87 RT T300 SHERMAN DRIVE 61+2 45 LT T400 SHERMAN DRIVE 63+18 44 LT T500 SHERMAN DRIVE 64+19 86 LT T600 SHERMAN DRIVE 64+65 46 RT SENSOR TYPE MOUNTING LOCATION PHASE SERVING AR101 ADVANCE MAST ARM 2 AR201 ADVANCE MAST ARM C AR401 ADVANCE MAST ARM 6 AR501 ADVANCE MAST ARM D RUN CONDUIT (FT) LENGTH EXTRA (FT)CONDUIT (EACH) CABLES (EACH) POWER BARE LUM ILSN OPTICOM CAMERA GRID SMART RADAR SIGNAL TRENCHED 2" PVC TRENCHED 3" PVC BORED 3" PVC TRENCHED 4" PVC BORED 4" PVC TRENCH 6" PVC XHHW NO. 6 No. 6 14 AWG 3 CNDR 14AWG 3 CNDR CABLE OPTICOM 4PR 24AWG CAT5E CABLE COMM RADAR 14 AWG 21 CNDR C1*5 5 C2 44 44 2 1 6 6 C3 6 6 2 1 4 2 4 6 C4**5 5 GB1 6 2 3 3 4 2 4 6 CABINET 15 4 2 4 6 C5 17 17 1 2 1 2 3 C6 17 17 2 1 3 3 C7 221 220 1 2 1 2 3 C8 221 220 1 3 3 GB2 6 3 3 2 1 2 3 GB100 6 1 1 1 1 T100 6 1 1 1 1 C101 95 45 50 1 1 1 C102 95 45 50 1 1 1 C103 10 10 1 1 1 C104 10 10 1 1 1 GB200 6 2 2 1 2 2 T200 6 1 1 1 1 1 C201 135 25 110 1 1 2 2 C202 135 25 110 1 2 2 C203 10 10 1 1 1 1 C204 10 10 1 1 1 GB300 6 3 3 2 1 2 3 T300 6 1 1 1 1 1 C301 114 44 70 1 2 1 2 3 C302 114 44 70 1 3 3 C303 10 10 1 1 1 1 C304 10 10 1 1 1 GB400 6 2 4 4 2 1 2 3 T400 6 1 1 1 1 1 C401 10 10 1 1 1 1 C402 10 10 1 1 1 GB500 6 2 6 6 1 1 1 2 T500 6 1 1 1 1 1 C501 105 60 45 1 1 1 1 2 C502 105 60 45 2 1 5 5 C503 10 10 1 1 1 1 C504 10 10 1 1 1 GB600 6 1 1 1 1 T600 6 1 1 1 1 C601 135 25 110 1 1 1 C602 135 25 110 1 1 1 C603 10 10 1 1 1 C604 10 10 1 1 1 TOTAL (FT)44 496 385 507 385 5 380 1814 2579 2579 1164 708 1406 2114 ** - PROPOSED CONDUIT FROM CABINET FOR FUTURE FIBER INTERCONNECT * - PROPOSED CONDUIT FROM METER SERVICE PEDESTAL TO DME POLE 2 C 5 A D B B A 6 D 1C 5 1 2 6 C A (1+2) B (5+6)SHERMAN DRWB RAMPEB RAMP(4+12) D(8+16) 08/05/2020 Traffic Operations Division Texas Department of Transportation POLE FOUNDATION TRAFFIC SIGNAL FDN TYPE LOCATION IDENTIFICATION TOTAL DRILLED SHAFT LENGTHS FOUNDATION SUMMARY TABLE DRILLED SHAFT LENGTH (FEET) 42-A36-B36-A30-A24-A/ft. BLOW N AVG. EA NO. 3 6 1'-0"Drilled Shaft LengthTraffic Signal Pole NOTES Table for size & pitch) bottom. (See Design top & 1 flat turn Spiral, 3 flat turns & number). Design Table for size Vertical Bars (See ELEVATION FOUNDATION DETAILS3" or as directedby the Engineer1"2"(Temporary) Template Circular Steel 18"MinTemplate Steel Circular pitch1'-0"Shaft Dia Drilled TYPICAL STRAIN POLE ASSEMBLY Wire loads. tension from the Span so that two bolts are in approximately oriented Anchor bolts to be R R12 Arm (optional) Luminaire required) the Engineer. 1 or 2 Orient as directed by Sheets for diameter. Conduit (See Layout Sway Cable Span Wires TYPICAL MAST ARM Arm (optional) LuminaireArm Supporting ILSN ASSEMBLY+-+-8'-0"19'-6"19'-6"35' Lum. Mounting HeightR12 3" Spiral Conduit TOP VIEW Bars Vertical Diameter Bolt CircleRTYPE FDN DIA SHAFT DRILLED STEEL REINFORCING BARS VERT & PITCH SPIRAL DIA BOLT ANCHOR (ksi) Fy K-ft MOMENT Kips SHEAR 24-A 24" 36 10 30-A 30" 55 87 36-A 36" 55 131 36-B 36" 55 190 42-A 42" 55 271 10- 9 12- 9 14- 9 1 2 2 2 2 TYPE ANCHOR 1 3 5 7 9 TYPICAL APPLICATION Strain pole taller than 30' & strain pole with mast arm 10 15 40 FOUNDATION DESIGN TABLE DIA CIR BOLT controller. Pedestal pole, pedestal mounted Mast arm assembly. (see Selection Table) 30' strain pole with or without luminaire. Mast arm assembly. (see Selection Table) Mast arm assembly. (see Selection Table) Mast arm assembly. (see Selection Table) 2 at 12" 3 at 6" 3 at 6" 3 at 6" 3 at 6" TOP BOLT R R12 1 •" 1 ƒ" 2" ƒ" 2 ‚" 1'-6" 3'-4" 3'-10" 4'-3" 4'-9" 3" 6" 7" 8" 4" 4 •" 12 ƒ" 17" 19" 21" 23" 7 „" 10" 11 ‚" 12 •" 13 ƒ" 7" 7 ƒ" 8 •" 9 ‚" ANCHOR BOLT & TEMPLATE SIZES longer bolts are acceptable. Min dimensions given, BOLT DIA THREAD THREAD 6" 9" 5 †" MAX SINGLE ARM LENGTH MAX SINGLE ARM LENGTH LENGTH COMBINATIONS MAXIMUM DOUBLE ARM LENGTH COMBINATIONS MAXIMUM DOUBLE ARM 32'48' 24' X 24' 28' X 28' 32' X 28'32' X 32' 44' X 28'44' X 36' 36'44' 24' X 24' 28' X 28' 32' X 24' 36' X 36' 40' X 36' 32' X 32' 36' X 36' 40' x24'80 MPH DESIGNWIND SPEED100 MPH DESIGNWIND SPEEDMAX SINGLE ARM LENGTH ARM PLUS ILSN SUPPORT ASSEMBLIES (ft) FOUNDATION SELECTION TABLE FOR STANDARD MAST 36-A can support a single 36' mast arm. For 100mph design wind speed, foundation another arm up to 28' 30-A can support up to a 32' arm with For 80mph design wind speed, foundation1. 2. EXAMPLE: Type 1 Type 2 R=d Nut (Typ) Heavy Hex TopThread1 •" MinAnchor Bolt Length(See Table)d Bott ThreadANCHOR BOLT ASSEMBLY HOOKED ANCHOR NUT ANCHOR (TYPE 1)(TYPE 2) 40' X 36' 44' x 36' FDN 36-B FDN 42-A N blows/ft CIRCLEIN. BOLT LENGTH Bolt Anchor 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 17-'6"Nominal.. 8- 9 4- 5 2LOAD DESIGN FOUNDATIONANCHOR BOLT DESIGN 1 7 foot for entry into Summary Table. penetrometer values. Round to nearest to allow interpolation for other Decimal lengths in Design Table are diameters into solid rock. Shaft shall extend a minimum of two If rock is encountered, the Drilled used to adjust shaft lengths. of approximately 3 to 5 feet may be Field Penetrometer readings at a depth for the Contractor's information only. of location and type. Quantities are or grouped according to similarity Foundations may be listed separately the base of the structure. allowable moments and shears at Foundation Design Loads are the Foundation Design Loads. foundation capacity given under Anchor bolt design develops the TEXAS CONE PENETROMETER FDN 36-AFDN 30-A concrete is placed. to do so when if material is firm enough on bottom of drilled hole Vertical bars may rest encasement. Listed for concrete connectors shall be UL jumper. Mechanical bar or #6 copper locations using #3 rebar cage, two Bond anchor bolts to BOTTOM Clamp Arm Length F ixed Arm Leng th 8 8 (See Summary Table) Embedded Dr Shaft Length5" 5 •" LENGTH-ft 4 , 5 , 6 EMBEDDED DRILLED SHAFT 5.7 11.3 13.2 15.2 13.6 12.0 10.3 17.4 5.3 15.6 4.5 8.0 9.4 10.4 11.9 ƒ" 1 •" 1 ƒ" 2" 2 ‚" 12 ƒ" 17" 19" 21" 23" tension under dead load. ensure that two bolts are in with the fixed arm direction to Orient anchor bolts orthogonal Ignore the top 1' of soil. embedded shaft. the top third of the Use average N value over concrete project above bolt shank shall ‚" to •" of per Anchor Bolt 2 Flat Washers than bolt diameter with holes ˆ" greater Steel Template Top Template Circular Steel ‚" thk. min. for FDN 24-A) (Omit bottom template Circular Steel Bottom Template d/4 (inch) min. Thickness = 2 Sides (Typ)Galvanize Length= Top Threadplus 6" Min. sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any August 1995C TxDOT REVISIONS 128 DN:CK:DW:CK: JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST HIGHWAY SHEET NO. MS JSY MA0/MMF JSY/TEB 5-96 11-99 1-12 Ground Rod Copper Clad 5/8" Dia. x 10' 1 MODIFICATIONS: 1 TS-FD-12 (DAL) ADDED GROUND ROD TO FOUNDATION DETAILS (9/15) 1 2" Max.GENERAL NOTES: rod clamps shall be listed for their intended purpose. Make connections to ground rods according to NEC. Ground a maximum of 2" above the finish grade of the foundation. Ground rod shall protrude a minimum of 1"and structure in accordance with Item 449, "Anchor Bolts". Lubricate and tighten anchor bolts when erecting the Templates and embedded nuts need not be galvanized. accordance with Item 445, "Galvanizing". shall be galvanized. All galvanizing shall be in otherwise noted. Exposed washers and exposed nuts thread length plus 6" for all anchor bolts unless to ASTM A36. Galvanize a minimum of the top end bolts that are 1" in diameter or less shall conform mild steel" per Item 449, "Anchor Bolts". Anchor shall conform to "alloy steel" or "medium-strength Anchor bolts that are larger than 1" in diameter Galvanized nuts shall be tapped after galvanizing. and nuts shall have Class 2A and 2B fit tolerances. in diameter or UNC series for all sizes. Bolts rolled or cut threads of 8UN series up to 2" Threads for anchor bolts and nuts shall be Concrete shall be Class "C". "Reinforcing Steel". Reinforcing steel shall conform to Item 440, Signals and interim revisions thereto. Highway Signs, Luminaires and Traffic Specifications for Structural Supports for Design conforms to 1994 AASHTO Standard DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1289654\071 TS-FD-12 (DAL).dgn8/5/20204:54:00 PM 30 44 39 DENTON 126 LOOP 288 SHERMAN DR AT UNIVERSITY DR NOTTINGHAM AT 13 10 10 30-A 36-A 4 2 26 44 10 10 10 24-A 24-A 36-A 3 3 1 18 12 S TATE OF TEXAS PROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LI CENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 10 221 22 T100 1 1 1 1 LMA(5)-12 PARTS LIST ARM ASSEMBLY LONG MAST Sheet 5 of 5 4-20-01 Shipping Parts List Ship each pole with the following attached: enlarged hand hole, pole cap, fixed arm connection bolts and washers, and any additional hardware listed in the table. Single Mast Arm Lf ft. Designation Quantity Designation Quantity Designation Quantity 50 50L 50S 50 55 55L 55S 55 60 60L 60S 60 65 65L 65S 65 Dual Mast Arm Lf Lc ft. ft. Designation Quantity Designation Quantity Designation Quantity 50 20 5020L 5020S 5020 24 5024L 5024S 5024 28 5028L 5028S 5028 32 5032L 5032S 5032 36 5036L 5036S 5036 40 5040L 5040S 5040 44 5044L 5044S 5044 55 20 5520L 5520S 5520 24 5524L 5524S 5524 28 5528L 5528S 5528 32 5532L 5532S 5532 36 5536L 5536S 5536 40 5540L 5540S 5540 44 5544L 5544S 5544 60 20 6020L 6020S 6020 24 6024L 6024S 6024 28 6028L 6028S 6028 32 6032L 6032S 6032 36 6036L 6036S 6036 40 6040L 6040S 6040 44 6044L 6044S 6044 65 20 6520L 6520S 6520 24 6524L 6524S 6524 28 6528L 6528S 6528 32 6532L 6532S 6532 36 6536L 6536S 6536 40 6540L 6540S 6540 44 6544L 6544S 6544 Foundation Summary Table ** Location Avg. N No. Drill Shaft *** Notes 48-A ** Foundations may be listed separately or grouped according to similarity of location and type. Quantities are for the Contractor's information only. *** Decimal lengths in Design Table are to allow interpolation for other penetrometer values. Round to nearest foot for entry into Summary Table. Total Drill Shaft Length Arm See note above plus: one (or See note above plus 20.25' (Dual Mast Arm) Nominal 30' Poles with Luminaire 24' Poles with ILSN 19.50' (Single Mast Arm) Length two if ILSN attached) small one small hand hole Poles with no Luminaire and no ILSN hand hole, clamp-on simplex See note above Ident. Blow/ft. Each Length (feet) Shipping Parts List Traffic Signal Arms (Fixed Mount) (1 per pole) Ship each arm with listed equipment attached Luminaire Arms (1 per 30' pole) Nominal Type IV Arm (4 Signals) Nominal Arm Length Quantity Arm 3 Bracket Assembly 8' Arm Length and 4 CGB Connectors ft. Designation Quantity ILSN Arm (Max. 2 per pole) Ship with 50 50IV clamps, bolts and washers 55 55IV Nominal Arm Length Quantity 60 60IV 7' Arm 65 65IV 9' Arm Traffic Signal Arms (80 MPH Clamp-On Mount) (1 per pole) Ship each arm with listed equipment attached Arm w/bolts and washers CGB connectors, and 1 clamp CGB connectors, and 1 clamp Length w/bolts and washers w/bolts and washers ft. Designation Quantity Designation Quantity Designation Quantity 20 20I-80 24 24I-80 24II-80 28 28I-80 28II-80 32 32II-80 32III-80 36 36II-80 36III-80 40 40III-80 44 44III-80 Traffic Signal Arms (100 MPH Clamp-On Mount) (1 per pole) Ship each arm with listed equipment attached Type I Arm (1 Signal) Type II Arm (2 Signals) Type III Arm (3 Signals) Arm w/bolts and washers CGB connectors, and 1 clamp CGB connectors, and 1 clamp ft. Designation Quantity Designation Quantity Designation Quantity 20 20I-100 24 24I-100 24II-100 28 28I-100 28II-100 32 32II-100 32III-100 36 36II-100 36III-100 40 40III-100 44 44III-100 Anchor Bolt Assemblies (1 per pole) Each anchor bolt assembly consists of the following: Top Anchor Anchor and bottom templates, 4 anchor bolts, 8 nuts, 8 flat Diameter Length Quantity per Standard Drawing "TS-FD". 2 1/2 " 5' - 3" Templates may be removed for shipment. Abbreviations Type I Arm (1 Signal) Type II Arm (2 Signals) Type III Arm (3 Signals) Bolt Bolt washers and 4 nut anchor devices (type 2) Nominal 2 CGB connector and 1 clamp 1 Bracket Assembly and 3 2 Bracket Assembly and 4 Nominal 2 CGB connector and 1 clamp 1 Bracket Assembly and 3 2 Bracket Assembly and 4 Lc= Clamp-on Arm Lf= Fixed Arm Length Length (44' Max.) Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:01 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1219493\DVI_SIG_14.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division November 2000 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 131E JK GRB FDN CAL 127 1-12 S TATE OF TEXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LI CENSED PRAGNA TATA 1 08/05/2020 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOTof this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:02 PMDOCUMENT NAMEDATE TIME Standard Division Operations Traffic ED(1)-14 71A ed1-14.dgn 128 CONDUIT A. MATERIALS B. CONSTRUCTION METHODS CONDUITS & NOTES ELECTRICAL DETAILS GENERAL NOTES FOR ALL ELECTRICAL WORK AWG 16" x 16" x 4" 12" x 12" x 4" 10" x 10" x 4" 10" x 10" x 4" #1 #2 #4 #6 #8 3 CONDUCTORS 5 CONDUCTORS 7 CONDUCTORS 4" x 12" x12" 4" x 8" x 8" 4" x 10" x10" 4" x 8" x8" 4" x 10" x10" 4" x 8" x8" 4" x 8" x8" 4" x 8" x8" 4" x 8" x8" 4" x 8" x8" 10" x 10" x 4" No substitutions will be allowed for materials on this list. listed on the MPL on TxDOT's website under "Roadway Illumination and Electrical Supplies." Material Producers List (MPL) intended for use on each project. Prequalified materials are 6. When required by the Engineer, notify the Department in writing of materials from the connectors, and bonding jumpers are subsidiary to the various bid items. conductor. Provide stranded bare copper or green insulated grounding conductors. Ground rods, conduits; metal poles; luminaires; and metal enclosures are bonded to the equipment grounding 5. Install grounding as shown on the plans and in accordance with the NEC. Ensure all metallic request. Operate test equipment during inspection as requested by the Engineer. calibrated within the last year. Provide calibration certification to the Engineer upon tester, torque wrenches, and torque screwdrivers. Ensure all equipment has been properly the contract and the NEC: voltmeter, ammeter, megohm meter (1000 volt DC), ground resistance 4. Provide the following test equipment as required by the Engineer to confirm compliance with steel when plans specify galvanized, provided the bolt size is • in. or less in diameter. 3. Miscellaneous nuts, bolts and hardware, except for high strength bolts, may be stainless additional cost to the Department. is justification for rejection. Replace or reinstall rejected material or equipment at no listing. Faulty fabrication or poor workmanship in any material, equipment, or installation acceptable equal to a NEMA listed device. Acceptable devices may have both a NEMA and IEC International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC) listed devices will not be considered an LLC can be considered equivalent to UL. Where reference is made to NEMA listed devices, as Canadian Standard Association (CSA), Intertek Testing Services NA Inc., or FM Approvals Underwriters Laboratories (UL) or a Nationally Recognized Testing Lab (NRTL). NRTLs such specifications, National Electrical Manufacturers Association (NEMA), and are listed by the applicable articles of the National Electrical Code (NEC), TxDOT standards and 2. Provide new and unused materials. Ensure that all materials and installations comply with diagrammatic and may be shifted to accommodate field conditions. 1. The location of all conduits, junction boxes, ground boxes, and electrical services is October 2014 not applicable to the table, size junction boxes in accordance with NEC. sizes is present, count the conductors as if all are of the larger size. For situations through one conduit with no more than four conduits per box. When a mixture of conductor the following table, which applies to the greatest number of conductors entering the box 3. Unless otherwise shown on the plans, provide junction boxes with a minimum size as shown in Properly bond all metal conduits. 2. Provide galvanized steel RMC for all exposed conduits, unless otherwise shown on the plans. called for on polyvinyl chloride (PVC) systems. systems. Provide liquidtight flexible nonmetallic conduit (LFNC) when flexible conduit is (LFMC) when flexible conduit is called for on galvanized steel rigid metallic conduit (RMC) substitute other types of conduits for those shown. Provide liquidtight flexible metal conduit Provide conduit types according to the descriptive code or as shown on the plans. Do not conduits listed under Item 618 on the MPL under "Roadway Illumination and Electrical Supplies." For Construction And Maintenance Of Highways, Streets, And Bridges," latest edition. Provide Specification (DMS) 11030 "Conduit" and Item 618 "Conduit" of TxDOT's "Standard Specifications 1. Provide conduit, junction boxes, fittings, and hardware as per TxDOT Departmental Material otherwise noted on the plans. 7. Provide PVC junction boxes intended for outdoor use on PVC conduit systems, unless the same requirements for junction boxes used with RMC systems. in accordance with the NEC. Provide junction boxes for IMC conduit systems that meet use, unless otherwise noted on the plans. Size all galvanized steel junction boxes junction boxes made from galvanized steel sheeting, listed and approved for outdoor unless specifically required by the plan sheets. When EMT is called for, provide 6. Do not use intermediate metal conduit (IMC) or electrical metallic tubing (EMT) aluminum boxes. Size outlet boxes according to the NEC. junction boxes containing only 10 AWG or 12 AWG conductors. Do not use die cast 5. Provide hot dipped galvanized cast iron or sand cast aluminum outlet boxes for an internal volume greater than 100 cu. inches. conduit entries are on the same side. Mechanically secure all junction boxes with conduit within 3 ft. of the enclosure or within 18 in. of the enclosure if all purpose and supported by connection of two or more rigid metal conduits. Secure entering raceways must have threaded entries or hubs identified for the intended 4. Junction boxes with an internal volume of less than 100 cu. in. and supported by paint as an alternative for materials required to be galvanized. as allowed under Item 445 "Galvanizing." Do not paint non-galvanized material with a zinc rich more zinc content) to alleviate overspray. Use zinc rich paint to touch up galvanized material cut ends of all mounting strut and RMC (threaded or non-threaded) with zinc rich paint (94% or 14. File smooth the cut ends of all mounting strut and conduit. Before installing, paint the field conduit sealant. tests. Do not use duct tape as a permanent conduit sealant. Do not use silicone caulk as a the Engineer. Seal conduit immediately after completion of conductor installation and pull 13. Seal ends of all conduits with duct seal, expandable foam, or by other methods approved by from the bottom of the box. See the ground box detail on sheet ED(4). 12. Place conduits entering ground boxes so that the conduit openings are between 3 in. and 6 in. 11. At all electrical services, install a 6 AWG solid copper grounding electrode conductor. required, if the duct extends the full length through the casing. grounding conductor. Bonding of conduit used as a casing under roadways for duct cable is not or equipment grounding conductor. Ensure all bonding jumpers are the same size as the equipment 10. Install a bonding jumper from each grounding bushing to the nearest ground rod, grounding lug, install a grounding type bushing on all metal conduit terminations. 9. Fit the ends of all PVC conduit terminations with bushings or bell end fittings. Provide and tight sealing hubs are not required. cans, service enclosures, auxiliary enclosures and junction boxes. Grounding bushings on water hubs or using boxes with threaded bosses. This includes surface mounted safety switches, meter 8. Ensure conduit entry into the top of any enclosure is waterproof by installing conduit sealing conduit and prove it clear in accordance with Item 618 prior to installing any conductors. durable duct tape are allowed. Tightly fix the tape to the conduit opening. Clean out the after installation to prevent entry of dirt, debris and animals. Temporary caps constructed of 7. During construction, temporarily cap or plug open ends of all conduit and raceways immediately 6. Provide and place warning tape approximately 10 in. above all trenched conduit as per Item 618. Backfill", 402 "Trench Excavation Protection", and 403 "Temporary Special Shoring." Items 110 "Excavation", 400 "Excavation and Backfill for Structures", 401 "Flowable new roadways, backfill all trenches with cement-stabilized base as per requirements of material unless otherwise noted on the plans. When placing conduit in the sub-base of 5. When placing conduit in the sub-grade of new roadways, backfill all trenches with excavated or Box" prior to installing conduit or duct cable to prevent bending of the connections. compact the bore pits below the conduit per Item 476 "Jacking, Boring, or Tunneling Pipe driveways, sidewalks, or after the base or surfacing operation has begun. Backfill and 4. Unless otherwise shown on the plans, jack or bore conduit placed beneath existing roadways, specifically in the plans or as approved by the Engineer. 3. Do not attach conduit supports directly to pre-stressed concrete beams except as shown on ED(2). Install conduit support within 3 ft. of all enclosures and conduit terminations. attaching metal conduit to surface of concrete structures. See "Conduit Mounting Options" 2. Space all conduit supports at maximum intervals of 5 ft. Install conduit spacers when for the required expansion conduit fittings. amount of expansion to the Engineer upon request. Do not use LFMC or LFNC as a substitute movement at no additional cost to the Department. Provide the method of determining the joint conduit fittings. Repair or replace expansion joint fittings that do not allow for requested by the project Engineer, supply manufacturer's specification sheet for expansion externally exposed on structures such as bridges at maximum intervals of 150 ft. When and install expansion joint fittings on all continuous runs of galvanized steel RMC conduit the structure's expansion joints to allow for movement of the conduit. In addition, provide 1. Provide and install expansion joint conduit fittings on all structure-mounted conduits at the service riser conduit. properly sized stainless steel or hot dipped galvanized one-hole standoff straps are allowed on 10. Use two-hole straps when supporting 2 in. and larger conduits. On electrical service poles, foundations. foundations. Provide PVC or galvanized steel RMC elbows as called for at all ground boxes and and schedule as shown on the plans. Do not extend substituted conduit into ground boxes or the HDPE conduit to PVC (or RMC elbow when required) at the bore pit. Provide conduit of the size except that the conduit is supplied without factory-installed conductors. Make the transition of size PVC called for in the plans. Ensure the substituted HDPE meets the requirements of Item 622, conduit bid under Item 618. Ensure bored HDPE substituted for PVC is schedule 40 and of the same the Engineer, substitute HDPE conduit with no conductors for bored schedule 40 or schedule 80 PVC conductors according to Item 622 "Duct Cable." At the Contractor's request and with approval by 9. When required, provide High-Density Polyethylene (HDPE) conduit with factory installed internal PVC elbows are subsidiary to various bid items. concrete. PVC extensions are allowed on these concrete encased rigid metal elbows. RMC or metal elbow is not required if the entire RMC elbow is encased in a minimum of 2 in. of elbow by means of a grounding bushing on a rigid metal extension. Grounding of the rigid the plans and any portion of the RMC elbow is buried less than 18 in., ground the RMC the PVC conduit system. When galvanized steel RMC elbows are specifically called for in a flat, high tensile strength polyester fiber pull tape for pulling conductors through 8. Provide PVC elbows in PVC conduit systems, unless otherwise shown on the plans. Use only \ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\ed2-14.dgn8/5/20204:54:05 PMDOCUMENT NAMEDATE TIMEStandard Division Operations Traffic ELECTRIC CONDUIT TO BRIDGE DECK ATTACHMENT CONDUIT MOUNTING OPTIONS 71B ED(2)-14 ed2-14.dgn CONDUIT SUPPORTS ELECTRICAL DETAILS 129 TYPICAL CONDUIT ENTRY TO BRIDGE STRUCTURE DETAIL EXPANSION ANCHOR NOTES FOR BRIDGE DECK ATTACHMENT See ED(1)B.2 Attachment to concrete surfaces h h introduced after conduit installation. at the required minimum embedment depth ( ef). No lateral loads shall be breakout, and concrete pullout strengths as determined by ACI 318 Appendix D) 6. Use anchors of minimum 1600 Lbs tensile capacity (minimum of steel, concrete thread length for proper torqueing and tightening of anchors. embedment depth, ( ef), as shown. Increase ( ef)as needed to ensure sufficient deck strands or reinforcement. Install anchors to ensure a minimum effective 5. Prior to hole drilling, use rebar locator to ensure clearing of existing the structure. be witnessed and approved by the Engineer prior to furnishing anchors on demonstration test to evaluate the procedures and tools. The test shall manufacturer's published installation instructions. Arrange a field 4. Install anchors as shown on the plans and in accordance with the anchor wedge shall be stainless steel. application in marine environment, both the anchor body and expansion bodies can be either zinc-plated carbon steel or stainless steel. For manufactured with carbon steel expansion wedges are not allowed. Anchor 3. Use anchors manufactured with stainless steel expansion wedges. Anchors uncracked concrete. list; and do not use expansion anchors that are only approved for use in do not use expansion anchors that are not included in the ICC-ES approval 2. Unless otherwise approved by the Engineer: do not use adhesive anchors; Anchors. maintained on the ICC-ES website under Division 031600 for Concrete ICC-ES Evaluation Report number, and its approval status shall be Service (ICC-ES). The chosen anchor product shall have a designated use in cracked concrete by the International Code Council, Evaluation 1. Use torque controlled mechanical expansion anchors that are approved for h HANGER ASSEMBLY DETAIL 1" ƒ" Bridge Deck Hex Nut Hex Nut efh Threaded Coupler Nut Washer & Flat Washer Hex Nut, Split Lock Washer & Flat Washer Hex Nut, Split Lock Oversized Cut Washer Washer & Square or Hex Nut, Split Lock Channel Mounting Conduit Min. =2 •" Anchor Expansion …" Dia. Rod Threaded …" Dia. "SPAN" less than 2' 2'-0" to 2'-6" >2'-6" to 3'-0" 1 †" x 1 …" "H" "W" 12 Ga. 1 †" x 1 †" 1 †" x 2 ‹" 12 Ga. 12 Ga. "W" x "H" CONDUIT MOUNTING CHANNEL "T" "T" capacity is not reduced by more than 15%. patterns are allowed, if the load carrying Channels with round or short slotted hole Conduit (RMC) Rigid Metal Channel Mounting Conduit CONDUIT HANGING DETAIL1'-3"6" [ Girder [ Girder Deck Bridge Min 1" Min ASSEMBLY DETAIL" See "HANGER MaxVaries Channel Conduit Mounting "SPAN" Clamp Conduit Conduit (RMC) Rigid Metal [ …" Diameter & Threaded Rods Expansion Anchors PVC Conduit Wing Wall 3' max. RMC Fitting Expansion Conduit galvanized) or equal) (Hot dip Kindorf, Unistrut Channel (B-line, Conduit Mounting Structure Concrete Conduit Strap galvanized or hot dipped Stainless steel Strut Type (mounting shoe) Conduit Spacer Structure Concrete Conduit min.1" conduit strap malleable galvanized Hot-dipped 1 •" max. depth 1" min., anchor. Anchor to 2" use …" dia. For conduits 1 •" ‚" dia. anchor. up to 1 ‚" use for conduit •" expansion anchor: Stainless steel Min. •"1 •" max. depth 1" min., anchor. Anchor steel expansion …" Stainless October 2014 DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO.of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:06 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic ED(3)-14 71C ed3-14.dgn 130 CONDUCTORS ELECTRICAL DETAILS tape adhesive Hot melt A. MATERIAL INFORMATION ELECTRICAL CONDUCTORS B. CONSTRUCTION METHODS Tube Shrink Heat type connector "C" clamp cover insulating splice with gel-filled Listed Screw Type molded cover See through molded clamp Snap-lock, SPLICE OPTION 3 overlap 2" Min. „" to ‚" of tubing by extend past end tape. Tape to hot melt adhesive conductors with Seal between Compression Type SPLICE OPTION 1 Split Bolt Type SPLICE OPTION 2 overlap 2" Min. tape adhesive Hot melt „" to ‚" of tubing by extend past end tape. Tape to hot melt adhesive conductors with Seal between sharp edges heat shrink from tape to protect hot melt adhesive connector with Wrap split bolt Tube Shrink Heat overlap 2" Min. Split bolt overlap 2" Min. „" to ‚" tubing by past end of Tape to extend adhesive tape. hot melt diameter with insulation Increase „" to ‚" tubing by past end of Tape to extend adhesive tape. hot melt diameter with insulation Increase connections for making Set Screw/Lug C. TEMPORARY WIRING GROUND RODS & GROUNDING ELECTRODES A. MATERIAL INFORMATION B. CONSTRUCTION METHODS the NEC. during the construction process in a timely manner and in conformance with 5. Protect and when necessary repair any existing electrical conduits uncovered conformance with the NEC. lowest point. Ground messenger wires that support power conductors in the vertical clearance to ground is at least 18 ft. when measured at the in areas subject to vehicle traffic or mobile construction equipment, ensure horizontally from any metal structure. Where installing temporary conductors the splices are more than 10 ft. above grade vertically and more than 5 ft. 4. Enclose conductor splices within a listed enclosure or ground box, or ensure where approved. 3. Use listed wire nuts with factory applied sealant for temporary wiring following: molded cord and plug set, receptacle, or circuit breaker type. and refrigerators located outdoors at grade. GFCI may be any one of the portable electrical equipment, power tools, ice machines, ice storage bins 2. Provide a ground fault circuit interrupter (GFCI) for power outlets for the NEC article "Temporary Installations" and Department standard sheets. 1. Install temporary conductors and electrical equipment in accordance with Listed Screw Type horizontal trench for rocky soil or a solid rock bottom. 7. Written authorization is required before installing a ground rod in a and properly sized bonding jumper on each end of the metal conduit. conductors with metal conduit, provide and install a grounding type bushing conductors with non-metallic conduit. When protecting grounding electrode 6. Unless otherwise called for in the plans, protect grounding electrode radius bend of four inches for these conductors. lightning protection ground rods. When a bend is required, ensure a minimum 5. Route all conductors as short and straight as possible for connection to at the clamp location. 4. Remove all non-conductive coatings such as concrete splatter from the rod the rod. 3. Install ground rods so the imprinted part number is at the upper end of 2. Do not place ground rods in the same drilled hole as a timber pole. soil, ensure that the upper end is between 2 to 4 in. below finished grade. readily accessible for inspection or repairs. For ground rods installed in in concrete, ensure the connection of the conductor to the ground rod is concrete, or both, as called for in the plans. For ground rods installed 1. Furnish auxiliary ground rods for lightning protection and install in soil, under Item 620. installations, provide a minimum size 8 AWG EGC. The EGC is paid for are bonded together at every accessible location. For traffic signal current carrying conductor contained in the conduit. Ensure all EGCs Unless shown elsewhere, size the EGC to be the same size as the largest (EGC) in all conduits that contain circuit wiring of 50 volts or more. 12. Provide and install a separate stranded equipment grounding conductor October 2014C TxDOT subsidiary to various bid items. materials, breakaway disconnects, splice covers, and fuse holders are UL listed gel-filled insulating splice covers. Splicing materials, insulating adhesive tape to fill the gap and seal the ends of heat shrink tubing. Provide split bolt connectors for splicing as specified in DMS 11040. Use hot melt 4. Use listed compression or screw type pressure connectors, terminal blocks, or with a permanent marker. identification as shown in the plans. Print circuit identification on the tag two straps, large enough to indicate circuit number, letter, or other around both circuit conductors at each accessible location. Provide tags with identify the conductors of each branch circuit by attaching a non-metallic tag 3. Where two or more circuits are present in one conduit or enclosure, permanently plans. electrode conductor to the concrete encased grounding electrode as shown in the with a UL listed connector in accordance with DMS 11040. Connect the grounding the service location. Connect the grounding electrode conductor to the ground rod service equipment to the concrete encased grounding electrode or the ground rod at 2. Provide a solid copper 6 AWG grounding electrode conductor to bond the electrical least 6 in. of the conductor's insulation with half laps of tape. jacket or by colored tape. When identifying conductors with colored tape, mark at color jacket. Identify electrical conductors 4 AWG and larger by continuous color system. Identify conductors 6 American Wire Gauge (AWG) and smaller by continuous except green, white, or gray. Keep color scheme consistent throughout the wiring or bare conductors. Identify ungrounded (hot) conductors with any color insulation white insulation. Identify grounding conductors (ground wires) with green insulation conductors in conformance with the NEC. Identify grounded (neutral) conductors with under "Roadway Illumination and Electrical Supplies" Item 620. Color code insulated conductors as listed on the Material Producers List (MPL) on the Department web site Specification (DMS)11040 "Conductors" and Item 620 "Electrical Conductors." Provide 1. Provide Type XHHW insulated conductors in accordance with Departmental Material as shown on the MPL. openings. Leave unused openings factory sealed. Use prequalified breakaway connectors a single opening in a boot. Provide waterproof boots with the correct number of around the conductor to ensure waterproof connection. Only one conductor may enter breakaway devices. Trim waterproofing boots on breakaway connectors to fit snugly threaded connections. Proper terminations are critical to the safe operation of instructions when terminating conductors to breakaway connectors. Properly torque conductors pass through a breakaway support device. Follow manufacturer's 11. Install breakaway connectors on conductors bid under Item 620 whenever those listing for maximum number and size of conductors allowed. connector is rated for multiple conductors. Do not exceed the pressure connector's 10. Do not terminate more than one conductor under a single connector, unless the Use only approved splicing methods. 9. Do not repair damaged conductors with duct tape, electrical tape, or wire nuts. insulation resistance test at no additional cost to the department. 8. Replace conductors and cables that are damaged beyond repair or that fail an conductor strands or removed strands will be considered damaged. nicking the individual strands of the conductor. Conductors with nicked individual 7. When terminating conductors, remove the insulation and jacketing material without 6. Support conductors in illumination poles with a J-hook at the top of the pole. accumulation of water. ground boxes. Install wire nuts in an upright position to prevent the smaller conductors in above ground junction boxes, but not in pole bases or 5. Wire nuts with factory applied waterproof sealant may be used for 8 AWG or manufacturer's specifications when used in place of heat shrink tubing. 4. Size and install gel-filled insulating splice covers according to been burned, or overheated, is considered defective and must be replaced. seal the ends of heat shrink tubing. Heat shrink tubing that appears to have past the heat shrink tubing. Use hot melt adhesive tape to fill the gap and the individual conductors and the heat shrink tubing. Ensure the tape extends insulation using hot melt adhesive tape to provide a watertight seal between conductors, prior to heating the tubing, increase the diameter of the conductor may not shrink sufficiently to provide a watertight seal around the individual minimum of 2 in. past both sides of the splice. Where heat shrink tubing watertight splice. Overlap conductor insulation with heat shrink tubing a heat shrink tubing or gel-filled insulating splice covers to provide a terminal blocks, or split bolt connectors. Insulate splices with heavy wall enclosures and use only listed compression or screw type pressure connectors, 3. Make splices only in junction boxes, ground boxes, pole bases, or electrical length of conductor at enclosures, weatherheads and pole bases. boxes when pulled through with no splice. Leave 1 ft. minimum, 1.5 ft. maximum ground boxes. Leave 3 ft. minimum, 4 ft. maximum length of conductor in ground 2. Leave 2 ft. minimum, 3 ft. maximum length for each conductor up to the splice in Engineer to witness the tests. insulation resistance tests in accordance with Item 620. Coordinate with the needed alterations or repairs at no additional cost to the department. Perform perform conductor pull test. If a conductor cannot be freely pulled, make any conductors through the conduit system. After installing conductors in conduit, 1. Use only a flat, high tensile strength polyester fiber pull tape for pulling specific locations including electrical service, see individual plan sheets. plans sheets. Concrete encased grounding electrodes may be called for in length rods may be called for in some specific locations, see the individual ground rods according to DMS 11040 and the plans. Larger diameter or longer 1. Provide and install a grounding electrode at electrical services. Provide \ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:07 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic ED(4)-14 71D ed4-14.dgn GROUND BOXES ELECTRICAL DETAILS GROUND BOXES APRON FOR GROUND BOX PLAN VIEW AA (1) SECTION A - A 3" to 6" 2"2" 10"(typ) box Ground steel Reinforcing No. 3 duct cable Conduit or steel Reinforcing No.3 box Ground (typ) 10"Depth of box Apron-Full (typ) 10" ell Conduit (when required) Concrete Apron Class A PVC (4) fitting for RMC. Bell end bushing for Grounding (2) fill (3) 9" Aggregate B. CONSTRUCTION METHODS 4. Provide larger ground boxes in accordance with Item 624 and as shown in the plans. 3. Ensure ground box cover is correctly labeled in accordance with DMS 11070. and Electrical Supplies," Item 624. the Material Producers List (MPL) on the Department web site under "Roadway Illumination 2. Provide Type A, B, C, D, and E ground boxes as shown in the plans, and as listed on Item 624 "Ground Boxes." accordance with Departmental Material Specification (DMS) 11070 "Ground Boxes" and 1. Provide polymer concrete ground boxes measuring 16x30x24 in. (WxLxD) or smaller in 131 GROUND BOX COVER L J K H I P PLAN VIEW SIDEEND M Nfor head recess bolt with Hole for •" See DMS 11070 requirements. and labeling For cover logo GROUND BOX DIMENSIONS TYPE A B C D E GROUND BOX COVER DIMENSIONS DIMENSIONS (INCHES) H I N PJKLM 23 13 ƒ13 • 30 •30 ‚17 •13 ‚17 ‚ 2 2 23 ‚9 ‡5 „ 6 ƒ 1 … 1 … A, B & E C & D TYPE October 2014 OUTSIDE DIMENSIONS (INCHES) 12 X 23 X 11 12 X 23 X 22 (Width x Length X Depth) 16 X 29 X 11 16 X 29 X 22 12 X 23 X 17 conduits terminating in a ground box. the ground box. Install a PVC bushing or bell end fitting on the upper end of all PVC Ground RMC elbows when any part of the elbow is less than 18 in. below the bottom of (4) Install a grounding bushing on the upper end of all RMC terminating in a ground box. interior volume of the box. (3) Place aggregate under the box, not in the box. Aggregate should not encroach on the (2) Maintain sufficient space between conduits to allow for proper installation of bushing. or bell end fittings. that ground box walls do not interfere with the installation of grounding bushings (1) Uniformly space ends of conduits within the ground box. Position ends of conduits so A. MATERIALS 11. Bond metal ground box covers to the grounding conductor with a tank ground type lug. identifying the specific boxes in writing. This work will be paid for separately. of the contract, the Engineer may direct the Contractor to bond the metal covers, 10. If other ground boxes with metal covers are within the project limits but are not part fully describing the work required. Verify existing ground boxes with metal covers are shown on the plans, with notes as the grounding conductor. The bonding jumper is subsidiary to various bid items. equipment grounding conductor with a 3 ft. long stranded bonding jumper the same size 9. If an existing ground box in the contract has a metal cover, bond the cover to the below grade. to cut an appropriately sized hole for conduit entry in the side wall at least 18 inches 8. When a type B or D ground box is stacked to meet volume requirements, it is allowable together and to the ground rod with listed connectors. 7. When a ground rod is present in a ground box, bond all equipment grounding conductors Do not use silicone caulk as a sealant. foam, or other method as approved. Do not use duct tape as a permanent conduit sealant. and pull tests. Permanently seal the ends of all conduits with duct seal, expandable 6. Permanently seal conduits immediately after the completion of conductor installation 5. Temporarily seal all conduits in the ground box until conductors are installed. conduits so grounding bushings and bell end fittings can easily be installed. 4. Install all conduits and ells in a neat and workmanlike manner. Uniformly space boxes. 3. Keep bolt holes in the box clear of dirt. Bolt covers down when not working in ground subsidiary to ground boxes when called for by descriptive code. under the box. Ground box aprons, including concrete and reinforcing steel, are of concrete for the apron extends from finished grade to the top of the aggregate bed 2. Cast ground box aprons in place. Reinforcing steel may be field bent. Ensure the depth aggregate. least 9 inches deep, prior to setting the ground box. Install ground box on top of Item 302 "Aggregates for Surface Treatments." Ensure aggregate bed is in place and at and setting ground box. Provide Grade 3 or 4 coarse aggregate as shown on Table 2 of 1. Remove all gravel and dirt from conduit. Cap all conduits prior to placing aggregate \ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:08 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic 71E ED(5)-14 ed5-14.dgn 132 ELECTRICAL SERVICES NOTES SERVICE NOTES & DATA ELECTRICAL DETAILS TOP MOUNTED PHOTOCELL or equal) Kindorf, B-line channel(Unistrut, Conduit mounting 6" and photocell receptacle photocell Standard 3-prong cell and pole. between photo- to 1" clearance to provide •" Conduit, bend •" RM utility company. as allowed by by Engineer, and or as directed finished grade to 20 feet above the pole or 18 from the top of 6" to 8" measured Mount Photocell Support Service of pole photocells as shown on Top Mounted Photocell Detail. operation. Mount photocell facing north when practical. Mount top photocell from stray or ambient night time light to ensure proper 1.Provide photocell as listed on the MPL. Move, adjust, or shield the 3/#2 2P/100 28.1N/A ID Service Elec. SB 183 Number Sheet Plan No./Size Conductors Service Amps Switch Safety Pole/Amps Ckt. Bkr. Main Amps Contractor Two-Pole Amp Rating Loadcenter Panelbd/ ID Circuit Branch Pole/Amps Ckt. Bkr. Branch Amps Circuit Branch Load KVA 262P/40Lighting NB Lighting SB Underpass Sig. Controller Luminaires Flashing Beacon 1 Flashing Beacon 2 252P/40 151P/20 231P/30 1P/20 1P/20 100 70 100 N/A 30 2P/60N/A N/A 3/#6 3/#6 1 ‚" 1 ‚" 289 30 58 NB Access 2nd & Main N/A ELECTRICAL SERVICE DATA 5.3 ELC SRV TY A 240/480 100(SS)AL(E)SF(U) ELC SRV TY D 120/240 060(NS)SS(E)TS(O) ELC SRV TY T 120/240 000(NS)GS(N)SP(O) * * Electrical Service Description documentation from the electric utility provider to the Engineer. breaker's ampere interrupting capacity (AIC) rating and provide verify that the available fault current is less than the circuit 2.When the utility company provides a transformer larger than 50 KVA, ensure handle is lockable in both the "On" and "Off" positions. 1.Field drill flange-mounted remote operator handle if needed, to * * * Size Conduit Service * 2"100 CCTV 2P/20 1P/20 9 3 4 4 October 2014 with a conduit sealing hub or threaded boss, such as a meter base hub. Grounding bushings are not required when the end of the metal conduit is fitted bushings on all metal conduits, and terminate bonding jumpers to grounding bus. penetrate the equipment mounting panel inside the enclosure. Provide grounding 15.Do not install conduit in the back wall of a service enclosure where it would enclosure that has no door pocket. drawings before completion of the work to the Engineer, instead of placing in 11 in. x 17 in. plan sheets to 8 • in. x 11 in before laminating. Deliver these sheets detailing equipment and branch circuits supplied by that service. Reduce 14.When providing an "Off The Shelf" Type D or Type T service, provide laminated plan sheets, the installing contractor is to redline plan sheets before laminating. 8 • in. x 11 in. before laminating. If the installation differs from the plan in the service enclosure's document pocket. Reduce 11 in. x 17 in. plan sheets to branch circuits supplied by that service. The laminated plan sheets are to be placed will copy and laminate the actual project plan sheets detailing all equipment and used to build the enclosure in the enclosure's data pocket. The installing contractor drawings and the laminated plan sheet showing the electrical service data chart service. Before shipment to the job site, place the applicable laminated schematic enclosure manufacturers will prepare and submit a schematic drawing unique to each 13.For all electrical service enclosures listed under Item 628 on the MPL, the UL 508 company specifications. 12.Ensure all mounting hardware and installation details of services conform to utility movement demonstrated to the satisfaction of the Engineer. required on all installed conductors, with at least six inches of free conductor conductor. Ensure any bend in LFMC never exceeds 180 degrees. A pull test is terminated with a grounding fitting. The LFMC must contain a grounded (neutral) need not be strapped. Each end of LFMC must have a grounding bushing or be length. Strap LFMC within 1 foot of each end. LFMC less than 12 inches in length LFMC the same size as service entrance conduit. LFMC must not exceed 3 feet in service enclosure when they are mounted 90 to 180 degrees to each other. Size the 11.Use of liquidtight flexible metal conduit (LFMC) is allowed between the meter and grounding bushing on the RMC where it terminates in the service enclosure. the conduit shown on the layout for that particular branch circuit. Install a a minimum of 6 inches underground and then couple to the type and schedule of on the layout sheets for branch circuit conduit. Extend all rigid metal conduits conduit for branch circuit entry to enclosure is the same size as that shown conductor. Size the service entrance conduit as shown in the plans. Ensure • in. PVC conduit containing the electrical service grounding electrode 10.Provide rigid metal conduit (RMC) for all conduits on service, except for the when furnished by the Contractor, will be paid for separately. the elbow, including service conduit and conductors for the utility pole riser service. For an underground utility feed, all service conduit and conductors after including the riser or the elbow below ground are subsidiary to the electrical 9.All electrical service conduit and conductors attached to the electrical service 12 inches minimum, 18 inches maximum, or as required by utility. weatherhead. The lengths of the conductors outside the weatherhead are to be entrance conductor exits through a separately bushed non-metallic opening in the with half laps of colored tape, when identifying conductors. Ensure each service jacket or by colored tape. Mark at least 6 inches of the conductor's insulation Identify electrical conductors sized 4 AWG and larger by continuous color Wire Gauge (AWG). Identify size 6 AWG conductors by continuous color jacket. and white colored XHHW service entrance conductors of minimum size 6 American 8.Provide wiring and electrical components rated for 75°C. Provide red, black, stainless steel may be used. 7.When galvanized is specified for nuts, screws, bolts or miscellaneous hardware, incidental contact as required by the NEC. enclosure do not need a dead front trim. Protect incoming line terminations from 6.Enclosures with external disconnects that de-energize all equipment inside the locks are installed. Unless otherwise approved, do not energize electrical service equipment until enclosures. Master Lock #2195 keys and locks become property of the State. provide Master Lock #2195 Type 2 with brass tumblers for "off the shelf" keyed #2195 for all custom electrical enclosures. Installing Contractor is to 5.The enclosure manufacturer will provide Master Lock Type 2 with brass tumblers work as approved. with the utility provider to determine costs and requirements, and coordinate the with these charges prior to engaging the utility company to do the work. Consult are paid for in accordance with Item 628. Get approval for the costs associated charges, and other charges by the utility company to provide power to the location with utility requirements. Primary line extensions, connection charges, meter 4.Coordinate with the Engineer and the utility provider for metering and compliance complete electrical service as specified in the plans. 3.Provide all work, materials, services, and any incidentals needed to install a detailed on the plans. Illumination and Electrical Supplies," Item 628. Provide other service types as on the Material Producers List (MPL) on the Department web site under "Roadway Standard Specifications. Provide electrical service types A, C, and D, as listed "Electrical Services-Pedestal (PS)", and Item 628 "Electrical Services" of the "Electrical Services-Type D," DMS 11084 "Electrical Services-Type T," DMS 11085 "Electrical Services-Type A," DMS 11082 "Electrical Services-Type C," DMS 11083 Departmental Material Specification (DMS) 11080 "Electrical Services,"DMS 11081 2.Provide electrical services in accordance with Electrical Details standard sheets, and guarantees as a customary trade practice, furnish these to the State. or installation is justification for rejection. Where manufacturers provide warranties Data chart in the plans. Faulty fabrication or poor workmanship in material, equipment, circuit breaker panels, and branch circuit breakers as shown on the Electrical Service Provide and install electrical service conduits, conductors, disconnects, contactors, Association (NEMA) standards. Ensure material is Underwriters Laboratories (UL) listed. provisions of the National Electrical Code (NEC) and National Electrical Manufacturers 1.Provide new materials. Ensure installation and materials comply with the applicable in the PS descriptive code, provide an AL enclosure. DMS 11080 and 11085. Do not provide GS pedestal services. If GS is shown 4.Provide pedestal service (PS) enclosures in accordance with ED(9) and not paint stainless steel. and D in accordance with DMS 11080, 11081, 11082, 11083, and 11084. Do 3.Provide aluminum (AL) and stainless steel (SS) enclosures for Types A, C, DMS 11080, 11082, 11083, and 11084. photocell or lighting contactor. Provide GS enclosures in accordance with and for Type D and T services that do not use an enclosure mounted 2.Type galvanized steel (GS) enclosures may be used for Type C panelboards 1.Provide threaded hub for all conduit entries into the top of enclosure. 1.0 requirements. Ensure conduit size meets the National ELectrical Code. Verify service conduit size with utility. Size may change due to utility meter electrical service data chart specific to that service as shown in the plans. Example only, not for construction. All new electrical services must have box with cover. aluminum outlet or sand cast cast iron, galvanized, Hot dipped Schematic Type Enclosure Type Photocell Mounting Location Service Support Type Service Voltage V / V ELEC SERV TY X XXX/XXX XXX (XX) XX (X) XX (X) EXPLANATION OF ELECTRICAL SERVICE DESCRIPTIVE CODE Typically Type T 000 indicates main lug only/ Disconnect Amp Rating Meter-Check with Utility (NS)= No safety Switch Ahead of Meter-Check with Utility (SS)= Safety Switch Ahead of AL= Aluminum (Custom Enclosure)See MPL SS= Stainless steel(Custom Enclosure)See MPL GS= Galvanized steel("off the shelf") Lighting Contactor Required (N)= None/No Photocell or (L)= Luminaire mounted (T)= Top of pole Mounted (E)= Inside Service/Enclosure from Utility U= Underground Service Feed from Utility O= Overhead Service Feed PS= Pedestal Service signal pole TS= Service on traffic EX= Existing pole for separately OT= Pole by others or paid SF= Steel frame SP= Steel pole TP= Timber pole OC= Other concrete GC= Granite concrete between straps supporting conduit. from box. 5 foot maximum spacing Install conduit strap maximum 3 feet SERVICE ASSEMBLY ENCLOSURE MAIN DISCONNECT & BRANCH CIRCUIT BREAKERS PHOTOELECTRIC CONTROL \ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:09 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic AND NOTES SERVICE ENCLOSURE ELECTRICAL DETAILS ed6-14.dgn 71F ED(6)-14 1 Service Assembly Enclosure 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 Control Station ("H-O-A" Switch) mounted shown) Photo Electric Control (enclosure- Lighting Contactor (See Electrical Service Data) Branch Circuit Breaker12 13 14 Load Center Power Distribution Terminal Blocks Neutral Bus SCHEMATIC LEGEND N G Power Wiring Control Wiring required Equipment grounding conductor-always WIRING LEGEND Safety Switch (when required) utility provider) Meter (when required-verify with electric Service Data) Main Disconnect Breaker (See Electrical Circuit Breaker, 15 Amp (Control Circuit) Auxiliary Enclosure 15 Ground Bus 240 2 120 4 jumper Bonding 3 12 8 7 9 1010 G N Typical 120 / 240 Volt Typical 240 Volt Branch Circuit Branch Circuit Luminaire G 120/240 VOLTS - THREE WIRE G N Typical 120 Volt Branch Circuit SCHEMATIC TYPE D - CUSTOM 15 weatherhead. conductor exits the with red tape where conductors' insulation of Line 1 or Line 2 color code 6" length Red insulation or exits the weatherhead. tape where conductor insulation with white of neutral conductors' color code 6" length White insulation or SCHEMATIC TYPE T Typical 120 Volt Branch Circuit 120/240 VOLTS - THREE WIRE no lighting contractor will be installed. top of the pole or on luminaire only, only. When required install photocell Galvanized steel-"Buy Off The Shelf" G N G N 2 120 12 240 14 1115 Typical 120 / 240 Volt Branch Circuit SCHEMATIC TYPE A THREE WIRE Typical Branch Circuits G G 1 2 8 3 5 4 11 10 12 V V12 7 N N 15 Typical Branch Circuit 13 12 5 9 11 SCHEMATIC TYPE C THREE WIRE V 6 7 G 2 1 4 V12 8 N 15 11 15 9 mounted. is listed as pole top required when photocell mounted. Windows not is listed as enclosure required when photocell windows not shown but Two Photocell viewing 8 Do not bond this bus to the enclosure exits the weatherhead. tape where conductor insulation with white of neutral conductors' color code 6" length White insulation or weatherhead. conductor exits the with red tape where conductors' insulation of Line 1 or Line 2 color code 6" length Red insulation or 10 Electrode Grounding Electrode Grounding Electrode Grounding Electrode Grounding 133 October 2014 Neutral Conductor Separate Circuit Breaker Panelboard \ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT CONT FILE:DATE:8/5/20204:54:11 PM Standard Division Operations Traffic ED(8)-14 ed8-14.dgn 134 SYSTEM DETAILS TYPICAL TRAFFIC SIGNAL ELECTRICAL DETAILS Line INSET A of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:Entrance Service type signal pole sheets for See layout box Ground 71H TRAFFIC SIGNAL NOTES 18" max. slack length, 12" min., weatherhead. Conductor conductor exits the with red tape where conductor's insulation of Line 1 or Line 2 color code 6" length Red insulation or exits weatherhead. tape where conductor insulation with white neutral conductor's color code 6" of White insulation or 3 Wire 120/240 Volt See Note 7 Meter See Note 7 Enclosure Service Inset A See Note 11 and conduit details sheet for foundation See TS-FD standard for details) layout sheet Conduits (See SIGNAL CONTROLLER SIGNAL POLE See Note 6 electrode conductor service grounding connect electrical tank ground fitting, •" X 13 UNC. Install Drill, top and thread October 2014 FRONT VIEW SIGNAL POLE WITH SERVICE additional details. and electrical service data chart for See electrical details, layout sheets, on signal pole shown as an example. Type T electrical service mounted End Fitting or Bell Bushing (see side view) Ground box SIGNAL CONTROLLER SIDE VIEW conduits that are required. locations and any additional sheets for ground box requirements. See layout conduit and grounding See TS-CF standard for view) requirements (see side conduits, and grounding number of required foundation details, for controller See TS-CF standard minimum burial depth for conduit placed under a roadway is 24". 11. For all conduits, ensure the burial depth is a minimum of 18". Ensure the seal conduit ends. entering enclosures with duct seal or expanding foam. Do not use silicone to grounding bushing to the ground bus with a bonding jumper. Seal all conduits conduits not connected to conduit-sealing hub or threaded boss. Bond the or threaded boss such as meter hub. Install a grounding bushing on all metal 10. Terminate conduits entering the top of enclosures with a conduit-sealing hub to the signal installation. 9. Lock all enclosures and bolt down all ground box covers before applying power on traffic signal cables after termination. To prevent electronics damage, do not conduct insulation resistance tests power conductors as required in Item 620 "Electrical Conductors" and ED(3). 8. Conduct pull tests and insulation resistance tests on all illumination and signal pole for attaching conduit. in the enclosure. Band or drill and tap properly sized stand-off straps to each enclosure. Install properly sized stainless steel washers on each bolt to bands using two-bolt brackets. Install brackets near top and bottom of steel bands. Ensure bands are a minimum width of ƒ in. Secure enclosures 7. Mount electrical service enclosure and meter to signal pole with stainless entrance conduit and branch circuit conduit as shown in the plans. ground fitting. See Inset A detail for further information. Size service is as short and straight as possible from the enclosure to the tank ground fitting. Ensure electrical service grounding electrode conductor Connect the electrical service grounding electrode conductor to the tank bottom of the enclosure for the service grounding electrode conductor. electrical service enclosure. Provide properly sized hole through the Provide and install tank ground fitting 4 in. to 6 in. directly below 6. Drill and tap signal poles for • in. X 13 UNC tank ground fitting. details. rated for embedment in concrete. See TXDOT standard TS-FD for further 6 AWG stranded copper conductors. Use listed mechanical connectors 5. Bond anchor bolts to rebar cage in two locations using #3 bars or ground the fixture to the pole with a 12 AWG green XHHW conductor. 4. If internally illuminated street name signs are approved for use, associated traffic signal system test. installed roadway luminaires for proper operation as a part of the Assemblies," except for performance testing of luminaires. Test material and construction sections of Item 610, "Roadway Illumination 3. Provide roadway luminaires, when required, in accordance with the conductor. the electrical system. Bond all exposed metal parts to the grounding 2. Include an equipment grounding conductor in all conduits throughout 1. Do not pass luminaire conductors through the signal controller cabinet.\ DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\ed9-14.dgn8/5/20204:54:12 PMStandard Division Operations Traffic ED(9)-14 ed9-14.dgn 135 PEDESTAL SERVICE TYPE PS ELECTRICAL SERVICE SUPPORT ELECTRICAL DETAILS 6"6"16" min.min. LINE LOAD 14"6" min. 6" min. Leveling Washers2"LOAD 1 10 7 8 6 9 3 5 4 Studs (as required) Equipment Mounting 11 12 13 Studs (as required) Equipment Mounting 12"Reinforcing Steel 17 ‚"2 5 LOAD SIDE CONDUIT LOAD SIDE CONDUIT LOAD SIDE CONDUIT 16" 2 SECTION A-A ANCHOR BOLT DETAIL FRONT VIEW SIDE VIEW LINE SIDE CONDUIT Hex Nut Lock Washer Flat Washer 20"1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 LEGEND Meter Socket, (when required) Meter Socket Window, (when required) Equipment Mounting Panel Photo Electric Control Window, (When required) Hinged Deadfront Trim Load Side Conduit Trim Line Side Conduit Area Utility Access Door, with handle Pedestal Door Hinged Meter Access Control Station (H-O-A Switch) Branch Circuit Breakers Main Disconnect 71J PEDESTAL SERVICE NOTES 5"14 Steel Reinforcing 14 Copper Clad Ground Rod - 5/8" X 10'48" min.max. 3"18" min.14 14 AA bolt detial See anchor Bushings or Grounding Bell End Fittings plan details determined by of conduits Size and number panel. CB Handles shall protrude through hinged deadfront trim. individual circuit breakers (CB) mounted on an equipment mounting TYPE C shown, TYPE A similar except that TYPE A shall have October 2014 17" min. properly terminated. extension conduits are metal, grounding bushings must be installed with a bonding jumper rigid metal conduits are more than 2 in. below the top of the concrete foundation. Where for underground conduit and feeders. PVC extensions may be installed provided the ends of the 8. Ensure all elbows in the foundation are sized as per utility provider's conduit requirements 7. Do not use liquidtight flexible metal conduit (LFMC) on pedestal type services. rocking or movement of the service enclosure at no additional cost to the department. the service enclosure is level front to back and side to side within ‚ in. Repair rise in the foundation of „ in. per foot. When properly installed, ensure the top of are used, ensure no more than „ in. gap at any corner. Do not exceed a maximum dip or 6. Finish top of concrete foundation in a neat and workmanlike manner. If leveling washers bolt, a properly sized locknut and a flat washer. the anchors in the foundation with a • in. galvanized or stainless steel machine thread each corner of enclosure. Secure each of the four corners of the pedestal enclosure to mounting pedestal enclosure to foundation. Anchor location to match mounting holes in 5. Install • in. X 2 ˆ in. minimum length concrete single expansion type anchors for for Concrete." 4. Provide #4 reinforcing steel for foundations in accordance with Item 440, "Reinforcement but is considered subsidiary to Item 628. Item 420, "Concrete Substructures," except that concrete will not be paid for directly 3. Provide Class A or C concrete for pedestal service foundations in accordance with complies with local utility requirements. 2. When a meter socket is required, provide a socket with a minimum 100 amp rating that utility company prior to manufacturing the pedestal enclosure. installing the electrical pedestal service. Submit any changes required by the Contact the local utility company for approval of pedestal details prior to hardware and installation details of services meet utility company specifications. "Roadway Illumination and Electrical Supplies," Item 628. Ensure all mounting listed on the Material Producers list (MPL) on the Department's web site under (PS)" and Item 628 "Electrical Services. "Provide pedestal electrical services as Specifications (DMS)11080 "Electrical Services", 11085 "Electrical Services-Pedestal 1. Manufacture pedestal electrical services in accordance with Departmental Material 2Sheet 1 of 5 (80 AND 100 MPH WIND ZONE) (50 TO 65 FT) LONG MAST ARM ASSEMBLY TRAFFIC SIGNAL SUPPORT STRUCTURES LMA(1)-12 4-20-01 L1 D D 2 11'-6" 8' Max Min. Radius = 20' C L1 D D 2 1 90°90° FIXED MOUNT TRAFFIC SIGNAL ARM F Nominal Arm Length - L (44' Max)Nominal Arm Length - L (50' TO 65') ` 2" Rise [ Pole See Sheet 3 of 5 for Arm Rise 1 1 2 2 measured as shown. to produce the unloaded rise within 8' of the base so as with a 20' or greater radius Note: The arm shall be fabricated 4 of 5 See Sheet connection- Mast arm the unload rise measured as shown. Note: The arm shall be fabricated straight with F or G Detail D, E, See Sheet 2 of 5 Handhole and Clamp-on Arm Details See Sheet 4 of 5 for Arm Rise (IF REQUIRED)CLAMP-ON TRAFFIC SIGNAL ARM 3 of 5 See Sheet connection- Built-up box See "Tenon Detail" See "Tenon Detail"See "Slip Joint Detail" A Nominal Arm Length - L 3'-0"3'-0" (8')(unless otherwise noted)30'-0"35'-0" Nominal Mounting HeightSee Sheet "MA-D" 3'-0" A Nominal Arm Length - L 3'-0"(unless otherwise noted)Traffic Signal Arm See Above Detail (Showing fixed mount arm)1'-0"16'-6" NominalF C DB Nom Arm Lgth D30 23'-6" NominalArm Length Arm Type II Arm Type III 24'28'32'36'60'65' 10' 10' 11' 11' 12'13' TABLE OF DIMENSIONS "A" ELEVATION ELEVATIONSTRUCTURE ASSEMBLY 3 3 3 Arm Type IV 40'44' 12'12' 50'55' 12'12'12'12' 3 A 3'-0" 33 3 A 3'-0" See Sheet "SNS" 6"2.375"L ArmC MA-3 ‰ TENON DETAIL NominalC C ILSN Arm Connection - See Sheet 4 of 5 ILSN Arm Connection - See Sheet 4 of 5 4 4 See Sheet 2 of 5 Detail B or C 17'-6"Nom15'-0"Min-19'-0"Max-by others) (Supplied Weather Head 17'-6"Nom15'-0"Min-19'-0"Max-40 pipe 2" Sch shape to match arm End Plate 3/8 " thick min. See Sheet "Lum-A" Luminaire Arm - -Detail A See Sheet 2 of 5 Detail Arm See Above Traffic Signal Assembly Bracket Assembly Bracket Assembly Bracket Assembly Bracket 3 of 5 See Sheet Foundation 3 of 5 See Sheet Foundation 3 18'-9" w/ clamp-on arm L 18'-0" w/o clamp-on arm L (Showing clamp-on arm) Crown of RoadCrown of Road Sheet 4 of 5 See "ARM COUPLING DETAIL" CGB Connector Threaded Coupling for El Paso St ~20" ` 1" 6'-0"(Min)~17'-0"(Max) for Tip Section .239" thickness is permissible I.D. times female equals 1.5 Min Lap disassembled. marked and shipped shop, but may be match shall be made in the length. The slip joint 50' and greater in permissible for arms Note: A slip joint is SLIP JOINT DETAIL(FIXED MOUNT ARM) with Item 445,"Galvanizing". galvanizing in accordance joint. Repair damaged projection after making Tack weld nut to thread 1- †" Dia galv A307 bolt. 4 - ƒ" Dia holes and El Paso St optimal fatigue performance. the tests, poles may need a retrofit to ensure performance; depending upon the results of plate will or will not result in optimal tests to determine if stiffeners at the base stiffeners at the base plate. TxDOT is conducting fatigue resistance except that there are no Design also conforms to NCHRP Report 412 for GENERAL NOTES: Arm Equivalent DL WL EPA 8' Luminaire Arm 9' ILSN Arm Fixed Mount Arm 50' to 65' Clamp-on Arm Up to 44' Luminaire 60 lbs Sign 85 lbs 310 lbs Signal Loads 180 lbs Signal Loads 5 5 5 6 6 under the direction of the Engineer for approval. Provision of the bracket assembly used to support the traffic signal heads shall be Installation of damping plate for the long mast arm is not recommended. are not acceptable. drawings in accordance with the Item 441, "Steel Structures". Alternate designs Deviations from the details and dimensions shown herein require submission of shop Item 445, "Galvanizing" after fabrication. Unless otherwise noted, all parts shall be galvanized in accordance with Assemblies (Steel)". shall also meet the requirements of this sheet and Item 686, "Traffic Signal Pole obtain prior to fabrication. Material, fabrication tolerances, and shipping practices Weld references call for preapproved weld procedures which the Fabricator must (Steel)" and with the details, dimensions, and weld procedures shown herein. Fabrication shall be in accordance with Item 686, "Traffic Signal Pole Assemblies bolt and foundation details. details, "SNS" for internally lighted street name sign details, and "TS-FD" for anchor Standard Sheet "MA-D" for pole details, "LUM-A" for luminaire arm and connection Except as noted in Sheet 1 thru 5 of 5, other details not covered shall refer to Each arm with its related attachment is shown below street name (ILSN) signs and two traffic signal arms with limited length combinations. Poles are designed to support one 8'-0" luminaire arm, two 9'-0" internally lighted or more. Angles of less than approximately 75 degrees will require a special design. traffic signal is required, designs are based on an arm included angle of 90 degrees Design Wind Speed can be either 100 mph or 80 mph plus a 1.3 gust factor. If clamp-on Highway Signs, Luminaires, and Traffic Signals and Interim Specifications thereto. Design conforms to 1994 AASHTO Standard Specifications for Structural Supports for 1.6 sq ft 11.5 sq ft 52 sq ft 32.4 sq ft of horizontal wind load. Effective projected area (actual area times drag coefficient) for the application ILSN arm, which applied 4.5' from the centerline of the pole. Equivalent dead load plus horizontal wind load applied at the end of arm except 4:54:13 PM8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lma.dgnJuly 2000C TxDOT DENTON 131A Texas Department of TransportationDISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver- sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.4:54:13 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lma.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division DN:CK:DW:CK: JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT 1-12 136 (80 AND 100 MPH WIND ZONE) (50 TO 65 FT) Sheet 2 of 5 LONG MAST ARM ASSEMBLY TRAFFIC SIGNAL SUPPORT STRUCTURES LMA(2)-12 4-20-01 Round Shafts or Polygonal Shafts Connection Bolts Pin Bolts Pipe Misc. Hardware Galvanized steel or stainless steel or as noted Plates MATERIALS ASTM A325 ASTM A36, A588, or A572 Gr.50 A1008 HSLAS-F Gr.50, A1011 HSLAS-F Gr.50 SECTION B-B See Detail J MD-4 ‚x ‹ // Penetration = 85% Min. 1‚" †" Š"1‰" x ‰" out Tab ‚" dia Slot Œ" 7 7 7 7 8 COPPER GROUND CONNECTOR stainless Hex. nut, •" - 13NC •" stainless Split lockwasher, 2-#6 or 1-#4 max. Will accept 4-#8, or approved equal. Blackburn TTC, Burndy #KC22J12T13, // ACCESS COMPARTMENT NOTES: ˆinch wider than the access compartment itself. Opening for access compartment shall be no more than to be installed. Ferraz-Shawmut #30352 fuse block for poles where luminaires are 4. Install one Bussmann #BM6032B, Littelfuse #L60030M-2C, or terminal strip, and one Bussmann #BM6032B fuse block. two Marathon #985GP12 terminal strips, one Marathon #985GP06CU 3. The screw hole spacing on the enclosure back plate shall be for The traffic signal contractor shall install the kit items in the field. connector (Blackburn TTC, Burndy KC22J12T13, or Ilsco SSS-5). self tapping type "F" stainless steel pan head screws, and one ground strips (Marathon #985GP12CU or approved equal), four #8-32 x 1 ‚" consisting of: one cover with two latching assemblies, two terminal 2. The pole manufacturer shall provide with each pole a separate kit feature. shall be 1/4-20 stainless flat socket head screws with tamper proof tightly to the enclosure ring to create a rainproof seal. Latch screws extreme weather. Cover shall latch with two screw latches and shall fit gray color, and shall be suitable for exposure to harsh sunlight and 1. The cover shall be one piece formed from ABS plastic, shall be a pearl 8 ASTM A325, or A449 except where noted ASTM A53 Gr.B, A501, or A1011 SS Gr.50 A1011 HSLAS Gr.50 Class 2, A572 Gr.50 ASTM A595 Gr.A, A588, A1008 HSLAS Gr.50 Class 2, A1011 SS requirements and the requirements of this item. will be acceptable providing the material meets all other thickness in excess of those stipulated under A1011 SS 18 percent in 8 inches or 23 percent in 2 inches. Material ASTM A1011 SS Gr.50 shall also have a minimum elongation of less elongation than the grade indicated. or A1011 SS may have higher yield strengths but shall not have ASTM A572, A1008 HSLAS, A1011 HSLAS, A1008 HSLAS-F, A1011 HSLAS-F, Š Š xŒ 2 •"21" BASE PLATE 34"34" Thick 2 •" R=3" 1"+ Slot 2 ƒ" x 5 •" Circle 27" Bolt L~or screw …" dia bolt 2'-3"30'-0" 1"assembly dual mast arm coupling - 2 per 2" dia threaded~L ~L 12g min. Handhole cover or screw …" dia bolt assembly dual mast arm coupling - 2 per 2" dia threaded ~ ~1'-6"4"+-‚" PL Y Y Pole Cap for regular See "Detail A" & Nut J-Bolt ‚" dia attachment J-Bolt wire and hanging Bar for •" dia C SECTION Y-Y DETAIL D DETAIL E DETAIL F ‚ 12g min. Handhole cover+Handhole 6" I.D. L of 4"x 1'-6"4"+-‚" PL Y Y attachment J-Bolt wire and hanging Bar for •" dia DETAIL G ‚ (for pole with luminaire) D30 6"C ClampL Luminaire Arm 4"+-hanging wire …" dia Hook for alternate Pole Cap See "Detail F" for set screws Cap with min. of 3 Alum. or Galv. Metal Zinc die cast or DETAIL A ‰ (If ILSN applied)9"11"4"+-for hanging wire …" dia Hook DETAIL B ‰ C +18'-0" 1"6"11"alternate Pole Cap See Detail "F" for hanging wire …" dia Hook for set screws Cap with min. of 3 Alum. or Galv. Metal Zinc die cast or ‰ DETAIL C 23'-6" 1"+Plate Base Base Plate Bottom of See Sheet 3 of 5 for ILSN. Clamp-on arm Clamp-on armClamp-on arm 18'-9" 1"16'-6" 1"++MD-1 ‚"‹"Pole Frame Handhole MD-4// PolePlug Pipe 45° assembly arm dual mast - 2 per coupling threaded 2" dia MD-2 threads ~ NPSL Coupling threaded 2" dia // Penetration = 85% Min. DETAIL H SECTION A-A ‚x ‹ BB ACCESS COMPARTMENT 4 ƒ" 27" 6" 1 ‡"MD-5 slot Tab and slot Tab and ground connector hole for copper •" clearance hole opening 4" x 6" hand block terminal 6 circuit for optional mtg. holes #8-32 notes 3 & 4) block (see double fuse for luminaire mtg. holes #10-32 (2 req'd) terminal block compression Type HD 12 circuit 600 volt A-36 MOD 50 Ring, …" x 2 •" sheet A-569 steel strip M-1020 or „" x 4 •" x 1'-6 †" Back plate Handhole Weld See Detail H for A A A A A A+18'-9" 1"Base Plate Bottom of Handhole Weld See Detail H for Fixed mount arm‰ pole diameter 21 „" opening Handhole L of 4"x6" I.D. and ILSN sign) (for 30' pole with luminaire luminaire, single or dual mast arm) (for 24' pole with ILSN sign and no dual mast arm) sign and no luminaire, (for 20.25' pole with no ILSN single mast arm) sign and no luminaire, (for 19.5' pole with no ILSN Compartment Access 45° Mount Arm L Fixed C 19.5D or D20.25 Back plate Compartment Access ‚" ‹" DETAIL J P …" x 2 min. Handhole Frame- P …" x 2 min. Handhole Frame- (4 req'd) stainless steel self-tap Type "F", #8-32 x 1 ‚" Phil. Pan HD. screws, „" to •"„" to •" MD-3 ‚ 9 9 12" ‚"`2'-3"or screw …" dia bolt 45° seam weld 180° opposite to 1st longitudinal seam weld, permissible 2nd Arm L Clamp-on POLE COUPLING DETAIL (Typ) ‰" x 1" P Min Threaded Strap C Handhole 6" I.D. L of 4"x (optional) …" dia Hook ~Fixed mount arm ‰ (optional) …" dia Hook C 100% penetration within 6" of circumferential base weld. each side) along the fixed mount arm. 60% min penetration required, Longitudinal seam weld must be oriented within 90° (45° rotation POLE ELEVATIONBase Plate Bottom of Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:13 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lma.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2000 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 131B JSY ARC TGG JSY 1-12 137 Sheet 3 of 5 (80 AND 100 MPH WIND ZONE) (50 TO 65 FT) LONG MAST ARM ASSEMBLY TRAFFIC SIGNAL SUPPORT STRUCTURES 4-20-01 Bolt Dia Length Top Thread Bottom Thread Bolt Circle R2 R1 ANCHOR BOLT & TEMPLATE SIZE 2 •"5'-2"10"27"16"11" Min dimension given, longer bolts are acceptable. in. 6 •" GENERAL NOTES: B 30 1 1 2 L D D thk112 ROUND ARMS 17.6 16.8 .3125 18.5 11.7 9.6 10.3 11.0 .3125 24 4'- 4" 3'-11" 3'- 7" 48-A ROUND POLES D D D D thkB2430 thk2 50 55 60 65 Foundation Type in.in.in.in.in. in.in.in.ft.ft. ft. Rise 18.5 18.5 18.5 50' 55' 60' 65' , , 3'- 3"49 54 59 64 .3125 .3125 .3125 21.0 12 12 12 18.2 19.5 D or 20.25 19.5 D = Pole Base O.D. D = Pole Top O.D. with no Luminaire D = Pole Top O.D. with no Luminaire D = Pole Top O.D. with ILSN D = Pole Top O.D. with Luminaire D = Arm Base O.D. 13 13 13 to be equivalent to round section. Shaft profile 16-sided or 18-sided is considered may be used. Thickness shown is minimum, thicker materials D = Arm End O.D. L = Shaft Length and no ILSN (single mast arm) and no ILSN (dual mast arm) w/out Luminaire Arm L Mount Fixed Arm L Mount Fixed F 20.25 L = Fixed Arm Length F F and for the first arm on dual mast arm assemblies. Fixed mount details are used for single mast arm assemblies mounting plates cannot contact directly. mounting plates shall not be allowed if the center of both The deformed-from-flat connection between arm and pole center of mounting plate to a radial distance of 13.5 in. plate shall not exceed ‘in., which is measured along the The deviation from flat for either arm or pole mounting taper shall also be included. or drainage. Arm stiffeners cut to match arm inclination and 4" dia hole in the pole need to be aligned for wiring access the pole. 2 •" dia hole in the pole mounting plate and creation. Specify the proper location of drain holes along connection, arm-to-plate socket connection, and arm rise specify the details of each box element, welds of arm-to-pole drawing of box connection for approval. The drawing shall is an example only, fabricators are required to submit a shop connection as a build-up box configuration illustrated here Built-up Box Connection: For the welded arm-to-pole Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:13 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lma.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division July 2000 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 131C JSY ARC TGG JSY TYPICAL APPLICATION Mast arm assembly. 50' to 65' FDN TYPE DRILLED SHAFT DIA REINFORCING STEEL VERT BARS SPIRAL & PITCH ANCHOR BOLT DIA Fy (ksi)MOMENT K-ft SHEAR Kips 48-A 48" 19.5 14.7 55 490 21.9 2 •" 27" 2 ANCHOR TYPE 10 10 15 40 FOUNDATION DESIGN TABLE BOLT CIR DIA #4 at 6" DRILLED SHAFT LENGTH-ft N blows/ft 20 #9 FOUNDATION DESIGN LOAD ANCHOR BOLT DESIGN TEXAS CONE PENETROMETER 17 18 R12 Bolt Circle DiameterR TEMPLATE DETAIL 2 Sides (Typ) Type 2 d Bott Thread2 Flat Anchor Bolt Heavy Hex Nut (Typ) NUT ANCHOR (TYPE 2) ANCHOR BOLT ASSEMBLY SEE SHEET "TS-FD" FOR ADDITIONAL DETAILS. Washers per 2'-5"2'-3"1"1"1'-9"G~ ƒ" PL ~ † 1" ƒ"ƒ"2'-5"C C L PoleC SECTION C-C 4 •"4 •" ƒ" PL 11 11 11 Š D D SECTION D-D „"~ 1 4 … 28"2" Mast Arm ~ 2'-5"2'-5"ƒ"ƒ" ~7"‡" Plate ƒ"ƒ"2"2'-4" Œx Š Mast Arm 45° 24" Bolt Circle Arm StiffenerL ArmCArm Stiffener… ‰ DETAIL "K" † Typ 2" † 2" 30° 0 G † † Typ 2" PL Š Š Pole Mounting Plate 1" ~~Top Gusset Plate ~ Plate Side Gusset 6 ‚"1'-4 •"6 ‚"See Detail "K" F F SECTION F-F 8 ‚"8 ‚"CL Side Gusset Stiffener Arm … … … BUILT-UP BOX CONNECTION C (both sides) 1" Radius Slot Gusset ƒ" Side Gusset plate at Bottom 1" Dia hole Stiffener Arm ARM STIFFENER (Cut to match arm inclination and taper) Plate Mounting Arm 4" Min from both sides. penetration weld 100% complete joint SECTION F-F or equivalent Provide Detail shown in is required for the remaining weld length. radius to connect Stiffener. Only a fillet weld a complete joint penetration weld. Smooth weld Only 4" length at tip of Arm Stiffener requires Optional weld splice Stiffener Reinforcing penetration 100% REINFORCING STIFFENER hole in PL 2 •" Dia hole in Pole 4" Dia Bolts Connection 1 •" Dia than bolt diameter holes ˆ" greater Steel Template with Side Gusset Plate Weld other side to Side Gusset Plate Weld other side to CL Mast Arm Stiffener L Reinf 9"C C L Box 16 , 17 , 18 penetrometer values. Round to nearest foot for entry into Summary Table. Decimal lengths in Design Table are to allow interpolation for other diameters into solid rock. If rock is encountered, the Drilled Shaft shall extend a minimum of two used to adjust shaft lengths. Field Penetrometer readings at a depth of approximately 3 to 5 feet may be the base of the structure. Foundation Design Loads are the allowable moments and shears at Foundation Design Laods. Anchor bolt design develops the foundation capacity given under ƒ" Dia inside box 2 optional drainage holes 14 15 16 14 15 Stiffener Reinf Arm Mounting Plate Top Template Circular Steel ‚" thick Min. Bottom Template Circular Steel †" thick Min. (optional) …" dia Hook Plate Bottom Gusset or wire access as shown for drainage Deburr holes and offset 1'-4" Min.LengthTop GalvanizeLengthTop Thread10"edge of adjacent 4" dia hole 3" Min. clear distance from the 2- ƒ" dia optional drainage holes. arm applied luminaire ILSN or required if Handhole L 4" x 6" I.D. LMA(3)-12 1-12 138 LMA(4)-12Sheet 4 of 5 (80 AND 100 MPH WIND ZONE) LONG MAST ARM ASSEMBLY TRAFFIC SIGNAL SUPPORT STRUCTURES (50 TO 65 FT) 4-20-01 MA-1 ARM WELD DETAIL 19 90° of circumferential base welds. 100% penetration within 6" 60% Min penetration of the signal arm. oriented within the lower 90° Longitudinal Seam Weld must be 19 1 •" Dia Threaded Coupling. "Sky Bracket" or "Easy Bracket" with and cast bracket as in "Astro-Brac", Stainless steel bands (or Cables) BRACKET ASSEMBLY MA-2 ‚ Threaded Coupling ƒ"Dia1"MA-2 ‚ Threaded Coupling 1•"Dia ARM COUPLING DETAIL ILSN ARM COUPLING DETAIL ƒ" Base Dia Thick A F Dia No. ea 6.5 .179 12 6 1 2 7.5 .179 14 8 1 2 8.0 .179 14 8 1 2 9.0 .179 16 10 1 2 9.5 .179 18 12 3 9.5 .239 18 12 3 10.0 .239 18 12 3 10.5 .239 18 12 3 11.0 .239 18 12 3 11.5 .239 18 12 3 1 ‚ 1 ‚ 1 ‚ 1 ‚ 1 ‚ 1 ‚ Mast Arm Size in.in.in.in.in. Thick A F Dia No. ea .216 10 4 ƒ2 ILSN Arm Size in.in.in.in.in. 3 Sch 40 pipe Dia CLAMP-ON ARM CONNECTION ft. D thk12 ft.in.in.in. 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 thk ft.in.in.in. L D D11 2 ROUND ARMS 19.1 23.1 27.1 31.0 35.0 39.0 43.0 Rise 6.5 7.5 8.0 9.0 9.5 9.5 10.0 3.8 4.3 4.2 4.7 4.6 4.1 4.1 .179 .179 .179 .179 .179 .239 .239 1'-9" 1'-10" 1'-11" 2'-1" 2'-4" 2'-8" 2'-11" 19.1 23.1 27.1 31.0 35.0 39.0 43.0 7.0 7.5 8.0 9.0 10.0 9.5 10.0 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 .179 .179 .179 .179 .179 .239 .239 1'-8" 1'-9" 1'-10" 2'-0" 2'-1" 2'-3" 2'-6" L D1 Rise ROUND ARMS 12 12 YGONAL ARMSPOL ft. D thk12 ft.in.in.in. 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 thk ft.in.in.in. L D D11 2 ROUND ARMS 19.1 23.1 27.1 31.0 35.0 39.0 43.0 Rise POLYGONAL ARMS 8.0 9.0 9.5 9.5 10.0 10.5 11.0 5.3 5.8 5.7 5.2 5.1 5.1 5.1 .179 .179 .179 .239 .239 .239 .239 1'-8" 1'-9" 1'-10" 1'-11" 2'-0" 2'-3" 2'-8" 19.1 23.1 27.1 31.0 35.0 39.0 43.0 8.0 9.0 10.0 9.5 10.0 11.0 11.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.5 4.0 .179 .179 .179 .239 .239 .239 .239 1'-7" 1'-8" 1'-9" 1'-10" 1'-11" 2'-1" 2'-3" L D1 Rise ROUND ARMS 1 2 1 12 12 12 may be used. Thickness shown is minimum, thicker materials 80 MPH WIND 100 MPH WIND Pin Bolts †" Dia. Pin Bolts †" Dia. L = Clamp-on Arm Length L = Shaft Length D = Arm End O.D. D = Arm Base O.D. C Arm L Clamp-on Arm L Clamp-on C C Bolts 4 Conn. Bolts 4 Conn. GENERAL NOTES: by the Engineer. the pole after arm orientations have been approved hole for each pin bolt shall be field drilled through a ƒ" diameter hole for each pin bolt. An •" diameter cotter pin. Back clamp plate shall be furnished with have ‰" diameter holes for a „" diameter galvanized shear plane. Pin bolt and ƒ" diameter pipe shall shall be ASTM A325 with threads excluded from the clamp-on arms under design wind forces. Pin bolts Pin bolts are required to prevent rotation of the detail. shown for part shall apply to all similar parts on Where duplicate parts occur on a detail, welds access after arm is oriented. Deburr both holes. be field drilled through the pole to provide wire clamp plate for wire access. A matched hole shall arm, a 1 •" diameter hole shall be cut in the front longer than the arm diameter minus 1". For an ILSN shall be centered behind the arm and shall be no to facilitate drainage during galvanizing. The slot slotted hole may be cut in the front clamp plate a clamp-on mast arm, a maximum 1 •" wide vertical dual mast arm assemblies or ILSN arm support. For Clamp-on details are used for the second arm on L ArmC L PoleC Base O.D. ‰ ‹x ‚2 •"2 •" E E SECTION E-E ELEVATIONAF drainage hole •" Dia required bolt where 3rd Pin 1 •" Maxpipe and hole [ Pin bolt,ArmGap 1" Max 2" Typ Typ ‚ Typ •" thick stiffener ! •" thick (Typ) pin bolts †" Dia strap ! •" thick CLAMP-ON CONNECTION Pipe (Typ) ƒ" Dia Sch 80 required Dia as (Typ) „ ILSN Arm to pole) (Mast Arm or and 2 lock washers. 2 flat washers heavy hex nut, Connection bolt with // Penetration = 85% Min. // ‚ 8" (ILSN Arm) threaded coupling or ƒ" Dia (Mast Arm) threaded coupling 1 •" Dia 9" for Tip Section .179" thickness is permissible ~I.D. times female equals 1.5 Min Lap + with Item 445, "Galvanizing". galvanizing in accordance joint. Repair damaged projection after making Tack weld nut to thread 1- †" Dia galv A307 bolt. 4 - ƒ" Dia holes and disassembled. marked and shipped shop, but may be match shall be made in the length. The slip joint 40' and greater in permissible for arms Note: A slip joint is 6'-0"(Min)~11'-0"(Max) SLIP JOINT DETAIL(CLAMP-ON ARM) Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:14 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lma.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division November 2000 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY 131D JK GRB FDN CAL 1-12 SHEET NO. 139 MAST-ARM CONNECTIONS SUPPORT STRUCTURES FOR TRAFFIC SIGNAL STANDARD ASSEMBLY MA-C(ILSN)-12 5-96 A F CONN. BOLTS PIN BOLTS No.Dia No.Dia GENERAL NOTES: TABLE OF DIMENSIONS MC-4 C L ArmC P AFPin Bolt L PoleC & 2 lock washers hex nut, 2 flat washers Connection Bolt with required Dia as Penetration Min. 85% CL ILSN Arm 89° ILSN CLAMP-ON DETAIL 1 ILSN CLAMP-ON DETAIL 2 10 4 4 ƒ2 † •" dia drainage hole ‹x ‚ R=ƒ" Grade 50 ƒ" L2 ‚" max.Gap = 1 •" max. ‰ Details 1,2 and 3 for ILSN Support Arm Clamp-on ILSN ARM SIZE pipe & hole L pin bolt Detail 3" "Clamp-on except Penetration Min. 85% Clamp PL Arm ~CLAMP-ON ARM ARM BASE WELD DETAILS‚"‹" in.in.ea.in.ea. 8" clamp-on arms under design wind forces. Pin bolts are required to prevent rotation of parts on the details. shown for one part shall apply to all similar Where duplicate parts occur on a detail, welds Deburr both holes. to provide wire access after arm is oriented. matched hole shall be field drilled through the pole cut in the front clamp plate for wiring access. A arm assemblies. A 1 •" inch diameter hole shall be Clamp-on details shall be used for ILSN support in. 40 Pipe Schedule 3 in. dia NOTE: Pin bolts shall be A325 with threads excluded from the shear plane. Pin bolt and ƒ" dia pipe shall have ‰" dia holes for a „" dia galvanized cotter pin. Back clamp plate shall be furnished with a ƒ" dia hole for each pin bolt. An •" dia hole for each pin bolt shall be field drilled through the pole after arm orientations have been 2 •"2 •"A B A B SECTION A-A SECTION B-B Sch 80 Pipe ƒ" Dia L ArmC pipe and hole [ Pin bolt, Gap 1" Max 2" Typ Typ ‚ Typ Pipe (Typ) ƒ" Dia Sch 80 required Dia as (Typ) „Max1 •"L PoleC Base O.D.2 •"2 •" AFArm(Typ) pin bolts †" Dia strap ! •" thick and 2 lock washers. 2 flat washers heavy hex nut, Connection bolt with approved by the Engineer. „thick …" ‹x ‚ stiffener ! •" thick Min. 85% Penetration drainage hole •" Dia ‰ „ conduit connector coupling for ƒ" Dia threaded conduit connector coupling for ƒ" Dia threaded 8" MA-2 ‚ Threaded Coupling ƒ"Dia ILSN ARM COUPLING DETAIL ƒ"MC-2 L ArmC AFPin Bolt L PoleC & 2 lock washers hex nut, 2 flat washers Connection Bolt with 2" 2"MC-2 ~ C CL ILSN Arm P & pipe hole L pin bolt 89° ILSN CLAMP-ON DETAIL 3 •" dia drainage hole ‹x ‚ •" U-Strap, Grade 50 Grade 50 …" L Š 2 •"2 •"…" gusset P ‰ 8" Dia as required L C C SECTION C-C Sch 80 Pipe ƒ" Dia conduit connector coupling for ƒ" Dia threaded „ 1-12 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:15 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\macilsn.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division August 1995 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 140 126B MS JSY MMF JSY MA-D-12 MAST ARM POLE DETAILS SUPPORT STRUCTURES TRAFFIC SIGNAL Back plate Back plate Round Pole Polygonal Pole Compartment Access Compartment Access ‚" ‹" ‹" ‚" DETAIL J XX ACCESS COMPARTMENT block terminal 6 circuit for optional mtg. holes #8-32 4ƒ" 27" 6" 1‡" steel strip M-1020 or sheet A-569 „" x 4•" x 1'-6 …" Back plate MD-5 slot Tab and slot Tab and (2 req'd) compression Type HD terminal block 12 circuit 600 volt ground connector hole for copper •" clearance hole opening 4" x 6" hand notes 3 & 4) block (see double fuse for luminaire mtg. holes #10-32 Ring, …" x 2 •" ASTM A572 Gr 50 (4 req'd) self-tap Type "F", stainless steel Phil. Pan HD. scres, #8-32 x 1‚" NOTES: to be installed. Ferraz-Shawmut #30352 fuse block for poles where luminaires are 4. Install one Bussmann #BM6032B, Littelfuse #L60030M-2C, or terminal strip, and one Bussmann #BM6032B fuse block. two Marathon #985GP12 terminal strips, one Marathon #985GP06CU 3. The screw hole spacing on the enclosure back plate shall be for items in the field. Ilsco SSS-5). The traffic signal contractor shall install the kit one ground connector (Blackburn TTC, Burndy KC22J12T13, or 1 ‚" self tapping type "F" stainless steel pan head screws, and strips (Marathon #985GP12CU or approved equal), four #8-32 x consisting of: one cover with two latching assemblies, two terminal 2. The pole manufacturer shall provide with each pole a separate kit socket head screws with tamper proof feature. rainproof seal. Latch screws shall be 1/4-20 stainless flat latches and shall fit tightly to the enclosure ring to create a sunlight and extreme weather. Cover shall latch with two screw pearl gray color, and shall be suitable for exposure to harsh 1. The cover shall be one piece formed from ABS plastic, shall be a (for pole with luminaire) D30 6"C ClampL Luminaire Arm 4"+-hanging wire …" dia Hook for for ILSN Clamp-on arm L ~P …" x 2 min Handhole Frame - for Handhole Weld See Detail G or screw …" dia bolt mast arm assemblies second arm on dual Clamp-on arm for1'-6"9"2'-6"Compartment Access30'-0" 1"and ILSN sign)TPlate Base DB See Detail H assembly dual mast arm coupling - 2 per 2" dia threaded~‰" x 1" P Min Threaded Strap L 6"~~V V LP …" x 2 min Handhole Frame- for Handhole Weld See Detail G 12g min. Handhole cover or screw …" dia bolt mast arm assemblies second arm on dual Clamp-on arm for assembly dual mast arm coupling - 2 per 2" dia threaded ~ ~ VV1'-0"4"+-‚" PL Y Y D19 to •" „" MD-1 ‚"‹"Pole Frame Handhole MD-4 Pole Plug Pipe 45° ‚‚" or 3g pole L LBolt CircleDiameterRange AdjustmentLength Slot Diameter Bolt Hole D ˆB ‚"‚" or 3g pole ‰"‰" or 7g pole ‹"Š"assembly arm dual mast - 2 per coupling threaded 2" dia MD-2 & Nut J-Bolt ‚" dia attachment J-Bolt wire and hanging Bar for •" dia Diameter Bolt Anchor Diameter Hole Bolt Length Slot Diameter Circle Bolt L x T Dim. Base PL Range Adjust. 1 •" 1 ƒ" 2" 1 ƒ" 2" 2 ‚" 3 •" 4" 4 •" 17" 19" 21" 18" x 1 •" 20" x 1 ƒ" 22" x 2" 13.4° 13.5° 13.6° threads ~ NPSL Coupling threaded 2" dia ~(If ILSN applied) arm assemblies arm on dual mast assemblies or first single mast arm Fixed mount arm for9"11"11"set screws Cap with min. of 3 Alum. or Galv. Metal Zinc die cast or 4"+-for hanging wire …" dia Hook C arm assemblies arm on dual mast assemblies or first single mast arm Fixed mount arm for hanging wire …" dia Hook for 2 •"23"13.7°2 ‚"5"24" x 2 ‚" DETAIL B DETAIL A DETAIL G SECTION Y-Y DETAIL D DETAIL E DETAIL F POLE ELEVATION BASE PLATE PLAN SECTION V-V DETAIL H ‰ ‰ ‹x ‚ ‰ Šx ‰ ‚x ‹ ‰ ‚ 12g min. Handhole cover +++23'-6" 1"18'-0" 1"+MD-3 at + + R = 3" 1" " pole ‰" or 7g MD-3 at (for 30' pole with luminaire and no luminaire) (for 24' pole with ILSN sign sign and no luminaire) (for 19' pole with no ILSN 2'-3"SECTION X-X „ See Detail J MD-4 COPPER GROUND CONNECTOR 12" ‚"‚x ‹ the access compartment itself. be no more than ˆinch wider than Opening for access compartment shall stainless Hex. nut, •" - 13NC •" stainless Split lockwasher, 1‚" †" Š"1‰" x ‰" out Tab ‚" dia Slot Œ" 2-#6 or 1-#4 max. Will accept 4-#8, or approved equal. Blackburn TTC, Burndy #KC22J12T13, V V C Handhole 6" I.D. L of 4"x DETAIL C Handhole 6" I.D. L of 4"xC for Handhole Weld See Detail G Screw Bolt or …" Dia. …"x 2" Min. Handhole Frame thickness pole 3 set screws with min. of Galv. Metal Cap or Alum. or Zinc die cast 1 base welds. 6" of circumferential 100% pemetration within 60% Min. penetration 85% Min. penetration 2 2 1 1 alternate Pole Cap See Detail F for alternate Pole Cap See Detail F for Pole Cap for regular See Detail A ‰(optional) …" dia Hook I.D. Handhole L of 4"x 6" POLE COUPLING DETAIL 8-99 1-12 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:16 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\mad.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division August 1995 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 141 127 MS JSY FDN CAL SUPPORT STRUCTURES DRAWINGS FOR LUMINAIRE STANDARD ASSEMBLY ARM DETAILS LUM-A-12 galvanized metal cap Removable plastic or length Simplex fittingL Bolt HolesCgalvanized metal cap Removable plastic or length POLE SIMPLEX DETAIL Threads 13NC Tapped Lip Smooth UPPER SIMPLEX FITTINGSimplex fittingL Bolt HolesCUPPER SIMPLEX FITTING Arm Simplex Pole Simplex (2 per fitting) Lock Washer Arm Simplex Pole Simplex (2 per fitting) Lock WasherClamp Diam. as requiredA A B B DETAIL ‚ LA-2 2 bolts & 2 lock washers per clamp 4 bolts & 4 lock washers per clamp LA-3 LA-3 DETAIL NO.2 CLAMP ATTACHMENT (HALF SECTION) DETAIL NO.1 CLAMP ATTACHMENT (HALF SECTION) LA-2LA-2 Clamp Clamp 4 bolts & 4 lock washers per clamp 4 bolts & 4 lock washers per clamp MATERIALS Pole or Arm Simplex Arm Pipes 7'-6" 1" (8' Nominal Arm Length)5'-6" 1"1'-6" •"LA-1 ‚ 1 •" SCH 40 Pipe 1 ‡" O.D. LA-1 ‰ 2'-0" •" Min. 2'-6" •" Max. 8" 2" Max. P 2 …" O.D. 2" SCH 40 Pipe P 8-FOOT LUMINAIRE ARM 10-FOOT LUMINAIRE ARM LA-1 ‰ LA-1 ‚5'-6" 1"1'-6" •"P P 2" Max. 8" 9'-6" 1" (10' Nominal Arm Length) C C 1" ‚"ƒ" ‚" L ‚" x 6"L 3g x 7"PP ‚‚1" •"1" •"‚ ‰6"C C (2 per fitting) A325 Bolt (2 per fitting) A325 Bolt •"1 ‡"†"‚"4" 5" Approx.C A36 5" Appox.DIRECT ATTACHMENT L •" Dia. Holes- •" Dia. x 1 •"•" Dia. x 1 •" pole hole in Field cut pole hole in Field cut 2" Dia. Approx. ‰" + +++++++ L •" Dia. A307 Bolts L •" Dia. A307 Bolts 2 at 4" c-c each side 2 at 5" c-c each side ++++A572 GR 50 2 at 4 ‚" c-c each side L †" Dia. A307 Bolts L †" Dia. A325 Bolts + + 2 …" O.D. 2" SCH 40 Pipe 1 •" SCH 40 Pipe 1 ‡" O.D. Clamp Min. straight Min. straight Misc.ASTM designations as noted 2'-3" •" Min. 0°(+2°,-0°)0°(+2°,-0°) Strut L Š"x 2" Min. Min. L Š"x 2" Strut Arm Strut Plates 2 1 3'-0" •" Max. 1 elongation than the grade indicated. have higher yield strengths but shall not have less 4 ASTM A572, A1008 HSLAS-F, and A1011 HSLAS-F may 35 ksi, and elongation in 2 inches of 22 percent. minimum tensile strength of 65 ksi, minimum yield of 3 A576 must be suitable for forging and also meet designation. where the drawings do not specify a particular ASTM 2 Any of the materials listed for plates may be used dimensions within specified tolerances. of a particular arm length shall have the same variation in design. All of a Fabricator's production 1 Dimensional limits are given to show acceptable Strut L Š"x 2" Min. Min. Strut L Š"x 2" required for the clamps and simplex fittings. package, including all nuts and washers one lower clamp assembly together in a single poles, the Fabricator shall ship one upper and If clamp assemblies are ordered without to the pole at the location shown on the plans. shall ship the clamp assembly securely attached clamp attachment is specified, the Fabricator hardware items called for in the plans. When shall be secured to the pole with the other the size specified. The bolts and lock washers with 2 ASTM A325 bolts and 2 lock washers of Each pole simplex fitting shall be supplied Alternate designs are not acceptable. in accordance with Item 441, "Steel Structures". shown herein require submission of shop drawings Deviation from the details and dimensions Item 445, "Galvanizing". galvanized after fabrication in accordance with Unless otherwise noted, all parts shall be obtainable in normal fabrication practice. shall be within the tolerances generally specified Fabricaton tolerances, dimensions obtain prior to fabrication. In the absense of weld procedures which the Fabricator must herein. Weld references call for preapproved dimensions, and weld procedures shown Assemblies (Steel)" and with the details, accordance with Item 686, "Traffic Signal Pole Materials and fabrication shall be in times drag coefficient) of 1.6 sq. ft. having an effective projected area (actual area Arms are designed to support a 60 lb. luminaire Speed equals 90 mph plus a 1.3 gust factor. and Interim Revisions thereto. Design Wind Highway Signs, Luminaires, and Traffic Signals Specifications for Structural Supports for Design conforms to 1994 AASHTO Standard GENERAL NOTES: A576 Gr.1021 3 , or A36 (Arm only) ASTM A27 Gr.65-35 or A148 Gr.80-50, HSLAS-F Gr.50 4 , or A1011 HSLAS-F Gr.50 4 ASTM A53 Gr.B, A501, A1008 ASTM A36, A572 Gr.50 4 , or A588 SECTON B-BSECTON A-A Arm Simplex Pole Simplex (2 per fitting) Lock Washerremoved Lip LOWER SIMPLEX FITTING LOWER SIMPLEX FITTING removed Lip (2 per fitting) Lock Washer Arm Simplex Pole SimplexClamp Diam. as requiredA A DETAIL NO.4 CLAMP ATTACHMENT (HALF SECTION) DETAIL NO.3 CLAMP ATTACHMENT (HALF SECTION) LA-2LA-2 Clamp 1" •"ƒ" •"‚‚ L Š" x 5"P Clamp L ‰" x 6"P (2 per fitting) A325 Bolt (2 per fitting) A325 Bolt 4"1 ‡"1 •"•" ‡" …" ‹" max•" Dia. x 1 •"•" Dia. x 1 •" ƒ" Dia. x 1"++A572 GR 50 Pipe Sch 80 A715 GR 50 Clamp 5 •" Approx.ARM SIMPLEX DETAIL 1 ‡" Dia. Approx. 5" Approx. 1-99 5-96 1-12 Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:17 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\lum-a.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division August 1995 DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 142 129 LEH JSY LTT TEB A A B Section A-A Section B-B pin S.S. cotter mounting block Cast alum. •" S.S. bar with bronze sleeve bearings and locking pin. lamps Fluorescent Ballast 5ƒ" 6" 23" (max.) 1‹" Internally lighted street name sign Sign length; INTERNALLY LIGHTED STREET NAME SIGN DETAILS 14" to 16•" 9" to 11•"6 or 8 feet as shown elsewhere in plans. ILSN SIGN o EXPLANATION OF DESCRIPTION MOUNTING BRACKET 6 or 8 ft. one straight connector, three - #12 XHHW conductors. ƒ" Liquid tight one 90 connector, ƒ" S.S. flexible metal conduit, and Arm Detail ILSN Sign 6 Hand Hole see "MA-D". Single or double face B pipe threaded to End cap signal mast arm 3" Sched. 40 pipe support arm 24" 6' for 6' signs, 8' for 8' signs 7' for 6' signs, 9' for 8' signs 3" min., 12" max. 3" Sched. 40 pipe support arm Mounting bracket attachment. fixture Slide track S Hand Hole see "MA-D". SIGN MOUNTING 2 bevel washers nut, lock washer, H.H. bolt - 5" min. length, ILSN SIGN NOTES: 1. Eight foot ILSN sign shall not exceed 11.5 sq.ft. effective projected area (EPA) and shall not exceed a weight of 85 lbs. Six foot ILSN sign shall not exceed 8.7 sq.ft. EPA and shall not exceed a weight of 70 lbs. 2. Sign message shall be as shown elsewhere in the plans. 3. See Special Specification, "internally Lighted Street Name Signs" for additional details. See "MA-C (ILSN)" for Clamp SNS-95 (ILLUMINATED) SIGN DETAILS STREET NAME Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:18 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\sns-95.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOTAugust 1995 82 143 CFA-12 130 LUMINAIRE MAST ARM FITTING ASSEMBLY FOR CLAMP ON 11-99 OTHER MATERIALS: GENERAL NOTES: 3. Nylon insert locknuts shall conform to ASTM A563. 2. Welded tabs and backplates shall be ASTM A-36 steel or better. minimum elongation of 22 percent in 2 inches. suitable for forging and also meet minimum tensile of 65ksi, minimum yield of 35ksi, and a 1. Pole simplex shall be ASTM A27 GR65-35 or A148 GR80-50 or A576 GR1021. ASTM A576 must be 6. Approximately 2 in. diameter hole in upper mast arm clamp. lower piece simplex fitting with the lip removed. 5. Each assembly shall consist of one upper piece simplex fitting having a smooth lip and one 1.6 sq.ft.,12 ft. maximum arm length. luminaire having an effective projected area (actual area times drag coefficient) of Wind Speed equals 80 mph plus a 1.3 gust factor. Clamps are designed to support a 60 lb. for Highway Signs, Luminaires, and Traffic Signals" and interim revisions thereto. Design 4. Design conforms to 1994 AASHTO "Standard Specifications for Structural Supports including all bolts, nuts, and washers required for the clamp and simplex fitting. hardware items. The Fabricator shall ship clamp assembly together in a single package, 2 lock washers. The bolts and lock washers shall be secured to the clamp with the other 3. Each simplex fitting shall be supplied with 2 ASTM A325 bolts, •in. X 1•in. and galvanizing process. The throat of the Simplex shall be made free of all rough or sharp edges resulting from the 2. All parts shall be galvanized after fabrication in accordance with Item 445, "Galvanizing". tolerances generally obtainable in normal fabrication practice. In the absence of specified fabrication tolerances, dimensions shall be within the preapproved weld procedures which the Fabricator must obtain prior to fabrication. the details, dimensions, and weld procedures shown herein. Weld references call for 1. Materials and fabrication shall be in accordance with Standard Sheet "MA-C" and with POLE SIMPLEX DETAILS arm clamps lip on lower mast * Remove portion of threads 13NC tapped C •" O holesL …" ‰"†" 1•" Approx. 5" Approx. 5" Approx. 4" 1…" •" *Smooth lip CLAMP DETAIL 3g x 7" A36 A572 GR50 or Clamp C ‚" x 6" 2 req'd 7 Gage A36, Plate gusset, gussets) (Typ. both LA-3 See Note 6 * LA-2 ‰ 12" clamp 3ƒ" ƒ" ƒ" + ‚" L L ‚ lock washer per bolt) (2 nuts, 3 washers, one (5" cc for A36) for A572 Gr50 2 @ 4" c-c each section C •" dia x 6" (6 ea,) A307 bolts (Two req'd for each mast arm) For 8.9 - 12 inch diameter Signal Poles PROJECTION Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:19 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\cfa.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 144 KAB RES FDN CAL 1-12 (4X) S.S. INSERT 1/2-13 UNC 20‚" 40•" 9‚" 18•" BASE AND PAD CONTROLLER CABINET TRAFFIC SIGNAL 108" 1" PVC To Telephone Service CL 56.5" 5" 10"10" 16"16" 96" 5" 3" 3" 44" SIDE VIEW Controller (4 Typical) Inserts Cabinet Bolts (4 Typical) •- 13 NC Mounting Cabinet Ground Bus To Signal Poles 3" Conduits (Slab & Base) 1" To Telephone Service 3" 3" Grade #8 AWG Grounding Conductor (See Note 12) Wire Mesh Slab CABINET BASE TRAFFIC SIGNAL CONTROLLER BASE: CONCRETE SLAB: (psi), minimum flexural strength of 3600 psi, and minimum shear strength of 3600 psi. 2. The polymer concrete material must have a minimum compressive strength of 10,300 pounds per square inch TxDOT basemount cabinet. 3. The polymer concrete cabinet base must conform to the dimensions shown and must accommodate a standard manufacturer's model number and name or logo. 7. The traffic signal base must be permanently marked either by impress or by permanent ink with the manufacturer's instructions. 8. Seal the base to the concrete with a silicone caulk bead and fastened to the slab per 11. Install a PVC sleeve to prevent the ground rod from direct embedment in the slab. use. Terminate the conduits with a bushing between 2 and 4-inches above the slab. the layouts. Install the number of conduits as shown on layouts plus two additional 3 inch conduits for future 14. Stub up and run 3-inch conduits through the slab to the various traffic signal poles and ground boxes as shown on CONDUITS: unused telephone conduit. coupling, and cap and seal so that the seal can be removed without damaging the coupling. This must also apply to 15. Extend conduits for future use at least 18-inches from the edge of the slab, terminate underground with a share a conduit with any other function. telephone service, usually located on the same pole as the electrical service. Telephone must not under any circumstance electrical feed directly to the electrical service enclosure. Run the conduit for the telephone line directly to the 16. Stub up two separate conduits through the slab from the electrical and telephone services. Run the conduit for the top of the base and secure to the base using a steel one-hole strap or similar suitable substitute. 17. Terminate electric and telephone conduits above the slab with a coupling. After the base is installed, extend the conduits above the 1‚" Minimum PVC To Electrical Service 1‚" Minimum PVC To Electrical Service 47„" Min. 28•" Min. Professional Engineer. Provide the cabinet base with hardware for attachment to a concrete slab. manufacturer must supply certification by an independent testing laboratory or sealed by a Texas Licensed the base or cabinet to come out of their anchored position or cause any permanent deformation. The minimum wind load of 125 mph or a 850 lb force applied at 49" above the bottom of the base without causing 6. The cabinet base, when secured to the concrete slab with controller cabinet attached, must withstand a 25" + 1"- TxDOT Traffic Operation Division. the following bases: Armorcast Part # A6001848X24, Quazite Model # PG3048Z709, or other as approved by cabinet base must be reinforced on the inside of the cabinet base with fiberglass matting. Provide one of of calcareous and siliceous stone; glass fibers and thermoset polyester resin. The polymer concrete 1. Provide a traffic signal controller base (cabinet base) manufactured of polymer concrete material consisting •"-13 UNC stainless steel screws and inserts. to attach field wiring to the racks to serve as strain relief. Secure cable racks to the base using eight T-slots spaced at 1-1/2 inches. The cable racks must easily accommodate the insertion of tie wraps edge of the base. Unless approved otherwise, cable racks must be 1-1/2 x Œx ‰inch steel channel with 5. Provide the cabinet base with 4 cable racks mounted one on each side of the base 2" to 7 " from the top 750 lbs. base. Inserts must withstand a minimum torque of 50 ft-lb and a minimum straight pull out strength of 4. Supply the cabinet base with four •"-13 UNC stainless steel inserts for attachment of the cabinet to the 20. Bid TS-CF as subsidiary to Item 680. PAYMENT: 19. The silicone caulk bead specified in Item 680.3.B must be RTV 133. 18. Anchor the controller cabinet to the base using four stainless steel 1/2-13 NC bolts. CONTROLLER CABINET: is required and must be terminated to the cabinet ground bus. for the electrical grounding conductor. The electrical grounding conductor specified in Item 680-3.A.4 UL Listed clamp and terminated to the cabinet grounding bus for the purpose of providing a local ground 10. Bond a #8 AWG copper ground wire and an 8 ft ground rod bonded to the reinforcing mesh by a suitable †" x 8' min. Copper-Clad Steel Ground Rod with Item 531. 13. Provide Class B concrete minimum for the slab in accordance with Item 421. Construct the slab in accordance the edges. minimum 6-inch overlap. Center the mesh between top and bottom and provide a minimum 3 inch cover on 12. Provide welded wire mesh 6X6-W2.9 X W2.9 for reinforcement. Provide joints and splices in the mesh with a conform to the dimensions shown, and must be level. 9. Traffic signal controller pad must be a portland cement concrete slab poured in place, must Grade TS-CF-04 12-04 TOP VIEW (Slab & Base) Texas Department of Transportation sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:20 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\tscf04.dgnDATE:Traffic Operations Division DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 145 132 TXDOT TXDOT TXDOT TXDOTOctober 2000 SECTION A-A Mast arm …" Minattachment [ Signal head 1'-4"Height requiredback plate Vented 1 aluminum sign blank) Damping ! (.125" thick Coupling mast arm Top of (Showing alternate placement of signal head)6" minMounting clamp U-bolt mounting Saddle nipple all threaded Sch 40, 1 •" dia, tube saddle 1 •" dia mounting pipe aluminum Sch 40 1 •" dia Setscrew mount clamp band (or cable) 1 •" Threaded (Mounting clamp U-bolt is not shown for clarity) required Height to achieve required height Recommended supporting assemblies each length One nipple each length Two nipples each length One couplingplus 7"-8 •" 9"-10 •" 11"-15 •" 16"-24" 3" 4" 6" - - - - - 4" 6" - - - 5" 10" 1 6"-6 ƒ" SECTION B-B plate Damping head bolt Š" square lock washer flat washer & Nylon washer, universal) (specified or mounting clamp (Showing damping plate attachment) pipe aluminum 1 •" Dia U-bolt clamp Mounting GENERAL NOTES: before the installation. Contractor shall verify applicable field dimensions Standard Specification Item 445, "Galvanizing". parts shall be galvanized finish in accordance with Unless stipulated by the manufacturers, all steel also acceptable. alignment and vertical clearance requirements are only, other supporting details which meet both as shown. The attachments shown here are examples and bottom of damping plate shall be maintained between signal head (with or without backing plate) centerline of signal head assembly. Vertical clearance Position centerline of damping plate to align with Damping plate shall be mounted horizontally. a minimum yield strength of 36 ksi. SMD(GEN)-08. U-bolts for saddle mounting shall have and u-bolt assemblies shall conform to Standard sheet 6061-T6 or 6063-T6. Damping plate mounting clamp pipe, pipe nipple and coupling shall be aluminum alloy accordance with manufacturers' stipulations. Mounting shall be aluminum castings or aluminum alloys as in Materials for mast arm mounting clamp and tube saddle to Departmental Material Specifications DMS-7110. Aluminum sign blank for damping plate shall conform this damping device. from these details may reduce the effectiveness of vibration, and thus fatigue damage. Any deviation structures reduces excessive harmonic vertical end of signal mast arms of SMA and DMA standard accordance with the details shown here at the research, the installation of a damping plate in In accordance with the findings of TxDOT sponsored SECTION A-A 1'-4" Vented back plate 6"-+aluminum sign blank) Damping ! (.125" thick (Showing standard placement of signal head) pipe aluminum mounting 1 •" Dia Sch 40 Mounting clamp Saddle mounting U-bolt 1 •" dia. tube saddle mast arm Top ofSetscrew 3" length nipple 1 •" dia, Sch 40 (Mounting clamp U-bolt is not shown for clarity) Mast arm mount clamp band (or cable) 1 •" Threaded ~ 5'-6"1'-4"A A ELEVATION PLAN 1'-0" Min Mast arm 4 Equal Spaces 1 •" 6" Location of 1 •" 4 •" Damping ! [ Damping ! Mounting Clamp Support Assemblies Spacing aluminum sign blank) Damping ! (.125" thick Vented back plate 5'-6" of damping plate pipe extending full aluminum mounting 1 •" dia Sch 40 3" B B (Typ) sq head ‚" dia Setscrew Mounting Clamp Damping ! mounting clamp. damping ! and connection bolts between [ Š" dia square head nipple all threaded Sch 40, 1 •" dia, threaded coupling All or partially U-bolt mounting Saddle tube saddle 1 •" dia 1 •" [ Damping ! and signal head assembly ~ tube saddle aluminum pipe 1 •" dia mount clamp band (or cable) 1 •" Threaded U-bolt clamp w/ mounting DAMPING PLATE MOUNTING DETAILS (Showing alternate placement of signal head) MA-DPD-12 DETAILS MAST ARM DAMPING PLATE Texas Department of Transportation Traffic Operations Division DN:CK:DW:CK:C TxDOT DENTON JOB COUNTY CONT SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. 133 JSYJSYARCTGGJanuary 2012 146 sion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use. kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conver-DISCLAIMER: The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any 4:54:21 PMFILE:8/5/2020c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\ma-dpd.dgnDATE: DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONTApril 1992 FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\wzbts-13.dgn8/5/20204:54:22 PMSHEET 1 OF 2 114 2-98 4-98 10-99 3-03 10' min. 10' min. Type 3 Barricade Heavy Work Vehicle Channelizing Devices Flag LEGEND Flagger Sign Message Sign (PCMS) Portable Changeable Flashing Arrow Board Trailer Mounted M Traffic Flow Attenuator (TMA) Truck Mounted L=Length of Taper(FT) W=Width of Offset(FT) S=Posted Speed(MPH) Taper lengths have been rounded off. Conventional Roads Only* ** 2 *** 75 750' 720' 825'900'75'900'540' 90' 120' 155' 195' 240' 295' 350' 410' 475' 60' 70' 80' 90' 100' 110' 120' 130' 140' 150' 120' 160' 240' 320' 400' 500' 700' 600' 800' 30' 35' 40' 45' 50' 55' 60' 65' 70' 150' 205' 265' 450' 500' 550' 600' 165' 225' 295' 495' 550' 605' 660' 180' 320' 600' 660' 650'715'780' 245' 540' 700'770'840' 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 60 WSL= Posted Speed "B" Buffer Space Longitudinal Suggested Tangent On a Taper On a12' OffsetOffset 11' Offset 10' Taper Lengths Desirable Minimum Devices Channelizing Spacing of Suggested Maximum Formula L=WS Spacing Sign Minimum Distance "X"XXXXXXXXXXX X X LLLSee Note 8 NEAR SIDE LANE CLOSURE FAR SIDE LEFT LANE CLOSUREFAR SIDE RIGHT LANE CLOSURE OPERATIONS IN THE INTERSECTION SHORT DURATION SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARY SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARY SHORT DURATION OR SHORT TERM STATIONARYMin.30'48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TL 48" x 48" CW20-5TL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20-5TR 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 30" R4-7 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 30" R4-7 24" x 30" R4-7 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 Typical 24" x 30" R4-7 Typical X •L X •L 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 GENERAL NOTES 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 Note 7SeeBX XX XX48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 WORK ABOVE OPEN LANES OF TRAFFIC. WORKERS IN BUCKET TRUCKS SHALL NOT TYPICAL DETAILS TRAFFIC SIGNAL WORK opposing traffic. channelizing devices on the centerline to protect the work space from a left lane closure by using a LEFT LANE CLOSED (CW20-5TL) and adding 9. Signs and devices for the NEAR SIDE LANE CLOSURE may be altered for the closed lane if space is not available at the beginning of the taper. option, the arrow board may be placed at the end of the taper in work if the work vehicle has an arrow board in operation. As an 8. The arrow board at this location may be omitted for Short Duration safety of the setup. (less than 1 hour) any buffer space provided will enhance the table should be used if field conditions permit. For Short Duration 7. For Short-Term Stationary work the buffer space "B" from the above signs may be implemented when approved by the engineer. If existing signals do not have power, All-Way Stop (R1-1 and R1-3P) may be placed in flashing red mode when approved by the engineer. 6. When work operations are performed on existing signals, the signals the vehicle. 5. High level warning devices (flag trees) may be used at corners of high intensity rotating, flashing, oscillating or strobe type lights. 4. Vehicles parked in roadway shall be equipped with at least two to field conditions. 3. Flaggers and Flagger Symbol (CW20-7) signs may be required according and delineated at all times. 2. Obstructions or hazards at the work area shall be clearly marked the device must be left unattended at night. cones, drums, vertical panels or barricades will be required when 1. The minimum size channelizing device is the 28" cone. 42" Two-piece wzbts-13.dgn WZ(BTS-1)-13 147 7-13 Standard Division Operations Traffic DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT TxDOT HIGHWAY SHEET NO. C TxDOT of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of anyDISCLAIMER:CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1247784\wzbts-13.dgn8/5/20204:54:22 PMSHEET 2 OF 2 115 2-98 4-98 10-99 3-03 April 1992 X X X FILE: REFLECTIVE SHEETING X WORK AREA TYPICAL ADVANCE SIGNAL PROJECT SIGNING 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 24" G20-5T 36" x 24" G20-5aP 36" x 36" R20-5T 36" x 18" R20-5aTP 48" x 42" R20-3T 48" x 42" R20-3T 48" x 24" G20-5T 48" x 30" G20-6T 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 36" x 18" G20-2 48" x 30" G20-6T 10' Min. SIDEWALK DIVERSION SIDEWALK DETOUR CROSSWALK CLOSURES 4' Min.(See Note 7 below) See Note 4 below Temporary Traffic Barrier 24" x 12" R9-9 24" x 12" R9-11aR 24" x 12" R9-11aL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 See Note 6 36" x 36" CW11-2 24" x 12" CW16-9P 24" x 12" R9-10DBL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 24" x 12" R9-11L 24" x 12" R9-11aR 24" x 12" R9-9 See Note 6 36" x 36" CW11-2 24" x 12" CW16-7PL 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 48" x 48" CW20SG-1 36" x 24" G20-5aP 36" x 36" R20-5T 36" x 18" R20-5aTP 36" x 18" G20-2 MINOR STREETMAJOR STREET FOR LONG TERM and INTERMEDIATE-TERM STATIONARY WORK OPERATIONS NOTES GENERAL NOTES FOR WORK ZONE SIGNS 9 feet, above the paved surface regardless of work duration. 3. Regulatory signs shall be mounted at least 7 feet, but not more than shown on Figure 6F-2 of the TMUTCD. 2. Sign height of Short-term/Short Duration warning signs shall be as shown on Figure 6F-1 of the TMUTCD. 1. Sign height of Long-term/Intermediate-term warning signs shall be as DURATION OF WORK SIGN MOUNTING HEIGHT REMOVING OR COVERING the requirements of the DMS and color usage table shown on this sheet. 1. All signs shall be retroreflective and constructed of sheeting meeting will not be allowed. 10. Damaged wood posts shall be replaced. Splicing wood posts for identification shall be 1". substrate. The maximum height of letters and/or company logos used 9. Identification markings may be shown only on the back of the sign directed by the Engineer. damaged or marred reflective sheeting shall be replaced as 8. Temporary signs that have damaged or cracked substrates and/or installed as per the manufacturer's recommendations. the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Device List" (CWZTCD), 7. The Contractor shall furnish sign supports and substrates listed in in the "Standard Highway Sign Designs for Texas" (SHSD). 6. The Contractor shall furnish the sign design shown in the plans or directed by the Engineer. 5. All signs shall be installed in accordance with the plans or as 4. Nails shall NOT be used to attach signs to any support. 3. Barricades shall NOT be used as sign supports. 2. Wooden sign posts shall be painted white. condition. 1. Signs shall be installed and maintained in a straight and plumb SIGN SUPPORT WEIGHTS level sign supports placed on slopes. 8. Sandbags shall NOT be placed under the skid and shall not be used to sign support. shall be placed along the length of the skids to weigh down the level or hung with rope, wire, chains or other fastners. Sandbags of the traffic control device and shall not be suspended above ground 7. Sandbags shall only be placed along or laid over the base supports list. manufactured with rubber bases may be used when shown on the CWZTCD for ballast on portable sign supports. Sign supports designed and 6. Rubber ballasts designed for channelizing devices should not be used vehicular impact. Rubber, such as tire inner tubes, shall not be used. 5. Sandbags shall be made of a durable material that tears upon 4. Sandbags should weigh a minimum of 35 lbs and a maximum of 50 lbs. permitted for use as sign support weights. 3. Rock, concrete, iron, steel or other solid objects will not be to maintain a constant weight. 2. The sandbags will be tied shut to keep the sand from spilling and filled with dry, cohesionless material. 1. Weights used to keep signs from turning over should be sandbags DEPARTMENTAL MATERIAL SPECIFICATIONS WHITE COLOR USAGE SHEETING MATERIAL ORANGE BLACK BACKGROUND BACKGROUND SIGN FACE MATERIALS FL FL FLEXIBLE ROLL-UP REFLECTIVE SIGNS DMS-8300 DMS-8310 LEGEND & BORDERS Sign Channelizing Devices LEGEND Only pre-qualified products shall be used. A copy of the "Compliant Work Zone Traffic Control Devices List" (CWZTCD) http://www.txdot.gov/txdot_library/publications/construction.htm Type 3 Barricade Work Area Work Area Work Area describes pre-qualified products and their sources and may be found at the following web address: X X warning sign spacing. 5. See the Table on sheet 1 of 2 for Typical directions. 4. Warning sign spacing shown is typical for both under way, as directed by the Engineer. construction operations are no longer 3. Advance signs shall be removed when signal locations will be as directed by the Engineer. intersections at the project limits. Actual intersection, but only in advance of the may not be required in advance of each 2. For closely adjoining projects, advance signing whenever signal contract work is in progress. 1. Project signing as shown shall be in place Texas Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices (TMUTCD). 1. Work zone durations are defined in Part 6, Section 6G.02 of the See Note 8 BARRICADES AND SIGNS TRAFFIC SIGNAL WORK 7-13 WZ(BTS-2)-13 wzbts-13.dgn Standard Division Operations Traffic 148 TYPE A SHEETING ACRYLIC NON-REFLECTIVE SHEETING TYPE B OR TYPE C SHEETING 2. "CROSSWALK CLOSURES" as detailed above will require the Engineer's approval prior to installation. 3. R9 series signs shown may be placed on supports detailed on the BC standards or CWZTCD list, or when fabricated from approved lightweight plastic substrates, they may be mounted on top of a plastic drum at or near the location shown. 4. For speeds less than 45 mph longitudinal channelizing devices may be used instead of traffic barriers when approved by the Engineer. Attenuation of blunt ends and installation of water filled devices shall be as per BC(9) and manufacturer's recommendations. 5. Location of devices are for general guidance. Actual device spacing and location must be field adjusted to meet actual conditions. 7. The width of existing sidewalk should be maintained if practical. 6. Where pedestrians with visual disabilities normally use the closed sidewalk Barricades shown. Detectable Pedestrian Barricades should be used instead of the Type 3 facility. features consistent with the features present in the existing pedestrian temporary facilities shall be detectable and shall include accessibility 9. When crosswalks or other pedestrian facilities are closed or relocated, appropriate bid items. 8. Pavement markings for mid-block crosswalks shall be paid for under the 1. Holes, trenches or other hazards shall be adequately protected by covering, delineating or surrounding the hazard with orange plastic pedestrian fencing or longitudinal channelizing devices, or as directed by the Engineer. completion of the work. 4. Signs and anchor stubs shall be removed and holes back filled upon sign face. 3. Duct tape or other adhesive material shall NOT be affixed to a be used to cover signs. Burlap, or heavy materials such as plywood or aluminum shall not automobile headlights at night without damaging the sign sheeting. the entire sign face and maintain their opaque properties under as heavy mil black plastic, or other materials which will cover 2. When signs are covered, the material used shall be opaque, such approved by the Engineer. shall be removed or completely covered, unless otherwise 1. When sign messages may be confusing or do not apply, the signs FED.RD. DIV.NO. STATE COUNTY CONT.SECT.JOB SHEET STATE NO. 6 DIST. FED.RD. DIV.NO. STATE COUNTY CONT.SECT.HIGHWAY SHEET STATE NO. NO. 6 TEXAS DIST. FEDERAL AID PROJECT NO. (SEE TITLE SHEET) C TXDOT 2018 081008103 DALLAS DISTRICT STANDARD DALLAS US 377, ETC. DENTON, ETC. NOTES: 1. 2. 3. OF THE PEDESTAL OR MAST ARM POLE. ALL POLE MOUNTED VEHICLE HEADS SHALL BE INSTALLED ON THE AWAY-FROM-TRAFFIC SIDE SIGNAL LAYOUT FOR REQUIRED SIGNAL HEADS, AND THE NUMBER AND ORIENTATION OF LOUVERS. BUT ARE REPRESENTATIVE OF SIGNAL HEADS COMMONLY IN USE. SEE THE TRAFFIC THE SIGNAL HEADS SHOWN ARE NOT MEANT TO REFLECT ALL POSSIBLE SIGNAL HEADS, VEHICLE SIGNAL HEADS SHALL BE MOUNTED WITH TYPE 1 CLAMP AND APPROPRIATE TUBING. SCREW ASSEMBLY STAINLESS STEEL GALVANIZED CABLE TYPE 1 AND 2 CLAMPS TYPE 2 CLAMP KIT SHALL BE INSTALLED WHEN ROTATION ABOUT THE HORIZONTAL AND VERTICAL AXES ARE NEEDED. H4FLT SY FYRR G H5FLTH5LT R Y Y G G MAST ARM R Y G V3 MAST ARM POLE PEDESTAL OR H4LT H4PLT R Y G G R R FYSY R GYR R Y G TYPE 1 CLAMP H3 LOUVERS H3L R Y G Y G G Y R V5RT TRAFFIC SIGNAL HEAD DETAILS (DAL) 149 FED.RD. DIV.NO. STATE COUNTY CONT.SECT.JOB HIGHWAY SHEET STATE NO. NO.3' - 6"INTEGRAL SIGN DIST. START CROSSING DON'T START If Started Vehicles Watch For Finish Crossing TIME REMAINING DON'T CROSS TO CROSS PUSH BUTTON To Finish Crossing STEADY TIMER FLASHING START CROSSING DON'T START If Started Vehicles Watch For Finish Crossing TIME REMAINING DON'T CROSS TO CROSS PUSH BUTTON To Finish Crossing STEADY TIMER FLASHING 9" X 15" SIGN R10-3eL 9" X 15" SIGN R10-3eR 2 NOTES: AWAY-FROM-TRAFFIC SIDE OF THE PEDESTAL OR MAST ARM POLE. WITHIN THE SIGNAL MOUNTING HARDWARE. DISPLAY THE SYMBOLIZED MESSAGES SHOWN ABOVE. PEDESTAL POLE PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON POLE PROJECT NO.4'6'TYPE 24-A FOUNDATION TYPE 24-A FOUNDATION PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL SCREW ASSEMBLY STAINLESS STEEL GALVANIZED CABLE PUSH BUTTON FOR PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEAD MOUNTING FOR ONE PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEAD 152A PEDESTRIAN PUSHBUTTON SIGN DETAILS 9" x 12" PUSH BUTTON FOR 9" x 12" PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEAD MOUNTING FOR TWO PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEADS 143C SIGN R10-4bL SIGN R10-4bR PUSH BUTTON FOR 9" x 12" SIGN R10-4bRL SIGN DETAILS 2 COUNTDOWN PEDESTRIAN PUSHBUTTON TYPE 1 CLAMP 1 ALTERNATIVE MOUNTING METHOD 2 ALTERNATIVE PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEAD AND SIGNING revised 12-92 revised 10-08 3 revised 01-11 NOTE: REQUIREMENTS SHOWN ON THESE DRAWINGS BE DEEMED ACCEPTABLE. SHOWN AS AN EXAMPLE ONLY. POLES OF AND ARE APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER WILL SIMILAR DESIGN FOR ANY CROSS SECTION WHICH MEET THE SPECIFICATIONS AND THE POLES ON THIS DRAWING ARE 3 1 TYPE 1 CLAMP AND BASE PEDESTRIAN POLE 1" PVC GROUND TANK PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON POLE GROUNDING DETAILS PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON POLE 4 revised 09-15 4 PEDESTRIAN PUSH BUTTON POLE GROUNDING DETAILS CONDUCTOR GROUNDING EQUIPMENT NO. 6 AWG FOUNDATION TYPE 24-A 6"6"2"-4"GROUND ROD COPPER CLAD 5/8" X 8' AS SHOWN IN THE PLANS CONDUIT - SIZE/TYPE CAP 3'-6"5'INTEGRAL SIGN WITH O.D. 4 •" BASE BREAKAWAY ON PLANS AS SHOWN SIDEWALK CONCRETE 3 APS UNIT FOR MOUNTING DUAL APS UNITS ADAPTER 5 5 revised 06-17 APS UNIT ADDED 88 5 SIGN R10-3eL 5 1. ALL PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEADS SHALL BE INSTALLED ON THE 2. ALL WIRING FOR PEDESTRIAN SIGNALS SHALL BE TOTALLY ENCLOSED 3. ALL PEDESTRIAN SIGNAL HEADS AND PUSH BUTTON SIGNS SHALL 5 5 8888 88 5 7'-0" MINIMUM - 10'-0" MAXIMUM5 MOUNTING HEIGHT REVISED REVISED MOUNTING HARDWARE NOTES SIGNAL HEAD REMOVED "SYMBOLS ONLY" PEDESTRIAN AS REQUIRED SIGN R10-3eR WITH APS UNIT 5 APPROVED EQUAL. OR McCAIN QUICKMOUNT OR FOR CLAM SHELLS, USE ICC P/N 4805 USED AS APPROVED BY THE ENGINEER. SHELL MOUNTING HARDWARE MAY BE NOTE: EITHER TYPE 1 CLAMPS OR CLAM HEAD DETAILS (DAL) C TXDOT 2017 DALLAS DISTRICT STANDARD 150 STOP LINE TRAFFIC FLOW (1-5 FT TYP) SECOND SETBACK ZONES (1-5 FT TYP) FIRST SETBACK ZONES (60-100 FT TYP FOR LEFT TURN LANES) (40-100 FT TYP FOR THROUGH LANES) STOP LINE ZONES (MPH) LIMIT SPEED APPROACH 45 50 55 60 565 485 405 245 300 325 355 380 410 (FT) A DISTANCE (FT) B DISTANCE 65 70 RADAR DETECTION INSTALLATION DETAILS DN:-CK:-DW:-CK:-EF FED.RD. DIV.NO. STATE JOB COUNTY FEDERAL AID PROJECT NO. DISTRICT CONTROL SHEET NO. HIGHWAY NO. 6 REVISIONS Texas Department of Transportation R C Dallas District DALLAS DISTRICT STANDARD TRF-Aus. SECTION TEXAS 18 $CNTY $JOB (SEE TITLE SHEET) $CONT $SECT $HWY RVDS-18 (DAL) 2018 EF---C TxDOT May 2018 360 445 525 DETECTION SYSTEM RADAR VEHICLE 400 440 490 530 575 620 (LF) DETECTION RANGE OF MINIMUMA B RADAR DETECTION ZONE LOCATIONS MAY BE SUBMITTED FOR APPROVAL. OR PRODUCT, AND ALTERNATE MOUNTING METHODS INTENDED TO REPRESENT ANY SPECIFIC BRAND 2. THE RADAR DETECTOR UNITS SHOWN ARE NOT LEFT, RIGHT, AND TO ROTATE. MUST BE ADJUSTABLE TO TILT UP, DOWN, 1. THE RADAR SENSOR MOUNTING BRACKET NOTES: POLE MOUNT SIGNAL MAST ARM POLE RADAR BRACKET RADAR DETECTOR FIELD DRILL WITH GROMMET CGB CONNECTION OR RADAR CABLE BANDING (2 PLACES MIN) 3/4" STAINLESS STEEL MAST ARM MOUNT "A-A"SIGNAL MAST ARM RADAR DETECTOR DRIP LOOP RADAR BRACKET FIELD DRILL WITH GROMMET CGB CONNECTION OR BANDING (2 PLACES MIN) 3/4" STAINLESS STEEL SECTION "A-A" DRIP LOOP SIGNAL MAST ARM RADAR BRACKET FIELD DRILL WITH GROMMET CGB CONNECTION OR RADAR DETECTOR BANDING (2 PLACES MIN) 3/4" STAINLESS STEEL SPAN WIRE MOUNT FOR ADVANCE RADAR SADDLE CLAMP JUNCTION BOX SWAY CABLE TETHER CABLE UNIT DETECTOR RADAR CABLE MESSENGER GROUND TO MESSENGER CABLE BRACKET MOUNTING SIGN 151 152 TS-000A & TS-000B CITY OF DENTON STANDARDSSCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:17:59 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR 7/1/2020 PRAGNA TATA, P.E. 129174 Direct Supervision of Prepared by or under the DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 153 TS-001 & TS-001A CITY OF DENTON STANDARDSSCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:04 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR 7/1/2020 PRAGNA TATA, P.E. 129174 Direct Supervision of Prepared by or under the DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 154 TS-001B & TS-001C CITY OF DENTON STANDARDSSCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:09 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR 7/1/2020 PRAGNA TATA, P.E. 129174 Direct Supervision of Prepared by or under the DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 155 TS-001D & TS-001E CITY OF DENTON STANDARDSSCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:13 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 156 TS-001F & TS-001G CITY OF DENTON STANDARDSSCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:17 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-001H & TS-001I CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 157SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:19 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-001J & TS-002A CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 158SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:23 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-002B & TS-002C CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 159SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:26 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-002D & TS-002E CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 160SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:29 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-002F & TS-002G CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 161SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:33 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-003A & TS-003B CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 162SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:36 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-004A & TS-004B CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 163SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:39 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:43 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET TS-004C & TS-004D CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 164 S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:46 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET TS-004E & TS-004F CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 165 S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:49 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET TS-004G & TS-004H CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 166 S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-004I & TS-004J CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 167SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:53 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:56 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET TS-004K & TS-004L CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 168 S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 TS-004M & TS-004N CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 169SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:18:59 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:19:04 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR 7/1/2020 PRAGNA TATA, P.E. 129174 Direct Supervision of Prepared by or under the 7/1/2020 KRISTAL BUSTER, P.E. 96621 Direct Supervision of Prepared by or under the DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS CARROLL BLVD & SHERMAN DR INTERSECTION90% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET $DCCS_SIG_01.dgn$170 TS-004O & TS-005 CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA SHEET 170 08/05/2020 SCALE:DVI_SIG NEW.tbl1:1PENTABLE:10:19:07 PMTIME:\DATE:7/1/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:FGAOUSER:FILE:PERMITTING, BIDDING, OR CONSTRUCTION. FOR INTERIM REVIEW ONLY. NOT FOR PRELIMINARY 972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR DENTON INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS100% SUBMITTALDATE 7/1/2020 PROJECT # ENTERED BY: DESIGNED BY: CHECKED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: DATE REVISION SHEET TS-006 CITY OF DENTON STANDARDS 171 S TATE OF TEXAS P ROFE S SIONAL ENGINEER129174 LICENSED PRAGNA TATA 08/05/2020 EROSION CONTROL PLAN 172 1 0 0+00101+0 0 102+00103+00PC 100+00.00 PT 103+70.89 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+00 PC 102+11.19PT 103+34.88POT 108+50.00112TX DOT MON TYP E25/8" IR F2" BRASS MON # 6445 6 DENTON1 /2" IR ON ROD FOUND652651 64 9 648 647 646 644 642641643652 65 1649648647 646646 644 643 6 42 6 41 641 643 642 641 644 644 644643 643 642 6426 4 2 643644 650 650 6 50650 651652 651 649 648 647646645 645645 6 45645 649 648 647 646645645645645 640 640 640639639 639 6 41 641641641642642 642 642 643 6 4 3 6 43 64 3644644644 644 6 4 3 6426 4 2 VER 1"=N/A HOR 1" = 50'25'50'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:50PENTABLE:1:52:56 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LONG ROAD & STUART ROAD SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS LEGEND ROCK FILTER DAM CONSTRUCTION AREA CONSTRUCTION EXIT ROW LINE CONTROL (BECL) LOGS BIODEGRADABLE EROSION CONTROL FENCE TEMPORARY SEDEMENT IN PLACE UNTIL CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE. CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY AND SHALL REMAIN INSTALLED PRIOR TO THE START OF ANY 4. EROSION CONTROL DEVICES SHALL BE EROSION CONTROL. ACCORDANCE WITH TXDOT STANDARDS FOR MAINTENANCE, AND REMOVAL SHALL BE IN 3. EROSION CONTROL DEVICE INSTALLATION, OR SCF. SEE PLANS FOR TYPE. 2. INLETS SHALL BE PROTECTED WITH BECL LOCATED AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. 1. CONSTRUCTION EXITS SHALL BE FIELD NOTES: NOTTINGHAM DRE UNI VERSI TY DRE UNI VERSI TY DRC [ XNOTT NOTTINGHAM DR [ XUNIV [ XNOTT C EXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROWEXIST ROW EXIST ROW EXI ST ROWEXI ST ROW0.00' RT STA 100+92.00 L XNOTT BEGIN PROJECT 0.00' RT STA 108+30.50 L XNOTT END PROJECT REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 68 LF BECL REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 46 LF BECL REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 18 LF BECL REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 23 LF BECL REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 113 LF BECL REMOVED _________ INSTALLED_________ 23 LF BECL (50'x14') CONSTRUCTION EXIT 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 64+00.00MATCHLINE STA. 64+00.00EROSION CONTROL PLAN 173 VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:53:00 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS EXIST ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROW EB RAMPEB RAMPSHERMAN DR WB RAMPWB RAMP[ XWB288ENTER [ XEB288ENTER [ XEB288EXIT [ XSHERM [ XSHERM US 288US 288MATCH EXIST C SHERM STA 56+00.00 BEGIN PROJECT SHERMAN DRIVE REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 413 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF RFD REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF RFD PROP ROW REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 488 LF BECL (50'x14') CONSTRUCTION EXIT EXIT (50'x14') CONSTRUCTION 54+00 55+00 56+00 57+00 58+00 59+00 60+00 61+00 62+00 63+00 64+00100+00101+0050+0051+0050+0051+00100+00101+00PC 50+00.00POT 101+66.75POT 50+00.00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+79.48 640 645645645645645645645645645 645 645 645645645 645 645645645 6 4 5645650650650650650650 650 650655655655655 655 660660 660665665 647 647 64+00 65+00 66+00 67+00 68+00 69+00 70+00 71+00 72+00 73+00 74+0050+0051+00POT 100+00.00 POT 101+66.75 TX DOT MON TYPE2 MON TYPE 2 BUSTED TX DOT 650 650650 65065 0 6 5 0 655655655 660660 665665670670675 675 680680LEGEND ROCK FILTER DAM CONSTRUCTION AREA CONSTRUCTION EXIT ROW LINE CONTROL (BECL) LOGS BIODEGRADABLE EROSION CONTROL FENCE TEMPORARY SEDEMENT IN PLACE UNTIL CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE. CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY AND SHALL REMAIN INSTALLED PRIOR TO THE START OF ANY 4. EROSION CONTROL DEVICES SHALL BE EROSION CONTROL. ACCORDANCE WITH TXDOT STANDARDS FOR MAINTENANCE, AND REMOVAL SHALL BE IN 3. EROSION CONTROL DEVICE INSTALLATION, OR SCF. SEE PLANS FOR TYPE. 2. INLETS SHALL BE PROTECTED WITH BECL LOCATED AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. 1. CONSTRUCTION EXITS SHALL BE FIELD NOTES:WB RAMPWB RAMP[ XWB288EXIT PROP ROW PROP ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROW [ XSHERM SHERMAN DRIVE MATCH EXIST C XSHERM STA 71+40.00 END PROJECT L10'10'PROP ROW EXIST ROW REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 488 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF RFD REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 576 LF BECL 8/5/2020 MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.00MATCHLINE STA. 108+50.00EROSION CONTROL PLAN 174 VER 1"=N/A 10050 HOR 1"=100'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:100PENTABLE:1:53:10 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS PC 116+39.30PT 118+78.9252+0053+0054+00109+00 110+00 111+00 112+00 113+00 114+00 115+00 116+00 117+00 118+00 #67 44 DEN TON 2" BRAS S MON PK NAIL FOUN DMAG NAILSSSS SS 675675 675 675675 675 675 673 673 674 674 672 672 673674 673673 673 674 674 673673 673 672 671 67267 3673674 LEGEND ROCK FILTER DAM CONSTRUCTION AREA CONSTRUCTION EXIT ROW LINE CONTROL (BECL) LOGS BIODEGRADABLE EROSION CONTROL FENCE TEMPORARY SEDEMENT IN PLACE UNTIL CONSTRUCTION IS COMPLETE. CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITY AND SHALL REMAIN INSTALLED PRIOR TO THE START OF ANY 4. EROSION CONTROL DEVICES SHALL BE EROSION CONTROL. ACCORDANCE WITH TXDOT STANDARDS FOR MAINTENANCE, AND REMOVAL SHALL BE IN 3. EROSION CONTROL DEVICE INSTALLATION, OR SCF. SEE PLANS FOR TYPE. 2. INLETS SHALL BE PROTECTED WITH BECL LOCATED AS DIRECTED BY THE ENGINEER. 1. CONSTRUCTION EXITS SHALL BE FIELD NOTES:PC 100+00.00PT 108+00.00POT 54+61.41 POT 50+00.00 POT 51+52.63 50+0051+00100+00 101+00 102+00 103+00 104+00 105+00 106+00 107+00 108+005/8"CIR F RPLS 3963 5/8"CIRF RPLS 39 63 5/8"CIRF RPLS 3963 5/8"CIRF RPLS 3963 5/8"CIRF RPLS 39 63 5/8"CIRF RPLS 39 635/8"CIR F5/8"CIRF RP LS 39 635/8"CIRF RP LS 39 635/8"CIRF RP LS 396 31/2"CIRF HHHH 665 665 665 665 67 0670 670 670 667666 664 664 667 668 667 668 671 672 6726736 73 673STA 108+30.50 L XLOCUS BEGIN PROJECT C [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW N LOCUST ST EXIST ROWPLUM HOLLOWN LOCUST ST EXIST ROW EXIST ROWEXIST ROW REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 224 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF RFD REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 428 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF BECL (50'x14') CONSTRUCTION EXIT EXIST ROW[ XHERCU [ XLOCUS EXIST ROW N LOCUST ST STA 115+33.00, L XLOCUS END PROJECT C [ XLOCUS N LOCUST ST EXIST ROW REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF RFD REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 646 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF BECL REMOVED___________ INSTALLED__________ 10 LF BECL (50'x14') CONSTRUCTION EXIT 8/5/2020 parallel to the slope contour. Dozer tracks create track imprints fabric Woven filter 90° 2" minimum of 6 times with hog rings. reinforcement sheets or rolls a Connect the ends of the successive FLOW FLOW hog rings or cord at a maximum spacing of 15". Fasten fabric to the top strand of the wire using A A Linear soil impressions.TEMPORARY SEDIMENT CONTROL FENCE SCF bottom in the upstream direction. side and approximently 2" across the trench Place 4" to 6" of fabric against the trench Backfill and hand tamp. Minimum trench size shall be 6" square. SEDIMENT CONTROL FENCE USAGE GUIDELINES to be filtered. runoff. A 2 year storm frequency may be used to calculate the flow rate of a disturbed area along a contour to intercept sediment from overland A sediment control fence may be constructed near the downstream perimeter erosion from a drainage area larger than 2 acres. rate of 100 GPM/FT . Sediment control fence is not recommended to control Sediment control fence should be sized to filter a maximum flow through 2 SECTION A-A FLOW Filter fabric 3' min. width. Embed posts 18" min. or Anchor if in rock. 6" 2" 90°Backfill & hand tamp. sewn vertical pockets for steel posts). for wooden posts (or 4 T-Clips or posts using 4 evenly spaced staples Attach the wire mesh and fabric on end Hardwood posts shall have a minimum cross section of 1.5" x 1.5" Softwood posts shall be 3" minimum in diameter or nominal 2" x 4". 4' minimum steel or wood posts spaced at 6' to 8'.GENERAL NOTES VERTICAL TRACKING LEGEND Sediment Control Fence SCF perpendicular to the slope or direction of water flow. Install continous linear track impressions where the minimum 12" length impressions are5. 4. Do not exceed 12" between track impressions. measuring a minimum of 12" in length by 2" to 4" in width by 1/2" to 2" in depth. Provide equipment with a track undercarriage capable of producing linear soil impressions 3. Perform vertical tracking on slopes to temporarily stabilize soil.2. unless otherwise approved. 1. Vertical tracking is required on projects where soil distributing activities have occurred HINGE JOINT KNOT WOVEN MESH (OPTION) DETAIL Top of Fence spaced at a maximum of 12 inches apart. a maximum of 12 inches apart and all vertical wires requires a minimum of five horizontal wires spaced at Galvanized hinge joint knot woven mesh (12.5 GA.SWG Min.) S L O P E S L O P E (W.M.)(See woven mesh option detail) opening size of 2"x 4"or Woven Mesh (12.5 GA. SWG Min.) with a maximum Galvanized welded wire mesh (W.W.M.) DN:CK:DW:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec116.dgn8/5/2020EC(1)-16 Standard Division Design DN/CK:KM LSVP JULY 2016C TxDOT: 175 TxDOT POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, FENCE & VERTICAL TRACKING ec116TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:DATEFILE Flow Earth embankment Width for payment SEE NOTE 6 RFD3RFD1RFD2OROR Galvanized Woven Wire Mesh (for Types 2 & 3) GENERAL NOTES 4" Min. Length for payment Toe of slope Native rock or other suitable material Sheet Flow Unconcentrated Optional Sandbags (See Usage Guidelines) 2' Min. rock Open graded See Note 4 2 1 (for Types 2 & 3) wire mesh Galvanized woven 4" Min. Types 1 & 2 = 18" Type 3 = 36" SECTION C-C Length 2' Min. 4" Min. 1 2 Level Crested Weir 1' Min. Width for Payment Weir PROFILE Wire Mesh Galvanized Steel Wire Mesh Galvanized Steel 3', 6' or 9' 2' Dia. SECTION A-ATYPE 4 (SACK GABIONS) Sack Gabions PLAN VIEW 3:1 Max.3:1 Max. Ditch Flow PLAN VIEW Rebar Stakes ƒ" Dia. SECTION B-B FILTER DAM AT TOE OF SLOPE RFD1 FILTER DAM AT SEDIMENT TRAP RFD1 RFD2OR FILTER DAM AT CHANNEL SECTIONS construction drawings) Excavation (If shown on RFD4 Type 4 Rock Filter Dam Type 3 Rock Filter Dam Type 2 Rock Filter Dam Type 1 Rock Filter Dam PLAN SHEET LEGEND RFD1 RFD2 RFD3 RFD4 ROCK FILTER DAM USAGE GUIDELINES 2 Type 5: Provide rock filter dams as shown on plans. and smaller channels to form an erosion control dam. Type 4 (Sack gabions) (3" to 6" aggregate): Type 4 May be used in ditches in stream flow and should be secured to the stream bed. Type 3 (36" high with wire mesh) (4" to 8" aggregate): Type 3 may be used used in ditches and at dike or swale outlets. Type 2 (18" high with wire mesh) (3" to 6" aggregate): Type 2 may be on the plans or directed by the Engineer. (4" deep min.) for better filtering efficiency of low flows if called for wash out may occur. Sandbags may be used at the embedded foundation high velocity flows (approximently 8 Ft/Sec or more) in which aggregate drainage area of 5 acres or less. Type 1 may not be used in concentrated swale outlets. This type of dam is recommended to control erosion from a used at the toe of slopes, around inlets, in small ditches, and at dike or Type 1 (18" high with no wire mesh) (3" to 6" aggregate): Type 1 may be to calculate the flow rate. GPM/FT of cross sectional area. A 2 year storm frequency may be used The dams should be sized to filter a maximum flow through rate of 60 to intercept sediment from overland runoff and/or concentrated flow. Rock Filter Dams should be constructed downstream from disturbed areas the Engineer. 11. The guidelines shown hereon are suggestions only and may be modified by 10. Flow outlet should be onto a stabilized area (vegetation, rock, etc.). double-twisted hexagonal weave with a nominal mesh opening of 2 •" x 3 ‚" 9. Sack Gabions should be staked down with ƒ" dia. rebar stakes, and have a stream bed prior to aggregate placement. hog rings. For in stream use, the mesh should be secured or staked to the tightly secured to itself on the downstream side using wire ties or The mesh shall be folded at the upstream side over the aggregate and be placed on the mesh to the height & slopes specified. woven wire mesh with 1" diameter hexagonal openings. The aggregate shall 8. Rock filter dam types 2 & 3 shall be secured with 20 gauge galvanized dimensions shown on the plans. 7. The sediment trap for ponding of sediment laden runoff shall be of the 6. Filter dams should be embedded a minimum of 4" into existing ground. embankment for filter dams at sediment traps. 5. Maintain a minimum of 1' between top of rock filter dam weir and top of have sideslopes of 6:1 or flatter. 4. Side slopes should be 2:1 or flatter. Dams within the safety zone shall 3. The rock filter dam dimensions shall be as indicated on the SW3P plans. Control". by the specification for "Rock Filter Dams for Erosion and Sedimentation 2. Materials (aggregate, wire mesh, sandbags, etc.) shall be as indicated channels to collect sediment. and/or downstream at drainage structures, and in roadway ditches and be placed near the toe of slopes where erosion is anticipated, upstream 1. If shown on the plans or directed by the Engineer, filter dams should "V" SHAPE (See "V" Shape Plan View below) higher velocity flows. A "V" Shape may be used for C C B A A C C of Flow Direction DN:CK:DW:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT EC(2)-16 Standard Division Design DN/CK:KM LSVP JULY 2016C TxDOT: 176 TxDOT POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, ec216 ROCK FILTER DAMS FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec216.dgn8/5/2020B TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER: DN:CK:DW:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec316.dgn8/5/2020TxDOT Standard Division Design 8" Min. 4' Min.4' Min. 6:1 Min. Foundation course Approach transition Approach transition 50' Min. 6" min. PLAN VIEW ELEVATION VIEW trapping device Drain to sediment Treated timber plank 2" X 10"Railroad ties Typical dimensions 8" X 10" X 8' 50' Min. 10" Min.2" X 6" Treated timber plank PLAN VIEW ELEVATION VIEW R.O.W. Soil Area Disturbed Paved Roadway Driveway Stabilized A A •" Min. thick plywood or of wood sheets nailed onto abutted ends 2" X 8" treated timbers pressed wafer board sheets See note 2 PLAN VIEW ROCK CONSTRUCTION (LONG TERM)TIMBER CONSTRUCTION (LONG TERM) Disturbed soil •" Min. thick treated plywood or of wood sheets Nailed onto ends 2" X 8" Timbers pressed wafer board sheets 1' on centers. 16 Penny Nails @ CONSTRUCTION EXIT (TYPE 3) SECTION A-A SHORT TERM 4' Min.4' Min. 6:1 Min. Foundation course Approach transition Approach transition 50' Min. 6" min. CONSTRUCTION EXIT (TYPE 1)CONSTRUCTION EXIT (TYPE 2) 2. The coarse aggregate should be open graded with a size of 4" to 8". be free from large and loose knots. constructed as directed by the Engineer. 4. The approach transitions shall be no steeper than 6:1 and as approved by the Engineer. bituminous concrete, portland cement concrete or other material 5. The construction exit foundation course shall be flexible base, 3. The treated timber planks shall be #2 grade min., and should 2. The treated timber planks shall be attached to the railroad 1. The length of the type 2 construction exit shall be as indicated on the plans, but not less than 50'. ties with •"x 6" min. lag bolts. Other fasteners may be used as approved by the Engineer. 7. The guidelines shown hereon are suggestions only and may be modified by the Engineer. sediment trapping device. 6. The construction exit should be graded to allow drainage to a Coarse Aggregate trapping device Drain to sediment 50' Min. KM C TxDOT: POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, EC(3)-16 CONSTRUCTION EXITS on the plans, but not less than 50'. 1. The length of the type 1 construction exit shall be as indicated as directed by the Engineer. 3. The approach transitions should be no steeper than 6:1 and constructed by the Engineer. bituminous concrete, portland cement concrete or other materialas approved 4. The construction exit foundation course shall be flexible base, trapping device. 5. The construction exit shall be graded to allow drainage to a sediment by the Engineer. 6. The guidelines shown hereon are suggestions only and may be modified 14' Min. One-Way20' Min. Two-Way20' Min. Two-Wayengineer. for two-way traffic for the full width of the exit, or as directed by the 7. Construct exits with a width of at least 14 ft. for one-way and 20 ft. 14' Min. One-wayGENERAL NOTES (TYPE 1)GENERAL NOTES (TYPE 2) 1. The length of the type 3 construction exit shall be as 2. The type 3 construction exit may be constructed from open graded crushed stone with a size of two to four inches spread a min. of 4" thick to the limits shown on the plans. shown on the plans, or as directed by the Engineer. 4. The guidelines shown hereon are suggestions only and may be modified by the Engineer. 3. The treated timber planks shall be #2 grade min., and should be free from large and loose knots. GENERAL NOTES (TYPE 3) engineer. for two-way traffic for the full width of the exit, or as directed by the 8. Construct exits with a width of at least 14 ft. for one-way and 20 ft. VPec316 JULY 2016 DN/CK:LSTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:177 SHEET 1 OF 3 SECTION C-C STAKE FLOW A A 1' B B R.O.W. BACK OF CURB FLOW DISTURBED AREA LIP OF GUTTER2'1'C C R.O.W. FLOW2'GENERAL NOTES:+-+-2"•"1"R REBAR STAKE DETAIL #3 BAR CONTROL LOGS SPECIFIED IN PLANS DIAMETER MEASUREMENTS OF EROSION DISTURBED AREA BACK OF CURB LIP OF GUTTER PLAN VIEW PLAN VIEW CL-ROW CL-BOC CL-D PLAN VIEW 1' MIN.ENGINEER. AS DIRECTED BY THE (4' MAX. SPACING), OR NEEDED TO SECURE LOG ADDITIONAL POINTS AS AT EACH END, AND AT SIDE AT THE CENTER, STAKE LOG ON DOWNHILL ENGINEER. OR AS DIRECTED BY THE AS NEEDED TO SECURE LOG, LOG AT 8' (ON CENTER) MAX. STAKE ON DOWNHILL SIDE OF ENGINEER. OR AS DIRECTED BY THE AS NEEDED TO SECURE LOG, LOG AT 8' (ON CENTER) MAX. STAKE ON DOWNHILL SIDE OF EROSION CONTROL LOG DAM STAKE SECTION B-B CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION 1' (TYP.) SECTION A-A EROSION CONTROL LOG AT EDGE OF RIGHT-OF-WAY EROSION CONTROL LOG AT BACK OF CURB THE ENGINEER. OR AS DIRECTED BY (4' MAX. SPACING), NEEDED TO SECURE LOG ADDITIONAL POINTS AS AT EACH END, AND AT SIDE AT THE CENTER, STAKE LOG ON DOWNHILL CONTROL LOG UNDER EROSION COMPOST CRADLE DIRECTED STAKE AS OF LOG TO SECURE END CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION R.O.W. CONTROL LOG UNDER EROSION COMPOST CRADLE CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION R.O.W. CONTROL LOG UNDER EROSION COMPOST CRADLE DIRECTED STAKE AS OF LOG TO SECURE END DIRECTED STAKE AS OF LOG TO SECURE END CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION LOG CONTROL EROSION TEMPORARY (TYP.) 1' CL-GI RUNOFF EVENTS STAKES FOR HEAVY ADDITIONAL UPSTREAM RUNOFF EVENTS STAKES FOR HEAVY ADDITIONAL UPSTREAM RUNOFF EVENTS STAKES FOR HEAVY ADDITIONAL UPSTREAM RUNOFF EVENTS STAKES FOR HEAVY ADDITIONAL UPSTREAM LOG FROM FOLDING IN ON ITSELF. UPSTREAM STAKES MAY BE NECESSARY TO KEEP FOR HEAVY RUNOFF EVENTS, ADDITIONAL10. LOG. TO PREVENT RUNOFF FROM FLOWING AROUND THE TURN THE ENDS OF EACH ROW OF LOGS UPSLOPE9. SIZE TO HOLD LOGS IN PLACE. ON TOP OF LOGS & SHALL BE OF SUFFICIENT SANDBAGS USED AS ANCHORS SHALL BE PLACED8. WILL NOT BE PAID FOR SEPARATELY. COMPOST CRADLE MATERIAL IS INCIDENTAL &7. MESH. DO NOT PLACE STAKES THROUGH CONTAINMENT 6. THE ENGINEER. 2" PROTRUDES ABOVE LOG, OR AS DIRECTED BY #3 REBAR, 2'-4' LONG, EMBEDDED SUCH THAT STAKES SHALL BE 2" X 2" WOOD OR5. DEFORMATION. SPECIFIED IN THE PLANS WITHOUT EXCESSIVE TO ACHIEVE THE MINIMUM COMPACTED DIAMETER FILL LOGS WITH SUFFICIENT FILTER MATERIAL4. USE RECYCLABLE CONTAINMENT MESH. SYSTEM. FOR TEMPORARY INSTALLATIONS, REMAIN IN PLACE AS PART OF A VEGETATIVE CONTAINMENT MESH ONLY WHERE LOG WILL BIODEGRADABLE OR PHOTODEGRADABLE UNLESS OTHERWISE DIRECTED, USE3. THE PURPOSE INTENDED. RECOMMENDATIONS AND AS REQUIRED FOR BE IN ACCORDANCE WITH MANUFACTURER'S LENGTHS OF EROSION CONTROL LOGS SHALL2. ENGINEER. RECOMMENDATIONS, OR AS DIRECTED BY THE IN ACCORDANCE WITH MANFACTURER'S EROSION CONTROL LOGS SHALL BE INSTALLED1. CL-D CL-BOC CL-ROW CL-SST CL-SSL CL-DI CL-CI EROSION CONTROL LOG DAM EROSION CONTROL LOG AT DROP INLET EROSION CONTROL LOG AT CURB INLET EROSION CONTROL LOG AT CURB & GRATE INLET LEGEND EROSION CONTROL LOG AT EDGE OF RIGHT-OF-WAY STAKE AND TRENCHING ANCHORING EROSION CONTROL LOGS ON SLOPES STAKE AND LASHING ANCHORING EROSION CONTROL LOGS ON SLOPES EROSION CONTROL LOG AT BACK OF CURB DN:FILE: DENTON JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT EC(9)-16 Standard Division Design JULY 2016C TxDOT: TxDOT POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, ec916 178 EROSION CONTROL LOG CK:DW:KM LSLS/PT CK:TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:DIAMETER COMPACTED MINIMUM DIAMETER COMPACTED MINIMUM FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec916-01.dgn8/5/2020SEDIMENT BASIN & TRAP USAGE GUIDELINES 3. Just before the drainage enters a water course 4. Just before the drainage leaves the right of way 1. Within drainage ditches spaced as needed or min. 500' on center sediment out of runoff draining from an unstabilized area. 2. Immediately preceding ditch inlets or drain inlets limits where drainage flows away from the project. 5. Just before the drainage leaves the construction will not be paid for separately. Cleaning and removal of accumulated sediment deposits is incidental and An erosion control log sediment trap may be used to filter Log Traps: The drainage area for a sediment trap should not exceed 5 acres. The trap capacity should be 1800 CF/Acre (0.5" over the drainage area). Control logs should be placed in the following locations: The logs should be cleaned when the sediment has accumulated to a depth of 1/2 the log diameter. SHEET 2 OF 3 TOE OF SLOPE 5'-0" ABOVE STAGGER JOINTS 5'-0" TO 10'-0" STAGGER JOINTS 5'-0" TO 10'-0" STAKE NOTCH DETAIL4"STAKE ROPE NOTCH •" x •" EROSION CONTROL LOG SPACING TABLE 6"8"12" 2:1 3:1 1'2' STAKE 18" TOP OF SLOPE 6' BELOW TOP OF SLOPE EROSION CONTROL LOG TOE OF SLOPE 5'-0" ABOVE TOP OF SLOPE 6' BELOW TOP OF SLOPE EROSION CONTROL LOG 2' MINIMUM SLOPE 1:1 OR STEEPER 4:1 OR FLATTER LOG DIAMETER TRENCH DEPTH TABLE LOG DIAMETER DEPTH 6" 8" 2" 3" 4"12" MINIMUM2" MINIMUM 6" DIAMETER EROSION CONTROL LOG SLOPE ROPE NOTCH Typ STAKE 2' TO 4' LONG. or #3 REBAR, 2" x 2" WOOD CONTROL LOG. SIDE OF EROSION MATERIAL ON UPHILL PLACE EXCAVATED 12" MI NI MU MHARD, ROCKY SOILS- ADJUST ROWS FARTHER APART SOFT, LOAMY SOILS-ADJUST ROWS CLOSER TOGETHER; * ADJUSTMENTS CAN BE MADE FOR SOIL TYPE: 2' 1' OVERLAP 2' LOG CONTROL EROSION LOG CONTROL EROSION TOE OF SLOPE TOE OF SLOPE 12" 18"5"MIN.2"DISTURBED AREA DIRECTED STAKE AS OF LOG TO SECURE END 5' END SECTION RAP DETAIL UNDERCUTTING. SOIL TO PREVENT NOTE: COMPACT EXCAVATED 1' 2' MINIMUM 2' OVERLAP LOG CONTROL EROSION EVENTS HEAVY RUNOFF NEEDED FOR STAKING IF ADDITIONAL 4' TABLE BELOW) SPACING CONTROL LOG (SEE EROSION LOG SPACING TABLE BELOW) SPACING CONTROL LOG (SEE EROSION LOG SPACING 5'10'15'20' 10'20'30'40' 15'30'45'60' 20'40'60'80' STAKE AND TRENCHING ANCHORING DETAIL STAKE AND LASHING ANCHORING DETAIL CL-SST CL-SSL CL-SSLCL-SST STAKE AND TRENCHING ANCHORING EROSION CONTROL LOGS ON SLOPES STAKE AND LASHING ANCHORING EROSION CONTROL LOGS ON SLOPES DENTON DN:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT EC(9)-16 Standard Division Design JULY 2016C TxDOT: 179 TxDOT POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, EROSION CONTROL LOG ec116 CK:DW:KM LSLS/PT CK:TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec916-02.dgn8/5/2020 24"24" MINIMUM OVERLAP ENDS TIGHTLY DIRECTED STAKE AS OF LOG TO SECURE END CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION Flow ROADWAYFlow Flo wFl o wCURB FLOWFLOW CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION EROSION CONTROL LOG AREA DRAIN INLETS WITH DRAINAGE ACCESS TO COMPLETELY SURROUND Flow 6" CURB ROADWAYFlow Fl o wFl o wCURB INLET EXTENSION INLET MIN. 2 FT MIN. 2 FT GRATE INLET CURB AND EROSION CONTROL LOG AT DROP INLET CL-DI CONTROL LOG TEMP. EROSION BB 24"-30" SHEET 3 OF 3 IN PLACE (TYPICAL) LOG AS NEEDED TO HOLD ON DOWNHILL SIDE OF STAKE OR USE SANDBAGS SANDBAG SANDBAG EROSION CONTROL LOG AT CURB & GRADE INLET NEEDED OR SANDBAGS TO HOLD IN PLACE. LOGS, AT ENDS, MIDPOINT, & AS USE STAKES ON DOWNSTREAM SIDE OF TEMPORARY EROSION CONTROL LOG NEEDED OR SANDBAGS TO HOLD IN PLACE. LOGS, AT ENDS, MIDPOINT, & AS USE STAKES ON DOWNSTREAM SIDE OF 2 SAND BAGS 2 SAND BAGS STORM SEWER SYSTEM IS NOT FULLY FUNCTIONAL. TRAFFIC OR FLOOD THE ROADWAY OR WHEN THE SHOULD ONLY BE USED IF THEY WILL NOT IMPEDE EROSION CONTROL LOGS USED AT CURB INLETS NOTE: 6"-8" CL-GI DENTON DN:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT EC(9)-16 Standard Division Design JULY 2016C TxDOT: 180 TxDOT POLLUTION CONTROL MEASURES SEDIMENT AND WATER TEMPORARY EROSION, EROSION CONTROL LOG ec916 CK:DW:KM LSLS/PT CK:TxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:c:\pwworking\central01\d1285730\ec916-03.dgn8/5/2020EROSION CONTROL LOG AT CURB INLET CL-CI EROSION CONTROL LOG AT CURB INLET CL-CI SANDBAG DETAIL SECTION B-B 16"-18" DN:CK:DW:CK:FILE: JOB COUNTY SECT DIST REVISIONS HIGHWAY SHEET NO. CONT TxDOT VP AR EPIC I. STORMWATER POLLUTION PREVENTION-CLEAN WATER ACT SECTION 402 1. 2. 3. 4. ACT SECTIONS 401 AND 404 II. WORK IN OR NEAR STREAMS, WATERBODIES AND WETLANDS CLEAN WATER They may need to be notified prior to construction activities. List MS4 Operator(s) that may receive discharges from this project. Temporary Vegetation Blankets/Matting Mulch Sodding Interceptor Swale Diversion Dike Erosion Control Compost Mulch Filter Berm and Socks Compost Filter Berm and Socks Erosion Control Compost Mulch Filter Berm and Socks Compost Filter Berm and Socks Silt Fence Rock Berm Triangular Filter Dike Sand Bag Berm Straw Bale Dike Brush Berms Stone Outlet Sediment Traps Sediment Basins Vegetative Filter Strips Retention/Irrigation Systems Extended Detention Basin Constructed Wetlands Wet Basin Erosion Control Compost Mulch Filter Berm and Socks Compost Filter Berm and Socks Vegetation Lined Ditches Sand Filter Systems permit can be found on the Bridge Layouts. to be performed in the waters of the US requiring the use of a nationwide The elevation of the ordinary high water marks of any areas requiring work and post-project TSS. and check Best Management Practices planned to control erosion, sedimentation Required Actions: List waters of the US permit applies to, location in project Action No. No Action Required Required Action 1. 2. water bodies, rivers, creeks, streams, wetlands or wet areas. USACE Permit required for filling, dredging, excavating or other work in any the following permit(s): The Contractor must adhere to all of the terms and conditions associated with No Permit Required Nationwide Permit 14 - PCN Required (1/10 to <1/2 acre, 1/3 in tidal waters) Individual 404 Permit Required Other Nationwide Permit Required: NWP# wetlands affected) Nationwide Permit 14 - PCN not Required (less than 1/10th acre waters or Best Management Practices: Erosion Sedimentation Post-Construction TSS VI. HAZARDOUS MATERIALS OR CONTAMINATION ISSUES General (applies to all projects): LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS 15 working days prior to scheduled demolition. activities as necessary. The notification form to DSHS must be postmarked at least the notification, develop abatement/mitigation procedures, and perform management If "Yes", then TxDOT must retain a DSHS licensed asbestos consultant to assist with If "Yes", then TxDOT is responsible for completing asbestos assessment/inspection. If "No", then no further action is required. area to 5 acres or more, submit NOI to TCEQ and the Engineer. 4. When Contractor project specific locations (PSL's) increase disturbed soil the site, accessible to the public and TCEQ, EPA or other inspectors. 3. Post Construction Site Notice (CSN) with SW3P information on or near required by the Engineer. 2. Comply with the SW3P and revise when necessary to control pollution or accordance with TPDES Permit TXR 150000 1. Prevent stormwater pollution by controlling erosion and sedimentation in products which may be hazardous. Maintain product labelling as required by the Act. compounds or additives. Provide protected storage, off bare ground and covered, for Paints, acids, solvents, asphalt products, chemical additives, fuels and concrete curing used on the project, which may include, but are not limited to the following categories: Obtain and keep on-site Material Safety Data Sheets (MSDS) for all hazardous products NOI: Notice of Intent NWP: Nationwide Permit NOT: Notice of Termination MBTA: Migratory Bird Treaty Act MS4: Municipal Separate Stormwater Sewer System MOU: Memorandum of Understanding MOA: Memorandum of Agreement FHWA: Federal Highway Administration DSHS: Texas Department of State Health Services CGP: Construction General Permit BMP: Best Management Practice Contact the Engineer if any of the following are detected: * Evidence of leaching or seepage of substances * Undesirable smells or odors * Trash piles, drums, canister, barrels, etc. * Dead or distressed vegetation (not identified as normal) replacements (bridge class structures not including box culverts)? Does the project involve any bridge class structure rehabilitation or Yes No (includes regional issues such as Edwards Aquifer District, etc.) Action No. 1. 2. 3. No Action Required Required Action Are the results of the asbestos inspection positive (is asbestos present)? Yes No VII. OTHER ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES Item 506. disturbed soil must protect for erosion and sedimentation in accordance with required for projects with 1 or more acres disturbed soil. Projects with any TPDES TXR 150000: Stormwater Discharge Permit or Construction General Permit ENVIRONMENTAL PERMITS, ISSUES AND COMMITMENTS Standard Division Design Engineer immediately. are discovered, cease work in the immediate area, and contact the nesting season of the birds associated with the nests. If caves or sinkholes work may not remove active nests from bridges and other structures during do not disturb species or habitat and contact the Engineer immediately. The If any of the listed species are observed, cease work in the immediate area, provided with personal protective equipment appropriate for any hazardous materials used. making workers aware of potential hazards in the workplace. Ensure that all workers are hazardous materials by conducting safety meetings prior to beginning construction and Comply with the Hazard Communication Act (the Act) for personnel who will be working with of all product spills. immediately. The Contractor shall be responsible for the proper containment and cleanup in accordance with safe work practices, and contact the District Spill Coordinator In the event of a spill, take actions to mitigate the spill as indicated in the MSDS, Maintain an adequate supply of on-site spill response materials, as indicated in the MSDS. Action No. 1. 2. 3. No Action Required Required Action on site. Hazardous Materials or Contamination Issues Specific to this Project: Any other evidence indicating possible hazardous materials or contamination discovered scheduled demolition. If "No", then TxDOT is still required to notify DSHS 15 working days prior to any asbestos consultant in order to minimize construction delays and subsequent claims. activities and/or demolition with careful coordination between the Engineer and In either case, the Contractor is responsible for providing the date(s) for abatement USFWS: U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service USACE: U.S. Army Corps of Engineers T&E: Threatened and Endangered Species TxDOT: Texas Department of Transportation TPWD: Texas Parks and Wildlife Department TPDES: Texas Pollutant Discharge Elimination System TCEQ: Texas Commission on Environmental Quality PSL: Project Specific Location PCN: Pre-Construction Notification SW3P: Storm Water Pollution Prevention Plan SPCC: Spill Prevention Control and Countermeasure III. CULTURAL RESOURCES No Action Required Required Action Action No. 1. 2. 3. 4. IV. VEGETATION RESOURCES work in the immediate area and contact the Engineer immediately. archeological artifacts (bones, burnt rock, flint, pottery, etc.) cease archeological artifacts are found during construction. Upon discovery of Refer to TxDOT Standard Specifications in the event historical issues or invasive species, beneficial landscaping, and tree/brush removal commitments. 164, 192, 193, 506, 730, 751, 752 in order to comply with requirements for Contractor must adhere to Construction Specification Requirements Specs 162, Preserve native vegetation to the extent practical. No Action Required Required Action Action No. 1. 2. 3. 4. AND MIGRATORY BIRDS. CRITICAL HABITAT, STATE LISTED SPECIES, CANDIDATE SPECIES V. FEDERAL LISTED, PROPOSED THREATENED, ENDANGERED SPECIES, No Action Required Required Action Action No. 1. 2. 3. 4. Grassy Swales 12-12-2011 (DS) 05-07-14 ADDED NOTE SECTION IV. TO ITEM 506, ADDED GRASSY SWALES. 01-23-2015 SECTION I (CHANGED ITEM 1122 C TxDOT:February 2015 epic.dgn RGTxDOT assumes no responsibility for the conversion of this standard to other formats or for incorrect results or damages resulting from its use.The use of this standard is governed by the "Texas Engineering Practice Act". No warranty of any kind is made by TxDOT for any purpose whatsoever. DISCLAIMER:FILE:DATE:X X X X X X X X X X 181 XX1 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 640 640 101+50.00 640 640 645 645 102+00.00 645 645 650 650 102+50.00 645 645 650 650 103+00.00 645 645 650 650 103+50.00 VARIES639.9520.98639.7429.30639.0337.79R.O.W.R.O.W.VARIES642.0021.96641.3434.50641.7040.18R.O.W.R.O.W.VARIES 643.7438.53643.3434.50644.1023.10R.O.W.R.O.W.VARIES645.3427.65644.9234.50645.4239.00648.0043.30648.0644.87648.6754.99CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:21 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX2 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 645 645 650 650 104+00.00 645 645 104+50.00 645 645 105+00.00 105+50.00 106+00.00 106+50.00 107+00.00 107+50.00 108+00.00 108+50.00 644.4025.73644.3626.94644.5131.56CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:22 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: NOTTINGHAM DRIVE & UNIVERSITY DRIVE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 56+00.00 640 640 56+50.00 640 640 57+00.00 640 640 57+50.00 640 640 58+00.00 XX3 645.3732.49640.6851.92645.6822.224 :1 4 :1 VARIES646.0622.54645.6843.13641.0461.694 :1VARIES646.2722.87646.0643.34641.1462.964:1 VARIES 646.1244.46641.4763.07646.3423.204 :1 VARIES CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:25 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 640 640 58+50.00 640 640 59+00.00 640 640 59+50.00 640 640 60+00.00 XX4 4 :1 VARIES 642.5147.12646.8629.42646.8122.10646.1223.37645.6245.57642.4058.424:1 VARIES 4:1 642.3859.94645.6946.68646.2123.28646.4322.47646.2635.54642.8149.544:1 VARIESVARIES 4:1 VARIESVARIES 642.9448.79645.9436.79646.2722.64646.2023.37645.5747.79643.1157.674:1 VARIES VARIES 645.0028.86646.1729.82645.7148.96643.6964.059:1 0% 5:1 CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:26 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 640 640 60+50.00 640 640 61+00.00 640 640 645 645 61+50.00 XX5 3:13:13:1 VARIESVARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 645.8139.04645.7939.01642.9546.14646.1428.00643.0852.007:1 2:1 COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST 2:1 VARIES COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST VARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 644.4350.54645.6839.00646.1328.00646.2727.09645.8339.00643.9952.00648.5763.16643.9445.556:1 2' CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:27 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 635 635 640 640 645 645 62+00.00 640 640 645 645 650 650 62+50.00 XX6 2:1 COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST 2:1 VARIES COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST VARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 3:1 649.2962.86644.8952.00646.3639.00646.7427.65646.2928.00645.7539.00644.9550.67643.9946.232:10%2' 2:1 5 :1 COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST 2:1 VARIES COLUMN LOCATION PROJECTED EXIST VARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 644.3246.50647.0628.00647.0827.89646.6239.00645.2852.00649.6363.03646.6039.00645.0050.673:10% 2' CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:28 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 640 640 645 645 63+00.00 645 645 63+50.00 645 645 64+00.00 645 645 64+50.00 XX7 3:1 VARIESVARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 8 :1 2:1 645.5452.00647.9758.86646.8339.00647.4228.06647.5628.00647.0239.00644.7746.50645.8050.562:10%3:1VARIES 3:1646.0153.22646.5257.23648.6628.00648.6528.41648.0044.08646.3859.37647.9744.58645.9456.56VARIES SSCB W/TRF SSCB W/TRF 0% 3:1 4:1 VARIESVARIES 648.4748.15650.5540.24651.0128.19651.0328.27650.1951.01648.0561.42648.8366.684:1 0% 4:1 CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:30 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 645 645 65+00.00 65+50.00 650 650 66+00.00 650 650 66+50.00 67+00.00 XX8 4:1 4:1 VARIESVARIES 649.1060.00651.1050.00652.1727.24652.1327.62651.5939.00650.5945.00650.5567.784:1 0% 4:1 4:1 4:1 VARIESVARIES 651.2260.00652.3766.60653.2250.00654.0426.39653.4026.84652.6939.00651.6945.00652.1748.904:1 0% 4:1 4:1 4:1 VARIESVARIES 653.8347.26653.7645.00654.7639.00655.4025.83655.4925.53654.3850.00652.3860.00654.1669.124:1 0% 4:1 CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:31 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 4 :14:1 VARIESVARIES656.0669.95653.9159.29655.9149.36657.2124.68657.1925.03656.5437.34655.5443.36655.7146.054 :10% 4:1 SURVEY ROW OUTSIDE 4:1 VARIESVARIES658.1666.32658.3245.80656.2155.92659.4424.78658.9635.67657.2342.564 :1 0% 4:1 SURVEY ROW OUTSIDE 8/5/2020 00 1010 2020 3030 4040 5050 606070 655 655 67+50.00 68+00.00 660 660 68+50.00 69+00.00 69+50.00 70+00.00 70+50.00 XX9 4:1 VARIESVARIES660.1056.36660.8437.81661.5622.98661.7324.03661.3334.01659.3241.97658.6647.934 :1 2% 4:1 SURVEY ROW OUTSIDE 4:1 VARIESVARIES 661.4241.56663.7432.34664.0923.61664.1122.43663.8129.81661.7639.940% 4:1 ROW OUTSIDE SURVEY VARIESVARIES 663.8636.07666.6924.76666.7722.45666.7223.41666.4730.67664.1439.914:1 SURVEY ROW OUTSIDE 4:1 4:1 VARIES 4:1 VARIES 4:1 VARIES CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:32 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: SHERMAN DRIVE & LOOP 288 SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX10 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 665 665 670 670 102+00.00 665 665 670 670 102+50.00 665 665 670 670 103+00.00 665 665 670 670 103+50.00 104+00.00 665.923212.5936665.922515.8177663.7824.394:1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.666.2612.84666.2616.87663.6327.414 :1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.667.0413.07666.9317.94664.6427.064 :1VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.667.8613.30667.8619.02664.8531.044 :1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:35 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX11 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 665 665 670 670 104+50.00 670 670 675 675 105+00.00 670 670 675 675 105+50.00 670 670 675 675 106+00.00 670 670 675 675 106+50.00 669.0113.66668.9621.20666.3631.604:1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.669.9213.66669.9522.31666.6835.414 :1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.670.6412.88670.6723.43667.6835.414:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.671.1012.70671.1424.56668.0936.784:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.671.9213.40671.9425.70669.0837.184:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:36 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX12 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 670 670 675 675 107+00.00 675 675 107+50.00 675 675 108+00.00 108+50.00 675 675 680 680 109+00.00 675 675 680 680 109+50.00 672.5111.50672.5826.50670.0036.834:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.673.2611.62673.3126.50671.0735.504 :1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.673.1811.50672.8524.25672.1132.934:1 VARIES674.6614.42673.8736.21673.5342.463:1 VARIES675.1311.50675.1626.50672.8735.684 :1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:37 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX13 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 675 675 680 680 110+00.00 675 675 680 680 110+50.00 675 675 680 680 111+00.00 675 675 680 680 111+50.00 675 675 680 680 112+00.00 675.0711.50674.8626.50672.6835.224:1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.675.0211.50675.1826.50672.7336.284:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.675.1011.50674.8326.50672.9034.224 :1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.675.4011.50675.5526.50672.3539.294:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.675.0118.54674.9826.50671.9738.534:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:39 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 8/5/2020 XX14 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 675 675 680 680 112+50.00 675 675 113+00.00 675 675 680 680 113+50.00 675 675 680 680 114+00.00 675 675 114+50.00 CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:40 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS675.1421.63675.1426.50671.9139.424:1 VARIESR.O.W.R.O.W.674.3423.95674.1326.50VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.674.6024.12674.6026.50670.8541.494 :1VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.674.6424.28674.6426.50670.8741.594 :1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.674.5324.86674.5326.50671.0840.324:1 VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.8/5/2020 XX15 00 00 1010 1010 2020 2020 3030 3030 4040 4040 5050 5050 6060 6060 7070 7070 675 675 680 680 115+00.00 CROSS SECTIONS 5'10'HOR 1" = 10' VER 1" = 10'SCALE:10160405.tbl1:10PENTABLE:1:53:41 PMTIME:\DATE:8/5/2020TXDOT_PDF_BW.pltcfgPLOT DRIVER:BVERWIJSTUSER:FILE:972.960.4400 Dallas, Texas 75248-1229 17111 Preston Road, Suite 300 Firm Registration No. F-754 HDR0 DATE 8/5/2020 SCALE DESIGNED BY: PROJ. ENGR.: PROJECT # DATE REVISIONENTERED BY: CHECKED BY: LOCUST STREET & HERCULES LANE SHEET No. S TATE OF T EXAS P R OFE S SIONAL ENGINEER127741 LICENSED BRIAN VERWIJST 2019 INTERSECTION IMPROVEMENTS 674.0325.24674.0326.52VARIES R.O.W.R.O.W.8/5/2020